J9JC9B0M DIVINA on COMMERCIAL LAW A Comprehensive Guide Volume II NILO T. DIVINA Published & Distributed by yW REX Book Store $ 856 Nlcanor Reyes, Sr. St Tel. Nos.: 8736-0567/8733-6746 2161-65 Freedom Bldg., C.M. Recto Avenue Tel. Nos.: 8522-4521/8522-4107 Manila, Philippines www.rex.com.ph w J9JC9B0M FOREWORD Among the different fields of law, commercial law has perhaps the most practical and utilitarian application in this day and age of incessant innovation, interconnectedness, and technological breakthroughs. Indeed, we engage in a myriad of commercial transactions on a daily basis, ranging from the more mundane activities of booking public transport and having our basic commodities delivered through thirdparty couriers, to the more complex pursuits such as business mergers and consolidations, and even corporate rehabilitation or liquidation. These matters and a whole lot more are given stability and structure through the different facets of commercial law, which, for its extensiveness and breadth, has become an indispensable aspect of today’s society and its ever-evolving future. In a sense, commerce is the lifeblood of a nation. As such, it is vital that our aptitude and understanding of commercial law be continuously honed. Emblematic of the subject, the commercial law qualities of practicality and utility are likewise reflected in this new undertaking of Dean Nilo T. Divina, whose expertise and experience in the field are i nsight fully showcased in this compendium of questions. In particular, Dean Divina craftily weaves various topics and issues in the realm of insurance, pre-need plans, transportation (including air transportation), partnerships, and corporate law, into useful hypotheticals that are intelligibly answered in order to convey the underlying essentials of each subject matter. In the same vein, fundamental definitions and enumerations for each subject are included, providing the reader an effective memory aid that is easy to follow. Truly, this book, with its clear, concise, and simple presentation, but comprehensive scope, will surely serve as an important tool not only for law practitioners and law students alike, but also to the layman who has a legitimate desire to familiarize himself with the basic concepts as well as seemingly intricate workings of commercial law. I would like to congratulate Dean Divina for this momentous effort well done. This comprehensive guide should be considered as an important resource in the field of commercial law that is definitely worthy of praise and commendation. 16 April 2021 ESTELA M^Rl/kS-BERNABE :reas-bernabe Senior Associate Justice Supreme Court of the Philippines iii J9JC9B0M iv J J9JC9B0M FOREWORD The motivational writer Paul j. Meyer once said: “Productivity is never an accident It is always the result of commitment to excellence, intelligent planning and focused effort" Never has this observation been as valid as when applied to the intellectual fecundity of UST Law Dean Nilo T. Divina, noted law practitioner and professor, a much sought after lecturer, respected academician, and best-selling author of law books. Nary has a year passed since the launch, against all pandemic odds, of his treatise on Philippine Corporation Law, when again today he astounds the legal community with a 2-volume 1,286 - page compendium on Philippine commercial law. The author examines, analyzes and deconstructs into understandable concepts our laws on insurance, pre-need companies, transportation, securities, banking, intellectual property, anti-money laundering, investments, data privacy and competition. Most remarkable is that he has conjoined all these separate pieces of legislation into just one instrument for easy and convenient research and reference. Generously spread all over it are annotations of provisions of commercial law, pertinent jurisprudence, and insightful commentaries reflective of the knowledge, wisdom and experience acquired by the writer as a staunch disciple of the law. Without question, this work is the result of the Dean's continuous pursuit of excellence most especially in that ratified discipline of legal scholarship and pedagogy. Commercial law has never been the cup of tea of a lot of law students, which most probably accounts for their comparably low ratings on the subject in bar examinations. In their law course, they plod through what they perceive, rightly or wrongly, as endless arid landscapes of v J9JC9B0M negotiable instruments, insurance, banking, securities, business organizations, investments ... laws seemingly divested of the human dimension, all too often absent the flesh and blood facets of, for example, family law or criminal law. But as in all Divina law books this work upends this perception. The dissection of commercial laws is done through a different perspective and methodology. Aimed at demystifying and decluttering the law, the treatise is underpinned by an undefinable sense of reaching out to and connecting with the humaneness of the reader. For the work in its entirety is understandable: its language intelligent but simple and clear, not at all opaque nor obsfuscatory which is oftentimes the hallmark of the intellectually pretentious. In other words, it is shorn of aoristicism and prolixity, as it adopts a style that is an honest-togoodness down-to-earth Q and A, all of which make for readability, easier comprehension as well as sufficiently good, if not total, recall. Entitled Divina on Commercial Law: A Comprehensive Guide and described as an opus ex caritate, the book is a welcome offering to the law academe and studentry, law practitioners, members of the bench, and even to non-lawyers as well. It is for this reason that the Legal Education Board is deeply indebted and grateful to Dean Nilo for his continuing efforts in contributing to the enhancement of the quality of legal education in the country. Thus, we say: Mabuhay, Dean! CCCQMlWob / ZENA1DA Nl ELEPANO Commissioner and Officer-in-Charge Legal Education Board Manila, Philippines vi J9JC9B0M FOREWORD Divina on Commercial Law: A Comprehensive Guide Knowledge production is the lifeblood of any field or discipline. It nurtures academic engagements by introducing new ideas and concepts as well as encourages a paradigm shift that may be rendered trail-blazing and cutting edge. It is integral for every field of study to challenge existing norms and codes in order for it to become up-to-date and relevant. The work dore by scholars and academics is never-ending. They constantly review current literature to see the gaps that require filling and in the process change the way people think and make them subscribe to a novel idea. Commercial Law is a vast field that benefits further study and explication since it covers various areas such as Insurance, Securities, Banking, Business Establishments, among others. Years of excellent law practice, dynamic leadership, a voluminous contribution to law literature that comes in the form of scholarly work and academic treatises, and a solid reputation that extends beyond Philippine shores, Atty. Nilo Divina is a stalwart in the field of law, capable of discoursing on this particular branch of law. Despite the growing number of business organizations in the country, there are still many things that professionals can learn about the dynamics and dimensions of Commercial Law. This is precisely the reason why there is a need to gain an understanding of the many complexities of Commercial Law from an expert like Atty. Nilo Divina. Atty. Nilo Divina, one of the country's top lawyers, once again publishes an important volume on commercial law. Divina's opus examines the subject point by point, which is counterpoised with popular myths and misconceptions regarding commercial law, and analyzes it by providing important cases as examples which highlight in his discussion binding agreements, standard rules and rights, interpretations and misinterpretations, exceptions, exemptions and entitlements, special interests and potential risks, benefits and liabilities, subtleties and severities. The book "Divina on Commercial Law" provides an in-depth look into the many facets of commercial law which will surely be the go-to reference book by students of law and law practitioners. The book is organized in such a way that it facilitates easy reading. The flow of the author's language is smooth; his grasp of the legal jargon, clear and precise. "Divina on Commercial Law" is a musthave for every law firm, law school, insurance company, and for anyone who wishes to further understand the many intricacies of the laws governing business and commerce, as the author immediately goes into the heart of the matter in a style that is akin to some of the best author­ barristers in the world. Indeed, Divina's new book is a major contribution to the field of law. 7^7 REV. HC RICHARD gZ\NG. O-P. Rec/or vii J9JC9B0M 1 viii J9JC9B0M FOREWORD Let me start by proudly saying that among the law deans in various law schools, only Dean Nilo T. Divina of the UST Faculty of Civil Law has produced bar topnotchers. In 2017, UST regained its past gZr/ as the best law school in the country. Dean Divina is not only an academician, but also a scholar, a bar topnotcher, a distinguished law practitioner, a prolific writer, and an Ideal family man. Above all, he is a benefactor. His reasons for writing this book is not only to lead his readers to the intricate realm of commercial law, but also to grant scholarships, derived from its proceeds, to academically deserving students and to enable law students to acquire it at a very reasonable price. When I asked him how he could write this two-volume work despite the pandemic, Dean Divina laughingly answered, "Because I love students." This statement is a window to his soul. Unquestionably, this book is a treasury of knowledge Influenced not only by Dean Divina's brilliance of mind, but also by his dose to 30 years of law practice and extensive work in the academe. It is said that genuine knowledge originates directly from a wide range of experience. Being a clear showcase of the author's ability to capture what is basic and vital in commercial law, the book in its entirety is thoroughly interesting and instructive. Thus, through a Socratic Q and A style, it presents a wonderful compact survey of the laws on Insurance, Pre-need Company, Transportation, Business Organizations, Securities, General Banking, and many other fields of commercial law. It contains annotations of cited laws usually intertwined with relevant Supreme Court Decisions. Not only that. Dean Divina's discourse thereon gives the readers a glimpse of his mindset and a chance to appreaate and assimilate its wisdom. Significantly, he evokes a web of legal and judicial issues, enough to send any assiduous reader to his or her study. As the title Indicates, this book is an excellent comprehensive guide to aspiring law students, academicians, bar reviewers, practitioners, members of the judiciary, and even lay persons as they journey on the winding road of commercial law. It is the answer to the continuing quest for knowledge of men and women of law. What makes this book impressive is its mode of educating its readers. Preeminent for his legal craftsmanship, Dean Divina's Q and A are well written, indeed "as dear and ludd as the fabled skies of Greece." Anyone who reads this book will readily grasp and remember what it imparts. Truly, a must read. The "Divina on Commercial Law" is a crowning masterpiece and a legacy of a great mind. Justice Angelina Sandoval-Gutierrez (Ret.) * Vice Chairperson - Judicial Integrity Board, Supreme Court Former Chair - MCLE Governing Board ix J9JC9B0M X J9JC9B0M FOREWORD “The field of commercial law serves as the backbone of a vibrant economic environment. Practitioners in commercial law have to be constantly abreast with the latest regulatory frameworks and jurisprudence. Dean Nilo Divina’s book weaves basic principles, hypothetical cases, and constructive views in a seamless narrative of the vast area of commercial law. The set of materials discussed by the author is useful for different readers, such as, law students, bar reviewees and practitioners. Legal researchers would definitely find more than enough leads in preparing pleadings and authoritative opinions. There is an enticing incentive to exhaust the entire text of this guidebook on account of the innovative pedagogical style employed by the author to clarify concepts and apply these to case facts. The author’s years of commercial law practice become evident in his occasional comments on difficult questions of law. This commendable piece of contribution to legal scholarship in this country ranks among the invaluable roster of commercial law materials to this date. I personally encourage Dean Nilo Divina to further pursue his goal of selflessly sharing his knowledge in this fast developing field of law. He has truly demonstrated his untiring commitment to the bar.” (Sgd.) DEAN SEDFREY M. CANDELARIA Officer-in-Charge, Mandatory Continuing Legal Education Board Chief of Office, Research, Publication and Linkages, Philippine Judicial Academy Former President of Philippine Association of Law School xi J9JC9B0M xii J9JC9B0M FOREWORD It has not even been a year, but I find myself with yet another Divina manuscript on a subject matter he can talk about in his sleep. Divina on Commercial Law - A Comprehensive Guide will hit the stands in the wake of the bestselling Questions & Answers on the Revised Corporation Code. Similar to its predecessor, this 2-volume compendium is responsive as it is instructive. No other commercial law reviewer would include laws such as Transportation Law, Personal Property Securities, Financial Rehabilitation and Insolvency, Data Privacy and Philippine Competition, among others, all in one line-up. The rationalized compilation of laws that are commercial in nature and application will definitely facilitate cohesion in learning and appreciation. With the limited text out there on the new laws, this comprehensive guide will serve well as a beacon for the uninitiated and eager to leam. It would be of note to point out that these are the only volumes available that would provide a faithful compilation of all the laws covered by the mercantile law scope of the current bar examinations. But more than the novelty of the collection and the content is the benevolence characteristic of the author that accompanies this latest addition to our legal archives. This book is another testament to Dean Nilo’s commitment to make legal education accessible to as many who wish to embrace it. Making this book affordable is an exercise in compassion that finds its very core in the heart of a healing world. The legal academe is once again grateful to Dean Divina for this outstanding effort to endow students and practitioners alike with this excellent presentation of existing laws and recent initiatives that enriches our commercial law framework. Congratulations! Chair xiii prL DL ANENIAS >on and President J9JC9B0M 1 xiv J9JC9B0M FOREWORD Commercial Law as a study and practice has always been marked by dynamism. The transformation our mercantile laws has undergone over the years reflects the volatility of the relations they govern. For no other field is as rapidly evolving and changing as commerce, trade, and business. Rightfully so, the universal clamor for a compact material that would capture the nucleus of the expanding commercial law subjects has long been overdue. For good measure, Dean Nilo Divina’s treatise, DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A Comprehensive Guide, becomes a most welcome addition to the growing literature of Commercial Law in the Philippines. While reference materials on the subject have been plenty, no other opus has better presented the course in a very reader-friendly, question-and-answer format. As Commercial Law has often been viewed by many to be very “mechanical” and “off-putting” owing to its highly specialized nature, the book departs from the verbose “legalese” that has intimidated many law students in their study of the subject. Dean Nilo has found a way to weather the technical tangles by presenting key doctrinal pronouncements in a straight-forward and conversational manner. This he does with uncompromising depth and thoroughness. This book, thus, acutely accomplishes its aim to infuse readers with synthesized doctrinal pronouncements and core knowledge that they can easily connect with practical applications and scenarios. I take special admiration of the book’s ability to weave the codal provisions and jurisprudence with the author’s annotations and commentaries. This addresses the common challenge students face in approaching the subject—the ability to make the necessary connections and formulate sound conclusions. Moreover, the inclusion of recent BAR exam questions, with sections devoted to defining key terms, rules, and concepts, makes this manual a complete guide for the bar reviewee. XV J9JC9B0M Dean Divina has painted for us a detailed anatomy of the laws governing our mercantile system. Comprehensive in scope, versatile in form, and uncompromising in content, Divina on Commercial Law: A Comprehensive Guide is an astute companion for law students, bar examinees, and legal practitioners alike. (Sgd.) DEAN JOAN S. LARGO Former President of Philippine Association of Law Schools Assistant Vice President for Academic Affairs, University of San Carlos xvi ■ J9JC9B0M FOREWORD Divina on Commercial l^w is an all-encompassing guide to the subject matter that will prove to be useful to undergraduates, bar reviewees and practitioners alike. I he text covers a wide variety of subtopics covering the whole gamut of commercial law. The language is straight to the point and coherent, allowing for a logical transition from one topic to the next. Situational examples are used to illustrate the principles for a concretized understanding of the concepts discussed in the text. In this light, the reviewer goes beyond presenting mere facts. However, what sets this reviewer apart from the others is its unique writing style: the question-and-answer format simulates the essence of the test-taking experience, making the hook an excellent supplementary material for bar reviewees. In the decades 1 have spent conducting bar reviews, most of the materials I have come across relied solely on the reviewees’ ability to question their own understanding of the information they absorb. Divina on Commercial Law attends to that concern— the need to repeatedly question oneself for the purpose of refining one's understanding of the subject. All in all, this brilliant work is a thorough and well-constructed educational material that I would highly recommend to anyone interested in developing their knowledge of commercial law. ATTY. ALDEN FRANCIS^. GONZALES President, Magnificus jfrfis Reviews and Seminars Inc. xvii J9JC9B0M xviii J9JC9B0M FOREWORD The review center believes that the use of scientifically written books will help bar candidates in their pursuit to successfully hurdle the bar examinations. Dean Divina’s latest published works — the two-volume Compendium on Commercial Law - are epitomes of scientific learning. It contains annotations of laws and decisions of the Supreme Court, which are organized in accordance with the 2020/2021 Bar Examinations Syllabus on Commercial Law. Engagingly, it is written in Q-and-A format, for easy understanding and retention. This Compendium on Commercial Law is a must-read for every bar candidate. One can never go wrong with the 30 years of academic and law practice of our legal luminary, Dean Nilo T. Divina. (Sgd.) ATTY. ARGEL JOSEPH T. CABATBAT Review Director, Legal Edge Experts Review Center, Inc. xix J9JC9B0M 1 I •; Cb:.' . I:. : . 1 XX J . J9JC9B0M CONTENTS Forewords Estela M. Perlas-Bernabe Zenaida N. Elepano Rev. Fr. Richard G. Ang, O.P Justice Angelina Sandoval-Gutierrez Dean Sedfrey M. Candelaria Marisol DL Anenias.............................. Dean Joan S. Largo Alden Francis C. Gonzales Argel Joseph T. Cabatbat iii v vii ix xi xiii XV xvii xix V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE R.A. No. 8799 1 22 33 34 34 State Policy Preferred Shares Issuance Civil liability Administrative sanctions Criminal liability VI. BANKING The New Central Bank Act State policies Creation of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas .... Corporate powers Operations of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas Authority to obtain data and information Supervision and examination Bank deposits and investments Prohibitions Examinations and fees Monetary Board; powers and functions xxi 80 80 81 82 S3 83 84 85 86 87 8S J9JC9B0M How the Bmigko Sent nil ng Pilipinus handles banka in distress Conservatorship Administrative sanctions on supervised entities Rules on bank deposits and invest ments by directors, officers. stockholders and their related interests Supervision and regulation of bank operations Law on Secrecy of Philippine Currency Bank Deposits (R.A. No. 1405) Purpose ........................................................................ Written permission of the depositor Order of a competent court Briber.- or dereliction of duty of public officials; prosecution for unexplained wealth; prosecution for violation of the Anti-Graft and Corrupt Practices Act Where the subject matter of litigation is the money deposited Violation of the anti-money laundering law Authority of BIR Garnishment of bank deposits Unclaimed Balances law Repeal or amendment of the law General Banking Law (R.A. No. 8791) Definition and classification of banks Distinction of banks from quasi-banks and trust entities Bank powers and liabilities Corporate Powers Banking and incidental powers Diligence required of banks in view of the fiduciary nature of banking Nature of bank funds and bank deposits Grant of loans and security requirements Ratio of net worth to total risk assets Single borrower’s limit Restrictions on bank exposure to directors, officers, stockholders and their related interest Foreclosure of mortgage by banks Floating interest rate and escalation clause Penalties for violations Fine, imprisonment xxii , 89 89 105 107 107 108 108 111 112 113 114 116 118 118 123 125 126 126 133 134 134 138 139 140 141 141 143 145 149 157 162 162 J9JC9B0M SiiHpcniiion or removal of director or officer... Dissolution of banka............................................ . Anti-Money Laundering Law . (R.A. No. 9160, as amended) Policy of the law............................................................ Covered institutions/persons and their obligations Covered and suspicious transactions........................ Money laundering-how committed and unlawful activities....................................................... Functions of the AMLC............................................... Application for a freeze order..................................... Safe harbor provision................................................... Forfeiture provisions..................................................... Mutual assistance among states................................ Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation............. Basic Policy..................................................................... Powers and functions of PDIC................................... Concept of insured deposit.......................................... Liability to depositors.................................................. Deposit liabilities required to be insured with PDIC........................................... Commencement of liability................................ Deposit accounts not entitled to payment..... Extent of liability 187 Determination of insured deposits and calculation of liability...................... Mode of payment................................................. Effect of payment of insured deposit/ preferred credit................................. Failure of depositor to claim insured deposits............................................... Examination of banks and deposit accounts. Splitting of deposits............................................ Prohibition against issuances of temporary restraining order.............................. Concept of bank resolution......................................... Role of PDIC in relation to banks in distress........ Truth in Lending Act (RA No. 3765)........................ 162 162 163 163 163 166 168 173 175 180 181 182 183 183 184 184 185 186 187 187 188 191 191 192 192 193 194 195 197 199 VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 202 Intellectual property rights in general................................ 202 Intellectual property rights......................................... xxiii J9JC9B0M PitYeivnces among copyright. trademarks and patents............................................................ Definition................................................................ Scope or object....................................................... Term of protection................................................. Modes of acquiring the various rights................ Patents............................................................................ Patentable invention...................................................... Non-patentable invention.............................................. Ownership of a patent................................................... Right to a patent................................................... First-to-file rule..................................................... Invention created pursuant to a commission.... Right of Priority.................................................... Grounds for cancellation of a patent.......................... Remedy of the true and actual inventor.................... Rights conferred by a patent........................................ Limitations of patent rights......................................... Patent infringement...................................................... Tests in patent infringement............................... Civil and criminal action..................................... Prescriptive period............................................... Defenses in action for infringement................... Licensing................................................................ Assignment and transmission of rights............ Trademarks............................................................................. Definition of Marks, Collective Marks, Trade Names................................................. Acquisition of ownership of mark................................ Acquisition of ownership of trade name.................... . Non-registrable marks.................................................. Immoral, deceptive, scandalous matter or falsely suggesting a connection with person, belief, institution or symbol. Name, portrait, signature of living individual Identical mark...................................................... Tests to determine confusing similarity between marks.................................... Idem sonans.......................................................... Well-known marks................................................ Rights conferred by registration.................................. Trademark Infringement.............................................. Remedies......................................................................... xxiv 206 206 207 208 208 210 212 217 218 218 220 220 221 222 223 224 225 231 233 235 238 238 240 247 247 247 250 253 253 255 256 256 257 267 273 285 289 291 J9JC9B0M Registration of nmrku under the Madrid Protocol ...................................... Coverage .............................. Rights conferred Term of protection Copyright............................................................................................. ......... Basic Principles Copyrightable Works Rights of the copyright owner Reproduction Derivative right First public distribution Rental right Right of public display Right of public performance Right of communication to the public Rules on Ownership of Copyright Limitations on Copyright Private Performance of a work Making of quotations Information purposes Under the direction and control of the government Judicial proceedings or professional advice Doctrine of fair use Copyright Infringement 300 303 303 305 305 305 307 315 318 320 320 322 322 323 323 325 331 334 335 337 338 339 340 343 VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS Guaranty Surety Real Estate Mortgage Law Personal Property Security Act (R.A. No. 11057) 357 368 372 378 IX. SPECIAL LAWS Foreign Investment Act of 1991 R.A. No. 7042, as amended by RA. No. 8179 Policy of Law A.............................. Definition of Terms Registration of Investments of Non-Philippine Nationals Foreign Investments in Export Enterprises Foreign Investments in Domestic Market Enterprises Foreign Investment Negative List XXV 403 408 430 430 431 432 J9JC9B0M 1 Financial Rehabilitation nnd Insolvency Act of 2010 R.A. No. 10142 Definition of Insolvency............................................... Suspension of Payments.............................................. Rehabilitation.............................................................. Types................................................................... Commencement order......................................... Stay or Suspension Order.................................. Rehabilitation Receiver....................................... Management Committee.................................... Rehabilitation Plan............................................. Cram-down effect................................................ Liquidation.................................................. Types.................................................. . Conversion of rehabilitation to liquidate proceedings................................ Liquidation Order...................................... Rights of secured creditors....................... Liquidator................................................... Determination of claims............................ Liquidation of plan.................................... 440 441 447 449 454 459 469 472 473 481 484 484 487 492 493 495 497 498 Data Privacy Act of 2012 R.A. No. 10173 500 Introduction. Philippine Competition Act 530 RA No. 10667 Trust Receipts Law P.D. No. 115 Definition/Concept of a Trust Receipt Transaction....... Ownership of the Goods, Documents and Instruments under a Trust Receipt....................................... Entrustee is the owner of the goods........................ Entrustee cannot mortgage the goods under trust receipt............................................... Validity of the Security Interest as Against the Creditors of the Entrustee/Innocent Purchaser for Value............................................................ Payment/Delivery of Proceeds of Sale or Disposition of Goods, Documents or Instrument............... xxvi 554 565 565 565 567 568 J9JC9B0M Return of Goods, Documents or Instruments in Caso of Non-Salo.................................................. . Liability for Lohh of Goods, Documents or Instruments..................................................................... Penal Sanctions if Offender is a Corporation.................... Criminal Liability of directors, officers and agents. Directors and officers of the corporation not civilly liable unless they assume personal liability.......................................................... Remedies Available................................................................. 568 569 569 569 570 571 E-Commerce Law (Electronic Commerce Act)............................................. 576 Negotiable Instruments Law.......................................... Forms and Interpretation..................................................... Requisites of negotiability............................................. Kinds of negotiable instruments................................. Completion and delivery....................................................... Insertion of Date.............................................................. Incomplete and Undelivered Instruments................. Complete but undelivered instruments..................... Signature.................................................................................. Signing in Trade Name............. ................................. Signature of Agent........................................................ Indorsement by Minor or Corporation..................... Forgery............................................................................ Consideration.......................................................................... Accommodation Party............................................................ Negotiation.............................................................................. Distinguished from Assignment................................ Modes of Negotiation................................................... Kinds of Indorsements................................................. Rights of the Holder.............................................................. Holder in Due Course.................................................. Defenses Against the Holder...................................... Liabilities of Parties.............................................................. Maker.............................................................................. Drawer............................................................................ Acceptor.......................................................................... Indorser........................................................................... Warranties..................................................................... Presentment for Payment.................................................... Necessity of Presentment for Payment................... 586 586 589 599 603 607 608 609 610 610 610 611 613 624 626 630 630 631 634 639 639 648 651 651 651 651 654 656 658 658 xxvii J9JC9B0M 1 Parties to Whom Presentment for Payment Should Be Made... Dispensation with Presentment for Payment. . Dishonor by Nonpayment Notice of Dishonor...................................................... . Parties to be Notified Parties Who May Give Notice of Dishonor .... EtYect of Notice................................................... Form of Notice..................................................... Waiver Dispensation with Notice EtYect of Failure to Give Notice Discharge of Negotiable Instrument Discharge of Negotiable Instrument Discharge of Parties Secondarily Liable Right of Party Who Discharged Instrument.. Renunciation by Holder Material Alteration Concept Effect of Material Alteration Acceptance Definition Manner Time for Acceptance Rules Governing Acceptance Presentment for Acceptance Time/Place/Manner of Presentment Effect of Failure to Make Presentment Dishonor by Nonacceptance Promissory Notes Checks Definition Kinds Presentment for Payment 660 660 661 663 663 663 664 665 665 665 667 668 668 671 671 671 672 672 673 675 675 677 678 678 679 679 680 681 682 683 683 684 688 Case Index 694 xxviii I J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) A. State Policy 1. What are the ends sought to be achieved by the enactment of the Securities Regulation Code (hereafter, SRC)? The ends sought to be achieved by the enactment of the SRC are embodied in the declaration of state policy under Section 2 thereof which provides: “The State shall establish a socially conscious, free market that regulates itself, encourage the widest participation of ownership in enterprises, enhance the democratization of wealth, promote the development of the capital market, protect investors, ensure full and fair disclosure about securities, minimize if not totally eliminate insider trading and other fraudulent or manipulative devices and practices which create distortions in the free market.” 2. What is the principal purpose of laws and regulations governing securities in the Philippines? The principal purpose of laws and regulations governing securities in the Philippines is to protect the public against nefarious practices of unscrupulous brokers and salesmen in selling securities and the imposition of worthless ventures and the sale of securities which have no basis at all. Hence, securities law provides for a system of registration of securities, registration of brokers and dealers of securities, prohibitions against manipulations and practices detrimental to the investing public and measures for the protection of investors.1 3. Why is the Securities Regulation Code called a “truth in securities law"? The Securities Regulation Code is called a “truth in securities law” because it requires the issuer to make full and fair disclosure of ‘BAR 1998. 1 J9JC9B0M 'I DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 2 information about securities being sold or offered to be sold within the Philippines and penalizes manipulative and fraudulent acts, devices, and schemes.2 4. What are the salient features of the SRC that are intended to protect the investing public? The following are the salient features of the SRC that are intended to protect the investing public: 1. Registration of securities prior to any public sale3 2. Rejection and revocation of registration of securities4 3. Regulation of pre-need plans6 4. Protection of shareholder interests6 5. Prohibitions on fraud, manipulations, and insider trading’ 6. Regulations of Securities Market Professional8 7. Revocation, refusal, or suspension of registration of brokers, dealers and salesmen, and associated persons” 8. Restrictions on “over-the-counter” markets10 9. Establishment of trust fund to compensate investors for extraordinary losses or damage they may suffer11 10. Self-regulation of associations of securities brokers, dealers, and other securities related organizations12 11. Registration of clearing agencies13 12. Limitations on margin trading14 2BAR 2015. 3Section 8, SRC. ^Section 13, SRC. 5Section 16, SRC. 6Section 19, SRC. ’Sections 24, 25, 26, and 27, SRC. “Section 28, SRC. “Section 29, SRC. ‘“Section 32, SRC. “Section 36.5, SRC. “Section 39, SRC. ‘“Section 42, SRC. “Section 49, SRC. J9JC9B0M V. HECURITIEH REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 5. 3 13. Civil liabilities from false statement in the registration10 14. Civil liabilities from false statements or omissions in the prospectus, communications, and reports10 15. Protection against: a. Manipulation of security prices, manipulative and deceptive devices” b. Fraud in pre-need plans and commodities futures contracts18 c. Fraudulent transactions10 d. Insider’s trading20 What are securities? “Securities” are shares, participation or interests in a corporation or in a commercial enterprise or profit-making venture and evidenced by a certificate, contract, instruments, whether written or electronic in character. It includes: (a) Shares of stocks, bonds, debentures, notes, evidences of indebtedness, asset-backed securities; (b) Investment contracts, certificates of interest or participation in a profit-sharing agreement, certificate of deposit for a future subscription; (c) Fractional undivided interests in oil, gas, or other mineral rights; (d) Derivatives like option and warrants; (e) Certificates of assignments, certificates of participation, trust certificates, voting trust certificates, or similar instruments; (0 Proprietary or nonproprietary membership certificates in corporations; and "“Section 56, SRC. "“Section 57, SRC. ’’Section 59, SRC. 18Section 60, SRC. I9Section 58, SRC. ’“Section 61, SRC. ■ J9JC9B0M i P1VINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 4 (g) 6. Other instruments as may in the future be determined by the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC).21 What are shares of stock? Shares of stock are forms of securities representing equity ownership of a corporation, divided up into units which indicate that the holder thereof has proportionate interest in the issuing corporation. 7. Cite examples of evidence of indebtedness, other than notes, bonds, and debentures. Other examples include commercial paper, also called CP, which is a short-term debt instrument issued by companies to raise funds generally for a time period up to one (1) year. They are typically issued by large corporations to cover short-term receivables and meet short-term financial obligations. 8. Are checks considered securities? Checks constitute mere substitutes for cash if so issued in payment of obligations in the ordinary course of business transactions. But when they are issued in exchange for a big number of individual non-personalized loans solicited from the public, the checks cease to be such. In such a circumstance, the checks assume the character of evidence of indebtedness.22 9. What is an asset-backed security? An asset-backed security (ABS) is a security, whose income payments and hence value is derived from and collateralized by a specified pool of underlying assets. For instance, when consumers take out loans, their debts become assets on the balance sheet of the lender. The lender, in turn, can sell these assets to a trust or “special purpose” vehicle which packages them into an ABS that can be sold in the market. The “special purpose” vehicle buys it at a discount and then sells to the public participations in the pool of underlying assets. As the consumers pay their debts, payments are proportionately distributed to the holders of the ABS. 2IBAR 1996. “Gabionza v. CA, G.R. No. 161057, September 12, 2008. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 10. 5 What is an investment contract? An investment contract is an investment of money in a contract, transaction, or scheme with the expectation of profits primarily from the efforts of another.23 11. TRUE or FALSE. The Howey Test is relevant in cases wherein a person invests money in a common enterprise and is led to expect profits primarily from the efforts of others. True. The Howey Test was established to determine whether a transaction falls within the scope of an “investment contract.” It requires a transaction, contract or scheme, whereby a person (1) makes an investment of money, (2) in a common enterprise, (3) with the expectation of profits, (4) to be derived solely from the efforts of others. Although the proponents must establish all four elements, the US Supreme Court stressed that the Howey Test “embodies a flexible rather than a static principle.” Our Securities Act appears to follow the flexible concept for it defines an investment contract as a contract, transaction or scheme (collectively “contract”) whereby a person invests his money in a common enterprise and is led to expect profits not solely but primarily from the efforts of others. Thus, to be a security subject to regulation by the SEC, an investment contract in our jurisdiction must be proved to be: (1) an investment of money, (2) in a common enterprise, (3) with expectation of profits, (4) primarily from efforts of others.24 12. The business scheme of Power Homes Unlimited Corporation (Power Homes) is that an investor will enroll under its program, and the latter would be entitled to recruit other investors and receive commissions from the investments of those directly recruited by him. Is Power Homes engaged in the sale of securities which must be registered? Yes. A corporation allowing a principal investor to enroll in its program by paying a certain amount, which in turn entitles him to be paid a certain amount if the recruit was able to get a 23Power Homes Unlimited Corporation v. Securities and Exchange Commission and Manero, G.R. No. 164182, February 26, 2008. uId. J9JC9B0M I 6 D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 minimum recruitment of four (4) investors, is engaged in the sale or distribution of an investment, contract. It must be registered with the SEC before its sale or offer for sale or distribution to the public, otherwise, the SEC cannot protect the investing public from fraudulent securities is founded on the premise that capital markets depend on the investing public’s level of confidence in the system.26 13. Prosperity.com, Inc. (PCI) sold computer software and hosted websites without providing internet service. It devised a scheme in which a buyer could acquire from it an internet website with 15-MB capacity. At the same time, by referring to PCI his own down-line buyers, a first-time buyer could earn commissions, interest in real estate and insurance coverage. Is PCI's scheme considered an investment contract which requires registration? No. The scheme does not satisfy the requisites of an investment contract. First, PCI’s clients do not make investments within the contemplation of Howey Test. The buyers of the website do no invest money in PCI that it could use for running some website that would generate profits for the investors.26 PCI appears to be engaged in network marketing, a scheme adopted by companies for getting people to buy their products outside the usual retail system where products are bought from the store’s shelf and where the buyer can become a down-fine seller, earning commissions from purchases made by new buyers whom he refers to the person who sold the product to him.2’ Second, the commissions, interest in real estate and insurance coverage can hardly be regarded as profits from investment of money under the Howey Test.21 These are incentives to down-line sellers to bring in other customers,29 not an investment contract. Lastly, PCI’s clients are not in expectation of profits as contemplated under the Howey Test. Rather, it is PCI that expects profit from the network marketing of its products.30 “7d. BAR 2010. “Securities and Exchange Commission 164197, January 25, 2012. 2,M. “W. mId. xId. Prosperity Com, Inc., G.R. No. J9JC9B0M V. HECURITIE8 REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 14. 7 CJH Development Corporation (CJHDC) is a real estate developer, while CJH Suites Corporation (CJHSC) is a hotel operator wholly-owned by the former. CJHDC entered into a lease agreement with the Bases Conversion and Development Authority (BCDA) for the development of a 247-hectare land into a public tourism complex. Pursuant to the development plan, CJHDC constructed two (2) condominium-hotels — "The Manor" and "The Suites." Subject to CJHDC's leasehold rights, the residential units in these condotels were offered for sale to the general public by means of two (2) schemes: The first is a straight purchase and sale contract where the buyer pays the purchase price for the unit bought, either in lump sum or on installment basis and, thereafter, enjoys the benefits of full ownership, subject to payment of maintenance dues and utility fees. The second scheme involves the sale of the unit with an added option to avail of a "leaseback" or a "money-back" arrangement. Under this added option, the buyer pays for the unit bought and, subsequently, surrenders its possession to the management of CJHDC or CJHSC. These corporations would then create a pool of these units and, in turn, will offer them for billeting under the management of the hotel operated by the Camp John Hay Leisure, Inc. (CJHLJ). This arrangement lasts for a period of fifteen (15) years with a renewal option for the same period until 2046. The buyers who opt for the "leaseback" arrangement will receive either a proportionate share in 70% of the annual income derived from the hotel operation of the pooled rooms or a guaranteed 8% return on their investment. On the other hand, those who choose to avail of the "money-back" arrangement are entitled to a return of the purchase price they paid for the units by expiration of the Lease Agreement in 2046. BCDA got wind of CJHDC's scheme and questioned its legality with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC), which issued a Cease and Desist Order against CJHDC upon a finding that the latter was engaged in the sale of securities without proper registration. CJHDC appealed the SEC's order with the CA. Is the sale of "The Manor" or "The Suites" units to the general public under the "leaseback" or "money-back scheme" a form of investment contract or sale of securities, and thus must comply with the requirements of law? Yes. The SEC arrived at a preliminary finding that CJHDC is engaged in the business of selling securities without the proper J9JC9B0M 1 8 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II registration issued by the Commission. Based on this initial finding, CJHDC’s act of selling unregistered securities would necessarily operate as fraud on investors as it deceives the investing public by making it appear that respondents have authority to deal with such securities. Section 8.1 of the Securities Regulation Code clearly states that securities shall not be sold or offered for sale or distribution within the Philippines without a registration statement duly filed with and approved by the SEC and that prior to such sale, information on the securities, in such form and with such substance as the SEC may prescribe, shall be made available to each prospective buyer. The Court agrees with the SEC that the purpose of this provision is to afford the public protection from investing in worthless securities.31 15. ASB Holdings Inc. (ASBHI) is a corporation engaged in investing in real or personal properties. Its business scheme consists of convincing investors to lend or deposit money with the corporation, and, in return, they would receive checks from ASBHI for the amount lent, invested, or deposited. The checks were drawn against DBS Bank. The number of investors ASBHI attracted was approximately 700. Is ASBHI’s business scheme considered an investment contract? Yes. Here, the checks were issued by ASB in lieu of the securities enumerated under the Revised Securities Act in a clever attempt, or so they thought, to take the case out of the purview of the law, which requires prior license to sell or deal in securities and registration thereof. The scheme was designed to circumvent the law. Checks constitute mere substitutes for cash if so issued in payment of obligations in the ordinary course of business transactions. But when they are issued in exchange for a big number of individual non-personalized loans solicited from the public, the checks ceased to be such. In such a circumstance, the checks assume the character of evidence of indebtedness. Moreover, it bears pointing out that the definition of securities set forth in Section 2 of the Revised Securities Act includes commercial papers evidencing indebtedness of any person, financial or non-financial entity, irrespective of maturity, issued, endorsed, sold, transferred, or in any manner conveyed to another. A check is a commercial paper evidencing indebtedness of any person, financial or non-financial entity. Since the checks in this 3ISEC v. CJH Development Corporation. G.R. No. 210316, November 28, 2016. 1 J9JC9B0M V. 8ECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799; 9 case were generally rolled over to augment the creditors existing investment with ASBHI, they most definitely take on the attributes of traditional stocks/12 16. Westmont Investment Corporation (Wincorp), a domestic corporation organized and licensed to operate as an investment house, offered to Ng Wee and to the public "sans recourse" transactions with the following mechanics: A corporate borrower that needs financial assistance or funding to run its business or to serve as working capital is screened by Wincorp. Once it qualifies as an accredited borrower, Wincorp enters into a Credit Line Agreement for a specific amount with a corporation, which the latter can draw upon in a series of availments over a period of time. The agreement stipulates that Wincorp shall extend a credit facility on "best effort" basis and that every drawdown by the accredited borrower shall be evidenced by a promissory note executed in favor of Wincorp and/or the investor/s who has/have agreed to extend the credit facility. Wincorp then scouts for investors willing to provide the funds needed by the accredited borrower. The investor is matched with the accredited borrower. An investor who provides the fund is issued a Confirmation Advice which indicates the amount of his investment, the due date, the term, the yield, the maturity, and the name of the borrower. Ng Wee, a valued client of Westmond Bank, was enticed to place investments thereon under accounts in his name or in those of his trustees. A summary of the said Confirmation Advices reveals that Ng Wee invested the aggregate amount of P213,290,410.36 in the "sans recourse" transactions through his trustees. Are the "sans recourse" transactions offered by Wincorp securities investment contract that must registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC)? Yes. The factual milieu of the case at bar sufficiently satisfies the Howey Test. The “sans recourse” transactions are, in actuality, investment contracts wherein investors pool their resources to meet the financial needs of a borrowing company First, Wincorp offered what it purported to be “sans recourse” transactions wherein the investment house would allegedly match investors with pre­ screened corporate borrowers in need of financial assistance. Second, 32Gabionza v. CA, G.R. No. 161057, September 12, 2008. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 10 Ng Wee invested the aggregate amount, of 1’213,290,410.36 in the "sans recourse" transactions through his trustees, as embodied in the Confirmation Advices. Third, prior to being matched with a corporate borrower, all the monies infused by the investors are pooled in an account maintained by Wincorp. This ensures that there are enough funds to meet large drawdowns bjr single borrowers. Fourth, the investors were induced to invest by Wincorp with promises of high yield. In Ng Wee’s case, his Confirmation Advices reveal that his funds were supposed to earn 13.5% at their respective maturity dates. Fifth. the profitability of the enterprise depended largely on whether or not Wincorp, on best effort basis, would be able to match the investors with their approved corporate borrowers.33 Thus, Wincorp cannot hide behind its license to operate as an investment house when it offered the “sans recourse” transactions to the public. 17. What is a derivative? Under the SRC Implementing Rules and Regulations, a ierivative is defined as a financial instrument whose value changes i response to changes in a specified interest rate, security price, ommodity price, foreign exchange rate, index of prices or rates, credit rating or credit index, or similar variable or underlying factor. It is settled at a future date. Simply put, it is a financial security with a value that is reliant upon or derived from an underlying asset or group of assets. 18. What are the kinds of options? Call option - it is an option but not an obligation to buy 1. securities at an agreed price on or before an agreed date. 2. Put option - it is an option but not an obligation to sell securities at an agreed price on or before an agreed date. 3. 19. Straddle - combination of both put and call options. What is a warrant? It is a type of derivative that gives the holder the right, but not the obligation, to subscribe or purchase new or existing shares of stock in a company at a fixed price on or before a pre-agreed date. ’’Virata v. Ng Wee, G.R. Nos. 220926, 221058, 221109, 221135, and 221218, July 5, 2017. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8709) 20. 11 What is the distinction between warrant and option? If warrants are exercised, the company will issue new stocks, thereby causing dilution of existing stockholders. Exercising a call option does not involve issuing new stock since a call option is a derivative instrument on the existing shares of a company. 21. What is a timeshare? Is it a security? A timeshare, sometimes called vacation ownership, is a property with a divided form of ownership or use rights. These properties are typically resort condominium units, in which multiple parties hold rights to use the property and each owner of the same accommodation is allotted their period of time. Timeshare is a form of certificate of membership and is, therefore, considered a security. 22. Is a corporation registered with the SEC authorized to sell timeshares to the public? No. Corporate registration is just one of several requirements before it may deal with timeshares. Under Section 8 of B.P. Big. 178 or The Revised Securities Act, all securities required to be registered shall be registered through the filing by the issuer or by any dealer or underwriter interested in the sale thereof, with the SEC, of a sworn registration statement with respect to such securities. Prior to fulfillment of all the other requirements of Section 8, corporations are absolutely proscribed under Section 4 from dealing with unregistered timeshares, thus: “No securities, except of a class exempt under any of the provisions of Section 5 hereof or unless sold in any transaction exempt under any of the provisions of Section 6 hereof, shall be sold or offered for sale or distribution to the public within the Philippines unless such securities shall have been registered and permitted to be sold as hereinafter provided.”34 23. Philippine Palaces Realty (PPR) had been representing itself as a registered broker of securities, duly authorized by the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). On October 6, 1996, PPR sold to spouses Leon and Carina one (1) timeshare of 3lTimeshare Realty Corporation v. Cesar Lao, 544 SCRA 254 (2008). The same provision was retained under the Securities Regulation Code. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 12 Palacio del Boracay for US$7,500.00. However, its Registration Statement became effective only on February 11,1998, after the SEC issued a resolution declaring that PPR was authorized to sell securities, including timeshares. On March 30,1998, Leon and Carina wrote PPR rescinding their purchase agreement and demanding the refund of the amount they paid, because the Palacio del Boracay timeshare was sold to them by PPR without the requisite license or authority from the SEC. PPR contended that the grant of the SEC authority had the effect of ratifying the purchase agreement (with Leon and Carina) of October 6,1996. Is the contention of PPR correct? Explain.35 No. The contention of PPR is not correct. Timeshare certificates are considered securities.36 Under Section 8 of the Securities Regulation Code, no securities shall be sold or offered for sale or distribution in the Philippines without a registration statement inly filed and approved by the SEC. The permit to sell should be issued before the actual sale or distribution of the securities. The permit does not retroact to the date of the actual sale. 24. X has the following plans: a. Organize the Tagaytay Country Club, Incorporated. b. Let the club buy a 1O-hectare land for P10 Million which will be developed into a sports and health club complete with an Olympic size swimming pool, tennis and pelota courts, bowling lanes, pool rooms, etc. Five (5) of the P10 Million needed to develop the club will be raised thru the sale of certificates of membership. d. The certificate of membership shall give the purchaser the right to use all club facilities, and shall be transferable. It shall not, however, give the purchaser any right in the income or assets of the club. The purchaser must also pay monthly dues. “BAR 2009. “Timeshare Realty v. Lao, G.R. No. 158941, February 11, 2008. J9JC9B0M V. HECIJRITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 13 X wants to know whether the certificate of membership is an investment contract and hence, a security within the meaning of the Revised Securities Act. What is your opinion? The certificate of membership, although not providing for a right of income or right over club assets, gives, however, to the holder thereof privileges on the use of club facilities, that are of value and transferable. The certificate is thus a security within the meaning of the Revised Securities Act.3’ Note that under the SRC, certificates of membership, whether proprietary or non-proprietary are considered securities independently of investment contracts. 25. 26. What are the kinds of securities? 1. Non-exempt securities - these are securities that cannot be sold or distributed within the Philippines unless registered with the SEC. 2. Exempt securities 3. Securities sold on exempt transaction What is the rule regarding sale or distribution of securities within the Philippines? Securities shall not be sold or offered for sale or distribution within the Philippines, without a registration statement duly filed with and approved by the Commission. Prior to such sale, information on the securities, in such form and with such substance as the Commission may prescribe, shall be made available to each prospective purchaser.38 “Registration statement” is the application for the registration of securities required to be filed with the Commission39 27. "Securities" issued to the public are required by law to be registered with — a) The Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas; b) The Philippine Stock Exchange; c) The Securities and Exchange Commission; 37BAR 1982. 38Section 8.1, SRC. 39Section 3.12, SRC. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 1-1 28. d) The Securities and Exchange Commission and the Philippine Stock Exchange. c) The Securities and Exchange Commission.10 ABC Corp, is engaged in the pawnshop business involving cellphones, laptops, and other gadgets of value. In order to expand its business and attract investors, it offered to any person who invests at least P100.000.00 a "Promissory Note" where it obligated itself to pay the holder a 50% return on investment within one (1) month. Due to the attractive offer, many individuals invested in the company but not one of them was able to realize any profit after one (1) month. Has ABC Corp, violated any law with its scheme? Explain." Yes. ABC Corporation violated the provisions of the Securities Regulation Code that prohibits sale of securities to the public, like promissory notes, without a registration statement filed with and approved by the Securities and Exchange Commission. 29. Andante Realty, a marketing company that promotes and facilitates sales of real property through leverage marketing, solicits investors who are required to be a Business Center Owner (BCO) by paying an enrollment fee of $250.00. The BCO is then entitled to recruit two (2) other investors who pay $250.00 each. The BCO receives $90.00 from the $250.00 paid by each of his recruits and is credited a certain amount for payments made by investors through the initial efforts of his Business Center. Once the accumulated amount reaches $5,000.00, the same is used as down payment for the real property chosen by the BCO. a. What procedure must be followed under the Securities Regulation Code to authorize the sale or offer for sale or distribution of an investment contract?42 Prior to the sale or offering for sale or distribution to the public of an investment contract, the issuer must file a registration statement with and obtain a permit to sell from "BAK 2012. "BAR 2016. “BAR 2010. j J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. «799) 15 the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) in accordance with Section 8 of the Securities and Regulation Code. b. What are the legal consequences of failure to follow this procedure?11 The failure to follow this procedure shall give rise to criminal, civil, and administrative liabilities. The penal sanction, upon conviction, includes a fine P50,000.00 to P5,000,000.00 and/or imprisonment of 7-12 years. It carries also civil liabilities such that the purchaser can recover from the seller (i) the consideration paid with interest thereon, less the amount of any income received on the purchased securities, upon the tender of such securities, or (ii) damages if the purchaser no longer owns such securities. Furthermore, the SEC may issue a cease and desist order to enjoin the sale of the unregistered securities and impose administrative sanctions against the issuer and its responsible directors, officers, and agents. 30. What are exempt securities? These are securities that can be sold or distributed within the Philippines without generally the requirement of registration under the SRC. These are the following: (a) Any security issued or guaranteed by the Government of the Philippines, or by any political subdivision or agency thereof, or by any person controlled or supervised by, and acting as an instrumentality of said Government. (b) Any security issued or guaranteed by the government of any country with which the Philippines maintains diplomatic relations, or by any state, province or political subdivision thereof on the basis of reciprocity: Provided, That the Commission may require compliance with the form and content for disclosures the Commission may prescribe. (c) Certificates issued by a receiver or by a trustee in bankruptcy duly approved by the proper adjudicatory body. (d) Any security or its derivatives the sale or transfer of which, by law, is under the supervision and regulation 43BAR 2010. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 16 of the Office of the Insurance Commission, Housing and Land Use Rule Regulatory Board, or the Bureau of Internal Revenue. 31. (e) Any security issued by a bank except its own shares of stock. (0 Other securities as determined by SEC." The SRC exempts from registration the securities issued by banking or financial institutions mentioned in the law. Does this exemption include reportorial requirements? No. Nowhere does it state or even imply that a bank, as a listed corporation, is exempt from complying with the reports required by the assailed Revised Securities Act Implementing Rules. The exemption from the registration requirement enjoyed by a bank does not necessarily connote that it is exempted from reportorial requirements. Having confined the exemption enjoyed by the bank merely to the initial requirement of registration of securities for public offering, and not to the subsequent filing of various periodic eports, the SEC, as the regulatory agency, is able to exercise its lower of supervision and control over corporations and over the securities market as a whole. Otherwise, the objectives of the “Full Material Disclosure” policy would be defeated since the bank and its dealings would be totally beyond the reach of the Commission and the investing public.45 32. What are the transactions exempt from the requirement of registration under the SRC? (a) At any judicial sale, or sale by an executor, administrator, guardian, or receiver or trustee in insolvency or bankruptcy. (b) By or for the account of a pledge holder, or mortgagee or any of a pledge lien holder selling of offering for sale or delivery in the ordinary course of business and not for the purpose of avoiding the provision of the Code, to liquidate a bona fide debt, a security pledged in good faith as security for such debt. "'Section 9, SRC; BAR 2009. '5Union Bank of the Philippines v. Securities and Exchange Commission, G.R. No. 138949, June 6, 2001. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 17 (C) An isolated transaction in which any security is sold, offered for sale, subscription or delivery by the owner therefore, or by his representative for the owner’s account, such sale or offer for sale or offer for sale, subscription or delivery not being made in the course of repeated and successive transaction of a like character by such owner, or on his account by such representative and such owner or representative not being the underwriter of such security. (d) The distribution by a corporation actively engaged in the business authorized by its articles of incorporation, of securities to its stockholders or other security holders as a stock dividend or other distribution out of surplus. (e) The sale of capital stock of a corporation to its own stockholders exclusively, where no commission or other remuneration is paid or given directly or indirectly in connection with the sale of such capital stock. (f) The issuance of bonds or notes secured by mortgage upon real estate or tangible personal property, when the entire mortgage together with all the bonds or notes secured thereby are sold to a single purchaser at a single sale. (g) The issue and delivery of any security in exchange for any other security of the same issuer pursuant to a right of conversion entitling the holder of the security surrendered in exchange to make such conversion: Provided, That the security so surrendered has been registered under the SRC or was, when sold, exempt from the provision of the SRC, and that the security issued and delivered in exchange, if sold at the conversion price, would at the time of such conversion fall within the class of securities entitled to registration under the SRC. Upon such conversion, the par value of the security surrendered in such exchange shall be deemed the price at which the securities issued and delivered in such exchange are sold. (h) Broker’s transaction, executed upon customer’s orders, on any registered exchange or other trading market. (i) Subscriptions for shares of the capitals stocks of a corporation prior to the incorporation thereof or in pursuance of an increase in its authorized capital stocks under the Corporation Code, when no expense is incurred, J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL I.AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 18 or no commission, compensation or remuneration is paid or given in connection with the sale or disposition of such securities, and only when the purpose for soliciting, giving or taking of such subscription is to comply with the requirements of such law as to the percentage of the capital stock of a corporation which should be subscribed before it can be registered and duly incorporated, or its authorized, capital increase. (j) The exchange of securities by the issuer with the existing security holders exclusively, where no commission or other remuneration is paid or given directly or indirectly for soliciting such exchange. (k) The sale of securities by an issuer to fewer than 20 persons in the Philippines during any twelve (12)-month period. 0) The sale of securities to any number of the following qualified buyers: (i) Bank; (ii) Registered investment house; (iii) Insurance company; (iv) Pension fund or retirement plan maintained by the Government of the Philippines or any political subdivision thereof or manage by a bank or other persons authorized by the Bangko Sentral to engage in trust functions; (v) Investment company; or (vi) Such other person as the Commission may rule by determine as qualified buyers, on the basis of such factors as financial sophistication, net worth, knowledge, and experience in financial and business matters, or amount of assets under management.46 33. Able Corporation sold securities to 21 non-qualified buyers during a 15-month period, without registering the securities with the Securities and Exchange Commission. Did Able Corporation violate the Securities Regulation Code? Explain. 4GSection 10.1, SRC. I J9JC9B0M V. 8ECURITIEH REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 19 Yes. Under the SRC, securities shall not be sold or offered to be sold to the public within the Philippines unless the securities are registered with and approved by the Securities and Exchange Commission. Public means 20 or more investors. The fact that the securities were sold during a 15-month period is immaterial." 34. TRUE or FALSE. The issuance by a corporation of previously authorized but unissued capital stock to existing stockholders is not automatically exempt from registration and requires an application from exemption with the Securities and Exchange Commission. True. The interpretation that the issuance of previously authorized but unissued capital stock would automatically constitute an exempt transaction would establish an inflexible rule of automatic exemption of issuances of additional, previously authorized but unissued, capital stock. This construction would disable the SEC from rendering protection to investors, in the public interest, precisely when such protection may be most needed.48 Note that under Section 10.3 of the SRC, the application for exemption for securities sold on exempt transactions, like issuance of previously authorized but unissued capital stock to existing stockholders, is done by filing a notice of exemption with the SEC identifying the exemption relied upon in such form and at such time as the SEC may prescribe and with such notice shall pay to the SEC a fee equivalent to one tenth (1/10) of one percent (1% ) of the maximum aggregate price or issued value of the securities. 35. Securities issued by the Philippine government are "exempt securities" and, therefore, need not be registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission prior to their sale or offering to the public in the Philippines. What is the rationale behind this exemption? The rationale for the exemption is that the public is amply protected even without the registration of the securities to be issued by the government.49 "BAR 2015. 48Nestle Philippines v. Court of Appeals & Securities and Exchange Commis­ sion, G.R. No. 86738, November 13, 1991. 49BAR 2015. J9JC9B0M D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 20 36. Assume that Greater Manila Telephone and Telegraph Company, Incorporated has 10,000 employees. It has a policy of encouraging stock ownership among its employees. Its Board of Directors intends to sell P2 Million worth of common stocks to either (a) its managerial employees only numbering about 1,000 or (b) indiscriminately to all its 10,000 employees. In case it decides to sell to its managerial employees only, does it have to register its securities? How about if the intended sale is to all employees? Exempt transactions are those that do not require registration either because the law itself exempts them therefrom or the SEC finds that the enforcement of the registration requirement is not necessary in the public interest and for the protection of investors by reason of the amount involved or the limited character of the public offering. The proposed sales stated in the problem do not strictly fall under any of the transactions exempted from registration.60 r- What is the distinction between exempt securities and securities sold on exempt transactions? Any person applying for an exemption shall file with the SEC a notice identifying the exemption relied upon on such form and at such time as the SEC by the rule may prescribe and with such notice shall pay a fee equivalent to one-tenth (1/10) of one percent (1%) of the maximum value aggregate price or issued value of the securities. Exempt securities may be sold or distributed within the Philippines, not subject to the foregoing requirement. 38. Discuss the procedure for registration of securities. All securities required to be registered under Section 8 of the SRC shall be registered through the filing by the issuer in the main office of the SEC of a sworn registration statement with the respect to such securities, in such form and containing such information and document as the SEC may prescribe. The registration statement shall include any prospectus required or permitted to be delivered under Subsections 8.2, 8.3, and 8.4.61 In promulgating rules governing the content of any registration statement (including any prospectus made a part thereof or annex thereto), the Commission may require the registration statement “BAR 1989. “Section 12, SRC. V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. H7!>9) 21 to contain such information or documents as it may, by rule, prescribe. It may dispense with any such requirements, or may require additional information or documents, including written information from an expert, depending on the necessity thereof or their applicability to the class of securities sought to be registered.'2 J9JC9B0M The information required for the registration of any kind, and all securities, shall include, among others, the effect of the securities issue on ownership, on the mix of ownership, especially foreign and local ownership.63 The registration statement shall be signed by the issuer’s executive officer, its principal operating officer, its principal financial officer, its comptroller, its principal accounting officer, its corporate secretary, or persons performing similar functions accompanied by a duly verified resolution of the board of directors of the issuer corporation. The written consent of the expert named as having certified any part of the registration statement or any document used in connection therewith shall also be filed. Where the registration statement includes shares to be sold by selling shareholders, a written certification by such selling shareholders as to the accuracy of any part of the registration statement contributed to by such selling shareholders shall be filed?1 (a) Upon filing of the registration statement, the issuer shall pay to the SEC a fee of not more than one-tenth (1/10) of one per centum (1%) of the maximum aggregate price at which such securities are proposed to be offered. The SEC shall prescribe by the rule diminishing fees in inverse proportion the value of the aggregate price of the offering. (b) Notice of the filing of the registration statement shall be immediately published by the issuer, at its own expense, in two (2) newspapers of general circulation in the Philippines, once a week for two (2) consecutive weeks, or in such other manner as the Commission by the rule shall prescribe, reciting that a registration statement for the sale of such securities has been filed, and that aforesaid registration statement, as well as the papers attached thereto are open to inspection at the Commission during business hours, and copies thereof, photostatic or “Section 12.2, SRC. “Section 12.3, SRC. “Section 12.4, SRC. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 22 otherwise, shall be furnished to interested parties at such reasonable charge as the Commission may prescribe.56 Within 45 days after the date of filing of the registration statement, or by such later date to which the issuer has consented, the Commission shall declare the registration statement effective or rejected, unless the applicant is allowed to amend the registration statement as provided in Section 14 of the SRC. The Commission shall enter an order declaring the registration statement to be effective if it finds that the registration statement together with all the other papers and documents attached thereto, is on its face complete and that the requirements have been complied with.56 The SEC may impose such terms and conditions as may be necessary or appropriate for the protection of the investors. Upon effectivity of the registration statement, the issuer shall state under oath in every prospectus that all registration requirements have been met and that all information are true and correct as represented by the issuer or the one making the statement. Any untrue statement of fact or omission to state a material fact required to be stated herein or necessary to make the statement therein not misleading shall constitute fraud.57 Preferred Shares Issuance issuer Reject 45 days R.S. I approved L R.S. Permit to Sell [ prospectus Correction 1. CEO 2. COO 3. CFO 4. Controller 5. Principal Accounting Officer 6. Corporate Secretary 7. Expert, if any Listing PSE By way of illustration, let us assume that ABC plans to increase its capital by offering preferred shares to the investing public. “Section 12.5, SRC. “Section 12.6, SRC. ‘’Section 12.7, SRC. I V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799? 23 ABC then engages the services of a reputable investment manager to assist in the capital offering and to reach as many interested investors as possible. J9JC9B0M 1. ABC is required to file a registration statement with the SEC. It may include any prospectus made a part thereof or as an annex thereto. The registration statement shall be signed by ABC’s executive officer (CEO), its principal operating officer (CFO), its principal financial officer (CFO), its comptroller, its principal accounting officer, its corporate secretary, or persons performing similar functions accompanied by a duly verified resolution of the board of directors of ABC Corporation. The written consent of the expert named as having certified any part of the registration statement or any document used in connection therewith shall also be filed. 2. The registration statement (and the prospectus which is made part of it or as an annex thereto) shall include all material information about the ABC Corporation, like nature of business, share ownership mix, director and management composition, operating performance, its financial condition and corporate goals for the immediate future, its plans on how to deploy the funds to be raised and other relevant material information. It should also include information on the type of securities that it plans to issue. For instance, the registration statement should indicate if the preferred shares will be voting or non-voting, preferred as to dividends and/or assets upon dissolution of the corporation, if they are preferred as to dividends, will they be cumulative or non-cumulative, participating or non-participating? What will be the indicate yield or amount of dividends, when and often are they payable? Will the preferred shares be redeemable? If they are redeemable, what is the date of redemption and what will be the effect of non-redemption? Will they be convertible to shares? In other words, the registration statement should contain all material information about ABC Corporation, as the issuer, and the type of securities that it plans to issue in order to guide the decision of the investing public. 3. After initial publication and payment of filing fees, the SEC, within 45 days, may approve, reject or require the amendments of the registration statement. J9JC9B0M 1 PlVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 24 4. Prior to SEC approval of the registration statement, ABC Corporation cannot consummate any subscription agreement but may accept preliminary offers from the investing public, through its investment manager. 5. If the SEC finds that the registration statement is completed and all requirements have been complied with the, it shall issue the permit to sell. 6. The preliminary offers for subscription may then be finalized and funds credited to the account of ABC Corporation. 7. ABC may also list the preferred shares of stock with the Philippine Stock Exchange (PSE) so that they can be publicly traded. The fisting is, of course, subject to compliance with PSE rules and regulations. It should be noted that PSE is a marketplace for selling listed securities. One does not sell to or buy from the PSE. A buyer buys shares from a seller, or vice versa, through the PSE accredited brokers using the PSE trading facilities. 39. What are the grounds for rejection of securities? The Commission may reject a registration statement and refuse registration of the security thereunder, or revoke the affectivity of a registration statement and the registration of the security thereunder after the due notice and hearing by issuing an order to such effect, setting forth its finding in respect thereto, if it finds that: (a) The issuer: (i) Has been judicially declared insolvent; (ii) Has violated any of the provision of the Code, the rules promulgate pursuant thereto, or any order of the Commission of which the issuer has notice in connection with the offering for which a registration statement has been filed; (iii) Has been or is engaged or is about to engage in fraudulent transactions; (iv) Has made any false or misleading representation of material facts in any prospectus concerning the issuer or its securities; J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) (V) 25 Has failed to comply with any requirements that the Commission may impose as a condition for registration of the security for which the registration statement has been filed; or (b) The registration statement is on its face incomplete or inaccurate in any material respect or includes any untrue statements of a material fact required to be stated therein or necessary to make the statement therein not misleading; or (C) The issuer, any officer, director or controlling person performing similar functions, or any under writer has been convicted, by a competent judicial or administrative body, upon plea of guilty, or otherwise, of an offense involving moral turpitude and/or fraud or is enjoined or restrained by the Commission or other competent or administrative body for violations of securities, commodities, and other related laws. For the purposes of this subsection, the term “competent judicial or administrative body” shall include a foreign court of competent jurisdiction as provided for under Rules of Court.58 The SEC may compel the production of all the books and papers of such issuer, and may administer oaths to, and examine the officers of such the issuer or any other person connected therewith as to its business and affairs.59 If any issuer shall refuse to permit an examination to be made by the Commission, its refusal shall be ground for the refusal or revocation of the registration of its securities.80 40. What are the prohibited acts relating to manipulation of security prices? It shall be unlawful for any person acting for himself or through a dealer or broker, directly or indirectly: (a) To create a false or misleading appearance of active trading in any listed security traded in an Exchange of any other trading market (hereafter referred to purposes of this Chapter as “Exchange”): 68Section 13, SRC. 69Section 13.2, SRC. “Section 13.3, SRC. J9JC9B0M 26 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II (i) By effecting any transaction in such security which involves no change in the beneficial ownership thereof: (ii) By entering an order or orders for the purchase or sale of such security with the knowledge that a simultaneous order or orders of substantially the same size, time and price, for the sale or purchase of any such security, has or will be entered by or for the same or different parties; or (iii) By performing similar act where there is no change in beneficial ownership. (b) To affect, alone or with others, a securities or transactions in securities that: (i) Raises their price to induce the purchase of a security, whether of the same or a different class of the same issuer or of controlling, controlled, or commonly controlled company by others; (ii) Depresses their price to induce the sale of a security, whether of the same or a different class, of the same issuer or of a controlling, controlled, or commonly controlled company by others; or (iii) Creates active trading to induce such a purchase or sale through manipulative devices such as marking the close, painting the tape, squeezing the float, hype and dump, boiler room operations and such other similar devices. (c) To circulate or disseminate information that the price of any security listed in an Exchange will or is likely to rise or fall because of manipulative market operations of any one or more persons conducted for the purpose of raising or depressing the price of the security for the purpose of inducing the purpose of sale of such security. (d) To make false or misleading statement with respect to any material fact, which he knew or had reasonable ground to believe was so false or misleading, for the purpose of inducing the purchase or sale of any security listed or traded in an Exchange. (e) To effect, either alone or others, any series of transactions for the purchase and/or sale of any security traded in an J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) •2.1 Exchange for the purpose of pegging, fixing or stabilizing the price of such security; unless otherwise allowed by the Code or by rules of the Commission/'1 No person shall use or employ, in connection with the purchase or sale of any security any manipulative or deceptive device or contrivance. Neither shall any short sale be effected nor any stop­ loss order be executed in connection with the purchase or sale of any security except in accordance with such rules and regulations as the Commission may prescribe as necessary or appropriate in the public interest for the protection of investors.62 41. A trading contract signed by the parties is a contract for the sale of products for future delivery, in which either seller or buyer may elect to make or demand delivery of goods agreed to be bought and sold, but where no such delivery is actually made. Is this contract illegal? What is the nature of the transaction made by the parties? No. The agreement is not illegal. As a contract in printed form signed by the parties, the trading contract bears it complies with the Rules and Regulations on Commodity Future Trading as prescribed by the SEC. However, when the transaction which was carried out to implement the written contract deviates from the true import of the agreement as when no such delivery, actual or constructive, of the commodity or goods is made, and final settlement is made by payment receipt of only the difference in prices at the time of delivery from that prevailing at the time the sale is made, the dealings in futures become mere speculative contracts in which the parties merely gamble on the rise or fall in prices.63 This gambling or wagering on prices within a given time is not buying and selling and is illegal as against public policy. 42. Suppose "A" is the owner of several inactive securities. To create an appearance of active trading for such securities, "A" connives with "B" by which "A" will offer for sale some of his securities and "B" will buy them at certain fixed price, with the understanding that although there would be an apparent sale, "A” will retain the beneficial ownership thereof. “‘Section 24.1, SRC. “Section 24.2, SRC. “Onapal Philippines Commodities, Inc. v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 90707, February 1, 1993. J9JC9B0M 28 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II a) Is the arrangement lawful? No. the arrangement is not lawful. It is an artificial manipulation of the price of securities. This is prohibited by the Securities Regulation Code. b) If the sale materializes, what is it called? If the sale materializes, it is called a wash sale or simulated sale.64 43. What is a wash sale? A wash sale is the buying and selling of stocks without change of beneficial ownership. 44. Define the following terms: a) Marking the Close b) Painting the Tape c) Squeezing the Float d) Hype and Dump e) Improper Matched Orders f) Boiler Room Operations g) Scalping h) Daisy Chain i) Flipping j) Short Sale k) Stop-loss Order a) Marking the Close means buying and selling securities at close market in an effort to alter the closing price of the security. b) Painting the Tape means engaging in the series of transactions that are reported publicly to give impression of activity or price movement in a security. c) Squeezing the Float means taking advantage of a shortage of securities in the market by controlling demand side and exploiting market congestion during such shortages to create artificial prices. “BAR 2001. J9JC9B0M V. HECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 29 d) Hype and Dump means engaging in buying activity at increasingly higher prices and then selling the securities in market at higher price. e) Improper Matched Orders means engaging in transac­ tions where both the buy and sell orders are entered at the same time with the same price and quantity by different but colluding parties. f) Boiler Room Operations ae well-organized operations where in a room there would be well-trained salesmen operating over several phones and using high-pressure sales-talk to get investors to invest in securities offered. g) Scalping is a situation where a person, like an investment advisor, purchases securities for his own account before recommending that security then selling the share at a profit upon a rise in the market price following the recommendation. h) Daisy Chain is a pattern fictitious trading activity by a group of persons who lure innocent people into the scheme. i) Flipping is operated when one office buys a particular stock for customers while another office simultaneously recommends that its customers sell the stock, with the stock being shifted from one office to another, and the firm makes a profit and the brokers earn their commissions j) 1. By the circulation or dissemination of information that the price of any security listed in the Exchange will or is likely to rise or fall because of manipulative market operations 2. To make, regarding any security registered on an exchange, any statement which is false or mislead­ ing with respect to any material fact, and which he knew or had reasonable ground to believe is false or misleading 3. To effect series of transactions for the purpose of pegging, fixing, or stabilizing the price of such se­ curity traded in an Exchange, unless otherwise al­ lowed by this Code or by the rules of the Commission Short Sale is a contract for sale of shares of stock which the seller does not own, or certificates which are not within his control. J9JC9B0M 30 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II k) 45. Stop-loss Order is a direction by a customer to his broker that if the commodity touches the price named, the broker shall close the trade at the best available price. What would be considered as unlawful acts in the sale of any equity security? It is unlawful for any beneficial owner, director, or officer, directly or indirectly, to sell any equity security of such issuer if the person selling the security or his principal does not own the security sold, or 46. a. If owning the security, does not deliver it against such sale within 20 days thereafter, or does not within five (5) days after such sale deposit it in the mails. b. No person shall be deemed to have violated SRC if he proves the exercise of good faith he was unable to make such delivery within such time, or to do so would cause inconvenience or expense.66 A complaint was filed with the SEC against Abacus Securities Corporation, Sapphire Securities Inc., and several other persons, including Jose Maximo Cuaycong III and Mark Angelo Cuaycong. It was alleged that Jose Maximo engaged in fraudulent and deceitful activities with the complicity of Abacus, Saphire and the other defendants. The complainants prayed that all defendants be held jointly and severally liable for all damages. Meanwhile, the complainants and Jose Maximo and Mark Angelo entered into a compromise agreement. Can this compromise agreement absolve Jose Maximo and Mark Angelo from the civil case? No. The SRC punishes the persons primarily liable for fraudulent transactions under Section 58 and their aiders or abettors under Section 51.5, by making their liability for damages joint and solidary. Thus, one cannot condone the liability of the person primarily liable and proceed only against his aiders or abettors because the liability of the latter is tied up with the former. Liability attaches to the aider or abettor precisely because of the existence of the liability of the person primarily liable.66 “Section 23.3, SRC. “Benedicto-Munoz, G.R. No. 179121, November 9, 2015. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799; 47. 31 Under the SRC, what is the Margin Trading Rule? Under the Margin Trading Rule, no registered broker or dealer, or member of an exchange shall extend credit on any security an amount greater than whichever is higher of: a) Sixty-five percent (65%) of the current market price of the security; b) One hundred percent (100%) of the lowest market price of the security during the preceding 36 calendar months, but not more than seventy-five percent (75%) of the current market price. The purpose of the Margin Trading Rule is to prevent excessive use of credit for the purchase of securities. It is a counter to the broker’s desire to generate more sales by encouraging clients to buy securities on credit.67 48. What is meant by ‘'Over-the-Counter Markets" as provided in the Revised Securities Act?68 The term “Over-the-Counter Markets” refers to markets made or created for the purchase and sale of securities other than on a security exchange. The SEC may provide rules and regulations of transactions therein, a violation of which renders the same or the trading therein unlawful.69 49. What is insider trading? Insider trading is the buying or selling of a security by an insider while in the possession of material non-public information.70 It shall be unlawful for an insider to sell or buy a security of the issuer, while in possession of material information with respect to the issuer or the security that is not generally available to the public, unless: a. The insider proves that the information was not gained from such relationship; or b. If the other party selling to or buying from the insider is identified, the insider proves: (i) that he disclosed information to the other party, or (ii) that he had reason 67BAR 2009. “BAR 1982. 69BAR 1982. 70BAR 2015. J9JC9B0M 32 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II to believe that other party otherwise is also in possession of the information.71 50. What are the elements of insider trading? The elements of insider trading are as follows: 51. 1. There is a buying or selling of securities, 2. It was done by an insider as defined under Section 3.8 of the SRC, 3. While in possession of material non-public information, and 4. Said information pertains to the issuer OR its securities. Is there a violation of the rule against insider trading if the insider did not make any purchase or sale of security? Generally, there can be no unlawful insider trading without the purchase and/or sale of securities. Nevertheless, it shall be unlawful for any insider to communicate material nonpublic information about the issuer or the security to any person who, by virtue of the communication, becomes an insider as defined in Subsection 3.8, where the insider communicating the information knows or has reason to believe that such person will likely buy or sell a security of the issuer while in possession of such information.72 52. Who is an insider? “Insider” means (a) the issuer; (b) a director or officer (or any person performing similar functions) of, or a person controlling the issuer; (c) any person whose relationship or former relationship to the issuer gives or gave him access to material information about the issuer or the security that is not generally available to the public; (d) a government employee, director, or officer of an exchange, clearing agency and/or self-regulatory organization who has access to material information about an issuer or a security that is not generally available to the public; or (e) a person who learns such information by a communication from any foregoing insiders.73 ’'Section 27.1, SRC. ’’Section 27.3, SRC. ’’Section 3.8, SRC. J9JC9B0M 33 V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 53. When is an information considered material non-public for the purpose of insider trading? For purpose of insider trading, the information is “material non-public” if: (a) It has not been generally disclosed to the public and would likely affect the market price of the security after being disseminated to the public and the lapse of a reasonable time for the market to absorb the information; or (b) would be considered by a reasonable person important under the circumstances in determining his course of action whether to buy, sell, or hold a security.74 54. What are the penalties for unlawful insider trading? Unlawful insider trading renders criminally, and administratively liable. a. the violators civilly, Civil liability Any insider who violates the rule against insider trading by purchasing or selling a security while in possession of material information not generally available to the public, shall be liable in a suit brought by any investor who, contemporaneously with the purchase or sale of securities that is the subject of the violation, purchased or sold securities of the same class unless such insider, or such person in the case of a tender offer, proves that such investor knew the information or would have purchased or sold at the same price regardless of disclosure of the information to him.76 An insider who violates the rule against insider trading by communicating material non-public information, shall be jointly and severally liable with, and to the same extent as, the insider, by­ reason of his purchase or sale of a security.76 All suits to recover damages pursuant shall be brought before the Regional Trial Court, which shall have exclusive jurisdiction to hear and decide such suits. The Court is hereby authorized to award damages in an amount not exceeding triple the amount of the transaction plus actual damages. Exemplary damages may also be awarded in cases of bad faith, fraud, malevolence, or wantonness in the violation of the SRC or the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder. ’■'Section 27.2, SRC. 76Section 61, SRC. 76Section 61.2, SRC. J9JC9B0M 34 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II The Court is also authorized to award attorney’s fees not exceeding thirty per centum (30%) of the award.” b. Administrative sanctions (i) Suspension, or revocation of any registration for the offering of securities; (ii) A fine of no less than Ten thousand pesos (PIO,000.00) nor more than One million pesos (Pl,000,000.00) plus not more than Two thousand pesos (P2,000.00) for each day of continuing violation; (iii) Disqualification from being an officer, member of the Board of Directors, or person performing similar functions, of an issuer required to file reports under Section 17 of the SRC or any other act, rule, or regulation administered by the Commission; (iv) Other penalties within the power of the Commission to impose. The imposition of the foregoing administrative sanctions shall oe without prejudice to the filing of criminal charges against the individuals responsible for the violation.78 c. Criminal liability The SRC provides that any person who violates these prohibitions shall, upon conviction, suffer a fine of not less than Fifty thousand pesos (P50,000.00) nor more than Five million pesos (P5,000,000.00) or imprisonment of not less than seven (7) years nor more than 21 years, o both in the discretion of the court.79 55. Ms. OB was employed in MAS Investment Bank. WIC, a medical drug company, retained the Bank to assess whether it is desirable to make a tender offer for DOP Company, a drug manufacturer. OB overheard in the course of her work the plans of WIC. By herself and thru associates, she purchased DOP stocks available at the stock exchange price at P20.00 per share. When WIC's tender offer was announced, DOP stocks jumped to P30.00 per share. Thus, OB earned a sizable profit. ’’Section 63, SRC. ’“Section 54.2, SRC. ’“Section 73, SRC. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8700) 35 Is OB liable for breach and misuse of confidential or insider information gained from her employment? Is she also liable for damages to sellers or buyers with whom she traded? If so, what is the measure of such damages? Explain briefly. OB is an insider (as defined in Subsection 3.8[3] of the SRC) since she is an employee of the Bank, the financial adviser of DOP, and this relationship gives her access to material information about the issuer (DOP) and the latter’s securities (shares), which information is not generally available to the public. Accordingly, OB is guilty of insider trading under Section 27 of the SRC, which requires disclosure when trading in securities. OB is also liable for damages to sellers or buyers with whom she traded. Under Subsection 63.1 of the SRC, the damages awarded could bean amount not exceeding triple the amount of the transaction plus actual damages. Exemplary damages may also be awarded in case of bad faith, fraud, malevolence, or wantonness in the violation of the SRC or its implementing rules. The court is also authorized to award attorney’s fees not exceeding 30% of the award.80 56. Grand Gas Corporation, a publicly listed company, discovered after extensive drilling, a rich deposit of natural gas along the coast of Antique. For five (5) months, the company did not disclose the discovery so that it could quietly and cheaply acquire neighboring land and secure mining rights to the land. Between the discovery and its disclosure of the information to the SEC, all the directors and key officers of the company bought shares in the company at very low prices. After the disclosure, the price of the shares went up. The directors and officers sold their shares at huge profits. a) What provision of the SRC did they violate, if any? Explain. They violated Section 27 of the SRC, on insider’s duty to disclose when trading, to wit: It shall be unlawful for an insider to sell or buy securities of the issuer, while in possession of material information with respect to the issuer or the security that is not generally available to the public, unless: “BAR 2004. J9JC9B0M D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 36 1. The insider proves that the information was not gained from such relationship; or 2 If the other party selling to or buying from the insider (or his agent) is identified, the insider proves: 1.1. That he disclosed the information to the other party, or 1.2. That he has reason to believe that the other party otherwise is also in possession of the information. b) Assuming that the employees of the establishment handling the printing work of Grand Gas Corporation saw the exploration reports which were mistakenly sent to their establishment together with other materials to be printed. They too brought shares in the company at low prices and later sold them at huge profits. Will they be liable for violation of the SRC? Why? Yes, the employees of the establishment handling the printing job of the corporation are also liable for violation of the prohibition against insider trading. These employees fall within the classification of an “insider” under Subsection 3.8(c) of the SRC, to wit: “a person whose relationship or former relationship to the issuer gives or gave him access to material information about the issuer or the security that is not generally available to the public.”81 57. X, who is the Executive VP of ABC Corporation, a listed company, can be held liable or guilty of insider trading if, he 82 a) Bought shares of ABC Corporation when it was planning to acquire another company to improve its asset base, the news of which increased the price of the shares in the Stock Exchange. 81 BAE 2008. “BAR 2012. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 58. 37 b) Bought shares of XYC Corporation, a sister company of ABC Corporation when he learned that XYC Corporation was about to also list its share in the Philippine Stock Exchange. c) Bought shares of ZZZ Corporation when he learned that ABC Corporation would acquire ZZZ Corporation. d) All of the above. Are persons whose relationship or former relationship to the issuer gives or gave them access to a fact of special significance about the issuer or the security that is generally not available, and one who learns of such fact from an insider knowing that the person from whom he learns the fact is such an insider included in the definition of "insiders"? Yes. For a person to be liable for insider trading, the person must be an “insider” included in this enumeration: (a) the issuer; (b) a director or officer (or any person performing similar functions) of, or a person controlling the issuer; (c) a person whose relationship or former relationship to the issuer gives or gave him access to material information about the issuer or the security that is not generally available to the public; (d) A government employee, director, or officer of an exchange, clearing agency and/or self-regulatory organization who has access to material information about an issuer or a security that is not generally available to the public; or (e) a person who learns such information by a communication from any forgoing insiders.83 Here, persons whose relationship or former relationship to the issuer gives or gave them access to a fact of special significance about the issuer or the security that is generally not available, and one who learns of such fact from an insider knowing that the person from whom he learns the fact are insiders included in the definition of the SRC. The phrase “fact of special significance” under the Revised Securities Act is now referred to as “material information” under the Securities Regulation Code. “Section 3.8, SRC. J9JC9B0M 38 59. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II What is an insider's duty? Insiders have the duty to disclose or abstain, which means that insiders are obligated to disclose material information to the other party or abstain from trading the shares of his corporation.84 60. You are a member of the legal staff of a law firm doing corporate and securities work for Coco Products Inc., a company with unique products derived from coconuts and whose shares are traded in the Philippine Stock Exchange. A partner in the law firm, Atty. Buenexito, to whom you report, is the Corporate Secretary of Coco Products. You have long been investing in Coco Products stocks even before you became a lawyer. While working with Atty. Buenexito on another file, he accidentally gave you the Coco products file containing the company's planned corporate financial rehabilitation. While you knew you had the wrong file, your curiosity prevailed and you browsed through the file before returning it. Thus, you learned that a petition for financial rehabilitation is imminent, as the company could no longer meet its obligations as they fall due. Soon after, your mother is rushed to the hospital for an emergency operation, and you have to raise money for her hospital bills. An immediate option for you is to sell your Coco Products shares. The sale would be very timely because the price of the company's stocks is still high. Would you sell the shares to raise the needed funds for your mother's hospitalization? Take into account legal and ethical considerations. No, I would not sell the shares. Although, the sale of the shares does not constitute insider trading under the SRC, it would be unethical to sell the shares. Even if Atty. Buenixito, as corporate secretary of Coco products, Inc. was an insider, the information was not obtained regarding the planned corporate rehabilitation by a communication from him. The file was just accidentally given. However, Rule 1.01 of the Code of Professional Responsibility provides, “A lawyer shall not engage in unlawful, dishonest, “Securities and Exchange Commission v. Interport Resources Corporation, et al., G.R. No. 135808, October 6, 2008. ■ J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799; 39 immoral or deceitful conduct.” A lawyer should not only refrain from performing unlawful acts. He should also desist from engaging in unfair deceitful conduct to conceal from the buyer of the shares the planned corporate rehabilitation."6 Taking into these rules on ethics, I will not sell the shares to raise the needed funds for my mother’s hospitalization. 61. Yenkell Cement Corporation (YCC) is a public corporation whose shares are listed at the PSE. It is 60% owned by Yenkell Holdings Corporation (YHC) and 20% by Yengco Exploration Inc. (YEI). The remaining 20% is held by the public. YHC is a private non-listed corporation which, in turn, is 60% owned by Yatlas Mines Inc. (YMI), and 40% by Yacnotan Consolidated Inc. (YCI). On August 8, 2008, the Board of Directors of YEI passed a resolution approving the acquisition of 50% and 25% of the shares held by YMI and YCI, respectively, in the authorized capital stock of YHC. Yolly, one of the staff members in the office of the Corporate Secretary of YEI, was immediately asked to type the resolution and file the disclosure with the PSE and the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). Before doing that, she secretly called her brother who works with a stock brokerage company, to purchase, in the name of Yolly's husband, 5,000 shares in YCC. After the acquisition was disclosed to the SEC and the PSE, the market price of YCC increased by 50%. Can Yolly be held liable for insider trading?86 Yolly cannot be held liable for insider trading. Insider trading is the buying and selling of securities by an insider while in the possession of a material non-public information. While Yolly is an insider because she has access to material non-public information by reason of her relationship with the issuer, she did not, however, buy the shares. Despite this, Yolly is liable under the SRC for disclosing the information to broker who will presumably buy the shares. Under the SRC, it shall be unlawful for any insider to communicate material nonpublic information about the issuer or the security to any person who, by virtue of the communication, becomes an insider, “BAR 2013. “BAR 2018. J9JC9B0M •10 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II where the insider communicating the information knows or has reason to believe that such person will likely buy or sell a security of the issuer while in possession of such information. 62. Mr. P, the president of JKL, Inc. whose shares are listed in the Philippine Stock Exchange, was notified that the corporation has just been awarded a 5 Billion peso (P5,000,000,000.00) construction contract by a reputable private company. Before this information could be disclosed to the public, Mr. P called his stockbroker to purchase 20,000 shares of JKL, Inc. He also mentioned the transaction to his brother, Mr. B. Mr. B, who was not involved at all in the business of JKL, Inc., also bought 50,000 shares of JKL, Inc. because of the tip disclosed to him by Mr. P. a. Is the information disclosed by Mr. P to Mr. B considered as material non-public information for purposes of insider trading? Explain.87 Yes, the information that the corporation has just been awarded a P5 Billion construction contract by a reputable private company is material non-public information. It has not been generally disclosed to the public and would likely affect the market price of the security after being disseminated to the public or would be considered by a reasonable person important under the circumstances in determining his course of action whether to buy, sell, or hold the security.88 b. Should Mr. P and Mr. B be held liable for insider trading? Explain.89 Mr. P is Hable for insider trading because he bought shares of the company, thru his broker, while in the possession of material non-public information. Mr. B is also Hable for insider trading. Mr. B became an insider after having received by communication a material non-public information from Mr. P, who as President of JKL is an actual insider.90 Mr. B is liable because he bought the shares of JKL while in the possession of material non-public information. 87BAR 2019. “Section 27.2, SRC. “BAR 2019. “Sections 3.8 and 27, SRC. = J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 63. 41 What is a "short swing" transaction? What are the rules on short swing transaction? A “short swing” transaction is one where a person makes a combined buying and selling of securities within a period of six (6) months. For the purpose of preventing the unfair use of information which may have been obtained by a person who is directly or indirectly beneficial owner of more than ten percent (10%) of any equity security, director, or officer by reason of his relationship to the issuer, any profit realized by the latter from any purchase or sale, or any sale or purchase, of any equity security of such issuer within any period of less than six (6) months, unless such security was acquired in good faith in connection with a debt previously contracted, shall inure to and be recoverable by the issuer, irrespective of any intention of holding the security purchased or of not repurchasing the security sold for a period exceeding six (6) months. A suit to recover such profit may be instituted before the Regional Trial Court by the issuer, or by the owner of any security of the issuer in the name and in behalf of the issuer if the issuer shall fail or refuse to bring such suit within 60 days after request or shall fail diligently to prosecute the same thereafter, but not such shall be brought more than two (2) years after the date such profit was realized.91 64. A, B, and C are directors of XYZ Mining Corporation whose shares of stock are listed in the Manila Stock Exchange. On February 1,1984, A, B, and C each purchased thru a stockbroker 1,000 shares of XYZ Mining Corporation at the then market price of P4.00 a share. On May 1,1984, B left for abroad for a medical check-up and a vacation. At the board meeting held on May 15,1984, at which B was absent but which A and C attended, the directors were apprised of an important discovery in an area covered by one XYZ Mining Corporation’s mining leases. After the discovery was duly publicized in the morning dailies, the market price of XYZ Mining Co. started to rise. When it hit P8.00 per share on May 28,1984, A sold all his 1,000 shares. 91Section 23.2, SRC. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 42 Upon his return to Manila in the middle of June, 1984, 8 sold 500 shares at P8.00 per share, just enough to cover the cost of the 1,000 shares he acquired in February, believing that the stock would continue to rise. The price, however, started to drop. On August 15,1984, when the price was P5.00 a share, C sold 1,000 shares of XYZ Mining Co. What are the rights of XYZ Mining Co. against A, B, and C? Explain your answer. For the purpose of preventing the unfair use of information which may have been obtained by a director by reason of his relationship to the issuer, any profit realized by him from any purchase, of any equity security of such issuer within any period of less than six (6) months shall inure to and be recoverable by the issuer, irrespective of any intention of holding the security purchased or of not repurchasing the security sold for a period exceeding six (6) months. Suit to recover such profit may be instituted in any court of competent jurisdiction of the issuer in the name and in behalf of the issuer. As the issuer, XYZ Mining Corporation can recover from B, a director, the amount of P2,000.00, the profit realized by B from the combined purchase and sale of the shares of the issuer within the period of February 1, 1984 to the middle of June, 1984. XYZ Mining Co. cannot recover from C, a director, since C sold his shares after the lapse of six (6) months from February 1, 1984, when he acquired the shares. In the case of A and B, it is immaterial whether or not they actually used inside information in buying and selling the stock. Any profit they made during the six (6)-month period from the combined purchase and sale within such period inures to the benefit of the issuer, XYZ Mining Corporation.92 65. What are the sale and purchase transactions excepted by the rule on short swing transaction? 1. Purchase and sale of security that was acquired in good faith in connection with a debt previously contracted. “BAR 1984. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 2. 66. 43 Purchase and sale, or sale and purchase of an equity security not then or thereafter held by him and an investment account, by a dealer in the ordinary course of his business and incident to the establishment or maintenance by him of a primary or secondary market, otherwise than on an Exchange, for such security.M Distinguish insider trading from short swing transaction. 1. Insider trading is the buying or selling by an insider of a security while in the possession of material non-public information. Short swing transaction is a one involving the combined purchase and sale of security within a six (6)-month period. 67. 2. Insider trading covers both the actual and constructive insiders, whereas short swing transaction only covers a stockholder who is the beneficial owner of more than 10% of the equity security of the issuer, director, and officer of the issuer. 3. Violation of insider trading rule renders the offender liable to criminally, civilly, and administratively while in a short swing transaction, the only legal consequence is that the beneficial owner, director or officer should deliver to the short swing profit to the issuer of the security. What are the other prohibited transactions for such beneficial owner, director, or officer of the issuer? It shall be unlawful for any such beneficial owner, director, or officer, directly or indirectly, to sell any equity security of such issuer if the person selling the principal: (a) does not own the security sold: or (b) if owning the security, does not deliver not deliver it against such sale within 20 days thereafter, or does not within five (5) days after such sale deposit in the mails or the unusual channels of transportation; but no person shall be deemed to have violated this subsection if he proves notwithstanding the exercise of good faith he was unable to make such delivery in such time, or that to do so would cause undue inconvenience or expense.94 “Section 23.4, SRC. 94Section 23.3, SRC. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 4-1 What is the tender offer rule under the SRC? 68. Tender offer means a publicly announced intention by a person acting alone or in concert with other persons to acquire the outstanding equity securities of a public company or outstanding equity securities of an associate or related company of such public company which controls said public company.95 The tender offer rule applies to acquisition of shares of stock in a public company and not any other kind of securities. Under Rule 3.1.16 of the SRC Implementing Rules and Regulations, public company means any corporation with a class of equity securities listed on an Exchange, or with assets in excess of Fifty Million Pesos (Php50.000,000.00) and has two hundred (200) or more holders each holding at least one hundred (100) shares of a class of its equity securities. The Exchange being referred to is the Philippine Stock Exchange. Note, however, that under Section 19 of the SRC, companies with assets of at least fifty million pesos (Php50,000,000.00) (not more than Php50 million) and having 200 or more stockholders owning at least one hundred shares each, are covered by the tender offer rule. In determining the threshold amount of assets for the purpose of the tender offer rule application, the law should be deemed more controlling than the implementing regulation. Mandatory tender offers include: a) Any person or group of persons acting in concert, who intend to acquire 15% of equity securities in a public company in one or more transactions within a period of 12 months shall file a declaration to that effect with the Commission. b) Any person or group of persons acting in concert, who intends to acquire 35% of the outstanding voting shares or such outstanding voting shares that is sufficient to gain control of the board in a public company in one or more transactions within a period of 12 months, shall disclose such intention and contemporaneously make a tender offer for the percentage sought to all holders of such securities within the said period. 9iSection 19.1.8, SRC Implementing Rules and Regulations. 1 J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 45 Note that while Section 19 of the SRC sets the threshold percentage of acquisition at 30% of the equity securities of a public company over a period of 12 months, the SEC increased it to 35% pursuant to its rule making authority. If the tender offer is oversubscribed, the aggregate amount of securities to be acquired at the close of such tender offer shall be proportionately distributed across selling shareholders with whom the acquirer may have been in private negotiations and other shareholders. For purposes of SRC Rule 19.2.2, the last sale that meets the threshold shall not be consummated until the closing and completion of the tender offer. c) Any person or group of persons acting in concert, who intends to acquire 35% of the outstanding voting shares or such outstanding voting shares that is sufficient to gain control of the board in a public company through the Exchange trading system shall not be required to make a tender offer even if such person or group of persons acting in concert acquire the remainder through a block sale if, after acquisition through the Exchange trading system, they fail to acquire their target of 35% or such outstanding voting shares that is sufficient to gain control of the board. d) Any person or group of persons acting in concert, who intends to acquire 35% of the outstanding voting shares or such outstanding voting shares that is sufficient to gain control of the board in a public company directly from one or more stockholders shall be required to make tender offer for all the outstanding voting shares. The sale of shares pursuant to the private transaction or block sale shall not be completed prior to the closing and completion of the tender offer. e) If any acquisition would result in ownership of over 50% of the total outstanding equity securities of a public company, the acquirer shall be required to make a tender offer for all the outstanding equity securities to all remaining stockholders of the said company at a price supported by a fairness opinion provided by an independent financial advisor or equivalent third party. The acquirer in such tender offer shall be required to accept all securities tendered. J9JC9B0M 46 69. PIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II A What is the rationale behind the tender offer rule? A tender offer is meant to protect minority stockholders against any scheme that dilutes the share value of their investments. It gives them the chance to sell their shares for the same price and under the same terms that a controlling stockholder sold his shares or for a price supported by a fairness opinion provided by an independent financial advisor or equivalent third party. The acquirer in such tender offer shall be required to accept all securities tendered. 70. C Corp, is the direct holder of 10% of the shareholdings in U Corp., a nonlisted (not public) firm, which in turn owns 62% of the shareholdings in H Corp., a publicly listed company. The other principal stockholder in H Corp, is C Corp., which owns 18% of its shares. Meanwhile, the majority stocks in U Corp, are owned by B Corp, and V Corp, at 22% and 30%, respectively. B Corp, and V Corp, later sold their respective shares in U Corp, to C Corp., thereby resulting in the increase of C Corp.'s interest in U Corp., whether direct or indirect, to more than 50%. Does the Tender Offer Rule apply in this case where there has been an indirect acquisition of the shareholdings in H Corp, by C Corp.? Discuss.96 Yes, the mandatory tender offer is still applicable even if the acquisition, direct or indirect, is less than 35% when the purchase would result in direct or indirect ownership of over 50% of the total outstanding equity securities of a public company.97 71. Yenkell Cement Corporation (YCC) is a public corporation whose shares are listed at the PSE. It is 60% owned by Yenkell Holdings Corporation (YHC) and 20% by Yengco Exploration Inc. (YEI). The remaining 20% is held by the public. YHC is a private non-listed corporation which, in turn, is 60% owned by Yatlas Mines Inc. (YMI), and 40% by Yacnotan Consolidated Inc. (YCI). On August 8,2008, the Board of Directors of YEI passed a resolution approving the acquisition of 50% and 25% of the shares held by YMI and YCI, respectively, in the authorized capital stock of YHC. “BAR 2016. 97Cemco Holdings v National Life Insurance Company of the Philippines, G.R. No. 171815, August 7, 2007. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. HTM) 47 Yolly, one of the staff members in the office of the Corporate Secretary of YEI, was immediately asked to type the resolution and file the disclosure with the PSE and the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC). Before doing that, she secretly called her brother who works with a stock brokerage company, to purchase, in the name of Yolly's husband, 5,000 shares in YCC. After the acquisition was disclosed to the SEC and the PSE, the market price of YCC increased by 50%. In acquiring 75% of the total capital stock of YHC, should YEI be required to do a mandatory tender offer?" In acquiring 75% of the total capital stock of YHC, YEI should be required to do a mandatory tender offer. By acquiring the combined 75% shareholdings of YMI and YCI in YCC, YEI effectively owns 45% of YCC. Add that to the 20% it directly owns in YCC, YEI now owns and controls 65% of YCC. Once a person singly or in concert with others acquires more than 50% of the voting stock of a public company, the mandatory tender offer rule applies. The tender offer rule covers not only direct acquisition but also indirect acquisition or any type of acquisition. Whatever may be the method by which control of a public company is obtained either through the direct purchase of its stocks or through indirect means, the mandatory tender offer rule applies." 72. ABC Corp, is a company which shares are listed in the Philippine Stock Exchange. In 2015, 25% of ABC Corp.’s shareholdings were acquired by XYZ, Inc., while 40% of the same were acquired by RST, Inc., both of which are non-Iisted private corporations. Meanwhile, the remaining 35% of ABC Corp.'s shareholdings are held by the public. In 2018, or three (3) years after it acquired its 25% stake in ABC Corp., XYZ Inc. sought to obtain an additional 12% shareholding in ABC Corp, by purchasing some of the shares owned by RST, Inc. therein. The new acquisition will not, however, result in XYZ, Inc. gaining majority control of ABC Corp.'s Board. Is XYZ, Inc. required to conduct a tender offer? Explain.1” "BAR 2018. "Cemco Holdings v. National Life Insurance Company, 529 SCRA 2007. l00BAR 2019. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 48 XYZ is not required to conduct a tender offer. While purchase of equity securities covering 35% of the public company is subject to mandatory tender offer, the equity securities should have been acquired during a 12-month period (Rule 19.2 of the IRR of the SRC). In this case, the additional 12% equity stake to bring XYZ’s acquisition to 37% was acquired after three (3) years from the first purchase transaction. It is when the acquisition would result in ownership of over 50% of the total outstanding equity securities of a public company, that the acquirer shall be required to make a tender offer regardless of the time he acquired the shares that brought his equity stake to over 50% of the public company. 73. Union Cement Corporation (UCC), a publicly-listed company, has two (2) principal stockholders namely: Union Cement Holdings Corporation (UCHC), a non-listed company, with shares amounting to 60.51%, and Cemco Holdings Inc. with 17.03%. In a disclosure letter, Bacnotan Consolidated Industries (BCI) which owned majority of UCHC’s stocks informed the Philippine Stock Exchange (PSE) that it and its subsidiary Atlas Cement Corporation (ACC) had passed resolutions to sell to Cemco BCIs stocks in UCHC equivalent to 21.31% and ACC's stocks in UCHC equivalent to 29.69%. As a result of Cemcos' acquisition of BCI and ACC's shares in UCHC, its total beneficial ownership, direct and indirect, in UCC has increased by 36% and amounted to at least 53%. Is Cemco's acquisition subject to mandatory tender offer? Yes. The coverage of the tender offer rule covers not only direct acquisition but also indirect acquisition or any type of acquisition. Whatever may be the method by which control of a public company is obtained either through the direct purchase of its stocks or through indirect means, the mandatory tender offer rule applies.101 Author’s note: For ease of reference, the various diagrams below illustrate the application of the mandatory tender offer rule. 1. ABC Corporation is a public company. As such, it is subject to the rules on mandatory tender offer. Its stockholders include Corporation 1, Corporation 2, Corporation 3 and Corporation 4 which own 35%, 18%, 17%, and 5%, respectively, of ABC’s outstanding capital stock. The rest 101Cemco Holdings, Inc. v. National Life Insurance Company of the Philippines, Inc., G.R. No. 171815, August 7, 2007; BAR 2010. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 49 of the shares of stock of ABC Corporation are owned by the public. If XYZ Corporation, alone or in concert with others, acquires the shares of Corporation 1 in ABC Corporation, XYZ is required to make a mandatory tender offer. It should make a bid to buy the shares of the remaining stockholders usually for a price and under the same terms of conditions it acquired the shares of ABC. XYZ may, however, bid for the shares offering another price which is supported by a fairness opinion provided by an independent financial advisor or equivalent third party. The price is subject to the approval of the SEC. If all the stockholders tendered their shares, XYZ is not required to purchase all shares. It is only required to buy 35%, the same percentage sought, which shall be proportionately distributed across selfing shareholders. 2. Let us assume that Corporation 1 only owns 33% of ABC Corporation while the rest of the share ownership percentage is the same as #1. XYZ Corporation is not required to make a mandatory tender offer if it acquires the shares of stock of Corporation 1 because it is below the threshold limit of 35%. However, if thereafter, XYZ acquires the 18% equity securities of Corporation 2, resulting in ownership of over 50% of the total outstanding equity securities of ABC Corporation, XYZ Corporation shall then be required to make a tender offer for all the outstanding equity securities to all remaining stockholders of the said company at a price supported by a fairness opinion provided by an independent financial advisor or equivalent third party. The acquirer in such tender offer shall be required to accept all securities tendered. The obligation exists regardless of the period XYZ Corporation acquired the shares of Corporation 2, or any shares of stock for that matter that, that resulted in majority ownership of ABC Corporation. 3. ABC Corporation, this time, is owned by Corporation 1 and Corporation 2 which hold 60% and 17%, respectively while the rest of the shares of ABC Corporation are held by the investing public. The stockholders of Corporation J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL I.AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 50 1 are <1. P and Corporation 2 which own 30%, 20% and 9*'o respectively. The rest are owned by the minority shareholders. If Corporation 2 acquires the 30% equity stake of J and. simultaneously or thereafter, buys the 20% share equity of Pin Corporation 1, Corporation 2 shall then be required to make a tender offer to all the stockholders of ABC Corporation. This is because after acquiring the shares of P in Corporation 1, Corporation 2 ended up acquiring, directly and indirectly, over 50% ownership of ABC Corporation. It directly owns 17% and indirectly owns 35.4% (59% of 60%) of ABC Corporation. ABC 35% CORP1 PUBLIC COMPANY PUBLIC 18% CORP 2 17% CORP 3 ABC 2. 5% CORP 4 PUBLIC COMPANY 33% CORP1 PUBLIC 18% 17% CORP 2 CORP 3 3. ABC 60% .CORP 1 17% CORP 2 20% P 9% CORP 2 5% CORP 4 PUBLIC COMPANY PUBLIC J9JC9B0M V. HECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 74. 51 The purpose of the "Tender Offer” Rule is to -102 a. Ensure an even playing field for all shareholders of a company in terms of opportunity to sell their shareholdings. b. Ensure that minority shareholders in a publicly listed company are protected in the sense that they will equally have the same opportunity as the majority shareholders in terms of selling their shares. c. Ensure that the shareholders who would also want to sell their shareholdings will have the opportunity for a better price. d. All of the above. d. All of the above. 75. What are the exemptions from the tender offer requirement? Unless the acquisition of equity securities is intended to circumvent or defeat the objectives of the tender offer rules, the mandatory tender offer requirement shall not apply to the following: a) Any purchase of securities from the unissued capital stock; Provided, the acquisition will not result to a fifty percent (50%) or more ownership of securities by the purchaser or such percentage that is sufficient to gain control of the board; b) Any purchase of securities from an increase in authorized capital stock; c) Purchase in connection with foreclosure proceedings involving a duly constituted pledge or security arrangement where the acquisition is made by the debtor or creditor; d) Purchases in connection with a privatization undertaken by the government of the Philippines; e) Purchases in connection with corporate rehabilitation under court supervision; 102BAR 2012. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 52 76. f) Purchases in the open market at the prevailing market price; and g^ Merger or consolidation.103 What is the violation for non-compliance with the tender offer rule? If equity securities of a public company are purchased at threshold amounts provided for in Rule 19 of the SRC’s Implementing Rules without complying with the tender offer requirements under this Rule, the Commission may, upon complaint, nullify such purchase and order the conduct of a tender offer, without prejudice to the imposition of other sanctions under the SRC.104 77. Where should a civil action for violation of the Securities and Regulation Code (SRC) be filed, with the SEC or the RTC? Civil suits falling under the SRC (like liability for selling unregistered securities) are under the exclusive original jurisdiction of the RTC and hence, need not be first filed before the SEC, unlike criminal cases wherein the latter body exercises primary jurisdiction.105 78. Mr. and Mrs. Reyes invested their hard-earned savings in securities issued by LEAD Bank. After discovering that the securities sold to them were not registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) in violation of the Securities Regulation Code (SRC), the spouses Reyes filed a complaint for nullity of contract and for recovery of a sum of money with the RTC. LEAD Bank moved to dismiss the case on the ground that it is the SEC that has primary jurisdiction over actions involving violations of the SRC. If you were the judge, how would you rule on the motion to dismiss?106 The motion should be denied. Civil suits falling under the SRC, like liability for selling unregistered securities, are under the exclusive original jurisdiction of the RTC and hence, need not be 103Rule 19.3, SRC Implementing Rules and Regulations. 101Rule 19.13, SRC Implementing Rules and Regulations. 1<bPua v. Citibank, N.A., G.R. No. 180064, September 16, 2013. 106BAR 2015. J9JC9B0M V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799> 53 first filed before the SEC unlike criminal cases, wherein the latter body exercises primary jurisdiction."'7 79. What damages may be awarded in case of sale of unregistered securities or sale of securities based on false registration statement? The Court is authorized to award: 80. a) Damages in an amount not exceeding triple the amount of the transaction plus actual damages. b) Exemplary damages in cases of bad faith, fraud, malevolence, or wantonness in the violation of the SRC or the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder. c) Award attorney’s fees not exceeding thirty per centum (30%) of the award.108 What are the prescriptive periods for any actions that may be filed under Section 56 or 57 of the SRC? Under Section 62 of the SRC, no action shall be maintained to enforce any liability created under Section 56 of the SRC (false registration statement) and Section 57 (sale of unregistered security and liabilities arising in connection with prospectus, communication, and other reports) unless brought within two (2) years after discovery of the untrue statement or omission or after the violation upon which it is based, but not more than five (5) years after the security was bona fide offered to the public or more than five (5) years after the sale, respectively. 81. Philippine Chromite, Inc., after registration of its securities, sold PIO Million worth of common stocks to the public at P0.01 per share. In its registration statement, it alleged that it holds a perfected mining claim on 100 hectares of chromite land in Botolan, Zambales. X, a Botolan resident, bought P50,000.00 worth of stocks of the corporation from the stock exchange. After its public offering, the value of the stock dropped to half its price. X made some investigations and discovered that the mining claims of the corporation had not been perfected at the time of the issuance of its securities. The stock, however, rallied and after two (2) years, commanded a price of one and 107Pua v. Citibank, G.R. No. 180064, September 16, 2013; Section 63, SRC. '“Section 63, SRC. J9JC9B0M 54 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II a half (U's) centavos per share. On its third year, the company collapsed and its stocks became totally valueless. What is the remedy of X? The remedy of X for damages is lost by prescription. Any suit therefore must be tiled within two (2) years after the discovery of the facts constituting the cause of action (but not beyond five [5] years after such cause of action accrued). Two (2) years having already elapsed since the time that X had discovered the misrepresentation in the registration statement of the corporation, the latter’s civil liability has prescribed. X, however, is not prevented from invoking SEC’s regulatory powers against the corporation.109 82. In 2007, a criminal complaint was filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission's Enforcement and Prosecution Department (SEC-EPD) for violation of the Securities Regulation Code (SRC) against Citibank N.A. (Citibank) and its officials. The complainants alleged that in sometime in 2000, they induced into signing a subscription agreement for the purchase of shares from Ceres II Finance Ltd. and Aeris Finance II Ltd. The complainants learned that their investments declined until their account was totally wiped out. It turned out that the said shares were not duly registered securities, and that said issuers were not duly-registered security issuers. The SEC-EPD, however, terminated the investigation upon a finding that the action had already prescribed. Is the SEC-EPD correct? No. Given the absence of a prescriptive period for the enforcement of criminal liability in violations of the SRC, Act No. 3326, the law applicable to offenses under special laws, applies. Under Section 73 of the SRC, violation of its provisions is punishable by imprisonment of not less than seven (7) years nor more than 21 years. Applying Act No. 3326, criminal prosecution for violations of SRC prescribes in 12 years. Based on the foregoing antecedents, only seven (7) years lapsed since the respondents invested their funds with the petitioners. Hence, the respondents’ complaint was filed well within the 12-year prescriptive period provided by Section 1 of Act No. 3326.“° ’“Section 62, SRC. ’’“Citibank N.A. v. Tanco-Gabaldon, et al., G.R. No. 198444, September 4, 2013. V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 83. 55 A complaint was filed against Oudine Santos, an investment consultant of Performance Investment Products Corporation (PIPC) for violation of Section 28 of the Securities and Regulation Code. The complainants were allegedly enticed to invest with PIPC with a promise of higher income and lowerrisk investment program. It turned out that neither PIPC nor its officers, employees, and agents were registered brokers/ dealers. Santos denied defrauding the complainants, claiming she was a mere employee of, and subsequently independent information provider for PIPC. Will the complaint against Santos prosper? Yes. The violation of Section 28 of the SRC has the following elements: (a) engaging in the business of buying or selling securities as a broker or dealer; or (b) acting as a salesman; or (c) acting as an associated person of any broker or dealer unless registered as such with the SEC. Thus, a person is liable for violating Section 28 of the SRC where the person acting as a broker, dealer, or salesman, is in the employ of a corporation which sold or offered for sale unregistered securities in the Philippines.111 J9JC9B0M 84. When may the SEC Exercise its power of investigation? When it deems necessary to determine whether any person has violated or is about to violate any provision of the SRC.112 85. How does the SEC proceed in the prosecution of criminal complaints/violations of the SRC and its Implementing Rules and Regulations? The Commission shall refer the criminal complaint to the Department of Justice for preliminary investigation and prosecution before the proper court.113 86. Can the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) issue a cease and desist order (CDO) without a formal charge? Yes. To equally protect individuals and corporations from baseless and improvident issuances, the authority of the SEC under ‘"Securities and Exchange Commission v. Santos, G.R. No. 195542, March 19, 2014. "2Section 53, SRC. "’Section 53.1, SRC. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 56 this rule is nonetheless with defined limits. A cease and desist order may only be issued by the Commission after proper investigation or verification, and upon showing that the acts sought to be restrained could result in injury or fraud to the investing public. In one case, the Court held that the Primasa educational plans were not registered with the SEC. Thus, a continued sale by the company would operate as fraud to its investors, and would cause grave or irreparable injury or prejudice to the investing public, grounds which could justify the issuance of a cease and desist order under Section 64 of the SRC.114 87. What are the different administrative sanctions that the Commission may impose for violations of the SRC? If. after due notice and hearing, the Commission finds that: (a) There is a violation of the SRC, its rules, or its orders; (b) Any registered broker or dealer, or associated person thereof has failed reasonably to supervise, with a view to preventing violations, another person subject to supervision who commits any such violation; (c) Any registrant or other person has, in a registration statement or in other reports, applications, accounts, records, or documents required by law or rules to be filed with the Commission, made any untrue statement of a material fact, or omitted to state any material fact required to be stated their or necessary to make the statements therein not misleading; or, in the case of an underwriter, has failed to conduct an inquiry with reasonable diligence to insure that a registration statement is accurate and complete in all material respects; or (d) Any person has refused to permit any lawful examinations into its affairs, it shall, in its discretion, and subject only' to the limitations hereinafter prescribed, impose any or all of the following sanctions as may be appropriate in light of the facts and circumstances: (i) Suspension, or revocation of any registration for the offering of securities; (ii) A fine of no less than Ten thousand pesos (P10,000.00) nor more than One million pesos (Pl,000,000.00) plus not more than Two thousand pesos (P2,000.00) for each day of continuing violation; 114Primanila Plans, Inc. v. SEC, G.R. No. 193791, August 2, 2014. V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8799) 57 (iii) In the case of a violation of Sections 19.2, 20, 24, 26, and 27, disqualification from being an officer, member of the Board of Directors, or person performing similar functions, of an issuer required to file reports under Section 17 of the SRC or any other act, rule or regulation administered by the Commission; (iv) In the case of a violation of Section 34, a fine of no more than three (3) times the profit gained or loss avoided as result of the purchase, sale, or communication proscribed by such Section, and (v) Other penalties within the power of the Commission to impose.116 The imposition of the foregoing administrative sanctions shall be without prejudice to the filing of criminal charges against the individuals responsible for the violation.116 J9JC9B0M The Commission shall have the power to issue writs of execution to enforce the provisions of Section 54.3 and to enforce payment of the fees and other dues collectible under the SRC.11’ If offender is a corporation, partnership or association or other juridical entity, the penalty shall be imposed upon such juridical entity and upon the officers responsible for the violation. If such officer is an alien, in addition to the penalties, shall be deported without further proceedings after service of sentence.118 88. What are the rules on proxy solicitation? The rules on proxy solicitation are as follows: 1. Proxies must be issued and proxy solicitation must be made in accordance with rules and regulations issued by the Commission;"9 2. Proxies must be in writing, signed by the stockholder or his duly authorized representative and file before the scheduled meeting with the corporate secretary.120 "“Section 54.1, SRC. "“Section 54.2, SRC. "’Section 54.3, SRC. "“Section 73, SRC. "“Section 20, SRC. '“Section 20.2, SRC. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 58 89. 3. Unless otherwise provided in the proxy, it shall be valid only for the meeting for which it is intended. No proxy shall be valid only for the meting for which it is intended. No proxy shall be valid and effective for a period longer than five (5) years at one time.131 4. No broker or dealer shall give any proxy, consent or any authorization, in respect of any security carried for the account of the customer, to a person other than the customer, without written authorization of such customer.132 5. A broker or dealer who holds or acquire the proxy for at least ten percent (10%) or such percentage as the commission may prescribe of the outstanding share of such issuer, shall submit a report identifying the beneficial owner of 10 days after such acquisition, for its own account or customer, to the issuer of security, to the exchange where the security is traded and to the Commission.123 6. The person who intends to solicit from the pubic must file a proxy statement with the SEC and pay the corresponding fees. Who has the power to investigate violations of SEC rules on proxy solicitation or to set aside the action taken by the corporate secretary relating to the validation of proxies? The power of the SEC to investigate violations of its rules on proxy solicitation is unquestioned when proxies are obtained to vote on matters unrelated to intra-corporate controversies. However, when proxies are solicited in relation to the election of corporate directors, the resulting controversy, even if it ostensibly raised the violation of the SEC rules on proxy solicitation, should be properly seen as an election controversy within the original and exclusive jurisdiction of the trial courts by virtue of Section 5.2 of the SRC in relation to Section 5(c) of P.D. No. 902-A. If the validation of proxies in this case relates to the determination of the existence of ““Section 20.3, SRC. '“Section 20.4, SRC. ‘“Section 20.5, SRC. V. SECURITIES REGULATION CODE (REPUBLIC ACT NO. STM) r>9 a quorum for the election of directors, the SEC has no jurisdiction over the dispute. It partakes of an election contest which is an intra­ corporate controversy cognizable by the RTC.124 In other words, if the corporate secretary accepts or rejects proxies in violation of the law or the by-laws of the corporation on matters that are not intra-corporate in nature, such as approval of the various corporate acts required under the Revised Corporation Code, the aggrieved party may file a petition with the SEC to nullify the resolution of the Secretary. He may even pray for the issuance of a cease and desist order against the use of the proxies when warranted under the circumstances.126 However, if the proxies were obtained on matters which are intra-corporate in nature, such as the election and removal of directors and corporate officers and the determination of quorum for the election of directors, the RTC has jurisdiction to hear the disputes arising from validation of proxies. In this regard, the validation of proxies will be considered an election contest, falling under the Rules on Intra-Corporate Controversy. J9JC9B0M 90. What is an SEC Disclosure obligation? An SEC Disclosure obligation require public companies to disclose to the SEC and to the company shareholders financial data on a regular basis as well as material information about the company. 91. What companies are subject to SEC disclosure rules? Public companies, are subject to detailed disclosure regulations about their financial condition, operating results, management compensation, and other areas of their business. Public companies, as previously stated, are those companies whose shares are listed or publicly traded on an Exchange or even though not listed, have assets equivalent to at least Php50 million, and with 200 or more stockholders owning at least 100 shares of stock each. ’“Securities and Exchange Commission v. Honorable Court of Appeals. Omico Corporation, et al., G.R. No. 187702; Astra Securities Corporation v. Omico Corpora­ tion, et al., G.R. No. 189014, October 22, 2014 reiterating Government Service Insur­ ance System v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 183805, April 16, 2009. 125 J9JC9B0M I VI. BANKING i. What is a letter of credit? A letter of credit is any arrangement, however named or described, whereby a bank, acting upon the request of its client or on its own behalf, agrees to pay another against stipulated documents, provided that the terms of the credit are complied with? 2. Explain the nature of a letter of credit as a financial device.2 A letter of credit is a financial device developed by merchants as a convenient and relatively safe mode of dealing with the sale of goods to satisfy the seemingly irreconcilable interest of the seller, who refuses to part with his goods before he is paid, and a buyer, who wants to have control of the goods before paying. To break the impasse, the buyer may be required to contract a bank to issue a letter of credit in favor of the seller so that, by virtue of the letter of credit, the issuing bank engages to pay the seller upon his presentation of documents required by the letter of credit. The buyer and the seller agree on what documents are to be presented for payment, but ordinarily they are documents of title evidencing or attesting to the shipment of the goods to the buyer. Once the credit is established, the seller ships the goods to the buyer and in the process secures the required shipping documents or documents of title, such as the bill of lading and commercial invoices describing the goods shipped. To get paid, the seller executes a draft and presents it together with the required documents to the issuing bank. The issuing bank redeems the draft and pays cash to the seller if it finds that the documents submitted by the seller conform with what the letter of credit requires. The bank then obtains possession of the documents upon paying the seller. The transaction is completed when the buyer reimburses the issuing bank and acquires the ■Section 2, Uniform Customs and Practices for Documentary Credit. 2BAR 2012. 60 VI. HANKING 61 documents entitling him to the goods. Under this arrangement, the seller gets paid only if he delivers the documents of title over the goods, while the buyer acquires said documents and control over the goods only after reimbursing the bank.'1 In other words, through a letter of credit, the bank substitutes its own promise to pay for one of its customers who in return promises to pay the bank the amount of funds mentioned in the letter of credit plus credit or commitment fees mutually agreed upon.4 The mere opening of a letter of credit, however, does not involve specific appropriation of a sum of money in favor of the beneficiary. To be able to collect, it should tender the stipulated documents and comply with the terms of the credit.6 J9JC9B0M The foregoing transaction illustrates a commercial or import letter of credit. A letter of credit, being a mere security arrangement, cannot exist without a main or originating contract. If the originating contract is a sale or importation of goods, the letter of credit is referred to as an import or commercial letter of credit. If both the buyer-applicant and the seller-beneficiary are situated in the Philippines, the letter of credit is called a domestic letter of credit. However, letters of credit are also used in non-sale settings where they serve to reduce the risk of nonperformance. Generally, letters of credit in non-sale settings have come to be known as standby letters of credit. Examples of non-sale transactions that a standby letter of credit may secure are loan transactions,6 transactions requiring payment of fees,7 and the construction of a power plant.8 The documents which are submitted to the issuing bank to be entitled to payment are those showing that the debtor or obligor defaulted or failed to perform his obligation under the originating contract underlying the letter of credit. 3Bank of America Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. 105395, December 10, 1993. ■■Prudential Bank v. Intermediate Appellate Court, et al., G.R. No. 74SS6, December 8, 1992. 6Feati Bank & Trust Company v. Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. 94209, April 30, 1991. 6Insular Bank of Asia & America v. Intermediate Appellate Court, et at, G.R. No. 74834, November 17, 1988. ’Metropolitan Waterworks and Sewerage Systems v. Hon. Reynaldo Daway, et al., G.R. No. 160732, June 21, 2004. ®Transfield Philippines v. Luzon Hydro Corporation, et al., G.R. No. 146717, May 19, 2006. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 62 What are the kinds of letter of credit? 3. A letter of credit may be: a. Commercial or import letter of credit - It is one where the main contract underlying the letter of credit is a sale or importation. The issuing bank undertakes to pay upon presentation of documents showing that the beneficiary has taken the necessary steps to comply with his obligation under the main contract underlying the letter of credit. b. Standby letter of credit - It is one where the transaction underlying the letter of credit is not a sale transaction. The issuing bank undertakes to pay the beneficiary of the letter of credit upon his presentation of the stipulated documents showing that the debtor has defaulted in his obligation under the main contract underlying the letter of credit. c. Irrevocable - It is one which cannot, during its lifetime, be cancelled or modified without the express permission of the beneficiary. It was held that the issuance of a court order releasing the proceeds of an irrevocable letter of credit to the applicant, which was issued to pay for tobacco purchased from the beneficiary of the letter of credit, was an error as it violated the irrevocable nature of the letter of credit. The proceeds are payable to the beneficiary, not to the applicant.9 d. Revocable - It is a letter of credit which may be changed or cancelled by the issuing bank at any time and for any reason even without the consent of the beneficiary. e. Confirmed — It is one where the letter of credit is guaranteed by adding payment confirmation by the advising bank or any third bank (confirming bank) on behalf of the issuing bank. The confirming bank lends credence to the letter of credit as if it is the one that issued the letter of credit. Confirmation can be added only to irrevocable and not to the revocable credits. ’Philippine Virginia Tobacco Administration v. De los Angeles, G.R. No. L-27829, August 19, 1988. 1 J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 4. 63 Is an irrevocable letter of credit synonymous with a confirmed letter of credit? An irrevocable letter of credit is not synonymous with a confirmed letter of credit. In an irrevocable letter of credit, the issuing bank may not, without the consent of the beneficiary and the applicant, revoke its undertaking under the letter, whereas, in a confirmed letter of credit, the correspondent bank gives an absolute assurance to the beneficiary that it will undertake the issuing bank’s obligation as its own according to the terms and conditions of the credit.10 5. What laws or rules govern a letter of credit? A letter of credit is a commercial transaction. It is governed by its own provisions, by the Code of Commerce, and by usages and customs. The Code of Commerce provides that in the absence of applicable laws governing commercial transactions, customs and usages shall be made to apply. Consistent with the rulings in several cases, usage and customs refer to the Uniform Customs and Practices (UCP) for Documentary Credit, a codification of customs and usages governing letter of credit prepared by the International Chamber of Commerce. The Supreme Court has recognized the validity and applicability of UCP in resolving issues and disputes relating to letter of credit." The use of international custom in our jurisdiction is justified by Article 2 of the Code of Commerce which provides that acts of commerce are governed by, among others, usages and customs generally observed. The UCP applies even if it is not incorporated in the letter of credit.12 6. Is a letter of credit a negotiable instrument? A letter of credit is not a negotiable instrument because it is does not have the elements of negotiability under Section 1 of the Negotiable Instruments Law. It is not payable to order or bearer. The promise to pay by the issuer of the letter of credit is not unconditional, as in fact, it is conditioned on the submission of stipulated documents and compliance with the terms of credit. 10Feati Bank & Trust Company v. Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. 94209, April 30, 1991. "Hong Kong & Shanghai Banking Corporation v. National Steel Corporation, G.R. No. 183486, February 24, 2016. '2Ibid.; BAR 2015. J9JC9B0M w DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II Not being a negotiable instrument, a letter of credit does not enjoy the presumption of consideration. However, the draft drawn in connection with a letter of credit, if it is negotiable on its face, is a negotiable instrument and as such, carries the presumption that it has been issued for a valuable consideration. The draft may be used to support the claim for reimbursement by the issuer of the letter of credit against the importer-applicant of the letter of credit which denied receipt of the loan and the shipped goods.13 7. Is the issuer of the letter of credit liable as a guarantor or surety? While a letter of credit is a security arrangement, the bank that issued the letter of credit is not liable as a guarantor or a surety. In AZ11SS u. Daway, MWSS granted Maynilad, under a Concession Agreement, a 20-year period to manage and operate the existing MWSS water delivery and sewerage services in the West Zone Service Area of Metro Manila, for which Maynilad undertook to pay the corresponding concession fees on the dates agreed upon. To secure the payment of concession fees and other obligations under the Concessionaire Agreement, Maynilad procured a standby letter of credit from a consortium of banks. Maynilad defaulted on its fees. MWSS submitted a written notice to the issuing banks that in view of the failure of Maynilad to perform its obligations, it was drawing on the standby letter of credit. Prior to this, however, Maynilad filed a petition for rehabilitation with the RTC of Quezon City. The RTC found the Petition for Rehabilitation to be sufficient in form and substance and issued a Stay Order staying enforcement of all claims, whether for money or otherwise and whether such enforcement is by court action or otherwise, against the petitioner, its guarantors and sureties not solidarily liable with the petitioner. It was held thatthe stay order issued by the rehabilitation court does not preclude the beneficiary from collecting on the letter of credit because the liability of the bank that issued the letter of credit is solidary with the principal debtor, the same being a direct, primary and absolute undertaking to pay the beneficiary upon presentation of the required documents and is not conditioned on the prior exhaustion of the debtor’s assets.H 13Charles Lee v. Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. 117913, February 1, 2002 ■■'Metropolitan Waterworks and Sewerage Systems v. Hon. Reynaldo Daway, et al., G.R. No. 160732, June 21, 2004. I VI. BANKING 65 Also, while the surety is liable solidarily with the principal debtor, the surety has no duty to indemnify the creditor until the latter establishes the fact of the obligor’s non-performance. The creditor may have to establish that fact in litigation. In the standby letter of credit, the beneficiary avoids that litigation burden and receives his money promptly upon presentation of the required documents. In case the beneficiary’s presentation of those documents is not rightful,the applicant may sue the beneficiary in tort, in contract, or in breach of warranty, but it does not preclude the beneficiary from collecting on the letter of credit16 J9JC9B0M The settlement of a dispute between the parties is not a prerequisite for the release of funds under the letter of credit. Payment is simply based on presentation of documents. Otherwise, there would be no practical and beneficial use for letter of credit in commercial transactions. A surety is only an accessory contract whereas a letter of credit is an absolute undertaking to pay the money advanced or the amount for which the credit is given. It is a primary obligation and not an accessory contract. In one case involving a loan of the debtor secured by a standby letter of credit, it was held that the payment made by the debtor cannot be added in computing the issuing bank’s liability under its own standby letter of credit. Payment made by the debtor is in compliance with his own prestation under the loan agreement. Although these payments could result in the reduction of the actual amount which could be collected from the issuing bank, the latter’s separate undertaking under the letter of credit remains. Although the letter of credit is a security arrangement, it is not converted thereby into a contract of guaranty.1C Of course, the issuing bank may obtain reimbursement from the debtor, as applicant of the letter of credit, any amount duly paid to the creditor, as beneficiary of the letter of credit. In case of excess payment, the debtor may recover it from the creditor to prevent unjust enrichment. 8. Who are the parties to a letter of credit? What are their respective rights and obligations? The parties to a letter of credit and their respective rights and obligations are as follows: Luzon Hydro Corporation, et al., G.R. No. 146717, ‘“Transfield Philippines May 19, 2006. ‘“Insular Bank of Asia & America v. Intermediate Appellate Court, et al., G.R. No. 74834, November 17, 1988. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 66 a. b. Applicant i. The person who is either the importer or buyer in a commercial letter of credit or the obligor/debtor in a standby letter of credit. He procures the letter of credit and agrees to pay the issuing bank the charges therefor and to reimburse the issuing bank the amount duly paid to the beneficiary under the letter of credit. ii. He has no obligation to reimburse the issuing bank if the latter pays without the stipulated documents or if the documents received are different from those stipulated in the letter of credit. iii. He has the right to have the marginal deposit deducted from the principal obligation under the letter of credit and to have the interest computed only on the balance and not on the face value thereof.17 The Issuing Bank i. It undertakes to pay the beneficiary upon the latter’s submission of stipulated documents/compliance with the credit despite any breach in the main contract underlying the letter of credit. ii. After due payment, the issuing bank is entitled to reimbursement as a matter of right. Reimbursement includes debiting the bank account of the applicant, if any, and applying the deposit against the obligation of the applicant with the issuing bank.18 1'Ramon Abad v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. L-42735, January 22, 1990. A marginal deposit is a collateral security given by the applicant, and is supposed to be returned to him upon his compliance with his secured obligation. Consequently, the bank pays no interest on the marginal deposit, unlike ordinary bank deposit which earns interest in the bank. Therefore, the Supreme Court ruled that it is only fair then that the importer’s marginal deposit (if one was made, as in this case), should be set off against his debt, for while the importer earns no interest on his marginal deposit, the bank, apart from being able to use said deposit for its own purposes, also earns interest on the money it loaned to the importer. It would be onerous to compute interest and other charges on the face value of the letter of credit which the bank issued, without first crediting or setting off the marginal deposit which the importer paid to the bank. ’“Land Bank of the Philippines V. Monet Export and Manufacturing Corporation, G.R. No. 161865, March 10, 2005. J9JC9B0M VI. HANKING c. 67 iii. The failure of the beneficiary to present the draft to the applicant does not affect the right of the issuing bank to reimbursement. It is because the draft is presented to the issuing bank and not the applicant. More so, if the draft is payable at sight. Sight drafts do not require presentment for acceptance.19 iv. An issuing bank which paid the beneficiary of an expired letter of credit can recover payment from the applicant, which obtained the goods from the beneficiary, to prevent unjust enrichment.20 The Beneficiary i. The beneficiary is the one entitled to payment from the issuing bank after submission of stipulated documents and compliance with the terms of the credit. ii. He has a prestation to do under the main contract but his failure to fulfill his obligation thereunder does not negate his right to collect payment from the issuing bank, as long as he is able to submit the required documents and comply with the terms of the credit, without prejudice to his liability against the applicant under the law on contract and damages. The number of parties, particularly in international trade practice, may be increased depending on the need of the issuing bank to engage a correspondent bank. The correspondent bank is classified differently depending on the functions that it performs. d. The Advising/Notifying Bank i. The advising bank determines the apparent authenticity of the letter of credit, notifies the beneficiary of the opening of the letter of credit and transmits the copy thereof to the beneficiary.21 ii. It does not guarantee the genuineness or due execution of the letter of credit. It is not liable for 19Prudential Bank v. Intermediate Appellate Court, et al., G.R. No. 74886, December 8, 1992. 20Rodzssen v. Far East Bank & Trust Company, G.R. No. 109087, May 9, 2001. 2,Bank of America v. Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. 105395, December 10, 1993. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 68 damages even if the letter of credit turns out to be spurious, provided the spurious character is not apparent on the face of the instrument. iii. It has no obligation to pay the beneficiary unless it is also the paying or confirming bank. While it has no obligation to pay the beneficiary of the letter of credit unless it is also the paying or confirming bank, the advising bank, independently of its function as such bank, may buy the draft of the beneficiary and becomes the holder of the instrument.22 9. Yeti Export Corporation (YEC), thru its President, negotiated for Yahoo Bank of Manila (YBM) to issue a letter of credit to course the importation of electronic parts from China to be sold and distributed to various electronic manufacturing companies in Manila. YBM issued the letter of credit and forwarded it to its correspondent bank, Yunan Bank (YB) of Beijing, to notify the Chinese exporters to submit the bill of lading in the name of YBM covering the goods to be exported to Manila and to pay the Chinese exporters the purchase price upon verification of the authenticity of the shipping documents. The electronic parts arrived in the Port of Manila, and YBM released them to the custody of YEC as an entrustee under a trust receipt. When YEC unpacked the imported parts in its warehouse, it found that they were not only of inferior quality but also did not fit the descriptions contained in the bill of lading. YEC refused to pay YBM the amount owed under the trust receipt. YBM thereafter commenced the following: Civil suit to hold YB liable for failure to ensure that the electronic parts loaded for exportation in China corresponded with those described in the bill of lading. Is there any merit in the case against YB?23 There is no merit in the case against YB. YB only acted as an advising bank whose only obligation after determining the apparent authenticity of the letter of credit is to transmit a copy to the beneficiary of the letter of credit. It has no obligation to ensure that -Ibid. 23BAR2018. I J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 69 the goods loaded for exportation corresponded with those described in the bill of lading. Even if it acted as a confirming or negotiating bank, such kind of correspondent bank has no similar obligation. The Paying Bank f. g. i. The paying bank is the agent of the issuing bank to facilitate payment to the beneficiary. It may also buy the draft of the beneficiary, if such draft is drawn on the issuing bank or another designated bank not in the city of the beneficiary.24 ii. The paying bank can also be the advising bank. The Confirming Bank i. The confirming bank lends credence to the letter of credit issued by a lesser-known bank as if it were the one that issued the letter of credit. ii. Its obligation is similar to the issuing bank. Thus, the beneficiary may tender documents to the confirming bank and collect payment.26 iii. The confirming bank collects fees for such engagement and obtains reimbursement from the issuing bank. The Negotiating Bank i. The negotiating bank becomes a party to the letter of credit transaction after it buys the draft drawn by the beneficiary and becomes the holder thereof. ii. As holder, it has the right to payment from the bank primarily liable on the draft (either the issuing bank or the confirming bank).26 iii. If the party primarily liable on the letter of credit (issuing bank or confirming bank) refuses to honor the draft, the negotiating bank has the right to proceed against the drawer thereof.27 24Charles Lee v. Court of Appeals, supra. ™Ibid. ™Ibid. ™Ibid. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 70 10. What are the modes of payment to the beneficiary of a letter of credit? They are as follows: 11. a. The issuer may directly pay the beneficiary; b. The issuer may accept the draft of the beneficiary; c. The issuer may authorize another to pay or accept the draft of the beneficiary; and d. Through negotiation by the beneficiary of the dr-aft payable to his order.28 Does a correspondent bank automatically obligation of a confirming bank? assume the In order to consider a correspondent bank as a confirming bank, it must have assumed a direct obligation to the seller as if it had issued the letter of credit itself. If the correspondent bank was . confirming bank, then a categorical declaration should have been tated in the letter of credit that the correspondent bank is to honor all drafts drawn in conformity with the letter of credit.29 12. What are the three (3) distinct relationships arising from a letter of credit transaction? A letter of credit transaction is a composite of at least three (3) distinct but intertwined relationships being concretized in a contract: a. One contract relationship links the party applying for the letter of credit (the account party or buyer or importer) and the party for whose benefit the letter of credit is issued (the beneficiary or seller or exporter). b. A second contract relationship is between the account party and the issuing bank. Under this contract, (sometimes called the “Application and Agreement” or the “Reimbursement Agreement”), the account party ^Section 2, Uniform Customs and Practices for Documentary Credit. 29Marphil Export Corporation v. Allied Banking Corporation, Substituted by Philippine National Bank, Respondent, G.R. No. 187922, September 21, 2016. J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 71 among other things, applies to the issuing bank for a specified letter of credit and agrees to reimburse the bank for amounts paid by that bank pursuant to the letter of credit. C. The third contract relationship is established between the issuing bank and the beneficiary, in order to support the contract referred to in letter “a” and to pay monies to the beneficiary. Certain other parties may be added to the foregoing, but the above three are the indispensable ones.30 It was held that the failure of the buyer to procure a letter of credit did not prevent the consummation of the contract of sale that the letter of credit would have secured. The contract of sale is consummated by the meeting of the minds of the parties on the cause, object and consideration of the sale. The seller is, therefore, entitled damages if the buyer could not accept the delivery or if the seller is forced to sell the object of the sale at a loss.31 13. What is the Doctrine of Independence?32 The doctrine of independence provides that the rights and obligations of the parties to a letter of credit are independent of the right and obligations of the parties to the underlying transaction. The legal relationships among: a) the issuing bank and the beneficiary; b) the issuing bank and the applicant; and c) the beneficiary and the applicant, while interrelated, are separate, distinct, and independent of one another. Thus, the beneficiary of the letter of credit, which is able to comply with the documentary requirements under the letter of credit, must be paid by the issuing or confirming bank, notwithstanding any issue on the fulfilment or non-fulfilment of main contract underlying the letter of credit transaction, say a contract of sale of goods where the buyer is not satisfied with the quality and/or quantity of the goods which the seller shipped or delivered. “Reliance Commodities v. Daewoo Industrial Co., G.R. No. L-100831, December 17, 1993. 3'Ibid. “BAR 2010, 2012, 2016. J9JC9B0M 72 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II In other words, in determining its obligation to pay the beneficiary, the issuing bank is not required to ascertain whether or not the beneficiary has performed his prestation under the main contract. The issuing bank is liable to pay the beneficiary upon the latter's submission of the stipulated documents and compliance with the terms of the credit regardless of any breach of contract by the beneficiary against the applicant of the letter of credit. Conversely, since the breach of contract is only between the parties in the underlying contract, it does not affect the right of the issuing bank to obtain reimbursement from the applicant. Such right is based on its own agreement with the latter. 14. Cite jurisprudence where the Supreme Court applied the doctrine of independence. In one case, a buyer applied with BPI for an irrevocable commercial letter of credit to cover the purchase of goods described in the covering letter of credit application as “dyestuffs of various •olors.” However, upon chemical test, the dyestuffs turned out to ie colored chalks. It was held that BPI, as issuer of the letter of credit, has no obligation to ensure that the goods shipped under the covering letter of credit conform to the item appearing thereon. The doctrine of independence negates any duty on the part of a bank to verify' whether what has been described in letters of credits actually tallies with what was loaded aboard the ship. In letter of credit transactions, all parties concerned deal only with the documents and not with the goods shipped to the buyer. Accordingly, BPI has the right to obtain reimbursement from the applicant of the letter of credit the value of the draft paid to the seller.33 In Land Bank v. Monet’s Export and Manufacturing Corporation,34 it was held that when the Issuing Bank paid the beneficiary because the latter presented all the stipulated shipping documents and after payment, the Bank debited the account of the applicant corresponding to the amount the Bank paid under the letter of credit, the Bank is not liable for damages even if the shipment did not conform to the specifications of the applicant. “Bank of the Philippine Islands v. De Reny Fabric Industries, et al., G.R. No. L-24821, October 16,1970. ^G.R. No. 161865, March 10, 2005. ■ J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 73 Under the doctrine of independence, the obligation of the issuing bank to pay the beneficiary arises once the latter is able to submit the stipulated documents under the letter of credit regardless of the fulfillment or non-fulfillment of the contract supporting the letter of credit. Once the issuing bank accordingly pays, it has the right to obtain reimbursement from the applicant regardless of any breach in the contract underlying the letter of credit. Thus, the Bank is not liable if as a consequence of such lawful act of debiting the account of the applicant, the latter lacked the funds to purchase raw materials to meet the orders of various customers and orders were cancelled resulting in lost profits. The doctrine is likewise applicable to a standby letter of credit. In one case, the Supreme Court ruled that in a standby letter of credit issued to secure a loan obligation, any payment of the debtor to the creditor should not be deducted from the total obligation of the issuing bank to the beneficiary. The issuing bank, after payment of the full amount, is entitled to full reimbursement from the debtor. But the debtor may recover excess payment from the creditor to prevent unjust enrichment.36 In another case, the Supreme Court held that the issuer of a standby letter of credit may pay the beneficiary upon its submission of a certification of default, the document required by the letter of credit, despite of the fact that the issue of default is still subject of arbitration.36 15. Where is the doctrine of independence derived? It is based on Article 17 of UCP which provides that an issuing bank assumes no liability or responsibility “for the form, sufficiency, accuracy, genuineness, falsification or legal effect of any documents, or for the general and/or particular conditions stipulated in the documents or superimposed thereon (xxx).” Thus, as long as the proper documents are presented, the issuing bank has an obligation to pay even if the buyer should later on refuse payment. It was held that to allow the issuing bank to refuse to honor the letter of credit simply because it could not collect first from the buyer is to countenance a breach of the Independence Principle.37 “Insular Life, ibid. 36Transfield v. Luzon Hydro Corporation, supra. 37The Hongkong & Shanghai Banking Corporation, Limited v. National Steel Corporation, el al., G.R. No. 183486, February 24, 2016. J9JC9B0M 74 16. D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II "B" entered into a contract with *'S" for the purchase of one container of Johnny Walker whisky. Upon the instance of B, ABC Bank issued a letter of credit in favor of S, undertaking to pay the latter upon submission of the shipping documents showing compliance with S' obligation under the contract of sale. However, S caused the shipment of container containing Emperador brandy but, through fraud, was able to submit the shipping documents required by the letter of credit. As a consequence, ABC Bank paid S. Can ABC Bank obtain reimbursement from B, or may B invoke the breach of contract on the part of S to validly refuse payment? ABC Bank may obtain reimbursement from B despite the breach of contract on the part of S. Under the independence principle, once the issuing bank pays the beneficiary of the letter of credit upon the latter’s submission of the stipulated documents, its right of reimbursement comes as a matter of right. Such right cannot be impaired by the non-fulfillment of the obligation under the main contract underlying the letter of credit. 17. San Miguel Corporation (SMC, for brevity) entered into an Exclusive Dealership Agreement with "B" giving the latter the right to trade, deal, market or otherwise sell its various beer products. B applied for a credit line with SMC, but one of the requirements for the credit line was a letter of credit. Thus, B applied for and was granted a letter of credit by PNB. Under the credit agreement, the PNB has the obligation to release the proceeds of B's credit line to SMC upon presentation of the invoices and official receipts of B's purchases of SMC beer products. B availed himself of his credit line with PNB and started selling SMC's beer products. B eventually defaulted in the payment of his obligation to SMC. Demands to pay were unheeded. Thus, SMC filed a complaint for sum of money against PNB and B. The Court rendered judgment finding B solely liable and omitted by inadvertence to insert in its decision the phrase "without prejudice to the decision that will be made against PNB." PNB moved to terminate the proceedings against it arguing that the court's decision finding B solely liable to pay the entire amount sought to be recovered by SMC, has settled the obligation of both B and PNB, and that there is no longer any ground to hold PNB for trial and make a separate judgment against it; otherwise, SMC will recover twice for the same cause of action. J9JC9B0M VI. HANKING 75 Is PNB correct? No. The obligation of 13 to pay under its agreement with SMC is distinct and independent from the right of SMC to draw on the letter of credit. Under the independence principle, the seller or beneficiary is assured of prompt payment independent of any breach of the main contract and precludes the issuing bank from determining whether the main contract is actually fulfilled or not.38 In effect, based on the foregoing case, in a commercial letter of credit, the beneficiary has two (2) options: either to collect payment of the purchase price from the buyer, or to draw on the letter of credit upon presentation of the stipulated documents. If the beneficiary is fully paid by the buyer, it loses its right of recourse against the issuer of the letter of credit. If the beneficiary draws on the letter of credit, it can no longer collect from the buyer as it will result in unjust enrichment. It is the issuing bank instead which has the right to obtain reimbursement from the buyer, as applicant of the letter of credit. Similarly, until the judgment against the buyer is fully satisfied, the seller, as beneficiary of the letter of credit, can still collect on the letter of credit. 18. What is the Fraud Exception Principle? The fraud exception principle is an exception to the doctrine of independence. Under the fraud exception principle, there is fraudulent abuse of the credit. The beneficiary may be enjoined from collecting on the letter of credit if the following elements are present: a) there is fraud on the part of the beneficiary; b) fraud must be in relation to the independent purpose or character of the credit; c) unless the beneficiary is restrained, the applicant shall suffer grave and irreparable injury. For the fraud exception principle to serve as an exception to the doctrine of independence, the fraud must not be in relation to the performance of the main contract but in relation to the independent purpose or character of the credit as when he presents to the issuing or confirming bank spurious or fraudulent documents that contain material facts that, to his knowledge, are untrue.39 “Philippine National Bank v. San Miguel Corporation, G.R. No. 186063, January 15, 2014. 39Transfield Luzon Hydro Corporation, ibid. J9JC9B0M 76 D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II For example, the seller-beneficiary that shipped goods to the buyer-applicant which are different from the object of the underlying contract of sale, may collect payment from the issuing bank upon presentation of the stipulated documents. The fraud the seller-beneficiary committed relates to the performance of his obligation under the underlying contract. As discussed, he may demand payment from the issuing bank based on the doctrine of independence, but is liable for breach contract to the buyer. Suppose, however, that no goods were shipped in favor of the buyer-applicant but the seller-beneficiary falsified the bill of lading, the commercial invoices and other documents required by the letter of credit. In this case, the fraud exception applies. 19. Transfield Philippines, Inc. ("Transfield") and Luzon Hydro Corporation ("LHC") entered into a Turnkey Contract whereby Transfield undertook to construct a hydro-electric power station. To secure performance of Transfield's obligation, it procured in favor of LHC two (2) standby letters of credit, with Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited ("ANZ Bank"), and with Security Bank Corporation ("SBC") as the issuers. Transfield sought various extensions of time to complete the Project. The extensions were requested allegedly due to several factors which prevented the completion of the Project on target date, such as force majeure occasioned by typhoon, barricades, and demonstrations. LHC denied the requests. This gave rise to a series of legal actions between the parties. The first of the actions was a Request for Arbitration which LHC filed before the Construction Industry Arbitration Commission (CIAC). This was followed by another Request for Arbitration, this time filed by Transfield before the International Chamber of Commerce (ICC). Because the Project was not completed on time, LHC drew on the letter of credit by submitting the certification of default required by the letter of credit. Was the drawdown on the letters of credit valid or should the funds be returned to the applicant of the letter of credit, considering that the issue of its default had not yet been resolved with finality by the CIAC and/or the ICC? J J9JC9B0M VI. HANKING 77 The drawdown is valid. The letters of credit are independent of the main contract between the parties and as such, the issuers have no responsibility to investigate the authenticity or accuracy of the certificates or the declarant’s capacity or entitlement to so certify. Owing to the nature and purpose of the standby letters of credit, the issuers were left with little or no alternative but to honor the credit upon presentation of the stipulated documents. In this case, Transfield also invoked the fraud exception principle. It averred that LHC’s call on the letters of credit is wrongful because it fraudulently misrepresented to the banks that there is already a breach in the Turnkey Contract knowing full well that this is yet to be determined by the arbitral tribunals. It asserted that the fraud exception exists when the beneficiary, for the purpose of drawing on the credit, fraudulently presented to the confirming bank, documents that contain, expressly or by implication, material representations of fact that to his knowledge are untrue. The Supreme Court ruled that to be able to declare the call on the letter of credit wrongful or fraudulent, it is imperative to resolve, among others, whether Transfield was in fact guilty of delay in the performance of its obligation; but the Court is not called upon to rule upon the issue of default, such issue having been submitted by the parties to the jurisdiction of the arbitral tribunals pursuant to the terms embodied in their agreement.10 It would have been different if Transfield and LHC previously agreed that in case of resort to arbitration, the parties must wait for the outcome therefor before LHC can collect on the letter of credit. In such a case, the issuance of a certification of default, during the pendency of the arbitration proceedings, would be premature and fraudulent. Consequently, the fraud exception rule would have applied and LHC, as beneficiary, may be enjoined from collecting on the letter of credit. 20. F Corp., a corporation engaged in the export of fertilizers, entered into a sale of its products with Mr. P. In its relation, Bank C, F Corp.'s bank, received an irrevocable letter of credit, payable on sight, issued by Bank I for the account of its client, Mr. P, in the amount of P1,000,000.00 to cover the purchase price of the sale. In the letter of credit, Bank C was designated as the confirming bank. ■*°Transfield, ibid. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 78 After being presented the required documents under the letter of credit, Bank C issued in favor of F Corp, a cashier’s check in the amount of PI,000,000.00. Bank C then informed Bank I of the payment made pursuant to the letter of credit. Thereafter, Bank C transmitted the documents presented by F Corp, to Bank I and sought to be reimbursed for the amount it paid to F Corp. . Bank I, however, refused to reimburse Bank C for the reason that it received an e-mail coming from Mr. P that the latter will not make any payment to Bank I in relation to the letter of credit because the products shipped to him by F Corp were of substandard quality. a. Is Bank I's refusal to reimburse Bank C warranted? Explain. Bank Fs refusal to reimburse Bank C is warranted. Under the doctrine of independence, as long as the stipulated documents are presented, the issuing bank has the obligation to pay even if the iuyer should later on refuse payment. The obligation to pay on the part of the issuing bank does not depend on the fulfillment or non­ fulfillment of the main contract underlying the letter of credit but simpty upon submission of the stipulated documents. To allow Bank I to refuse to honor the Letter of Credit simply because it could not collect first from Mr. P, the buyer, is to countenance a breach of the Independence Principle.41 b. Assuming that the documents submitted by F Corp, were proven to be actually forged but were nonetheless accepted by Bank C as sufficient, may Bank I refuse Bank C's claim for reimbursement? Explain.42 Yes, Bank I may refuse Bank C’s claim for reimbursement if the documents submitted by F Corp, were proven to be actually forged but were nonetheless accepted by Bank C as sufficient. Under the fraud exception principle, the beneficiary of the letter of credit should not be entitled to payment if the following elements 4lThe Hongkong & Shanghai Banking Corporation, Limited v. National Steel Corporation and Citytrust Banking Corporation (Now Bank of The Philippine Islands), G.R. No. 183486, February 24, 2016. 42BAR 2019. J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 79 are present: a) there is fraud on the part of the beneficiary; b) the fraud constitutes fraudulent abuse of the independent purpose of the letter of credit and not only fraud under the main agreement; c) irreparable injury might follow if the beneficiary is paid. The forged documents qualify as fraud sufficient to prevent payment to F Corporation by Bank C and the right to reimbursement by Bank C from Bank I.43 21. What is the doctrine of strict compliance? Under this doctrine, the documents that the beneficiary should tender to the issuing bank or confirming bank must strictly conform to the documents stipulated. The tender of documents by the beneficiary (seller) must include all documents required by the letter. Since a bank deals only with documents, it is not in a position to determine whether or not the documents required by the letter of credit are material or superfluous. If there is omission or discrepancy, the issuing bank is not liable to pay. If the bank pays despite the incompleteness or discrepancy of the documents, it pays at its own risk and cannot obtain reimbursement from the applicant.44 In one case, the letter of credit required the issuance from the buyer that he has inspected the goods and found them to be of good condition. The buyer had obtained delivery of the goods and even sold them for a profit, but refused to issue the certification required by the letter of credit. It was held that the unjustified refusal to issue the certification does not obligate the bank to pay the seller­ beneficiary, following the doctrine of strict compliance. The remedy of the seller, in this case, is not to collect from the issuer of the letter of credit but to sue the buyer under the general law on contracts.45 22. Distinguish a letter of credit from a trust receipt. In a letter of credit transaction, the issuing bank will not release the documents of title and goods to the importer-applicant unless the latter has fully paid the bank. The bank, however, may release possession of documents and/or the goods to the importer but subject to the execution of a trust receipt, whereby the importer, 43Transfield Philippines v. Luzon Hydro Corporation, 443 SCRA 307. 44Feati Bank & Trust Company v. Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. 94209, April 30, 1991. 4SZbid. J9JC9B0M D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 80 now referred as the entrustee holds the released documents and goods in trust for the issuing bank, now called, the ontruster. While the trust receipt, may have been executed as a security on the letter of credit, still the two documents involve different undertakings and obligations. A letter of credit is an engagement by a bank or other person made at the request of a customer that the issuer will honor drafts or other demands for payment upon compliance with the conditions specified in the credit. By contrast, a trust receipt transaction is one where the entruster, who holds an absolute title or security interests over certain goods, documents or instruments, release the same to the entrustee, who executes a trust receipt binding himself to hold the goods, documents or instruments in trust for the entruster and to sell or otherwise dispose of the goods, documents and instruments with the obligation to turn over to the entruster the proceeds thereof to the extent of the amount owing to the entruster, or as appears in the trust receipt, or return the goods, documents or instruments themselves if they are unsold, or not otherwise disposed of, in accordance with the terms and conditions specified in the trust receipt.46 The other distinctions between the two transactions are as follows: A. 1. There are two parties to a trust receipt, the entruster and the entrustee, whereas there are basic parties to a etter of credit, the applicant, the issuing bank and the beneficiary; 2. The failure of the applicant to pay the issuing bank merely gives rise to civil liability whereas the failure of the entrustee to deliver the proceeds of the sale of the goods, or to return the goods to the entruster, in case of non-sale, is considered a criminal offense. The New Central Bank Act a23. State policies What is the policy of the State regarding the creation of a central monetary authority? shall maintain a central monetary authority that , ii 'io'6 nction and operate as an independent and accountable s a <6Bank of Commerce v. Teresita Serrano, G.R. No. 151895, February 16, 2005. J9JC9B0M VI. HANKING Hl body corporate in the discharge of its mandated responsibilities concerning money, banking and credit. In line with this policy, and considering its unique functions and responsibilities, the central monetary authority established, while being a government-owned corporation, shall enjoy fiscal and administrative autonomy.47 b. 24. Creation of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas What is the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas ("BSP")? It is a government-owned-and-controlled corporation which the law has established to be the independent central monetary authority of the country.48 25. What are the responsibilities and primary objectives of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas? The Bangko Sentral shall provide policy directions in the areas of money, banking, and credit. It shall have supervision over the operations of banks and exercise such regulatory and examination powers over the quasi-banking operations of non-bank financial institutions. As may be determined by the Monetary Board, it shall likewise exercise regulatory and examination powers over money service businesses, credit granting businesses, and payment system operators. The Monetary Board is hereby empowered to authorize entities or persons to engage in money service businesses. The primary objective of the Bangko Sentral is to maintain price stability conducive to a balanced and sustainable growth of the economy and employment. It shall also promote and maintain monetary stability and the convertibility of the peso. The Bangko Sentral shall promote financial stability and closely work with the National Government, including, but not limited to, the Department of Finance, Securities and Exchange Commission, the Insurance Commission, and the Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation. The Bangko Sentral shall oversee the payment and settlement systems in the Philippines, including critical financial market infrastructures, in order to promote sound and prudent practices consistent with the maintenance of financial stability. 47Section 1, R.A. No. 7653, otherwise known as the New Central Bank. 48Section 2, R.A. No. 7653, as amended by R.A. No. 11211. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 82 In the attainment of its objectives, the Bangko Sentral shall promote broad and convenient access to high quality financial services and consider the interest of the general public.'” 26. Why is the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas considered a lender of last resort? Banks are considered the usual lenders to the public. The BSP is considered the lender of last resort because it can lend to banks and similar institutions under financial distress when they have no other means to raise funds. The general public cannot obtain loans from BSP.'”’ C. 27. Corporate powers What are the corporate powers of the BSP? The BSP is authorized to adopt, alter, and use a corporate seal which shall be judicially noticed; to enter into contracts; to lease or own real and personal property; and to sell or otherwise dispose of the same; to sue or be sued; and otherwise to do and perform any and all things that may be necessary or proper to carry out the purposes of the charter creating it. It may acquire and hold such assets and incur liabilities in connection with its operations authorized by law, or as are essential to the proper conduct of such operations. It may compromise, condone or release, in whole or in part, any claim or settled liability to the BSP; regardless of the amount involved, under such terms and conditions as may be prescribed by the Monetary Board to protect the interests of the BSP.61 28. Does the BSP have the power to prosecute for the violation of banking laws? BSP is a government corporation created principally to administer the monetary and banking system of the Republic, not a prosecution agency like the fiscal’s office. Being an artificial person, it is limited to its statutory powers and the nearest power to which prosecution of violators of banking laws may be attributed is ’’Section 3, ibid; BAR 1998. “BAR 2015. ‘’Section 5. ibid. J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 83 its power to sue and be sued. But this corporate power of litigation evidently refers to civil cases only. Mandamus will not lie to compel a prosecuting officer, like the Secretary of Justice, to prosecute a case in court. Violations of banking laws, however, constitute a public offense, the prosecution of which is a matter of public interest and hence, anyone, even private individuals, can denounce such violations before the prosecuting authorities.62 29. d. Operations of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas i. Authority to obtain data and information State the extent of the authority of BSP to obtain data and information in relation to the proper discharge of its functions and responsibilities. The Bangko Sentral shall have the authority to require from any person or entity, including government offices and instrumentalities, or government-owned-or-controlled corporations, any data, for statistical and policy development purposes in relation to the proper discharge of its functions and responsibilities: Provided, that disaggregated data gathered are subject to prevailing confidentiality laws. The Bangko Sentral through the Governor or in his absence, a duly authorized representative shall have the power to issue a subpoena for the production of the books and records for the aforesaid purpose. Those who refuse the subpoena without justifiable cause, or who refuse to supply the Bangko Sentral with data required, shall be subject to punishment for contempt in accordance with the provisions of the Rules of Court. The authority of the Bangko Sentral to require data from banks shall continue to be exercised pursuant to its supervisory powers set under the law. Data on individuals and firms, other than banks, gathered by the Bangko Sentral shall not be made available to any person or entity outside of the Bangko Sentral whether public or private except under order of the court or under such conditions as may be prescribed by the Monetary Board: Provided, however, that the collective data on firms may be released to interested persons or entities: Provided, finally, that in the case of data on banks, the provisions of Section 27 of this Act shall apply.” “Damaso Perez v. Monetary Board, et al., G.R. No. L-23307, June 30, 1967, J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 84 ii. 30. Supervision and examination Discuss the supervision and examination authority of the BSP, The BSP shall have supervision over, and conduct regular or special examinations of banking institutions and quasi-banks, including their subsidiaries and affiliates engaged in allied activities. It shall have regulatory authority over, and conduct regular or special examinations of, entities which are subject to its jurisdiction under existing laws. The department heads and the examiners of the super-vising and'or examining departments of BSP are authorized to administer oaths to any director, officer, or employee of any institution under their respective supervision or subject to their examination, and to compel the presentation of all books, documents, papers or records necessary in their judgment to ascertain the facts relative to the true condition of any institution as well as the books and records of persons and entities relative to or in connection with the operations, activities or transactions of the institution under examination, subject to the provision of existing laws protecting or safeguarding the secrecy or confidentiality of bank deposits as well as investments of private persons, natural or juridical, in debt instruments issued by the Government.63 31. Does injunction lie against the authority of BSP to conduct examination and supervision of covered entities? No restraining order or injunction shall be issued by the court enjoining the BSP from examining any institution subject to its supervision or examination, unless there is convincing proof that the action of the BSP is plainly arbitrary and made in bad faith and the petitioner or plaintiff files with the clerk or judge of the court in which the action is pending a bond executed in favor of the BSP, in an amount to be fixed by the court. The provisions of Rule 58 of the New Rules of Court insofar as they are applicable and not inconsistent herewith shall govern the issuance and dissolution of the restraining order or injunction.6,1 •'■’Section 25, R.A. No. 7653, as amended. MIbid. J9JC9B0M VI. HANKING 32. 85 What do BSP's supervisory and regulatory powers include? The BSP’s supervisory and regulatory powers include: conduct of examination to determine compliance with laws and regulations if the circumstances so warrant as determined by the Monetary Board; overseeing to ascertain that laws and regulations are complied with; regular investigation which shall not be oftener than once a year from the last date of examination to determine whether an institution is conducting its business on a safe or sound basis; and inquiring into the solvency and liquidity of the institution. If any irregularity is discovered in the process, the MB may impose appropriate sanctions, such as suspending the offender from holding office or from being employed with the CB, or placing the names of the offenders in a watchlist.55 It was held that the RTC has no jurisdiction to hear and decide a suit that seeks to place a bank under receivership or under a management committee. That authority is lodged with the BSP. The court’s jurisdiction could only have been invoked after the Monetary Board had taken action on the matter and only on the ground that the action taken was in excess of jurisdiction or with such grave abuse of discretion as to amount to lack or excess of jurisdiction.56 e. 33. Bank deposits and investments What are the requirements to be complied with if any director, officer or stockholder contracts a loan or any form of financial accommodation from his bank? The loan or financial accommodation granted to the director, officer or stockholder shall be subject to the following requirements: a. Approval requirement - the loan must be approved by at least majority of the entire board, excluding the borrowing director; b. Reportorial requirement - the loan must be reported to BSP and entered into the books and records of the bank; and, 55Romeo Busuego v. Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. 95326, March 11, 1999. 56Ana Maria Koruga v. Teodoro Arcenas, Jr., et al., G.R. No. 168332, June 19, 2009. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 86 C. Unless (he loan is non-risk, the amount of the loan shall not exceed the book value of his paid-up contribution and the amount of his unencumbered deposit. In addition to the foregoing requirements, any director, officer or stockholder who. together with his related interest, contracts a loan or any form of financial accommodation from: (1) his bank; or (2) from a bank (a) which is a subsidiary of a bank holding company of which both his bank and the lending bank are subsidiaries, or (b) in which a controlling proportion of the shares is owned by the same interest that owns a controlling proportion of the shares of his bank, in excess of five percent (5%) of the capital and surplus of the bank, or in the maximum amount permitted by law, whichever is lower, shall be required by the lending bank to waive the secrecy of his deposits of whatever nature in all banks in the Philippines. Any information obtained from an examination of his deposits shall be held strictly confidential and may be used by the examiners only in connection with their supervisory and examination responsibility or by the in an appropriate legal action it has initiated involving the deposit account.67 f. Prohibitions 34. What are the prohibited acts for the personnel of the BSP? In addition to the prohibitions found in R.A. Nos. 3019 and 6713, personnel of the BSP are hereby prohibited from: a. Being an officer, director, lawyer or agent, employee, consultant or stockholder, directly or indirectly, of any institution subject to supervision or examination by the BSP, except non-stock savings and loan associations and provident funds organized exclusively for employees of the BSP, and except as otherwise provided by law; b. Directly or indirectly requesting or receiving any gift, present or pecuniary or material benefit for himself or another, from any institution subject to supervision or examination by the BSP; c. Revealing in any manner, except under orders of the court, the Congress or any government office or agency "Section 26, ibid. i VI. BANKING 87 authorized by law, or under such conditions as may be prescribed by the Monetary Board, information relating to the condition or business of any institution. This prohibition shall not be held to apply to the giving of information to the Monetary Board or the Governor of the BSP, or to any person authorized by either of them, in writing, to receive such information; and d. Borrowing from any institution subject to supervision or examination by the Bangko Sentral unless said borrowing is transacted on an arm’s length basis, fully disclosed to the Monetary Board, and shall be subject to such rules and regulations as the Monetary Board may prescribe. Note that prior to the amendments under R.A. No. 11211, borrowings from any institution subject to supervision or examination by the BSP are prohibited unless said borrowings are adequately secured. Under the amendatory law, it is enough that the borrowing is transacted on an arm’s length basis. The prohibition against the personnel of the supervising and examining departments borrowing from a bank under their supervision or examination was likewise removed. J9JC9B0M g- 35. Examinations and fees How often should the supervising and examining department examine the operations of banks and quasi-banks? The supervising and examining department head, personally or by deputy, shall examine the operations of every bank and quasi-bank, including their subsidiaries and affiliates engaged in allied activities, and other entities which under the law are subject to BSP supervision, in accordance with the guidelines set by the Monetary Board taking into consideration sound and prudent practices: Provided, that there shall be an interval of at least 12 months between regular examinations: Provided, further, that the Monetary Board, by an affirmative vote of at least five (5) members, may authorize a special examination if the circumstances warrant. The institution concerned shall afford to the head of the appropriate supervising and examining departments and to his authorized deputies full opportunity to examine its books and records, cash and assets and general condition and review its systems and procedures at any time during business hours when J9JC9B0M I 88 niVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II requested to do so by the BSP: Provided, however, that none of the reports and other papers relative to such examinations shall be open to inspection by the public except insofar as such publicity is incidental to the proceedings hereinafter authorized or is necessary for the prosecution of violations in connection with the business of such institutions. Supervised institutions shall pay to the BSP, no later than May 31 of each year, an annual supervision fee as may be prescribed by the Monetary Board. In determining the amount of the annual supervision fee, the Monetary Board shall consider the costs of supervision.58 h. 36. Monetary Board; powers and functions What are the powers and functions of the Monetary Board? The powers and functions of the BSP are exercised by the BSP Monetary Board, composed of seven (7) members appointed by the President of the Philippines for a term of six (6) years. 37. Are transfers and acquisitions of voting shares in banks and quasi-banks subject to BSP approval? Transfers or acquisitions, or a series thereof, of at least ten percent (10%) of the voting shares in banks or quasi-banks shall require the prior approval of the BSP. The selling or conveying stockholder shall submit such transfer or acquisition for approval by the BSP within such period as may be prescribed by the Monetary Board. In approving such transfers or acquisitions, regard shall be given by the BSP to the fitness of the incoming stockholders as may be indicated in their integrity, reputation and financial capacity. Without BSP approval, no such transfer or acquisition shall have legal effect nor shall the same be recognized in the books of the institution or by any government agency, and the transferor­ stockholders shall remain accountable and responsible therefor. Transfer of actual control or management of the institution to the new stockholders or their representatives prior to BSP approval shall make the transferor, the transferee and any person responsible therefor liable under Sections 36 and 37 of the Central Bank Act. Notwithstanding any provision of law to the contrary, the BSP “Section 28, ibid. VI. BANKING VJ may share with the Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation any information that the BSP may obtain pertaining to transfer or acquisition of shares or series of transfers or acquisition of shares in banks and quasi-banks.“ i. How the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas handles banks in distress a. 38. Conservatorship What are the tools/remedies available to BSP to handle banks in financial distress? The BSP may either appoint a conservator, or a receiver, or direct the closure and liquidation of the financially distressed bank. 39. When may a bank be placed under conservatorship? Whenever on the basis of the report of the appropriate supervising and examining department, the Monetary Board finds that a bank or quasi-bank is in a state of continuing inability or unwillingness to maintain a condition of liquidity deemed adequate to protect its depositors and creditors, the Monetary Board may appoint a conservator to take charge of the assets, liabilities and management of that institution, reorganize management, collect all monies and debts due said institution, and exercise all powers necessary to restore its viability. The conservator shall have the power to overrule or revoke the actions of the previous management and board of directors of the bank or non-bank financial intermediary performing quasi-banking functions.60 J9JC9B0M The conservator should be competent and knowledgeable in bank operations and management. The conservatorship shall not exceed one year.61 40. Does the appointment of a conservator result in the closure and liquidation of a bank? A conservator, once appointed, merely takes over the management of the bank and assumes exclusive powers to oversee every aspect of the bank’s operations and affairs. However, the bank 69Section 25-A, R.A. No. 7653, as amended. “Section 29, R.A. No. 7653. “'Ibid. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 90 retains its juridical personality even if placed under conservatorship; it is neither replaced nor substituted bj' the conservator.02 41. May a conservator revoke a valid contract of the bank? The vast and far-reaching powers of the conservator of a bank must be related to the preservation of the assets of the bank, the reorganization of the management thereof, and the restoration of its viability. Such powers cannot extend to the post-facto repudiation of perfected transactions, otherwise they would infringe against the non-impairment clause of the Constitution. The law merely gives the conservator power to revoke contracts that are, under existing law. deemed to be defective. Hence, the conservator merely takes the place of a bank’s board of directors, so what the board cannot do, the conservator cannot do either.63 42. When may the Monetary Board of the BSP appoint a receiver? Whenever, upon report of the head of the supervising or examining department, the Monetary Board finds that a bank or quasi-bank: (a) Has notified the Bangko Sentral or publicly announced a unilateral closure, or has been dormant for at least sixty (60) days or in any manner has suspended the payment of its deposit/deposit substitute liabilities, or is unable to pay its liabilities as they become due in the ordinary course of business: Provided, that this shall not include inability to pay caused by extraordinary demands induced by financial panic in the banking community; (b) Has insufficient realizable assets, as determined by the Bangko Sentral, to meet its liabilities; or (c) Cannot continue in business without involving probable losses to its depositors or creditors; or (d) Has willfully violated a cease and desist order under Section 37 of the Central Bank Act that has become final, involving acts or transactions which amount to fraud or “Central Bank of the Philippines v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 88353, May 8, 1992. “First Philippine International Bank January 24,1996. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 115849, I J9JC9B0M VI. HANKING 91 a dissipation of the assets of the institution; in which cases, the Monetary Board may summarily and without need for prior hearing forbid the institution from doing business in the Philippines and designate the Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation (PDIC) as receiver in the case of banks and direct the PDIC to proceed with the liquidation of the closed bank pursuant to this section and the relevant provisions of R.A. No. 3591, as amended. The Monetary Board shall notify in writing, through the receiver, the board of directors of the closed bank of its decision.64 Note that unilateral closure, dormancy for at least six (6) months and suspension in the payment of deposit and deposit substitute liabilities are new grounds under the amendatory law. Note further that determination of the sufficiency of the realizable assets is lodged with the BSP. BSP is not required to consult with the bank or secure its approval, as previously required under the old law, and held in the Banco Filipino case.65 The authority of the Monetary Board to summarily and without need for prior hearing forbid the bank or quasi-bank from doing business in the Philippines as provided above may also be exercised over non-stock savings and loan associations, based on the same applicable grounds. For quasi-banks and non-stock savings and loan associations, any person of recognized competence in banking, credit or finance may be designated by the Bangko Sentral as a receiver.66 43. What is the nature of power of the receiver? Section 30 of the New Central Bank Act expressly provides that “[t]he receiver shall immediately gather and take charge of all the assets and liabilities of the institution, administer the same for the benefit of its creditors, and exercise the general powers of a receiver under the Revised Rules of Court but shall not, with the exception of administrative expenditures, pay or commit any act that will involve the transfer or disposition of any asset of the institution.” This means that a bank receiver only has powers of administration. It cannot exercise acts of strict ownership. The properties of the bank may be sold only to pay its debts. “Section 30, ibid. 66 Supra. “Section 30, ibid. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE ('.HIDE VOLUME II 92 44. What are the legal effects when a bank is placed under receivership? a. The appointment of a receiver operates to suspend the authority of the bank and of its directors and officers over its property and effects, such authority being reposed in the receiver, and in this respect, the receivership is equivalent to an injunction to restrain the bank officers from intermeddling with the property of the bank in any way. Since the bank officers were no longer authorized to transact business in connection with the bank’s assets and property, the exclusive option to purchase granted by the President of the Bank is unenforceable against the bank.67 b. The bank shall be forbidden to do business. As such, it is not Hable to pay interest on deposits. It is however liable for obligations that accrued before the order forbidding it to do business.68 It was also held that the period during which the bank cannot do business due to insolvency is not a fortuitous event, unless it is shown that the government’s action to place a bank under receivership or liquidation proceedings is tainted with arbitrariness, or that the regulatory body has acted without jurisdiction.69 c. A criminal case for violation of BP 22 against a bank placed under receivership by the Monetary Board may be dismissed for the demandability of the obligation to be performed has been suspended. The filing of a petition for assistance in liquidation by PDIC as receiver as a result of the Monetary Board’s order for closure made it legally impossible for the officer who signed the check to comply with his obligation with the payee.70 67Abacus Real Estate Development v. Manila Banking Corporation, G.R. No. 162270, April 6, 2005. “Overseas Bank of Manila v. Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. L-45866, April 19, 1989. “Spouses Jaime and Matilde Poon v. Prime Savings Bank, represented by the Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation as Statutory Liquidator, G.R. No. 183794, June 13, 2016. ,0Cu Small Business Guarantee and Finance Corporation, G.R. No. 211222, August 7, 2017. VI. BANKING d. 45. 93 The receiver shall immediately gather and take charge of all the assets and liabilities of the institution, administer the same for the benefit of its creditors, and exercise the general powers of a receiver under the Revised Rules of Court. Due to growing financial difficulties, Z Bank was unable to finish construction of its 21-storey building on a prime lot located in Makati City. Inevitably, the Bangko Sentral ordered the closure of Z Bank and consequently placed it under receivership. In a bid to save the bank’s property investment, the President of Z Bank entered into a financing agreement with a group of investors for the completion of the construction of the 21-storey building in exchange for a 10-year lease and the exclusive option to purchase the building. A. Is the act of the President valid? Why or why not? B. Will a suit to enforce the exclusive right of the investors to purchase the property prosper? Reason briefly. A. No, the bank president’s act is not valid. He had no authority to enter into the financing agreement. Z Bank was ordered closed and placed under receivership. Control over the properties of Z Bank passed to the receiver. The appointment of a receiver operates to suspend the authority of the bank and its officers over the bank’s assets and properties, such authority being reposed in the receiver. Since the bank officers were no longer authorized to transact business in connection with the bank’s assets and property, the exclusive option to pin-chase granted by the President of the Bank is unenforceable against the bank. B. Since the exclusive option to purchase granted to the investors is unenforceable, the bank, therefore, cannot be compelled to sell the property. Under Section 30 of the R.A. No. 7653, New Central Bank Act, the properties of Z Bank should be administered for the benefit of its creditors. The property in question can be disposed of only for the purpose of paying the debts of Z Bank. Furthermore, in Abacus u. Manila Banking Corporation, the Supreme Court ruled that the receiver or conservator appointed by J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 94 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL MW; A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II BSP cannot perforin acts of dominion but only acts of administration. The confirmation or ratification of an option to purchase real property is an act of dominion.71 46. Can a bank under a receivership can still grant new loans and accept new deposits? No, duringthe receivership, the bank is forbidden to do business. Its assets and properties shall be gathered and administered by the receiver for the benefit of the bank’s creditors. Granting new loans and accepting new deposits would constitute doing business for the bank in the ordinary course of business which is contrary to the purpose and nature of a receivership proceeding.72 47. Can a bank under receivership be rehabilitated? Under Section 30 of R.A. No. 7653, the receiver has 90 days from appointment to rehabilitate the bank. If it fails, it shall recommend to BSP the bank’s closure and liquidation. If it succeeds, it shall recommend to BSP the resumption of bank’s business. However, R.A. No. 11211, which became effective on March 1, 2019, removed the authority of the receiver to rehabilitate the closed bank. Upon its appointment for any of the statutory grounds, the receiver must proceed with the liquidation of the closed bank.73 48. Who is the statutory receiver for closed banks? The PDIC under the charter that created it is considered the receiver of closed banks. 49. May a closed bank under receivership sue or be sued? A closed bank under receivership can only sue or be sued through its receiver, the PDIC. Hence, the petition filed by the peti­ tioner bank which has been placed under receivership is dismissible if it did not join PDIC as a party to the case.74 ’’BAR 2007 "Section 30. R.A. No. 7653; BAR 2009 "Section 30(d), R.A. No. 11211. "Banco Filipino Savings and Mortgage Bank v. Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, G.R. No. 200678, June 4, 2018. ■ J9JC9B0M VI. HANKING 50. 95 May a court designate a conservator or appoint a receiver for a financially distressed bank? The designation of a conservator or the appointment of a receiver for a financially distressed bank shall be vested exclusively with the Monetary Board.76 51. Is the designation of a conservator a precondition to the appointment of a receiver? No, the designation of a conservator is not a precondition to the appointment of a receiver.76 The choice of remedies on the part of the Monetary Board of the BSP depends on the nature of the bank’s financial condition. 52. Distinguish conservator from receiver. A conservator is appointed if the bank is in a continuing state of lack of liquidity adequate to protect the interest of the bank’s creditors and depositors (meaning, its assets are more than liabilities but are not in cash or readily convertible to cash), whereas a receiver is generally appointed if the bank is insolvent. A conservator takes charge of the assets, liabilities and management of the bank in distress, whereas a receiver shall immediately gather and take charge of all the assets and liabilities of the institution, administer the same for the benefit of its creditors, and exercise the general powers of the receiver under the Rules of Court. The bank is allowed to do business if it is only under conservatorship but cannot do business if it is placed under receivership. A conservator has one (1) year from appointment to restore the bank’s financial viability, whereas the receiver, upon its appointment based on any of the statutory grounds, must proceed with the liquidation of the closed bank.77 76Section 30, ibid. 76Section 30, ibid. 77BAR 2015 as revised to conform with Section 30, R.A. No. 7693, as amended byR.A. No. 11211. J9JC9B0M 96 53. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II What do you mean by the "close now hear later" doctrine? It is the rule that allows BSP to order the closure of the bank even without prior notice and hearing.”1 BSP may rely on the report of the head of its supervising and examining department, or of the conservator, if one is appointed. Under R.A. No. 7653, the power of the Monetary Board (MB) over banks, including rural banks, was increased and expanded. The Court, in several cases, upheld the power of the MB to take over banks without need for prior hearing. It is not necessary in as much as the law entrusts to the MB the appreciation and determination of whether any or all of the statutory grounds for the closure and receivership of the erring bank are present. The MB, under R.A. No. 7653. has been invested with more power of closure and placement of a bank under receivership for insolvency or illiquidity, or because the bank’s continuance in business would probably result in the loss to depositors or creditors. The doctrine is founded on practical and legal considerations to obviate unwarranted dissipation of the bank’s assets and as a valid exercise of police power to protect the depositors, creditors, stockholders, and the general public. Swift, adequate and determined actions must be taken against financially distressed and mismanaged banks by government agencies lest the public faith in the banking system deteriorate to the prejudice of the national economy.’9 54. Is BSP required to conduct an audit of the bank before ordering its closure? It is not required to conduct a thorough audit of the bank before ordering its closure. Under R.A. No. 7653, only a report of the head of the supervising or examining department is necessary. Needless to say, the decision of the MB and BSP, like any other administrative body, must have something to support itself and its findings of fact must be supported by substantial evidence. But it ’“Alfredo Vivas v. Monetary Board of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, et al., G.R. No. 191424, August 7, 2013. ’“Vivas v. Monetary Board of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, G.R. No. 191424, August 7, 2013. J Vf. BANKING 97 is clear under R.A. No. 7653 that the basis need not arise from an examination as required in the old law."" It was likewise held that the bank is not entitled to a copy of the report of examination that the Supervision and Examination Department of BSP has prepared nor can the bank be validly entitled to injunction to restrain BSP from adopting such report.” The Supreme Court likewise ruled that the Monetary Board is not required to make its own independent finding that the bank could no longer be rehabilitated but may rely on the findings of the PDIC as statutory receiver, in ordering the liquidation of a bank. Once the receiver determines that rehabilitation is no longer feasible, the Monetary Board is simply obligated to: (a) notify in writing the bank>s board of directors of the same; and (b) direct the PDIC to proceed with liquidation.82 This case should now be construed in relation to R.A. No. 11211 which, as previously stated, removed the option of rehabilitation once a bank is placed under receivership. Nevertheless, it is submitted that a bank may still be rehabilitated in the course of liquidation as when, for instance, the assets and shares of the bank are sold to a buyer, which, in turn, decided to rehabilitate the bank. What is clear under R.A. No. 11211 is that the receiver does not have the 90-day period under R.A. No. 7653 to rehabilitate the bank. After its appointment, PDIC, as the statutory receiver, must proceed to liquidation but there is nothing in the law that precludes rehabilitation in the course of the liquidation. J9JC9B0M 55. What is the rationale of the "close now, hear later" doctrine? The “close now, hear later” scheme is grounded on practical and legal considerations to prevent unwarranted dissipation of the bank’s assets and as a valid exercise of police power to protect the depositors, creditors, stockholders, and the general public.83 It is justified as a measure for the protection of the public interest. Swift “Rural Bank of San Miguel v. Monetary Board, G.R. No. 1508S6, February 16, 2007. “'Ibid. 82Apex Bancrights Holdings, Inc. v. Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, G.R. No. 214866, October 2, 2017. “BSP Monetary Board v. Hon. Antonio-Valenzuela, G.R. No. 184778, October 2,2009. J9JC9B0M 98 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL 1 .AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II action is calk'd for on the part of the BSP when it finds that a bank is in dire straits. Due process does not necessarily require a prior hearing: a hearing or an opportunity to be heard may be subsequent to the closure. One can just imagine the dire consequences of a prior hearing: bank runs would be the order of the day, resulting in panic and hysteria. Swift, adequate, and determined actions must be taken against financially distressed and mismanaged banks by government agencies lest the public faith in the banking system deteriorate to the prejudice of the national economy.84 56. Does injunction, as a remedy, lie against the authority of BSP to appoint a conservator, or designate receiver, or direct the closure of a financially distressed bank? No. The authority of BSP to designate a conservator, or appoint a receiver, or direct its closure, is a valid exercise of police power. The order is final and executory and not subject to injunction. However, such order is subject to judicial scrutiny. The authority may not be exercised arbitrarily or unreasonably and could be set aside if it is either capricious, discriminatory, whimsical, arbitrary, unjust, or is tantamount to a denial of due process and equal protection clauses of the Constitution.86 The order may be set aside through a petition for certiorari if the action was taken in excess of jurisdiction or with such grave abuse of discretion as to amount to lack or excess of jurisdiction.86 In other words, the remedy of the bank is not prior to but after issuance of the order by the BSP. 57. What is the remedy available to the bank to set aside the order of BSP designating a conservator, appointing a receiver, or directing the closure and liquidation of the bank? The remedy available to the bank is to file a petition for certiorari with the Court of Appeals on the ground that the action taken by BSP was in excess of jurisdiction or with such grave abuse of discretion as to amount to lack or excess of jurisdiction. “Alfredo Vivas, supra. “Apex Bancrights Holdings, Inc. Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, G.R. No. 214866, October 2, 2017. '“‘Ibid. Sections 29 and 30, R.A. No. 7653. i J9JC9B0M VI. HANKING 99 The petition for certiorari may only be filed by the stockholders of record representing the majority of the capital stock within 10 days from receipt by the board of directors of the institution of the order directing receivership, closure/liquidation or conservatorship.87 There must be convincing proof, after hearing, that the resolution of BSP is plainly arbitrary and made in bad faith.88 The Board of Directors of a bank may also question the validity of the conservator’s (or receiver’s) fraudulent acts and abuses and the arbitrary action of the Monetary Board but subject to the same requisites above-mentioned.89 Note that appeal is not the remedy. 58. Cite jurisprudence where the Supreme Court held that the order of closure was arbitrary or made in bad faith. a. The arbitrariness and bad faith of Central Bank is evident from the fact that it pressured the controlling stockholders into relinquishing the management and control of a bank to a supposed investor, which did not have any intention of restoring the bank into its former sound financial condition but whose interest was merely to recover its deposits from the bank and thereafter allowing such investor to mismanage the bank until the bank’s financial deterioration and subsequent closure. Central Bank acted whimsically and withdrew its commitment to support the bank to the detriment of the latter.90 b. When the closure was preceded by Central Bank making express representations to the controlling stockholders that it would support the Bank, and avoid its liquidation if the stockholders would execute (a) the Voting Trust Agreement turning over the management of the Bank to the CB or its nominees, and (b) mortgage or assign their properties to the Central Bank to cover the overdraft “’Section 30, ibid.; Yuseco v. PDIC, as the statutory liquidator of the Unitrust Development Bank, G.R. No. 217899, September 28, 2016. ““Central Bank v. Court of Appeals, supra. ssIbid. "Central Bank of the Philippines v. Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. L-50031, July 27,1981. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 100 balance of the bank to which stockholders have complied with.91 c. 59. In case of premature conclusion that the bank is insolvent as when the Central Bank unilaterally deducted valuation reserves or allowance for probable losses for loans and investments from the assets of the bank.92 Is the resolution of the BSP issued in the exercise of its quasi-judicial functions like imposing sanctions for violations of banking laws or regulations or appointing a receiver or conservator or closing a bank subject to declaratory relief? No. It is not. A resolution issued in the exercise of quasi-judicial functions is not subject to declaratory relief. Similarly, in one case, a bank deducted from the loan proceeds of their borrowers certain amount of fees representing premiums to guarantee payment of outstanding loans. The resolution of the BSP directing a bank to refund to its borrowers said fees because the scheme was in the nature of insurance activity cannot be the subject of a petition for declaratory relief. The Supreme Court explained that undoubtedly, the BSP Monetary Board is a quasijudicial agency exercising quasi-judicial powers or functions. It is an independent central monetary authority and a body corporate with fiscal and administrative autonomy, mandated to provide policy directions in the areas of money, banking, and credit. It has the power to issue subpoena, to sue for contempt those refusing to obey the subpoena without justifiable reason, to administer oaths and compel presentation of books, records and others, needed in its examination, to impose fines and other sanctions and to issue cease and desist order. Section 37 of R.A. No. 7653, in particular, explicitly provides that the BSP Monetary Board shall exercise its discretion in determining whether administrative sanctions should be imposed on banks and quasi-banks, which necessarily implies that the BSP Monetary Board must conduct some form of investigation or hearing regarding the same. 91Emerito Ramos v. Central Bank of the Philippines, G.R. No. L-29352, October 4, 1971. “Banco Filipino Savings Bank v. Central Bank, supra. 1 J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 101 The decision of the BSP Monetary Board cannot be a proper subject matter for a petition for declaratory relief since it was issued by the BSP Monetary Board in the exercise of its quasi-judicial powers or functions. The authority of the petitioners to issue the questioned MB Resolution emanated from its powers under Section 37 of R.A. No. 7653 and Section 66 of R.A. No. 8791 to impose, at its discretion, administrative sanctions upon any bank for violation of any banking law.93 60. State the Rules on Liquidation. a. Once a bank is ordered closed by BSP for any of the grounds allowed by law, liquidation of the bank follows. PDIC, as the statutory receiver and/or liquidator of closed banks, shall file a petition with the RTC for assistance in liquidation. b. All disputed claims against the bank should be filed before the liquidation proceeding. The judicial liquidation is intended to prevent multiplicity of actions against the insolvent bank. It is a pragmatic arrangement designed to establish due process and orderliness in the liquidation of the bank, to obviate the proliferation of litigations and to avoid injustice and arbitrariness.94 c. The claims against the bank shall be determined and passed upon and then paid based on the rules on concurrence and preference of credit. The residual assets are then distributed to the stockholders. d. The liquidation of a bank may be carried out despite lack of tax clearance unlike in a voluntary dissolution of a corporation under the Corporation Code.95 The debts and liabilities of the bank under liquidation are to be paid in accordance with the rules on concurrence and preference of credit under the Civil Code. With reference to the other real and personal property of the debtor, sometimes referred to as “free property,” the taxes and Philippine Veterans Bank, G.R. No. 93The Honorable Monetary Board 189571, January 21, 2015. 94Jerry Ong v. Court of Appeals, et al., G.R. No. 112830, February 1, 1996. 96Zn Re'. Petition for Assistance in the Liquidation of the Rural Bank of Bokod (Benguet) v. Bureau of Internal Revenue, G.R. No. 158261, December 18, 2006. J9JC9B0M DININA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 102 assessments due the National Government, other than those in Articles 2241(1) and 2242(1) of the Civil Code, such as the corporate income tax, will come only in ninth place in the order of preference. If the BIR’s contention that a tax clearance be secured first before the project of distribution of the assets of a bank under liquidation may be approved, then the tax liabilities will be given absolute preference in all instances, including those that do not fall under Articles 2241(1) and 2242(1) of the Civil Code.96 e. The exclusive jurisdiction of the liquidation court pertains only to the adjudication of claims against the bank. It does not cover the reverse situation where it is the bank which files a claim against another person or legal entity. Thus, the liquidator should not file the petition for issuance of a writ of possession for foreclosed property in the liquidation court because such petition is not in the nature of a disputed claim against the bank. It should be filed in the city or municipality where the property is situated.97 f. The issuance of the cashier’s checks by a bank to the petitioner created a debtor/creditor relationship between them. This disputed claim should therefore be lodged in the liquidation proceedings by the petitioner as creditor, since the closure of the bank has rendered all claims subsisting at that time moot which can best be threshed out by the liquidation court and not the regular courts. Bank deposits are not preferred credits except when the deposits are covered by a cashier’s check purchased from the bank when the bank officers knew or ought to have known that the bank is insolvent.98 g- Any final judgment against the bank which has been ordered closed should be stayed as to execute the judgment would unduly deplete the assets of the bank to the prejudice of other creditors since after the Monetary Board has declared that a bank is insolvent and has ordered it “Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation v. Bureau of Internal Revenue, G.R. No. 172892, June 13,2013. “’Domingo Manalo v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 141297, October 8, 2001. ““Leticia Miranda v. Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation, et al., G.R. No. 169334, September 8, 2006. J J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 103 to cease operations, the Board becomes the trustee of its assets for the equal benefit of all the creditors, including depositors. The assets of the insolvent banking institution are held in trust for the equal benefit of all creditors, and after its insolvency, one cannot obtain an advantage or a preference over another by an attachment, execution or otherwise." 61. Family Bank was placed under statutory receivership and subsequently ordered liquidated by the Central Bank (CB) due to fraud and irregularities in its lending operations which rendered it insolvent. Judicial proceedings for liquidation were thereafter commenced by the CB before the RTC. Family Bank opposed the petition. Shortly thereafter. Family Bank filed in the same court a special civil action against the CB seeking to enjoin and dismiss the liquidation proceeding on the ground of grave abuse of discretion by the CB. The court was poised to: (1) restrain the CB from closing Family Bank; and (2) authorize Family Bank to withdraw money from its deposits during the pendency of the case. If you were the judge, would you issue such orders? Why? No. Once the bank is ordered closed by BSP and a petition for assistance in liquidation is filed in court, the stockholders of the closed bank cannot file a separate action to enjoin the liquidation proceeding but should instead file a comment or opposition to the petition for liquidation invoking therein as affirmative defenses the bad faith on the part of BSP. This is necessary to prevent multiplicity of suits or conflicting resolutions.100 The foregoing Bar examination question was based on the case of Salud. v. Central Bank of the Philippines.101 In a recent case, however, the Supreme Court ruled that the RTC, acting as a liquidation court, has no power to overrule the "Spouses Lipana Development Bank of Rizal, G.R. No. 73884, September 24,1987. 100BAR 1992. 101G.R. No. L-17620, August 19, 1986. J9JC9B0M PIV1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 104 findings of the Monetary Board. In fact, the liquidation court’s authority is limited to adjudicating disputed claims against the institution, assisting the enforcement of individual liabilities of the stockholders, directors and officers and deciding on other issues to implement the liquidation plan. The exclusivity of the Monetary Board's power is highlighted by the absence of appeal from its actions under Section 30 of R.A. No. 7653. The MB’s actions are final and executory’ and can only be set aside by filing a petition for certiorari within 10 days from receipt by the bank’s board of directors of the MB’s order directing the receivership, liquidation, or conservatorship.102 62. What is the legal tender power of notes and coins? All notes and coins issued by the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas shall be fully guaranteed by the government and shall be legal tender for all debts, both public and private. However, with respect to coins, they have legal tender power only for the following amounts: a. One peso coins and coins of higher peso value are legal tender for obligations not exceeding Pl,000.00; and b. Twenty-five cents and coins of lower value are legal tender for obligations not exceeding P100.00. Notes, regardless of denomination, are legal tender for any amount. Coins which show signs of filing, clipping or perforation and notes which have lost more than two-fifths (2/5) of their surface or all of the signatures inscribed therein shall be withdrawn from circulation and demonetized without compensation to the bearer. 63. Can a creditor be compelled to accept payment all in 25-centavo Central Bank coins of a forty (P40.00) peso debt? Explain briefly. Coins are legal tender only up to certain amount. For denominations from P1.00 and above, coins shall be legal tender up to Pl,000.00. For denominations from 25 centavos and below, coins shall be legal tender up to P1OO.OO.103 "“Yuseco v. PDIC, as the statutory liquidator of the Unitrust Development Bank, G.R. No. 217899, September 28,2016. '“BAR 1975. J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 64. 105 After many years of shopping in the Metro Manila area, housewife HW has developed the sound habit of making cash purchases only, none on credit. In one shopping trip to Mega Mall, she got the shock of her shopping life for the first time, a store's smart salesgirl refused to accept her coins in payment for a purchase worth not more than P100. HW was paying P70 in 25-centavo coins and P25 in 10-centavo coins. Strange as it may seem, the salesgirl told HW that her coins were not "legal tender." Do you agree with the salesgirl in respect of her understanding of "legal tender"? Explain. No. The salesgirl’s understanding that coins are not legal tender is not correct. Under a recent BSP circular, the legal tender power of coins has been increased as follows: 25 centavo coins and coins of lower value are legal tender up to P100.00, while one peso coins and coins of higher value are legal tender for obligations not exceeding Pl,000.00.10'' 65. Are notes and coins withdrawn from circulation still legal tender? Notes and coins called in for replacement shall remain legal tender for a period of one (1) year from date of call. After this period, they shall cease to be legal tender but during the following year or such longer period as the Monetary Board may determine, they may be exchanged at par. After expiration of this latter period, the notes and coins which have not been exchanged shall cease to be the liability of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas. j. 66. Administrative sanctions on supervised entities What are the administrative sanctions that the Monetary Board may impose? Without prejudice to the criminal sanctions against the culpable persons provided in Sections 34, 35, and 36 of R.A. No. 7653, the Monetary Board may, at its discretion, impose upon any bank, quasi-bank, including their subsidiaries and affiliates engaged in allied activities, or other entity which under R.A. No. 7653 or special laws are subject to the Bangko Sentral supervision, and/or their directors, officers or employees, for any willful violation of its charter or by-laws; willful delay in the submission of reports or publications thereof as required by law, rules and regulations; 1O’BAR 2000. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 106 any refusal to permit examination into the affairs of the institution; any willful making ot a false or misleading statement to the Board or the appropriate supervising and examining department or its examiners: any willful tailure or refusal to comply with, or violation of. any banking law or any order, instruction or regulation issued by the Monetary Board, or any order, instruction or ruling by the Governor: or any commission of irregularities, and/or conducting business in an unsafe or unsound manner as may be determined by the Monetary Board, the following administrative sanctions, whenever applicable: (a) Fines in amounts as may be determined by the Monetary Board to be appropriate, but in no case to exceed Pl,000,000.00 for each transactional violation or P100,000.00 per calendar day for violations of a continuing nature, taking into consideration the attendant circumstances, such as the nature and gravity of the violation or irregularity and the size of the institution: Provided, that in case profit is gained or loss is avoided as a result of the violation, a fine no more than three (3) times the profit gained or loss avoided may also be imposed; (b) Suspension of rediscounting privileges or access to Bangko Sentral credit facilities; (c) Suspension of lending or foreign exchange operations or authority to accept new deposits or make new investments; (d) Suspension of interbank clearing privileges; and/or (e) Suspension or revocation of quasi-banking or other special licenses. Resignation or termination from office shall not exempt such director, officer or employee from administrative or criminal sanctions. The Monetary Board may, whenever warranted by circumstances, preventively suspend any director, officer or employee of the institution pending an investigation: Provided, that should the case be not finally decided by the Bangko Sentral within a period of 120 days after the date of suspension, said director, officer or employee shall be reinstated in his position: Provided, further, that when the delay in the disposition of the case is due to the fault, negligence or petition of the director or officer, the period of delay J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 107 shall not be counted in computing the period of suspension herein provided. The above administrative sanctions need not be applied in the order of their severity. Whether or not there is an administrative proceeding, if the institution and/or the directors, officers or employees concerned continue with or otherwise persist in the commission of the indicated practice or violation, the Monetary Board may issue an order requiring the institution and/or the directors, officers or employees concerned to cease and desist from the indicated practice or violation, and may further order that immediate action be taken to correct the conditions resulting from such practice or violation. The cease and desist order shall be immediately effective upon service on the respondents. The respondents shall be afforded an opportunity to defend their action in a hearing before the Monetary Board or any committee chaired by any Monetary Board member created for the purpose, upon request made by the respondents within five (5) days from their receipt of the order. If no such hearing is requested within said period, the order shall be final. If a hearing is conducted, all issues shall be determined on the basis of records, after which the Monetary Board may either reconsider or make final its order. The Governor is hereby authorized, at his discretion, to impose upon banks and quasi-banks, including their subsidiaries and affiliates engaged in allied activities, and other entities which under the Central Bank Act or special laws are subject to Bangko Sentral supervision for any failure to comply with the requirements of law, Monetary Board regulations and policies, and/or instructions issued by the Monetary Board or by the Governor, fines not in excess of P100,000.00 for each transactional violation or P30,000.00 per calendar day for violations of a continuing nature, the imposition of which shall be final and executory until reversed, modified or lifted by the Monetary Board on appeal.105 k. Rules on bank deposits and investments by directors, officers, stockholders and their related interests.100 1. Supervision and regulation of bank operations. ’“Section 37, ibid. 'xInfra. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 108 67. Why are banks required to maintain reserves against their deposits and deposit substitutes? State one of three purposes for these reserves.k’: Any one of the following purposes for requiring banks to maintain reserves against their deposits and deposit substitutes will suffice: a. To control the volume of money arising from the credit operations of the banking system; b. To provide the bank’s reserves which they can tap in case of inadequate liquidity to service withdrawals of bank deposits; and c. To help the Government to finance its operations. B. Law on Secrecy of Philippine Currency Bank Deposits (R.A. No. 1405) 1. Purpose 68. What are the prohibited acts under R.A. No. 1405? It shall be unlawful for any official or employee of a banking institution to disclose or allow the examination or inquiry by any person, government official, bureau, or office, other than those excepted by law, any information concerning Philippine currency bank deposits of whatever nature and kind, as well as investment in government securities.108 69. Who are covered by the prohibition? Bank officials and employees. A non-bank official or employee is not covered by the prohibition. Disclosure by a bank official or employee of information about bank deposit in favor of a co-employee in the course of the performance of his duties is not covered by the prohibition. 70. What are the items covered by the prohibition against unauthorized disclosure under R.A. No. 1405? a. All Philippine currency bank deposits of whatever nature with banks, including investment in bonds issued by the 107BAR 2010. '“Sections 1 and 3 of R.A. No. 1405, otherwise known as the Law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits. J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 109 government of the Philippines, its political subdivisions and instrumentalities.109 71. b. Trust funds and any sum of money invested in the bank which the bank may use for loans and similar transactions are now included in the term “deposits.”110 c. Deposits are thus no longer limited to those governed by the law on loans giving rise to creditor-debtor relationship. Raymond invested his money in securities issued by the Philippine government, through his bank. Subsequently, the Bureau of Internal Revenue asked his bank to disclose his investments. His bank refused the request for disclosure on the ground that the investments are confidential under the Secrecy of Bank Deposits Law (R.A. No. 1405, as amended). Is the bank's refusal justified? Defend your answer.1" It is justified. Under Secrecy of Bank Deposits Law, investment in bonds issued by the Philippine government are also absolutely confidential and may not be examined, inquired or looked into by any person, government official, bureau or office save for the exceptions provided by law. None of the exceptions apply in the present case. 72. X, a government official, has a number of bank accounts in T Bank containing millions of pesos. He also opened several trust accounts in the same bank which specifically covered the placement and/or investment of funds. X was later charged with graft and corruption before the Sandiganbayan (SB) by the Ombudsman. The Special Prosecutor filed a motion praying for a court order authorizing it to look into the savings and trust accounts of X in T Bank. X opposed the motion arguing that the trust accounts are not "deposits'* under the Law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits (R.A. No. 1405). Is the contention of X correct? Explain.112 The contention of X is not correct. Deposits in the context of the Secrecy of Philippine currency deposits include deposits of whatever nature and kind. They include funds deposited in the bank giving '"Section 2, R.A. No. 1405. 110Ejercito v. Sandiganbayan, G.R. No. 157294-95, November 30, 2006. "'BAR 2015. "2BAR 2016. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 110 rise to creditor-debtor relationship, ns well as funds invested in the bank like trust accounts.11’ 73. In what cases may information on Philippine currency bank deposits, as well as investment in government securities, be disclosed, examined or looked into without violating the law? a. Written permission of the depositor;"4 b. In case of impeachment;116 c. In case of order of a competent court in any of the following cases: i. In case of bribery or dereliction of duty of public officials;116 ii. Where the subject matter of litigation is the money deposited;117 iii. Prosecution for unexplained wealth (plunder is akin to unexplained wealth);118 iv. Prosecution for violation of the anti-graft and corrupt practices act; v. In case of violation of the anti-money laundering law; and, vi. Garnishment of bank deposits. NB. Under R.A. No. 1405, the issuance of court order is limited to bribery or dereliction of duty of public officials and where the subject matter of litigation is the money deposited. The rest of the enumeration is based on jurisprudence and the other laws. d. The BIR may inquire into the deposit and other related information to determine the gross estate of the deceased taxpayer for computation of estate tax;119 ‘"Ejercito v. Sandiganbayan, G.R. No. 157294-95, November 30, 2006. ‘"Section 2, RA No. 1405. "'-Ibid. ™Ibid. "7Ibid. 118PNB v. Gancayco but see discussion on effects of the Marques v. Desierto ruling, infra. “’Section 6(F)(1) of the Tax Code, as amended. J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 111 e. The BIR may also inquire into bank deposits if there is an offer of compromise of tax liability on account of financial incapacity to pay his tax liability;'20 f. Disclosure by the bank to the National Treasurer of information concerning dormant deposits under the Unclaimed Balances law;121 g- PDIC and/or BSP may inquire into or examine deposit accounts and all information related thereto in case there is a finding of unsafe and unsound banking practice;122 h. BSP may, the course of a periodic or special examination, check the compliance of a covered institution with the requirements of AMLA and its implementing rules and regulations;123 i. In case of amendment or repeal of the law. Written permission of the depositor 74. Debtor filed a petition for voluntary insolvency. The appointed receiver filed a motion for the parties to enter into compromise agreement. Two of the creditors of the insolvent debtor filed a joint motion to approve agreement which contains their authority to have access to the bank account of the insolvent debtor. The court approved the joint motion. Was the approval by the court of the joint motion sufficient to allow the creditors access to the bank account of the insolvent debtor? No, the Joint Motion to Approve Agreement executed by the parties on waiver of confidentiality of the insolvent debtor’s deposits does not bind the latter who was not a party and signatory to the said agreement.124 ‘“Section 6(F)(2), Tax Code, as amended. l21Act No. 3936, as amended. '“Section 8, R.A. No. 3591, as amended. ‘“Section 11, R.A. No. 9160, as amended. 124Dona Adela Export International, Inc. v. Trade and Investment Development Corporation, G.R. No. 201931, February 11, 2015. J9JC9B0M 112 1HV1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II Order of a competent court 75. May the Senate Blue Ribbon Committee, in aid of legislation, subpoena the bank deposit records of resource persons who were called to shed light on matters under investigation by the Committee? No. the Senate Blue Ribbon Committee is not a competent court. Investigation by the Committee or any committee of Congress, for that matter, is not one of the exceptions to allow access to bank deposit information. 76. May a prosecutor who is conducting an investigation for estafa and/or violation of BP 22 validly subpoena the bank deposit records of the respondent as part of the clarificatory process of the preliminary investigation? No, because to fall within the exception, the subpoena must >e issued by a competent court in the cases provided by law. The rosecution office is not a court. 77. Elizabeth, through her daughter Ruby, charged Norlina of unauthorized deduction of her ABC Savings Account, as well as for failure to post certain check deposits to the said account, with the Office of Special Investigation of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas (OSI-BSP). During the investigation, Norlina filed a Motion for Production of Documents praying that the she be allowed to inspect and copy the Statement of Account of other depositors with two others, claiming that resort to discovery process is part of her right to due process and Ruby signed a document allowing Norlina and ABC access to these deposit accounts. The OSI-BSP denied the motion ruling that the action is an administrative proceeding aimed at determining respondent's liability, if any, for violation of banking laws and that a deposit account may only be examined or looked into if it is the subject matter of a pending litigation. Did the OSI-BSP abuse its discretion in denying the motion? No, other than OSI-BSP is not a competent court, records show t^le account holders or depositors of the two other banks are t different from the complainant. Perforce, the documents executed y Ruby purportedly granting ABC access to the foregoing accounts J9JC9B0M VI, BANKING 113 do not equate to their permissions to allow access to their bank account.126 78. The Bank Secrecy Law (R.A. No. 1405) prohibits disclosing any information about deposit records of an individual without court order except:126 a. In an examination to determine gross estate of a decedent. b. In an investigation for violation of Anti-Graft and Corrupt Practices. In an investigation by the Ombudsman. C. d. In an impeachment proceeding. a. In an examination to determine gross estate of a decedent. Bribery or dereliction, of duty of public officials: prosecution for unexplained wealth; prosecution for violation of the Anti-Graft and Corrupt Practices Act 79. TRUE or FALSE. Answer TRU E if the statement is true, or FALSE if the statement is false. Explain your answer in not more than two (2) sentences. If the Ombudsman is convinced that there is a violation of law after investigating a complaint alleging illicit bank deposits of a public officer, the Ombudsman may order the bank concerned to allow in camera inspection of bank records and documents.127 False. In the case of Marquez v. Desierto,™ the Supreme Court held that the Ombudsman can only examine bank deposit accounts upon compliance with the following requisites: a. b. c. d. There is a case pending before a court of competent jurisdiction; The account holder and the bank official must be informed of the examination; The account to be examined must be clearly identified; and, The examination must be limited to the account specified. ‘“Sibayan v. Alda, G.R. No. 233395, January 17, 2018. 126BAR 2012. 127BAR 2009. 128G.R. No. 135882, June 27, 2001. J9JC9B0M 114 IIIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II If there is no pending ease yet, but only an investigation by the Ombudsman, any order for the examination of the bank account is premature. A’B. The ruling in Marquez v. Desierto effectively modified the rulings in PNB r. Gancayco1” and Banco Filipino v. Purisima'30 that Section 8 of the Anti-Graft Law is intended to amend Section 2 of R.A. No. 1405 by providing additional exception to the rule against the disclosure of bank deposits. In both cases, it was held while R.A. No. 1405 provides that bank deposits are “absolutely confidential ... and [therefore] may not be examined, inquired or looked into,” except in those cases enumerated therein, the Anti-Graft Law directs in mandatory terms that bank deposits “shall be taken into consideration in the enforcement of this section, notwithstanding any provision of law to the contrary.” Cases of unexplained wealth are similar to cases of bribery or dereliction of duty and no reason is seen why these two classes of cases cannot be excepted from the rule making bank deposits confidential. In both PNB and Banco Filipino cases, it was held that the pecial prosecutor (which is not a court) may have access to bank deposit records of persons under investigation for violation of the Anti-Graft and Unexplained Wealth laws. Pursuant to the ruling 1 in Marquez v. Desierto, it is not enough that there is a pending criminal investigation; the Ombudsman must comply with the above mentioned formalities. Where the subject matter of litigation is the money deposited 80. What is the test to consider in determining whether or not the subject matter of litigation is the money deposited? The inquiry into bank deposits allowable under R.A. No. 1405 must be premised on the fact that the money deposited in the account is itself the subject of the action. Thus, where the information filed in court charged respondent with qualified theft, the subject matter of litigation is the money alleged to have been stolen by the respondent. Where the subject matter of the testimonial and documentary evidence is not at all 12SG.R. No. L-18343, September 30,1965. '“Banco Filipino Savings Bank v. Hon. Fidel Purisima, G.R. No. L-56429, May 28,1988. 1 VI. BANKING 115 relevant to the case, the suppression of such testimony is valid, otherwise, it constitutes an attempt by the prosecution at an impermissible inquiry into a bank deposit account, the privacy and confidentiality of which is protected by law.131 In this case, the criminal information did not allege that the funds stolen were deposited to the account subject of testimonial evidence. Similarly, if the information alleges that the funds stolen are deposited in a particular bank account, evidence on the funds of the respondent in other bank accounts should not be permitted. In one case, a wire transfer erroneously indicated US$ 1,000,000 when it was supposed to be for US$ 1,000 only. It was held that Section 2 of R.A. No. 1405 allows the disclosure of bank deposits in cases where the money deposited is the subject matter of the litigation. Inasmuch as the civil case is aimed at recovering the amount converted by the payees for their own benefit, necessarily, an inquiry into the whereabouts of the illegally acquired amount extends to whatever is concealed by being held or recorded in the name of persons other than the one responsible for the illegal acquisition.132 In another case, it was ruled that the examination of bank books and records cannot be justified if the only issue is whether the money paid and deposited to an account was the consideration for the sale of treasury bills or whether it was money intended for placement. Hence, whether the transaction is considered a sale or money placement does not make the money the “subject matter of litigation” within the meaning of Section2 of R.A. No. 1405 which prohibits the disclosure or inquiry into bank deposits except “in cases where the money deposited or invested is the subject matter of litigation.”133 81. J9JC9B0M "D" issued a check drawn against ABC Bank payable to the order of "P" for P1,000,000.00 who, in turn, deposited the check in his account with XYZ Bank. XYZ sent the check for clearing through the Philippine Clearing House Corporation (PCHC) but XYZ's clearing staff committed a clearing discrepancy when he erroneously under-encoded the charge slip to P1,000.00. While XYZ credited the account of "P" for PI,000,000.00, it only recovered P1,000.00 from ABC. After discovery of the 131BSB Group, Inc. v. Go, G.R. No. 168644, February 16, 2010. 132Mellon Bank v. Hon. Celso Magsino, el al., G.R. No, 71479, October 18,1990. ,330nate v. Abrogar, G.R. No. 107303, February 23,1995. J9JC9B0M 116 D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II under-encoding, XYZ notified ABC of the discrepancy, by way of a charge slip of P999,000.00 for automatic debiting of ABC's clearing account with PCHC. ABC refused to accept the charge slip. XYZ filed a complaint against ABC with the PCHC Arbitration Committee. It also filed with the court a petition for the examination of the account of "D." Should the court grant the petition? The petition should be denied. It does not seek recovery of the ven- money contained in the deposit. The subject matter of the dispute may be the amount of P999,000.00 that XYZ seeks from ABC as a result of the discrepancy; but it is not the P999,000.00 deposited in the drawer’s account. By the terms of R.A. No. 1405, the “money deposited itself should be the subject matter of the litigation. That XYZ feels a need for such information in order to establish its case against ABC does not, by itself, warrant the examination of the bank deposits. The necessity of the inquiry, or the lack thereof, is mmaterial since the case does not come under any of the exceptions dlowed by the Bank Deposits Secrecy Act.134 Violation of the anti-money laundering law 82. What is the basis of the authority of the Anti-Money Laundering Council to inquire into deposits or funds without committing a violation of the law on secrecy of bank deposits? ALMC’s authority is statutory. It is based on Section 11 of the AMLA which provides that notwithstanding the provisions of R.A. No. 1405 as amended, R.A. No. 6426 as amended, R.A. No. 8791, and other laws, the AMLC may inquire into or examine bank deposits or investments, including related accounts, with any banking institution or non-bank financial institution upon order of a competent court when it has been established that there is a probable cause that the deposits or investments, including related accounts involved, are related to unlawful activity, as defined by AMLA or a money laundering offense under the same law.136 Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 134699, 13,Union Bank of the Philippines December 23,1999. ’“Section 11, R.A. No. 9160, as amended, otherwise known as the Anti-Money Laundering Law. VI. BANKING 117 Thus, AMLC may inquire into deposits, regardless of currency, funds, other than deposits, investments, including related accounts as long as there is a probable cause that the deposits or investments are related to unlawful activity, as defined by AMLA or a money laundering offense under the same law. 83. Does AMLC need a court order to be able to inquire into such deposits, funds or investments? Yes, AMLC needs to obtain a bank inquiry order from the Court of Appeals. The application can be done ex-parte.'x However, AMLC must establish probable cause that the deposits, funds or investments relate to unlawful activity under AMLA and the Court of Appeals, independently of AMLC, must make itself a finding that such probable cause exists before the bank inquiry order may be issued.137 Court order shall not be necessary in the following cases: a. Kidnapping for ransom under Article 267 of Act No. 3815 (RPC); b. Violations of Sections 4, 5, 6, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, and 16 of R.A. No. 9165 (Comprehensive Dangerous Drugs Act of 2002); c. Hijacking and other violations under R.A. No. 6235; destructive arson and murder, as defined under the RPC, as amended, including those perpetrated by terrorists against non-combatant persons and similar targets; d. Felonies and offenses similar to the foregoing which are punishable under the penal laws of other countries; e. Terrorism and conspiracy to commit terrorism as defined under R.A. No. 9372, as amended.138 84. Through various acts of graft and bribery. Mayor Ycasiano accumulated a large amount of wealth which he converted into U.S. dollars and deposited in a Foreign Currency Deposit Unit (FCDU) account with the Yuen Bank (YB). On a tip given “Section 11, ibid. 137Subido Pagente Certez Mendoza and Binay Law Offices v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 216914, December 6, 2016. “Section 11, R.A. No. 9160, as amended. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 1 118 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II by the secretary of the mayor, the Anti-Money Laundering Council (AMLC) sent an order to YB to confirm the amount of U.S. dollars that Mayor Ycasiano had in his FCDU account. YB claims that, under the Foreign Currency Deposit Act (R.A. No. 6426, as amended), a written permission from the depositor is the only instance allowed for the examination of FCDU accounts. YB alleges that AMLC on its own cannot order a banking institution to reveal matters relating to bank accounts. Is the legal position of YB, in requiring written permission from the depositor, correct?139 Yes, the legal position of YB in requiring written permission from the depositor is correct. The AMLC cannot order the bank to inquire into the bank account of any depositor on mere suspicions of acts of graft and bribery without his written consent or a bank inquiry order issued by the competent court. Authority ofBIR 85. When may the Bureau of Internal Revenue (BIR) inquire into the deposits of a taxpayer? The BIR may inquire into the deposit and other related information to determine the gross estate of the deceased taxpayer for computation of estate tax;140 and if there is an offer of compromise of tax liability on account of the taxpayer’s financial incapacity.141 Apart from these, the BIR may not inquire into deposits without violating the right of the taxpayer to secrecy of deposits under existing laws.142 Garnishment of bank deposits 86. May the bank disclose information about Philippine currency bank deposits pursuant to a writ of garnishment? The Bank may disclose information about Philippine currency bank deposits pursuant to a writ of garnishment. The disclosure in this case is only incidental to the execution process. There is ‘“BAR 2018. ““Section 6(F)(1), Tax Code, as amended. “'Section 6(F)(2), Tax Code, as amended. “2BAR 2004. VI, BANKING 119 nothing in the records of Congress that would show the intention of legislature to place Philippine currency bank deposits beyond the reach of judgment creditor.143 87. Is the rule allowing garnishment of Philippine currency bank deposit similar to foreign currency deposits? No, the rule is different. Foreign currency deposits are exempt from attachment, garnishment or any other order or process of any court, legislative body, government agency or any administrative body whatsoever.144 88. In what cases may foreign currency deposits be examined, inquired or looked into? As a general rule, all foreign currency deposits authorized under R.A. No. 6426, as amended, are hereby declared as and considered of an absolutely confidential nature and in no instance shall foreign currency deposits be examined, inquired or looked into by any person, government official, bureau, or office whether judicial or administrative or legislative, or any other entity whether public or private, except in the following cases: a. Written permission of the depositor.145 b. The AMLC may inquire into or examine bank deposits or investments, including related accounts, with any banking institution or non-bank financial institution upon order of a competent court when it has been established that there is a probable cause that the deposits or investments, including related accounts involved, are related to unlawful activity, as defined by AMLA or a money laundering offense under the same law.146 c. The AMLC, either upon its own initiative or at the request of the Anti-Terrorism Council, is authorized to investigate: (a) any property or funds that are in any way related to financing of terrorism or acts of terrorism; (b) "’China Bank v. Ortega, G.R. No. L-34964, January 31,1973; PCIB v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 84526, January 28, 1991. "’Section 8, R.A. No. 6426, as amended. "‘Section 8, ibid. "‘Section 11, R.A. No. 9160, as amended, otherwise known as the Anti-Money Laundering Law. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M niVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 120 property or funds of any person or persons in relation to whom there is probable cause to believe that such person or persons are committing or attempting or conspiring to commit, or participating in or facilitating the financing of terrorism or acts of terrorism as defined in the law. For purposes of this section and notwithstanding the provisions ofR.A. No. 1405, otherwise known as the “Law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits”, as amended; R.A. No. 6426, otherwise known as the “Foreign Currency Deposit Act of the Philippines”, as amended; R.A. No. 8791, otherwise known as “The General Banking Law of 2000” and other laws, the AMLC is authorized to inquire into or examine deposits and investments with any banking institution or non-bank financial institution and their subsidiaries and affiliates without a court order.147 d. If the account holder is not the owner of foreign currency account as when he holds the deposits in trust for another.148 e. If the person asking for the court relief is a co-owner of the account.149 In one case, it was held that since Jose Gotianuy is the named co-payee of Mary Margaret Dee in the Citibank checks, which checks were deposited by Mary Margaret Dee in China Bank, then, Jose Gotianuy is likewise a depositor thereof. As the owner of the funds unlawfully taken and which are indisputably now deposited with China Bank, Jose Gotianuy has the right to inquire into the said deposits. Jose Gotianuy’s request for the assailed subpoena is tantamount to an express permission of a depositor for the disclosure of the name of the account holder. On that basis, no written consent from Mary Margaret Dee is necessitated. f. If the foreign currency deposit is made by a transient or a tourist as this is not the kind of deposit encouraged by the FCDU law and given incentives and protection by said laws because such depositor stays only for a few days in “’Section 10, RA. No. 10168. ““Van Twest v. Hon. Salvador de Guzman, G.R. No. 106253, February 10, 1994. “’China Bank v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 140687, December 18, 2006. VI. BANKING 121 the country and, therefore, will maintain his deposit in the bank only for a short time."1" This is particularly true if the transient committed a wrongdoing (e.g., rape of a minor). The law is intended to encourage foreign currency deposits to beef up the country’s international reserves. It cannot be invoked for a purpose contrary to what the law intended. 89. May foreign currency deposits be inquired into when the funds are the subject matter of litigation? No, R.A. No. 6426 is a special law designed especially for foreign currency deposits in the Philippines. R.A. No. 1405, which covers all bank deposits in the Philippines, is the general law which does not nullify the special law on foreign currency deposits. Thus, it was held that the surety which issued a bond to secure the obligation of the principal debtor cannot inquire into the foreign currency deposits of the debtor even if its purpose is to determine whether or not the loan proceeds were used for the purpose specified in the surety agreement. The foreign currency deposits cannot be examined without the consent of the depositor. The subpoena issued by the bank should be quashed because foreign currency deposits are not subject to court order except for violation of the anti-money laundering law.161 In this case of GSIS u. Court of Appeals, the Supreme Court held that there are only two permissible cases where foreign currency deposits may be examined. As enumerated above, there are other exceptions scattered in various cases. This case, however, may serve as authority that foreign currency deposits cannot be examined in case of impeachment. It should also be noted that R.A. No. 1405 lists impeachment as an exception to the rule against unauthorized examination of bank deposits while R.A. No. 6426 does not. J9JC9B0M 90. Mayor J has two (2) bank accounts: (1) a Peso savings account with Bank P, and (2) a U.S. Dollar savings account with Bank D. In 2018, Mayor J’s former business partner, Mr. K, filed a civil case for collection of sum of money against him. 160Karen Salvacion v. Central Bank of the Philippines, China Bank, et al., G.R. No. 94723, August 21, 1997. ,61GSIS v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 189206, June 8, 2011. J9JC9B0M 122 D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II In the same year, a criminal case for Direct Bribery under the Revised Penal Code was filed against Mayor J. It was alleged in the information that in exchange for the expeditious approval of various permits and licenses, Mayor j received kickbacks, which amounts were deposited to his bank accounts. In the event Mayor J is held ultimately liable in the civil case filed by Mr. K, may Mayor J’s bank accounts in Bank P and Bank D be subject to garnishment? Explain.162 The peso savings account of Mayor J with Bank P may be garnished. The prohibition against examination or inquiry into bank deposits under R.A. No. 1405 is not a bar to the garnishment of the deposit because the disclosure is only incidental to the execution process and there is nothing in the records of Congress that would indicate that Philippine currency bank deposits are beyond the reach of judgment creditor.153 The dollar savings account with Bank D, however, cannot be garnished. Except in case of written consent of depositor or in case of court order for violation of the Anti-Money Laundering law, foreign currency deposits are exempt from garnishment under R.A. No. 6426.15* 91. First Bank received an order of garnishment over a client's peso and dollar deposits in First Bank. Should First Bank comply with that order? Explain.155 First Bank should comply with the order of garnishment over a client’s peso deposits because as previously pointed out, there is nothing in R.A. No. 1405 that places bank deposits beyond the reach of judgment creditor. And the disclosure of information on bank deposits pursuant to the writ of garnishment is only incidental to the execution process.166 The dollar deposits, however, are exempt from garnishment or court order under the Foreign Currency Act (R.A. No. 6426). Thus, the bank should not comply with this part of the garnishment. 152BAR 2019. ‘“China Bank v. Ortega, G.R. No. L-34964, January 31. 1973. 161GSIS v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 189206, June 8, 2011. '“BAR 2015. ’“PCIB v. Court of Appeals, 193 SCRA 452. J VI. BANKING 123 Unclaimed Balances law 92. What does the term "unclaimed balances" mean in the context of the Unclaimed Balances Law? “Unclaimed balances” shall include credits or deposits of money, bullion, security or other evidence of indebtedness of any kind, and interest thereon with banks, buildings and loan associations, and trust corporations, as hereinafter defined, in favor of any person known to be dead or who has not made further deposits or withdrawals during the preceding ten years or more. Such unclaimed balances, together with the increase and proceeds thereof, shall be deposited with the Treasurer of the Philippines to the credit of the Government of the Republic of the Philippines.15’ 93. What are the obligations of banks, building and loan associations and trust corporations under the Unclaimed Balances law? Within the month of January of every odd year, all banks, building and loan associations, and trust corporations shall forward to the Treasurer of the Philippines a statement, under oath, of their respective managing officers, of all credits and deposits held by them in favor of persons known to be dead, or who have not made further deposits or withdrawals during the preceding 10 years or more, arranged in alphabetical order according to the names of creditors and depositors, and showing: J9JC9B0M (a) The names and last known place of residence or post office addresses of the persons in whose favor such unclaimed balances stand; (b) The amount and the date of the outstanding unclaimed balance and whether the same is in money or in security, and if the latter, the nature of the same; (c) The date when the person in whose favor the unclaimed balance stands died, if known, or the date when he made his last deposit or withdrawal; and (d) The interest due on such unclaimed balance, if any, and the amount thereof. 167Section 2, Act No. 3936, as amended. J9JC9B0M 124 PIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II A copy of the above sworn statement shall be posted in a conspicuous place in the premises of the bank, building and loan association, or trust corporation concerned for at least 60 days from the date of tiling thereof: Provided, that immediately before filing the above sworn statement, the bank, building and loan association, and trust corporation shall communicate with the person in whose favor the unclaimed balance stands at his last known place of residence or post office address. It shall be the duty of the Treasurer of the Philippines to inform the Solicitor General from time to time the existence of unclaimed balances held by banks, building and loan associations, and trust corporations.‘“ 94. What happens to such unclaimed balances? Whenever the Solicitor General shall be informed of such ■mclaimed balances, he shall commence an action or actions in the ame of the People of the Republic of the Philippines in the Court f First Instance of the province or city where the bank, building and loan association or trust corporation is located, in which shall be joined as parties the bank, building and loan association or trust corporation and all such creditors or depositors. All or any of such creditors or depositors or banks, building and loan association or trust corporations may be included in one action. Upon the trial, the court must hear all parties who have appeared therein, and if it be determined that such unclaimed balances in any defendant bank, building and loan association or trust corporation are unclaimed as hereinbefore stated, then the court shall render judgment in favor of the Government of the Republic of the Philippines, declaring that said unclaimed balances have escheated to the Government of the Republic of the Philippines and commanding said bank, building and loan association or trust corporation to forthwith deposit the same with the Treasurer of the Philippines to credit of the Government of the Republic of the Philippines to be used as the National Assembly169 may direct.160 ‘“Section 2, ibid. ‘“Now, Congress of the Philippines. '“Section 3, Act No. 3936, as amended. VI. BANKING 125 95. What is the liability of the bank, building and loan association or trust corporation for failure to file the sworn statement as required by law? If the president, cashier or managing officer of the bank, building and loan association, or trust corporation neglects or refuses to make and file the sworn statement required by this action, such bank, building and loan association, or trust corporation shall pay to the Government the sum of P500.00 a month for each month or fraction thereof during which such default shall continue.161 96. Istheofficer who reported to the National Treasurer information about unclaimed balances, as required by law, liable for violation of the law on secrecy of deposits? No, disclosure to the Treasurer information on unclaimed balances for the purpose of initiating escheat proceedings does not violate R.A. No. 1405 or the law on secrecy of Philippine currency deposits. Disclosure is a duty imposed by law. It should be noted though that escheat is akin to garnishment. And if foreign currency deposits cannot be garnished under R.A. No. 6426, as amended, then the same deposits cannot be likewise be escheated. Repeal or amendment of the law 97. J9JC9B0M The law (R.A. No. 6832) creating a Commission to Conduct a Thorough Fact-Finding Investigation of the Failed Coup d'Etat of December 1989, Recommended Measures to Prevent The Occurrence of Similar Attempts at a Violent Seizure of Power and for Other Purposes, provides that the Commission may ask the Monetary Board to disclose information on and/ or grant authority to examine any bank deposits, trust or investment funds, or banking transactions in the name of and/ or to grant authority to examine any bank deposits, trust or investment funds, or banking transactions in the name of and/ or utilized by a person, natural or juridical, under investigation by the Commission, in any bank or banking institution in the Philippines, when the Commission has reasonable ground to believe that said deposits, trust or investment funds, 161Section 4, ibid. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL I AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 126 or banking transactions have been used in support or in furtherance of the objectives of the said coup d'etat. Does not the above provision violate the Law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits (R.A. No. 1405)? 162 The law on Secrecy of Bank Deposits is itself merely a statutory enactment, and it may, therefore, be modified, or amended (such as by providing further exceptions therefrom), or even repealed by a subsequent law. The law did not amount to a contract between the depositors and depositary banks within the meaning of the non­ impairment clause of the Constitution. Even if it did, the police power of the State is superior to the non-impairment clause.163 98. What is the penalty for violation of the laws on secrecy of deposits? Any violation of R.A. No. 1405 will subject the offender upon conviction, to an imprisonment of not more than five (5) years or a ine of not more than P20,000.00 or both, in the discretion of the court.16* On the other hand, any violation of R.A. No. 6426 or any regulation duly promulgated by the Monetary Board pursuant thereto shall subject the offender upon conviction to an imprisonment of not less than one (1) year nor more than five (5) years or a fine of not less than P5,000.00 nor more than P25.000.00, or both such fine and imprisonment, at the discretion of the court.166 C. General Banking Law (R.A. No. 8791) a. 99. Definition and classification of banks What is a bank? A bank is an entity engaged in the lending of funds obtained from the public in the form of deposits.166 It has three elements: a) it is engaged in the lending of funds; b) the funds are obtained from 162BAR 1991. ‘“BAR 1991. ‘“Section 5, R.A. No. 1405. ‘“Section 10, R.A. No. 6426. ‘“Section 3.1, R.A. No. 8791, otherwise known as the General Banking Law (GBL). VI. BANKING 127 the public, which means, 20 or more lenders; and c) the funds are obtained from the public in the form of deposits. Note that unlike the old law, these activities need not be performed with habituality. Thus, when a corporation loans out the money obtained from almost 60,000 savings account deposits opened by the public with the said corporation, it is clear that these transactions partake the nature of banking, as defined by the law.167 However, transactions involving purchase of receivables at a discount, well within the purview of investing, reinvesting or trading in securities, which an investment company is authorized to perform, does not constitute banking. Similarly, if the funds supposedly lent have not been shown to have been obtained from the public by way of deposits, it cannot be said that the investment company was engaged in banking.168 100. Fatima Investment Corporation is engaged in the purchase of accounts receivables or specifically, installment papers of purchasers of cars and trucks. As a source of its funding, it sells its bonds from time to time to the public. The proceeds of the sale of its bonds are utilized by Fatima Investment Corporation in its financing operations. a. Is Fatima Investment Corporation engaged in banking? A bank is an entity engaged in the lending of funds obtained from the public in the form of deposits. These elements are not present in the transaction involving Fatima Investment Corporation. Purchase of receivables, if it is without recourse, is not lending, and bond issuance to obtain funds from the public is not a deposit taking activity.169 b. What is the effect if a corporation engages in illegal banking? The General Banking Act, as well as the Central Bank Act, provides for civil and criminal liabilities, not only on the corporation, 167Republic of the Philippines v. Security Credit and Acceptance Corporation, G.R. No. L-20583, January 23, 1967. 168Teodoro Banas v. Asia Pacific Finance Corporation, G.R. No. 128703, October 18, 2000. 169BAR 1978; The act of ABC Investment Corporation amounts to quasi­ banking. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL IAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 128 but likewise on the officers and directors thereof in proper cases, when a corporation engages in illegal banking. Furthermore, a quo warranto proceeding may also be initiated to oust the corporation from the exercise of banking powers and functions.170 101. What are the requirements for the grant of a banking license? The requirements are as follows: a. The entity must be organized as a stock corporation. As a stock corporation, it must have not less than five (5) but more than 15 directors, two of whom shall be independent directors.1’1 However, in case of merger or consolidation, the bank may have up to 21 directors;172 b. That its funds are obtained from the public, which shall mean 20 or more persons; and c. That the minimum capital requirements prescribed by the Monetary Board for each category of banks are satisfied.173 The Securities and Exchange Commission shall not register the articles of incorporation of any bank, or any amendment thereto, unless accompanied by a certificate of authority issued by the Monetary Board, under its seal. Such certificate shall not be issued unless the Monetary Board is satisfied from the evidence submitted to it that: a. All requirements of existing laws and regulations to engage in the business for which the applicant is proposed to be incorporated have been complied with;174 b. The public interest and economic conditions, both general and local, justify the authorization;176 and c. The amount of capital, the financing, organization, direction and administration, as well as the integrity ’’"BAR 1988, 1978; Republic of the Philippines v. Security Credit and Acceptance Corporation, ibid. ’’’Section 15, GBL. ‘“Section 17, GBL; BAR 2012. ‘“Section 8, GBL. ‘“Section 14.1, GBL. ‘“Section 14.2, GBL. J VI. BANKING 129 and responsibility of the organizers and administrators reasonably assure the safety of deposits and the public interest.170 The Securities and Exchange Commission shall not register the by-laws of any bank, or any amendment thereto, unless accompanied by a certificate of authority from the Bangko Sentral.’77 102. May foreigners be elected directors of domestic bank? Yes, foreigners may be elected directors of a domestic bank to the extent of their actual foreign equity. Foreign individuals and non-bank corporations may own or control up to 40% of the voting stock of a domestic bank. This rule shall apply to Filipinos and domestic non-bank corporations.178 The percentage of foreign-owned voting stocks in a bank shall be determined by the citizenship of the individual stockholders in that bank. The citizenship of the corporation which is a stockholder in a bank shall follow the citizenship of the controlling stockholders of the corporation, irrespective of the place of incorporation. However, while the allowable foreign equity in domestic bank is 40% of its voting stock, foreigners can be elected to the board only in proportion to the bank’s actual foreign equity. Thus, if the foreign-held stocks amount only to 30% of the bank’s foreign equity, foreigners can only have three (3) seats in a 10-person board of directors. A foreign bank, allowed to operate under the foreign bank liberalization law, can be wholly-owned by foreigners.’79 103. May foreigners be appointed officers of a domestic bank? No, it will violate the Anti-Dummy law. Under such law, any foreigner is not allowed to intervene in the management, operation, administration or control, whether as an officer, employee or laborer therein of a corporation which, having in its name or control, a right, J9JC9B0M ’’’Section 14.3, GBL. ’’’Section 14, GBL. ’’’Section 11, GBL. ”’R.A. No. 10641. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 130 franchise, privilege, property or business, the exercise or enjoyment of which is expressly reserved by the Constitution or the laws to citizens of the Philippines. 104. What is the limit on the number of shares a person may own in a domestic bank? Foreign individuals and non-bank corporations may own or control up to 40% of the voting stock of a domestic bank. This rule shall apply to Filipinos and domestic non-bank corporations.181 Forty percent (40%) is the aggregate limit for foreign-held stocks while 40% is an individual limit for Filipino natural persons and domestic non-bank corporations. The exceptions to the 40% share ownership limit Eire as follows: a. Foreign banks allowed to operate under the foreign bank liberalization law through any of the following modes of entry: i) acquiring, purchasing, or owning up to 100% of the voting stock of an existing bank; ii) by investing in up to 100% of the voting stock of a new banking subsidiary incorporated under the laws of the Philippines; or (iii) by establishing branches with full banking authority.182 b. A universal bank can own up to 100% of the equity in a thrift bank, a rural bank or a financial allied enterprise. A publicly-listed universal or commercial bank may own up to 100% of the voting stock of only one other universal or commercial bank.183 Note that the 100% ownership on voting stocks must be in either bank only.181 105. What are the classifications of banks? Banks shall be classified into: a. Universal banks; b. Commercial banks; '“Section 2-A, Anti-Dummy Law. Commonwealth Act 108. “'Section 11, GBL. '“Section 2, R.A. No. 10641. '“Section 25, GBL. '“BAR 2012. VI. BANKING 131 Thrift banks, composed of: C. i. ii. iii. Savings and mortgage banks; Stock savings and loan associations; and Private development banks, as defined in the R.A. No. 7906 (hereafter the “Thrift Banks Act'). d. Rural banks, as defined in R.A. No. 7653 (hereafter the “Rural Banks Act’)-, e. Cooperative banks, as defined in R.A. No. 6938 (hereafter the “Cooperative Code’)-, f. Islamic banks as defined in R.A. No. 6848, otherwise known as the "Charter of Al Amanah Islamic Investment Bank of the Philippines”; and g- Other classifications of banks as determined by the Monetary Board of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas.185 106. Describe each type of bank.186 J9JC9B0M A. A universal bank is a commercial bank which has the power of an investment house and the power to invest in the equity of allied and non-allied enterprises.187 It is otherwise known as an expanded commercial bank. B. A commercial bank is a bank that can: a. Accept drafts; b. Issue letters of credit; c. Discount and negotiate promissory notes, bills of exchange, and other evidence of debt; d. Accept or create demand deposits; e. Receive other types of deposits, as well as deposit substitutes; f. Buy and sell foreign exchange, as well as gold or silver bullion; g- Acquire marketable bonds and other debts securities; and ‘“Section 3.1, GBL. ‘“BAR 2010. 187Section 23, GBL. J9JC9B0M 1 niVINAON COMMERCIAL 1.AW: A (VMI’KEHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 132 h. Extend credit, subject to such rules promulgated by the Monetary Board."* Note that an entity authorized by the Bangko Sentral to perforin universal or commercial banking functions shall likewise have the authority to engage in quasi-banking functions.189 C. A thrift bank is one established as a savings and mortgage bank, a stock savings and loan association, or a private development bank, for the purpose of: a. Accumulating the savings of depositors and investing them together with capital loans secured by bonds, mortgages in real estate and insured improvements thereon, chattel mortgage, bonds and other forms of security, or in loans for personal or household finance, whether secured or unsecured, or in financing for homebuilding and home development, in readily marketable and debt securities, in commercial papers and account receivables, drafts, bill of exchange, acceptance or notes, arising out of commercial transactions or in outlets determined by the Monetary Board as necessary in the furtherance of national economic objectives; b. Providing short-term working capital, medium and long-term financing, to business engaged in agriculture, services, industry and housing; and c. Providing diversified financial and allied services for its chosen market and constituencies especially for small and medium enterprises and individuals.100 D. A rural bank is one established to provide credit facilities to farmers and merchants or their cooperatives and, in general, to the people of the rural communities.191 E. A cooperative bank is a bank organized under the Cooperative Code to provide financial and credit services to cooperatives. '““Section 29, GBL. '““Section 6, GBL. '“Section 3, R.A. No.7906. '“‘Section 2, R.A. No.7353. 1 133 VI. BANKING 107. Distinguish universal bank from commercial bank. The distinctions are as follows: The minimum capital requirement for a universal bank is as follows: P 3 billion Head Office only P 6 billion Up to 10 branches 1. 11 to 100 branches More than 100 branches P 15 billion P 20 billion The minimum capital requirement for a commercial bank is as follows: P 2 billion Head Office only Up to 10 branches P 4 billion 11 to 100 branches More than 100 branches P 10 billion P 15 billion 2. A universal bank may perform the functions of an investment house, a commercial bank may not. 3. A universal bank may invest in the equity of allied and non-allied enterprises whereas a commercial bank may only invest in the equity of allied enterprises. b. Distinction of banks from quasi-banks and trust entities 108. Distinguish banks from quasi-banks and trust entities. Quasi-banks shall refer to entities engaged in the borrowing of funds through the issuance, endorsement or assignment with recourse or acceptance of deposit substitutes as defined in Section 95 ofR.A. No. 7653 (hereafter the “New Central Bank Act”) for purposes of re-lending or purchasing of receivables and other obligations.’92 Persons or entities found to be performing banking or quasi­ banking functions without authority from the Bangko Sentral shall be subject to appropriate sanctions under the New Central Bank Act and other applicable laws.193 J9JC9B0M ’“Section 4.6, GBL. ’“Section 6, GBL. J9JC9B0M 1 134 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II A trust company is a legal entity that acts as fiduciary, agent or trustee on behalf of a person or business for a trust. A trust company is typically tasked with the administration, management and the eventual transfer of assets to beneficiaries. Note, however, that a bank may obtain a trust license and once it is issued, the bank may act as trustee with power to administer and manage assets for the trustor. The trust department of the bank, while it is organizationally and operationally distinct from the regular bank, has no separate legal personality from the bank. c. Bank powers and liabilities i. Corporate Powers 109. What are the powers of a bank? In addition to the general powers incident to corporations, a commercial bank has the following powers: 1. 2. All such powers as may be necessary to carry on the business of commercial banking such as: a. Accepting drafts and issuing letters of credit; b. Discounting and negotiating promissory notes, drafts, bills of exchange, and other evidences of debt; C. Accepting or creating demand deposits; d. Receiving other types of deposits and deposit substitutes; e. Buying and selling foreign exchange and gold or silver bullion; f. Acquiring marketable bonds and other debt securities; and extending credit, subject to such rules as the Monetary Board may promulgate.184 It may invest in equities subject to the rules that the Monetary Board may prescribe. To invest in equities means to be a stockholder in a corporation. A commercial bank, however, can only invest in the equity of allied ■’’Section 29, GBL. J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 135 enterprises. It means that that it may own shares of stock in a corporation only if the latter is engaged in a business related to banking. Whether an enterprise is allied or not to banking is determined by BSP. 3. It has the power to purchase or acquire shares of its own capital stock or accept its own shares as a security for a loan but only when authorized by the Monetary Board. Provided, that in every case the stock so purchased or acquired shall, within six (6) months from the time of its purchase or acquisition, be sold or disposed of at a public or private sale.195 In Filipinos Mills v. Dayrit, the Supreme Court held that a bank, as judgment creditor, may garnish shares in satisfaction of a judgment debt.196 While this case was decided based on the old General Banking Act which allowed a bank to acquire its shares of stock in the course of its operations, there is no rhyme or reason why a bank, as a judgment creditor, should be precluded from effecting a garnishment on the shares of stock of its stockholder to satisfy a judgment debt. The shares, once acquired by the bank, become treasury shares. 4. A bank may acquire, hold or convey real property under the following circumstances: a. When it is necessary for its own use or in the conduct of its business;197 b. Such as shall be mortgaged to it in good faith by way of security for debts; c. Such as shall be conveyed to it in satisfaction of debts previously contracted in the course of its dealings; or d. Such as it shall purchase at sales under judgments, decrees, mortgages, or trust deeds held by it and such as it shall purchase to secure debts due it.198 '“Section 10, GBL. 196G.R. No. 56620, December 10,1990. 197Section 51, GBL. '“Section 52, GBL. J9JC9B0M PIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 136 110. What are the limitations on the power of a bank to invest in equity? a. A universal bank can invest in the equity of allied and non-allied enterprises whereas a commercial bank can only invest in the equity of allied enterprises. Thus, a commercial bank cannot acquire shares in a cement manufacturing company while a universal bank can.199 b. The equity investment of a universal bank, or of its wholly or majority-owned subsidiaries, in a single non-allied enterprise shall not exceed 35% of the total equity in that enterprise nor shall it exceed 35% of the voting stock in that enterprise.2™ c. The total investment in equities of allied and non-allied enterprises shall not exceed 50% of the net worth of the bank.201 d. The equity investment in any one enterprise, whether allied or non-allied, shall not exceed 25% of the net worth of the bank. “Net worth” shall mean the total of the unimpaired paidin capital including paid-in surplus, retained earnings and undivided profit, net of valuation reserves and other adjustments as may be required by the Bangko Sentral. e. 111. The acquisition of such equity or equities is subject to the prior approval of the Monetary Board. What are the limitations on the power of a bank to acquire real property? a. A domestic bank can only acquire real property in any of the cases specified in Sections 51 and 52 of the General Banking Law. Thus, it was held that a real property cannot be conveyed to the bank in settlement of a civil liability arising from a criminal offense. Civil liability is not a debt. The debt which can be satisfied by dation in payment is that which is incurred or contracted in ‘"BAR 2015. ““Section 27, GBL. “'Section 24.1, GBL. VI. BANKING 137 the course of the bank’s dealings, like loan and similar transactions.202 b. Any real property acquired or held under the circumstances enumerated in Section 52 shall be disposed of by the bank within a period of five (5) years or as may be prescribed by the Monetary Board: Provided, however, that the bank may, after said period, continue to hold the property for its own use.203 C. While a bank may acquire real estate as shall be necessary for its own use in the conduct of its business, the total investment in such real estate and improvements thereof including bank equipment, shall not exceed 50% of the bank’s combined capital accounts: Provided, further, that the equity investment of a bank in another corporation engaged primarily in real estate shall be considered as part of the bank’s total investment in real estate, unless otherwise provided by the Monetary Board. d. A foreign bank cannot own real property even though it is allowed to operate under the Foreign Bank Liberalization law. Such foreign bank, however, is allowed to bid and take part in foreclosure sales of real property mortgaged to it, as well as to avail itself of enforcement and other proceedings, and accordingly take possession of the mortgaged property, for a period not exceeding five (5) years from actual possession. Provided, that in no event shall title to the property be transferred to such foreign bank. In case said bank is the winning bidder, it shall, during the said five-year period, transfer its rights to a qualified Philippine national, without prejudice to a borrower’s rights under applicable laws. Should the bank fail to transfer such property within the five-year period, it shall be penalized one-half (1/2) of one percent (1%) per annum at the price for which the property was foreclosed until it is able to transfer the property to a qualified Philippine national.204 “Register of Deeds of Manila (1962). “Section 52, GBL. “Section 9, R.A. No. 10641. J9JC9B0M China Banking Corporation, 4 SCRA 1145 J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 138 ii. Blinking and incidental powers 112. What are the services that banks may render? In addition to the operations specifically authorized by the General Banking Act, a bank may perform the following services: a. Receive in custody funds, documents and valuable objects:2"5 Thus, it is not correct to say that funds received by the bank are always treated as deposits and governed by creditor-debtor relationship. Funds may be received by the bank for safekeeping. Unlike deposits, funds held for safekeeping cannot be used or mingled with other funds of the bank, without the consent of the depositor. b. Act as financial agent and buy and sell, by order of and for the account of their customers, shares, evidences of indebtedness and all types of securities;206 Thus, the bank does not need a separate stock broker license to be able to buy shares of stock on behalf of a client. c. Make collections and payments for the account of others and perform such other services for their customers as are not incompatible with banking business;“7 Thus, a bank may accept payment for utility bills. d. Upon prior approval of the Monetary Board, act as managing agent, adviser, consultant or administrator of investment management/advisory/consultancy accounts;208 and Rent out safety deposit boxes.209 113. Is the above enumeration as to the services that the bank may render exclusive? No, the bank may render other services for its customers as long as they are not incompatible with banking business. A bank, “‘Section 53.1, R.A. No. 8791. “‘Section 53.2, ibid. “’Section 53.3, ibid. ““Section 53.4, ibid. “’Section 53.5, ibid. VI. BANKING 139 for instance, cannot sell sweepstakes or lotto tickets for the PCSO, because it is not compatible with banking business. 114. How do you characterize the legal relationship between a commercial bank and its safety deposit box client?210 A contract for the use of safety deposit box is a special kind of deposit. The relationship between a commercial bank and its safety deposit box client is that of a bailee and bailor, the bailment being for hire and mutual benefit. As such, the bank has the obligation to exercise the diligence of a good father of a family as such depositary. The bank was held liable for the loss of the certificates of title in the safety deposit box since the deposit box is located in the bank premises and is under the absolute control of the bank.211 Note that in Sia v. Court of Appeals, the ruling of the Supreme Court that a contract for the use of a safety deposit box is a special kind of deposit was based on the provision of the old General Banking Act.212 The old law stated that in renting out safety deposit box, the bank shall act as depositary. Such description of function was not incorporated in R.A. No. 8791. It is submitted that there is now basis to hold that a contract for the use of a safety deposit box should be governed by the law on lease. This means that the obligation of the bank is to allow the renter possession of the safety deposit box. It should not be burdened with the duty to safe keep the items in the box because it is not supposed to know the contents thereof in the first place. 115. Is a stipulation in the contract for the use of a safety deposit box relieving the bank of liability in connection with the use thereof valid?213 The stipulation relieving the bank of liability in connection with the use of the safety deposit box is void as it is against law and public policy. J9JC9B0M d. Diligence required of banks in view of the fiduciary nature of banking 210BAR 2010. 211Sia v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 102970, May 13,1993. “Section 72, R.A. No. 337. ™Ibid. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 140 116. What is the kind of diligence required of banks? The diligence required of banks is more than that of a good father of a family where the fiduciary nature of their relationship with their depositors is concerned. The highest degree of diligence is based on the General Banking Law which requires of banks the highest standards of integrity and performance. A banking institution owes it to its clients to observe the high standards of integrity and performance in all its transactions because its business is imbued with public interest. The high standards are also necessary to ensure public confidence in the banking system, for the stability of banks largely depends on the confidence of the people in the honesty and efficiency of banks.2H It was held that the bank failed in its duty to exercise the highest degree of diligence by prematurely foreclosing the mortgages md unwarrantedly causing the foreclosure sale of the mortgaged properties despite the mortgagor not being yet in default.216 But the same degree of diligence is not expected to be exerted by banks in commercial transactions that do not involve their fiduciary relationship with depositors, such as sale and issuance of demand draft216 or in acting as advising bank in a letter of credit. e. Nature of bank funds and bank deposits 117. Describe the nature of bank funds and bank deposits. Bank deposits are governed by the law on loans. A creditor and debtor relationship is created between the Bank and its depositors. The fiduciary nature of a bank-depositor relationship does not convert the contract between the bank and its depositors from a loan to trust agreement. Failure by the bank to pay the depositor is failure to pay a simple loan and not a breach of trust.217 21<Philippine National Bank V. Spouses Eduardo and Ma. Rosario Tajonera, G.R. No. 195889, September 24,2014; Comsavings Bank v. Sps. Capistrano, G.R. No. 170942, August 28, 2013. ’“Development Bank of the Philippines v. Guarina Agricultural and Realty Development Corporation, G.R. No. 160758, January 15, 2014. 216Gregorio Reyes v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 118492, August 15, 2001. 217Consolidated Bank and Trust Corporation v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 138569. I VI. BANKING 141 118. Differentiate "bank deposits" from "deposit substitutes."218 Bank deposits are funds obtained by a bank from the public which are relent by such bank to its own borrowers. They are governed by the law on loans. They give rise to creditor-debtor relationship between the bank as debtor, and the depositors as creditors. Deposit substitutes are alternative forms of obtaining funds from the public, other than deposits, through the issuance, endorsement, or acceptance of debt instruments for the own account of the borrower, for the purpose of relending or purchasing of receivables and other obligations. These instruments may include, but need not be limited to, bankers’ acceptances, promissory notes, participations, certificates of assignment and similar instruments with recourse, and repurchase agreements.219 f. Grant of loans and security requirements i. Ratio of net worth to total risk assets 119. What is capital adequacy ratio? Capital adequacy ratio, also known as the capital to riskweighted assets ratio, measures a bank’s financial strength by using its capital and assets. It is used to protect depositors and promote the stability and efficiency of the bank. The Monetary Board shall prescribe the minimum ratio which the net worth of a bank must bear to its total risk assets which may include contingent accounts. Ten percent (10%) is the minimum total adequacy ratio banks must comply with. It means that the risk assets must not exceed 10 times the capital of the bank. Risk assets are the loans and investments of the bank. In case a bank does not comply with the prescribed minimum ratio, the Monetary Board may limit or prohibit the distribution of net profits by such bank and may require that part or all of the net profits be used to increase the capital accounts of the bank; restrict or prohibit the acquisition of major assets and the making of new investments by the bank, with the exception of purchases of J9JC9B0M 218BAR 2010. 219Section 95, R.A. No. 7653. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 142 readily marketable evidence of indebtedness of the Republic of the Philippines and of the Bangko Sentral and any other evidence of indebtedness or obligations the servicing and repayment of which are fully guaranteed by the Republic of the Philippines, until the minimum required capital ratio has been restored. In case of a bank merger or consolidation, or when a bank is under rehabilitation under a program approved by the Bangko Sentral. the Monetary Board may temporarily relieve the surviving bank, consolidated bank, or constituent bank or corporations under rehabilitation from full compliance with the required capital ratio under such conditions as it may prescribe. 120. What are the limitations on the power of the bank to grant loans? The limitations on the power of the bank to grant loans are as follows: a. Except as the Monetary Board may otherwise prescribe for reasons of national interest, the total amount of loans, credit accommodations and guarantees as may be defined by the Monetary Board that may be extended by a bank to any person, partnership, association, corporation or other entity shall at no time exceed 25% of the net worth of such bank.220 This rule is known as the single borrower’s limit.221 b. Loans granted to directors, officers, stockholders and their related interests must conform to certain procedural and substantive requirements, otherwise, criminal sanctions may be imposed. These requirements are known as DOSRI rules and regulations.222 c. Except as the Monetary Board may otherwise prescribe, loans and other credit accommodations against real estate shall not exceed 75% of the appraised value of the respective real estate security, plus 60% of the appraised value of the insured improvements, and such loans may be ^Section 35, GBL. While the law sets the SBL to 20% of the bank’s net worth, the Monetary Board has increased the threshold limit to 25%. “‘BAR 2015. “Section 36, GBL. VI. BANKING 143 made to the owner of the real estate or to his assignees223 whereas, loans and other credit accommodations on security of chattels and intangible properties such as, but not limited to, patents, trademarks, trade names, and copyrights shall not exceed 75% of the appraised value of the security, and such loans and other credit accommodation may be made to the title-holder of the chattels and intangible properties or his assignees.224 d. A bank shall grant loans and other credit accommodations only in amounts and for the periods of time essential for the effective completion of the operations to be financed. Such grant of loans and other credit accommodations shall be consistent with safe and sound banking practices.225 e. The amortization schedule of bank loans and other credit accommodations shall be adapted to the nature of the operations to be financed. In case of loans and other credit accommodations with maturities of more than five (5) years, provisions must be made for periodic amortization payments, but such payments must be made at least annually: Provided, however, that when the borrowed funds are to be used for purposes which do not initially produce revenues adequate for regular amortization payments therefrom, the bank may permit the initial amortization payment to be deferred until such time as said revenues are sufficient for such purpose, but in no case shall the initial amortization date be later than five (5) years from the date on which the loan or other credit accommodation is granted.226 ii. Single borrower’s limit 121. When may the single borrower's limit be increased? The total amount of loans, credit accommodations and guarantees prescribed in the preceding paragraph may be increased by an additional 10% of the net worth of such bank provided the additional liabilities of any borrower are adequately secured by trust receipts, shipping documents, warehouse receipts or other J9JC9B0M “‘Section 37, “‘Section 38, “‘Section 39, “‘Section 44, GBL. GBL. GBL. GBL. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 144 similar documents transferring or securing title covering readily marketable, non-perishable goods which must be fully covered by insurance.01 122. What liabilities, other than loans, credit accommodations and guarantees, are included in the above prescribed ceiling? a. The direct liability of the maker or acceptor of paper discounted with or sold to such bank and the liability of a general endorser, drawer or guarantor who obtains a loan or other credit accommodation from or discounts paper with or sells papers to such bank; b. In the case of an individual who owns or controls a majority interest in a corporation, partnership, association or any other entity, the liabilities of said entities to such bank; c. In the case of a corporation, all liabilities to such bank of all subsidiaries in which such corporation owns or controls a majority interest; and d. In the case of a partnership, association or other entity, the liabilities of the members thereof to such bank.228 123. What loans, other credit accommodations and guarantees are excluded in the computation of single borrower's limit? The following loans, credit accommodations and guarantees are excluded in the computation of single borrower’s limit: a. b. Those secured by obligations of the Bangko Sentral or of the Philippine Government; Those fully guaranteed by the government as to the payment of principal and interest; c. Those covered by assignment of deposits maintained in the lending bank and held in the Philippines; d. Loans, credit accommodations and acceptances under letters of credit to the extent covered by margin deposits; and ^Section 35,2, GBL. -'“Section 35.3, GBL. VI. BANKING 145 e. Those which the Monetary Board may from time to time, specify as non-risk items.22” iii. Restrictions on bank exposure to directors, officers, stockholders and their related interest 124. What are the restrictions on a bank's exposure to directors, officers, stockholders and their related interests? No director or officer of any bank shall, directly or indirectly, for himself or as the representative or agent of others, borrow from such bank nor shall he become a guarantor, endorser or surety for loans from such bank to others, or in any manner be an obligor or incur any contractual liability to the bank except with the written approval of the majority of all the directors of the bank, excluding the director concerned: Provided, that such written approval shall not be required for loans, other credit accommodations and advances granted to officers under a fringe benefit plan approved by the Bangko Sentral. The required approval shall be entered upon the records of the bank and a copy of such entry shall be transmitted forthwith to the appropriate supervising and examining department of the Bangko Sentral.230 The outstanding loans, credit accommodations and guarantees which a bank may extend to each of its stockholders, directors, or officers and their related interests, shall be limited to an amount equivalent to their respective unencumbered deposits and book value of their paid-in capital contribution in the bank: Provided, however, that loans, credit accommodations and guarantees secured by assets considered as non-risk by the Monetary Board shall be excluded from such limit: Provided, further, that loans, credit accommodations and advances to officers in the form of fringe benefits granted in accordance with rules as may be prescribed by the Monetary Board shall not be subject to the individual limit. The Monetary Board shall define the term “related interests.” The limit on loans, credit accommodations and guarantees prescribed herein shall not apply to loans, credit accommodations and guarantees extended by a cooperative bank to its cooperative shareholders.231 J9JC9B0M “’Section 35.4, GBL. “Section 36, GBL. mIbid. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 146 The rule on DOSRI transaction covers loan obtained or guaranteed by the director, officer, stockholder or their related interest and not to loans both obtained and guaranteed by them. The rule in fact covers any transaction where the DOSRI may incur contractual obligations with their bank. Thus, it is not limited to loan transactions. It may include the purchase by the DOSRI of a bank property. In this case, though, only the approval and reportorial requirements should be observed. In other words, DOSRI transactions are subject to the following rules/restrictions: 1. The transactions must be approved by at least majority of the entire board excluding the director concerned (“approval requirement”); 2. The required approval shall be entered upon the records of the bank and copy of such entry shall be submitted to the BSP (“reportorial requirement”); and 3. Unless the loan is non-risk, the loan must not exceed the book value of the paid- up shares of the borrowing DOSRI and the amount of unencumbered deposits (“ceiling requirement”).232 However, if there is no loan component to the transaction, as when a director, officer or stockholder buys a property of the bank, only the first two restrictions shall apply. 125. All senior officers of ABC Bank are entitled to obtain a housing loan. X is an Executive Vice President for Operations of ABC Bank. She obtained a housing loan with the ABC Bank. Which statement is most accurate?233 a. The housing loan of X requires a guarantor from somebody who is not connected with the bank. b. The housing loan of X requires the approval of the Board of Directors of the bank. c. The housing loan of X, being a benefit for employees, does not require (a) but will require (b). ““Section 36, R.A. No. 8791. ““BAR 2012. VI. BANKING d. 147 The housing loan ofX, being a benefit for employees, will not require (a) and (b). 126. How many criminal offenses are committed by the failure to observe the approval, reporting and ceiling requirements? DOSRI transactions are subject to approval, reportorial and ceiling requirements. Approval requirement means that the DOSRI transaction must be approved by at least majority of the directors excluding the director concerned. Reportorial requirement means that the transaction must be recorded in the books of the bank and reported to BSP. Ceiling requirement means that the amount of the loan shall not exceed the book value of the paid-in contribution and the amount of unencumbered deposits. Three different offenses are committed by those who fail to observe the board approval, reporting and ceiling requirements.234 127. A criminal information alleged that spouses Enrico and Amalia appeared to have an outstanding loan of P8 million with the RBSM Bank, but had never applied for nor received such loan; that it was HS, who was then president of RBSM, who had ordered, facilitated, and received the proceeds of the loan; and that the P8 million loan had never been authorized by RBSM's Board of Directors and no report thereof had ever been submitted to the Department of Rural Banks, Supervision and Examination Sector of the BSP. J9JC9B0M HS moved to quash the information contending that the commission of estafa is inherently incompatible with the violation of DOSRI law, hence a person cannot be charged for both offenses. He argued that a violation of DOSRI law requires the offender to obtain a loan from his bank, without complying with procedural, reportorial, or ceiling requirements. On the other hand, estafa requires the offender to misappropriate or convert something that he holds in trust, or on commission, or for administration, or under any other obligation involving the duty to return the same. He theorized that the characterization of possession is different in the two offenses. If HS acquired the loan as “Go v. BSP, October 23, 2009. J9JC9B0M 148 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 DOSRI, he owned the loaned money and therefore, cannot misappropriate or convert it as contemplated in the offense of estafa. Conversely, if he committed estafa, then he merely held the money in trust for someone else and therefore, did not acquire a loan in violation of DOSRI rules. Discuss whether the loan transaction within the ambit of the DOSRI law could also be the subject of estafa under Article 315(1)(b) of the Revised Penal Code. The information filed against HS for estafa and violation of DOSRI law do not negate each other. The bank money which came to the possession of HS was money held in trust or administration by him for the bank, in his fiduciary capacity as the President of said bank. It is not accurate to say that he became the owner of the P8 million because it was ‘he proceeds of a loan. That would have been correct if the bank nowingly extended the loan to him. But that is not the case here, hrough fraudulent device, he made it appear that other persons cere the borrowers but he obtained the loan proceeds and converted the same. Under these circumstances, it cannot be said that he became the legal owner of the P8 million. Thus, he remained the bank s fiduciary with respect to that money, which makes it capable of misappropriation or conversion in his hands. The prohibition under the DOSRI law is broad enough to cover various modes of borrowing. It covers loans by a bank director or officer flike herein HS) which are made either: (1) directly, (2) indirectly, (3) for himself, (4) or as the representative or agent of others. It applies even if the director or officer is a mere guarantor, indorser or surety for someone else’s loan or is in any manner an obligor for money borrowed from the bank or loaned by it. Directors, officers, stockholders, and their related interests cannot be allowed to interpose the fraudulent nature of the loan as a defense to escape culpability for their circumvention of the law.234 128. What are the legal effects of non-compliance with the DOSRI rules and regulations? After due notice to the board of directors of the bank, the office of any bank director or officer who violates the DOSRI rules and 235Soriano v. People of the Philippines, et al., G.R. No. 162336, February 1, 2010. VI. BANKING 149 regulations may be declared vacant and the director or officer shall be subject to the penal provisions of the New Central Bank Act.238 129. What is the nature of the loan that does not comply with the rules on DOSRI and/or Single Borrower’s limit? Loans, assuming that they were of a DOSRI nature or without the benefit of the required approvals or in excess of the Single Borrower’s Limit, would not be void for those reasons. Instead, the banks or the officers responsible for the approval and grant of DOSRI loan would be subject only to the sanctions under the law.237 In other words, the loan transaction is valid but without prejudice to criminal prosecution against the erring DOSRI. iv. Foreclosure of mortgage by banks 130. What are the three different kinds of sale relating to the property of the debtor/mortgagor? There are three different kinds of sale under the law, namely: an ordinary execution sale, a judicial foreclosure sale, and an extrajudicial foreclosure sale. An ordinary execution sale is governed by the pertinent provisions of Rule 39 of the Rules of Court. Rule 68 of the Rules of Court applies in case of judicial foreclosure. On the other hand, Act No. 3135, as amended by Act No. 4118, known as “An Act to Regulate the Sale of Property under Special Powers Inserted in or Annexed to Real Estate Mortgages” applies in case of extrajudicial foreclosure sale. A different set of law applies to each class of sale mentioned.238 131. What is the right of redemption in relation to mortgage? The right of redemption in relation to mortgage is the prerogative of the mortgagor to reacquire the mortgaged property after foreclosure sale conditioned on the payment of the redemption price within the period set by law. This right exists only in case of extra-judicial foreclosure of real estate mortgage under Act No. 3135, as amended.239 J9JC9B0M “Ibid. “’Republic v. Sandiganbayan, G.R. No. 166859, April 12, 2011. “Quano v. Court of Appeals, 398 SCRA 405. “Huerta Alba Resort v. Court of Appeals, 339 SCRA 534. J9JC9B0M 1 150 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II There is no right of redemption in judicial foreclosure of real estate mortgage. The only right available is equity of redemption, which means the right of the mortgagor not to be divested of the ownership of the real property by paying the mortgage debt, as fixed by the court, within a period of not less than 90 nor more than 120 days from entry of judgment. It is only when there is default of such payment that the property shall be sold at auction to satisfy the judgment. Thereafter, there will be a judicial confirmation of the sale. After confirmation of the sale, the purchaser shall be entitled to possession of the property.210 Even after the lapse of the 90- to 120day period, the mortgagor can still exercise his equity of redemption so long as there is no confirmation of the sale yet. If the mortgagee, however, is a bank, the mortgagor, on top of equit}' of redemption, has one (1) year to redeem the property within one (1) year from registration of the order confirming the sale of the real property.211 This is based on Section 3 of Rule 68 which provides for a period of redemption when allowed by law. Section 47 of the GBL, in turn, provides that in the event of foreclosure, whether judicially or extrajudicially, of any mortgage on real estate which is security for any loan or credit accommodation, the mortgagor has on year to redeem the property. 132. How much is the redemption price if the mortgagee is a bank? In the event of foreclosure of mortgage on real estate, the mortgagor shall have the right to redeem the property by paying the amount due under the mortgage deed, with interest thereon at the rate specified in the mortgage, and all the costs and expenses incurred by the bank from the sale and custody of said property less any income derived therefrom.212 Accommodation mortgagors, however, may be allowed to redeem their mortgaged property by paying only the winning bid price thereof (plus interest thereon) at the public auction sale.213 210Section 2, Rule 68. ’“Section 3, Rule 68 in relation to Section 47, GBL. ’“Section 47, GBL. 2,3Belo v. Philippine National Bank, 353 SCRA 359. a VI. BANKING 151 133. State the rules on the period to exercise the right of redemption of natural and juridical persons after the bank's foreclosure of real estate mortgage on their properties. The rules are as follows: a. Generally, the period of redemption is one (1) year from registration of the certificate of foreclosure sale. b. However, the period to redeem real property is reduced to three (3) months after foreclosure or the registration of the certificate of foreclosure sale, whichever comes earlier, if the following elements are present: i. The mortgagor is a juridical person; ii. The mode of foreclosure is extra-judicial, under Act No. 3135, as amended; and, iii. The mortgagee is a bank.244 The redemption period may thus be terminated even the day following the foreclosure sale if the sale is registered. Nevertheless, if the sale is not registered, the period to redeem shall expire three (3) months after foreclosure, ipso facto. c. The period to redeem real property after extra-judicial foreclosure is one (1) year from date of the sale in the following cases: i. The mortgagor is a natural person; and/or ii. The mortgagee is not a bank; and/or iii. The mode of foreclosure is judicial; provided that the mortgagee is a bank. The date of the sale has been construed to mean, however, the date of registration of the sale.246 Therefore, unless the foreclosure sale is registered in any of the foregoing cases, the period to redeem shall not start to run. d. As previously stated, in judicial foreclosure of real estate mortgage when the mortgagee is a bank, the applicable 244Section 47, GBL. 245Development Bank of the Phil. v. Gagarin, 565 SCRA 545; Heirs of Estelita Burgos-Lipat v. Heirs of Eugenio Trinidad, et al., G.R. No. 185644, March 2, 2010. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M > 152 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II redemption period is one (1) year. This should be reckoned not from the sale but from the issuance of the order confirming the sale, given the requirement under Rule 68 for the confirmation of the sale. 134. ABC Corporation obtained a loan from XYZ Bank. The loan is secured by real estate mortgage on the property of ABC Corporation. The appraised value of the property is not sufficient to secure the loan of ABC. Thus, its President, acting as accommodation mortgagor, also mortgaged his house and lot to fully secure the loan obligation of ABC. Unfortunately, ABC Corporation experienced financial difficulties and failed to settle the loan. XYZ Bank eventually foreclosed the mortgages on the real estate of ABC and its President, in accordance with Act No. 3135, as amended. Four (4) months after the foreclosure sale, both ABC and its President want to redeem their respective properties. Do ABC and its President have the right of redemption? ABC Corporation has lost its right to redeem the property because its period of redemption has expired. Under Section 47 of the GBL, the period to redeem has been reduced to three (3) months from date of foreclosure sale or registration of the certificate of foreclosure sale, if the following elements are present: a) the mortgagor is a juridical person; b) the mortgagee is a bank; and c) the mode of foreclosure is extra-judicial. All elements are present in this case. However, the President of ABC Corporation may still redeem the property. The GBL retained the one-year period to redeem the property if the mortgagor is a natural person. 135. Grandwood Furniture & Woodwork (Grandwood) obtained a loan from Metropolitan Bank and Trust Company (Metrobank). The loan was secured by a real estate mortgage. Metrobank later sold its rights and interests over the loan and mortgage contract to Asia Recovery Corporation (ARC). The loan was subsequently assigned to Cameron Granville 3 Asset Management (CGAM3). CGAM3 extrajudicially foreclosed the real estate mortgage with White Marketing Development (White Marketing) as the highest bidder. White Marketing was informed that Grandwood wanted to redeem the property. VI. BANKING 153 What is the applicable redemption period? The applicable redemption period is the reduced redemption period under Section 47 of the GBL. White Marketing stepped into the shoes of Metrobank by virtue of the assignment of credit. A contracting party’s assignees, although seemingly a third party to the transaction, remain bound by the original party’s transaction under the relativity principle because of the concept of subrogation, which inheres in assignment. In an assignment of credit, the assignee acquires the power to enforce it to the same extent as the assignor could have enforced it against the debtor. Through the assignment of credit, the new creditor is entitled to the rights and remedies available to the previous creditor and includes accessory rights such as mortgage and pledge. Consequently, ARC acquired all the rights, benefits and obligations of Metrobank under its mortgage contract with Grandwood. The same could be said for subsequent assignees or successors-in-interest after ARC like White Marketing. And due to the subrogation of White Marketing to the rights of Metrobank, White Marketing is entitled to the shorter redemption period under Section 47 of the General Banking Law. 136. Is Section 47 of the GBL (which provided for different redemption periods for natural and juridical persons) not violative of the equal protection clause under the Philippine Constitution? Section 47 of the GBL does not infringe on the equal protection clause nor discriminate mortgagors/property owners who are juridical persons. One class may be treated differently from another where the groupings are based on reasonable and real distinctions. The difference in the treatment of juridical persons and natural persons was based on the nature of the properties foreclosed, whether these are used as residence, for which the more liberal one-year redemption period is retained, or used for industrial or commercial purposes, in which case a shorter term is deemed necessary to reduce the period of uncertainty in the ownership of property and enable mortgagee-banks to dispose sooner of these acquired assets. In this context, the amendment introduced by Section 47 embodied one of such safe and sound practices aimed at ensuring the solvency and liquidity of our banks. It cannot therefore be disputed that the said provision amending the redemption period in Act No. 3135 was based on a reasonable classification and germane to the purpose of the law. This legitimate public interest pursued by the legislature J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 154 further enfeebles petitioner's impairment of contract theory. The right of redemption being statutory, it must be exercised in the manner prescribed by the statute, and within the prescribed time limit, to make it effective. Furthermore, as with other individual rights to contract and to property, it has to give way to police power exercised for public welfare.-’*6 137. May a bank engage in insurance business? A bank shall not directly engage in insurance business as the insurer.247 The bank may, however, issue a standby letter of credit to secure performance of an obligation under the primary contract which gave rise to the letter of credit.248 A bank may also organize a subsidiary to engage in insurance business and cross-sell to its clients the insurance products of its subsidiary. 138. What are the prohibited transactions under the General Banking Law? The following are the prohibited transactions under the General Banking Law: a. No director, officer, employee, or agent of any bank shall:249 i. Make false entries in any bank report or statement or participate in any fraudulent transaction, thereby affecting the financial interest of, or causing damage to, the bank or any person; Banks are entities engaged in the lending of funds obtained through deposits from the public and it is for this reason that their viability depends largely on their ability to return those deposits on demand. In this case, when the borrower is proven to have committed fraud by altering and falsifying its financial statements in order to obtain its credit facilities, the bank has the right to annul any credit accommodation or loan, and demand the immediate payment thereof.250 24GGolden Way Merchandising v. Equitable PCI Bank, G.R. No. 195540, March 13,2013. 247Section 54, GBL. ™Supra. 249Section 55.1, GBL. 250Banco de Oro-EPCI, Inc. JAPRL Development Corporation, G.R. No. 179901, April 14, 2008. 1 J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING ii. 155 Without order of a court of competent jurisdiction, disclose to any unauthorized person any information relative to the funds or properties in the custody of the bank belonging to private individuals, corporations, or any other entity: Provided, that with respect to bank deposits, the provisions of existing laws shall prevail; Funds received by the bank for safekeeping are not deposits and as such, are not covered by R.A. No. 1405,“' but they cannot be disclosed under the foregoing rule. Similarly, monies and properties inside the safety deposit box cannot be disclosed without the consent of the depositor. Without the ruling in Ejercito v. Sandiganbayan.,252 trust funds, not being deposits, would have been confidential under this provision. But because the Supreme Court considered trust funds as deposits, it is submitted that the cases where deposits may be disclosed under R.A. No. 1405 now apply to trust funds. Trust funds, even though considered deposits in the context of R.A. No. 1405 are not insured with PDIC.253 . iii. Accept gifts, fees, or commissions or any other form of remuneration in connection with the approval of a loan or other credit accommodation from said bank; iv. Overvalue or aid in overvaluing any security for the purpose of influencing in any way the actions of the bank or any bank; or v. Outsource inherent banking functions. This means that security, messengerial and utility services may be outsourced because they are not inherent banking functions. b. On the other hand, no borrower of a bank shall:254 i. Fraudulently overvalue property offered as security for a loan or other credit accommodation from the bank; a'Supra. a2Supra. wInfra. “‘Section 55.2, GBL. J9JC9B0M 1 01V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 156 ii. Furnish false or make misrepresentation or suppression of material facts for the purpose of obtaining, renewing, or increasing a loan or other credit accommodation or extending the period thereof; iii. Attempt to defraud the said bank in the event of a court action to recover a loan or other credit accommodation; or iv. Offer any director, officer, employee or agent of a bank any gift, fee, commission, or any other form of compensation in order to influence such persons into approving a loan or other credit accommodation application. Consistent with the provisions of R.A. No. 1405, otherwise known as the Bank Secrecy Law, no bank shall employ casual or non-regular personnel or too lengthy probationary personnel in the conduct of its business involving bank deposits.265 No bank should conduct business in an unsafe and unsound manner. In determining whether a particular act or omission, which is not otherwise prohibited by any law, rule or regulation affecting banks, quasi-banks, or trust entities, may be deemed as conducting business in an unsafe or unsound manner for purposes of Section 56 of the General Banking Law, the Monetary Board shall consider any of the following circumstances:256 a. The act or omission has resulted or may result in material loss or damage, or abnormal risk or danger to the safety, stability, liquidity or solvency of the institution; b. The act or omission has resulted or may result in material loss or damage or abnormal risk to the institution’s depositors, creditors, investors, stockholders or to the Bangko Sentral or to the public in general; c. The act or omission has caused any undue injury, or has given any unwarranted benefits, advantage or preference to the bank or any party in the discharge by the director or officer of his duties and responsibilities through manifest partiality, evident bad faith or gross inexcusable negligence; or “‘Section 55.4, GBL. 256Section 56, GBL. VI. BANKING d. ir>7 The act or omission involves entering into any contract or transaction manifestly and grossly disadvantageous to the bank, quasi-bank or trust entity, whether or not the director or officer profited or will profit thereby. Whenever a bank, quasi-bank or trust entity persists in conducting its business in an unsafe or unsound manner, the Monetary Board may, without prejudice to the administrative sanctions provided in Section 37 of the New Central Bank Act, take action under Section 30 of the same Act and/or immediately exclude the erring bank from clearing, the provisions of law to the contrary notwithstanding. v. Floating interest rate and escalation clause 139. State the rules on payment of interest for loans or forbearance of money, goods or credit (collectively, loan). J9JC9B0M a. Interest is the cost of borrowing money. Interest is generally a matter of agreement and therefore the parties are free to stipulate the terms thereof. b. The Usury Law capped the interest that can be imposed upon a loan. On March 17, 1980, the Usury Law was amended by Presidential Decree (P.D.) No. 1684, giving the Central Bank the authority to prescribe different maximum rates of interest which may be imposed for loans or renewal thereof. c. In the exercise of the authority granted to it, the Monetary Board issued CB Circular No. 905, Series of 1982, which removed the ceilings on interest rates on loans or forbearance of any money, goods or credits by declaring that such rates are no longer subject to any ceiling prescribed under or pursuant to the Usury Law, as amended. Under the current rules, therefore, the debtor and creditor may enter into a contract providing for any amount of interest.267 Note that CB Circular No. 905 did not repeal nor in anyway amend the Usury Law but simply suspended the latter’s effectivity. “’PNB v. Court of Appeals, 238 SCRA 20. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 158 d. Although there is no longer any cap on interest rates that the parties may stipulate on, excessive, iniquitous, unconscionable and exorbitant interest rates are still not allowed, for these are deemed contrary to morals, if not against law. Unconscionable interest rates are those which will either enslave their borrowers or lead to a hemorrhaging of their assets. Even if knowingly and voluntarily assumed, unconscio­ nable interest rates are void ab initio for being “contrary to morals, and the law.” e. There is no hard and fast rule in determining whether the rate of interest is unconscionable. Each case must be decided based its own peculiar circumstances. The rule of thumb is reasonability. In William C. Louh, Jr. and Irene L. Louh v. Bank of the Philippine Islands,251 it was held that the finance charges of 3.35% interest per month and 6% penalty per month were excessive. In Leticia Medel v. Court of Appeals,259 the Supreme Court, while conceding that the Usury Law was legally inexistent with the issuance of CB Circular 905, and that interest could be charged as lender and borrower may agree upon, nevertheless found the stipulated interest iniquitous, unconscionable, and contrary to morals. Thus, the court annulled a stipulated 5.5% per month or 66% per annum interest on a P500,000.00 loan and a 6% per month or 72% per annum interest on a P60,000.00 loan, for being excessive, iniquitous, unconscionable and exorbitant. In Ching v. Niedao,™ the Supreme Court categorically ruled that estoppel cannot give validity to an act that is prohibited by law or one that is against public policy. Hence, even if the payment of interest has been reduced in writing, a 6% monthly interest rate on a loan is unconscionable, regardless of who between the parties proposed the rate.261 ““G.R. No. 225562, March 8, 2017. “9G.R. No. 131622, November 27,1998. “°G.R. No. 141181, April, 27,2007. “'See also De la Paz v. L& J Development Co., G.R. No. 183360, September 8, 2014. VI. BANKING 159 However, in Philippine Global Communications v. Vigil Investments,2112 the Supreme Court considered security deposit and rental payments as in the nature of forbearance of money and upheld astipulation that late payments for back rentals would bear interest of 3% per month (compounded every quarter) and an additional 3% per month as penalty or surcharge. For the security deposit, since there was no stipulation on the interest, the Court imposed the legal interest rate of 12% per annum from the time of judicial or extrajudicial demand of the rental fees until June 30, 2013, and 6% per annum from July 1, 2013 until fully paid. f. If the stipulation is void, the courts may reduce equitably liquidated damages, whether intended as an indemnity or a penalty if they are iniquitous or unconscionable. This should mean the legal rate of 6% interest per annum, the default interest set by BSP if the parties agreed on payment of interest but silent as to rate. The unconscionable interest is set aside. But, a contract of loan, nevertheless assumes that the parties agreed on an interest rate. Thus, the legal rate should apply. 140. State the rules regarding an award of interest in the concept of actual and compensatory damages. In Lara’s Gifts & Decors, Inc. v. Midtown Industrial Sales, Inc. (G.R. No. 225433, August 28, 2019), the Supreme Court en banc clarified that the stipulated interest is the law between the parties, and should be applied until full payment of the obligation. This is in accordance with Article 2209 of the Civil Code which mandates that when a debtor incurs a delay in obligations to pay a sum of money, the indemnity for damages shall be the payment of the interest agreed upon. Unless the stipulated interest is excessive and unconscionable, there is no legal basis for the reduction of the stipulated interest at any time until full payment of the principal amount. The stipulated interest remains in force until the obligation is satisfied. In the absence of stipulated interest, the prevailing legal interest prescribed by the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas shall apply. Thus, when the judgment of the court awarding a sum of money becomes final and executory, the stipulated interest, provided the same is not excessive and unconscionable, shall be applied until J9JC9B0M »G.R. No. 205348, September 19, 2018. J9JC9B0M 160 D1V1NAON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II full payment of the obligation because that is the law between the parties. The Supreme Court thus modified the guidelines on the imposition of interest in Eastern Shipping Lines, Inc. v. Court of Appeals■ and Aocar t>. Callery Frames,as follows: \\ ith regard to an award of interest in the concept of actual and compensatory damages, the rate of interest, as well as the accrual thereof, is imposed as follows: a. b. When the obligation is breached, and it consists in the payment of a sum of money, i.e., a loan or forbearance of money, goods, credits or judgments, the interest due shall be that which is stipulated by the parties in writing, provided it is not excessive and unconscionable, which, in the absence of a stipulated reckoning date, shall be computed from default, i.e., from extrajudicial or judicial demand in accordance with Article 1169 of the Civil Code, UNTIL FULL PAYMENT, without compounding any interest unless compounded interest is expressly stipulated by the parties, by law or regulation. Interest due on the principal amount accruing as of judicial demand shall SEPARATELY earn legal interest at the prevailing rate prescribed by the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, from the time of judicial demand UNTIL FULL PAYMENT. In the absence of stipulated interest, in a Ioan or forbearance of money, goods, credits or judgments, the rate of interest on the principal amount shall be the prevailing legal interest prescribed by the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, which shall be computed from default, i.e., from extrajudicial or judicial demand in accordance with Article 1169 of the Civil Code, UNTIL FULL PAYMENT, without compounding any interest unless compounded interest is expressly stipulated by law or regulation. Interest due on the principal amount accruing as of judicial demand shall SEPARATELY earn legal interest at the prevailing rate prescribed by the Bangko Sentral 2MG.R. No. 97412, July 12,1994, “1G.R. No. 189871, August 13, 2013. L VI. BANKING 161 ng Pilipinas, from the time of judicial demand UNTIL FULL PAYMENT. c. When the obligation, not constituting a loan or forbearance of money, goods, credits or judgments, is breached, an interest on the amount of damages awarded may be imposed in the discretion of the court at the prevailing legal interest prescribed by the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, pursuant to Articles 2210 and 2011 of the Civil Code. No interest, however, shall be adjudged on unliquidated claims or damages until the demand can be established with reasonable certainty. Accordingly, where the amount of the claim or damages is established with reasonable certainty, the prevailing legal interest shall begin to run from the time the claim is made extrajudicially or judicially (Article 1169, Civil Code) UNTIL FULL PAYMENT, but when such certainty cannot be so reasonably established at the time the demand is made, the interest shall begin to run only from the date of the judgment of the trial court (at which time the quantification of damages may be deemed to have been reasonably ascertained) UNTIL FULL PAYMENT. The actual base for the computation of the interest shall, in any case, be on the principal amount finally adjudged, without compounding any interest unless compounded interest is expressly stipulated by law or regulation. 141. What is an escalation clause in a loan agreement? Is it a valid stipulation? An escalation clause refers to the stipulation allowing increases in the interest rates agreed upon by the contracting parties. Such stipulation shall be valid provide that there should be a corresponding de-escalation clause that authorizes a reduction in the interest rates corresponding to downward changes made by law or by the Monetary Board. The escalation clause should specifically provide: (1) that there can be an increase in interest rates if allowed by law or by the Monetary Board; and (2) that there must be a stipulation for the reduction of the stipulated interest rates in the event that the applicable maximum rates of interest are reduced by law or by the Monetary Board. The latter stipulation ensures the mutuality of contracts. The purpose of the law in mandating the inclusion of a deescalation clause is to prevent one-sidedness in favor of the lender J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 162 which is considered repugnant to the principle of mutuality of contracts. A de-escalation clause is an indispensable requisite to the validity and enforceability of an escalation clause in the contract. In other words, in the absence of a corresponding de-escalation clause, the escalation clause shall be considered null and void. However, the absence of a de-escalation clause in the loan agreement would not invalidate the repricing of the interest rates, if in actuality, the lender did reduce the interest on certain repricing dates. Such actual reduction or downward adjustment by the lender bank eliminated any one-sidedness of its contracts with the borrower.-"*5 142. What interest rate should be imposed on a loan transaction if the stipulated interest rate is judicially determined to be excessive or unconscionable? The legal rate of interest shall be applied if the stipulated interest in a loan transaction is judicially determined to be excessive br unconscionable. Under BSP Circular 799, dated July 1, 2013, such legal rate of interest is 6% per annum. g. Penalties for violations i. Fine, imprisonment ii. Suspension or removal of director or officer iii. Dissolution of banks 143. What is the penalty for violation of any of the provisions of the General Banking Law? Unless otherwise provided by law, the violation of any of the provisions of the General Banking Law shall be subject to Sections 34, 35, 36, and 37 of the New Central Bank Act.260 If the offender is a director, officer of a bank, quasi-bank or trust entity, the Monetary Board may also suspend or remove such director or officer. If the violation is committed by a corporation, •‘“Villa Crista Monte Realty & Development Corp. v. Equitable PCI Bank, G.R. No. 208336, November 21,2018. 2UiSee discussion on the Central Bank Act, supra. 163 VI. BANKING such corporation may be dissolved by quo warranto proceedings instituted by the Solicitor General.2117 ANTI-MONEY amended) a. LAUNDERING LAW (R.A. No. 9160, as Policy of the law 144. What is the declared laundering? State policy regarding anti-money It is the declared policy of the State to protect and preserve the integrity and confidentiality of bank accounts and to ensure that the Philippines shall not be used as a money laundering site for the proceeds of any unlawful activity. Consistent with its foreign policy, the State shall extend cooperation in transnational investigations and prosecutions of persons involved in money laundering activities wherever committed, as well as in the implementation of targeted financial sanctions related to the financing of the proliferation of weapons of mass destruction, terrorism, and financing of terrorism, pursuant to the resolutions of the United Nations Security Council.268 b. Covered institutions/persons and their obligations 145. Who are the covered institutions/persons under the Anti­ Money Laundering law? J9JC9B0M “Covered institutions” refer to: (1) Banks, non-banks, quasi-banks, trust entities, and all other institutions and their subsidiaries and affiliates supervised or regulated by the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas (BSP); (2) Insurance companies and all other institutions supervised or regulated by the Insurance Commission; and (3) (i) Securities dealers, brokers, salesmen, investment houses and other similar entities managing securities or rendering services as investment agent, advisor, or consultant; (ii) mutual funds, closed-end investment companies, common trust funds, pre-need companies and other similar entities; (iii) foreign exchange corporations, 267Section 66, GBL. 26fiSection 2, R.A. No. 9160, as amended by R.A. No. 11521. J9JC9B0M 164 P1VINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II money changers, money payment, remittance, and transter companies and other similar entities; and (iv) other entities administering or otherwise dealing in currency, commodities or financial derivatives based thereon, valuable objects, cash substitutes and other similar monetary instruments or property supervised or regulated by Securities and Exchange Commission. (4) Jewehj dealers in precious metals, who, as a business, trade in precious metals, for transactions in excess of one million pesos (Pl,000,000.00); (5) Jewelry dealers in precious stones, who, as a business, trade in precious stones, for transactions in excess of one million pesos (Pl,000,000.00); (6) Company service providers which, as a business, provide any of the following services to third parties: (i) acting as a formation agent of juridical persons; (ii) acting as (or arranging for another person to act as) a director or corporate secretary of a company, a partner of a partnership, or a similar position in relation to other juridical persons; (iii) providing a registered office, business address or accommodation, correspondence or administrative address for a company, a partnership or any other legal person or arrangement; and (iv) acting as (or arranging for another person to act as) a nominee shareholder for another person; and (7) Persons who provide any of the following services: (i) managing of client money, securities or other assets; (ii) management of bank, savings or securities accounts; (iii) organization of contributions for the creation, operation or management of companies; and (iv) creation, operation or management of juridical persons or arrangements, and buying and selling business entities.269 Notwithstanding the foregoing, the term ‘covered persons shall exclude lawyers and accountants acting as independent legal professionals in relation to information concerning their clients or Section 3(a), R.A. No. 9160, as amended. VI. BANKING 165 where disclosure of information would compromise client confidences or the attorney-client relationship: Provided, that these lawyers and accountants are authorized to practice in the Philippines and shall continue to be subject to the provisions of their respective codes of conduct and/or professional responsibility or any of its amendments.270 (8) Casinos, including internet and ship-based casinos, with respect to their casino cash transactions related to their gaming operations;271 (9) Real estate developers and brokers; (10) Offshore gaming operators, as well as their: service providers, supervised, accredited or regulated by the Philippine Amusement and Gaming Corporation (PAGCOR) or any government agency.272 146, What are the obligations of covered institutions/persons? The obligations of covered institutions/persons under AMLA are as follows: a. Customer identification Covered institutions shall establish and record the true identity of its clients based on official documents. They shall maintain a system of verifying the true identity of their clients and, in case of corporate clients, require a system of verifying their legal existence and organizational structure, as well as the authority and identification of all persons purporting to act on their behalf. The provisions of existing laws to the contrary notwithstanding, anonymous accounts, accounts under fictitious names, and all other similar accounts shall be absolutely prohibited. Peso and foreign currency non-checking numbered accounts shall be allowed.273 b. Record keeping All records of all transactions of covered institutions shall be maintained and safely stored for five (5) years from the dates J9JC9B0M ™Supra. 271Section 1(a)(8), R.A. No. 9160, as amended by R.A. No. 10927. 272Section 3(a), R.A. No. 9160, as further amended by R.A. No. 11521. 273Section 9(a), R.A. No. 9160. J9JC9B0M niVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 166 of transactions. With respect to closed accounts, the records on customer identification, account files and business correspondence, shall be preserved and safely stored for at least five (5) years from the dates when they were closed.274 C. Reporting of covered and suspicious transactions Covered institutions shall report to the AMLC all covered transactions within five (5) working days from occurrence thereof, unless the Supendsing Authority concerned prescribes a longer period not exceeding ten (10) working days.276 147. Under the Anti-Money Laundering Law, a covered institution is required to maintain a system of verifying the true identity of their clients as well as persons purporting to act on behalf of a. those doing business with such clients. b. unknown principals. c. the covered institution. d. such clients. 148. The Anti-Money Laundering Law is a law that seeks to prevent money laundering activities by providing for more transparency in the Philippine Financial System, hence the following institutions are covered by the law, except:276 a. bank and any financial institutions; b. pawnshops; casino operators; d. AU of the above. NB Casino operators were made covered institution in July 2017 under R.A. No. 10927. 27'Section 9(b), ibid. ’’‘Section 9(c), ibid. 276BAR 2012. VI. BANKING c. 167 Covered and suspicious transactions 149. What is a Covered Transaction? “Covered Transaction” is a transaction in cash or other equivalent monetary instrument involving a total amount in excess offive hundred thousand pesos (P500,000.00) within one (1) banking day; for covered persons under Section 3(a)(8), a single casino cash transaction involving an amount in excess of five million pesos (P5,000,000.00) or its equivalent in any other currency.277 For covered persons under Section 3(a)(9),278 a single cash transaction involving an amount in excess of seven million five hundred thousand pesos (P7,500,000.00) or its equivalent in any other currency.279 150. What are Suspicious Transactions? “Suspicious transactions” are transactions with covered persons, regardless of the amounts involved, where any of the following circumstances exist: J9JC9B0M a. There is no underlying legal or trade obligation, purpose or economic justification; b. The client is not properly identified; c. The amount involved is not commensurate with the business or financial capacity of the client; d. Taking into account all known circumstances, it may be perceived that the client’s transaction is structured in order to avoid being the subject of reporting requirements under the Act; e. Any circumstance relating to the transaction which is observed to deviate from the profile of the client and/or the client’s past transactions with the covered person; f. The transaction is in any way related to an unlawful activity or offense under the Act that is about to be, is being or has been committed; or ^’Section 2 3 (b), R.A. No. 9160, as amended by R.A. No. 10927. 27“Real estate developers and brokers. 279Section 3(b), R.A. No. 9160, as amended further by R.A. No. 11521. J9JC9B0M 1 168 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL I .AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II g- Any transaction that is similar or analogous to any of the foregoing.2" 151. What is the distinction between a "covered transaction report" and a "suspicious transaction report"?281 A covered transaction report involves transaction/s in cash or other equivalent monetary instrument involving generally a total amount in excess of P500,000.00 within one (1) banking day, while suspicion transaction report involves transactions with covered institutions regardless of the amounts involved made under any of the suspicious circumstances enumerated by law. d. Money laundering-how committed and unlawful activities 152. When is money laundering committed? Money laundering is a crime whereby the proceeds of an unlawful activity are transacted thereby making them appear to have originated from legitimate sources. It is committed by the following: Money laundering is committed by any person who, knowing that any monetary instrument or property represents, involves, or relates to the proceeds of any unlawful activity: a. Transacts said monetary instrument or property; b. Converts, transfers, disposes of, moves, acquires, possesses or uses said monetary instrument or property; c. Conceals or disguises the true nature, source, location, disposition, movement or ownership of or rights with respect to said monetary instrument or property; d. Attempts or conspires to commit money laundering offenses referred to in paragraphs (a), (b) or (c); e. Aids, abets, assists in or counsels the commission of the money laundering offenses referred to in paragraphs (a), (b) or (c) above; and “““Section 3(b.l), RA No. 9160, as amended by R.A. No. 11521. “‘BAR 2015. 169 VI. BANKING f. Performs or fails to perform any act as a result of which he facilitates the offense of money laundering referred to in paragraphs (a), (b) or (c) above. Money laundering is also committed by any covered person who, knowing that a covered or suspicious transaction is required under this Act to be reported to the Anti-Money Laundering Council (AMLC), fails to do so.282 153. What are the predicate Laundering law? crimes under the Anti-Money Save for the omission to report covered and suspicious transactions, a money laundering offense, by definition, assumes the commission of an unlawful activity. For instance, kidnapping is an unlawful activity. If the kidnapper deposits the ransom money with a bank, another offense is committed—money laundering. There is money laundering because the proceeds of the unlawful activity were transacted to make it appear that they originated from lawful sources. To constitute money laundering, however, the predicate crime must be based on any of the unlawful activities enumerated by law. Unlawful activity, as defined by AMLA, refers to any act or omission or series or combination thereof involving or having direct relation to the following: J9JC9B0M 1. Kidnapping for ransom under Article 267 of Act No. 3815, otherwise known as the Revised Penal Code, as amended; 2. Sections 4, 5, 6, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, and 16 of R.A. No. 9165, otherwise known as the Comprehensive Dangerous Drugs Act of 2002; 3. Section 3 paragraphs B, C, E, G, H and I of R.A. No. 3019, as amended, otherwise known as the Anti-Graft and Corrupt Practices Act; 4. Plunder under R.A. No. 7080, as amended; 5. Robbery and extortion under Articles 294, 295, 296, 299, 300, 301 and 302 of the Revised Penal Code, as amended; “Section 4, R.A. No. 9160, as amended by R.A. No. 10365. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL I .AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 170 6. Jueteng and masiao punished as illegal gambling under P.D. No. 1602; 7. Piracy on the high seas under the Revised Penal Code, as amended and P.D. No. 532; 8. Qualified theft under Article 310 of the Revised Penal Code, as amended; 9. Swindling under Article 315 and Other Forms of Swindling under Article 316 of the Revised Penal Code, as amended; 10. Smuggling under R.A. Nos. 455 and 1937; 11. Violations of R.A. No. 8792, otherwise known as the Electronic Commerce Act of 2000; 12. Hijacking and other violations under R.A. No. 6235; destructive arson and murder, as defined under the Revised Penal Code, as amended; 13. Terrorism and conspiracy to commit terrorism as defined and penalized under Sections 3 and 4 of R.A. No. 9372; 14. Financing of terrorism under Section 4 and offenses punishable under Sections 5, 6, 7 and 8 of R.A. No. 10168, otherwise known as the Terrorism Financing Prevention and Suppression Act of 2012; 15. Bribery under Articles 210, 211 and 211-A of the Revised Penal Code, as amended, and Corruption of Public Officers under Article 212 of the Revised Penal Code, as amended; 16. Frauds and Illegal Exactions and Transactions under Articles 213, 214, 215 and 216 of the Revised Penal Code, as amended; 17. Malversation of Public Funds and Property under Articles 217 and 222 of the Revised Penal Code, as amended; 18. Forgeries and Counterfeiting under Articles 163,166,167, 168, 169 and 176 of the Revised Penal Code, as amended; 19. Violations of Sections 4 to 6 of Republic Act No. 9208, otherwise known as the Anti-Trafficking in Persons Act of 2003; 20. Violations of Sections 78 to 79 of Chapter IV, of P.D. No. 705, otherwise known as the Revised Forestry Code of the Philippines, as amended; J9JC9B0M VI. BANKING 171 21. Violations of Sections 86 to 106 of Chapter VI, of R.A. No. 8550, otherwise known as the Philippine Fisheries Code of 1998; 22. Violations of Sections 101 to 107, and 110 of R.A. No. 7942, otherwise known as the Philippine Mining Act of 1995; 23. Violations of Section 27(c), (e), (f), (g) and (i), of R.A. No. 9147, otherwise known as the Wildlife Resources Conservation and Protection Act; 24. Violation of Section 7(b) of R.A. No. 9072, otherwise known as the National Caves and Cave Resources Management Protection Act; 25. Violation of R.A. No. 6539, otherwise known as the Anti­ Carnapping Act of 2002, as amended; 26. Violations of Sections 1, 3 and 5 of P.D. amended, otherwise known as the decree Laws on Illegal/Unlawful Possession, Dealing In, Acquisition or Disposition Ammunition or Explosives; 27. Violation of P.D. No. 1612, otherwise known as the Anti­ Fencing Law; 28. Violation of Section 6 of R.A. No. 8042, otherwise known as the Migrant Workers and Overseas Filipinos Act of 1995, as amended by R.A. No. 10022; 29. Violation of R.A. No. 8293, otherwise known as the Intellectual Property Code of the Philippines; 30. Violation of Section 4 of R.A. No. 9995, otherwise known as the Anti-Photo and Video Voyeurism Act of 2009; 31. Violation of Section 4 of R.A. No. 9775, otherwise known as the Anti-Child Pornography Act of 2009; 32. Violations of Sections 5, 7, 8, 9, 10(c), (d) and (e), 11, 12 and 14 of R.A. No. 7610, otherwise known as the Special Protection of Children Against Abuse, Exploitation and Discrimination; 33. Fraudulent practices and other violations under R.A. No. 8799, otherwise known as ‘The Securities Regulation Code of 2000’; No. 1866, as Codifying the Manufacture, of Firearms, J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 172 34. Violation of Section 19 (a)(3) of R.A. No. 10697, otherwise known as the ’Strategic Trade Management Act’, in relation to the proliferation of weapons of mass destruction and its financing pursuant to United Nations Security Council Resolution Numbers 1718 of 2006 and 2231 of 2015"; 35. Violations of Section 254 of Chapter II, Title X of the National Internal Revenue Code of 1997, as amended, where the deficiency basic tax due in the final assessment is in excess of twenty-five million pesos (P25,000,000.00) per taxable year, for each tax type covered and there has been a finding of probable cause by the competent authority: Provided, further, that there must be a finding of fraud, willful misrepresentation or malicious intent on the part of the taxpayer; Provided, finally, that in no case shall the AMLC institute forfeiture proceedings to recover monetary instruments, property or proceeds representing, involving, or relating to a tax crime, if the same has already been recovered or collected by the Bureau of Internal Revenue (BIR) in a separate proceeding; and 36. Felonies and offenses of a similar nature that are punishable under the penal laws of other countries.283 154. Flora, a frequent traveler, found a purse concealed between the cushions of a large sofa inside the VIP lounge in NAIA while she was waiting for her flight to be called. Inside the purse was a very valuable diamond-studded necklace. She decided not to turn over the purse to the airport management, and instead to keep it. On her return from her travels, she had a dependable jeweler appraise the necklace, and the latter told her that the necklace was easily worth at least P5,000,000.00 in the open market. To test the appraisal, she pawned the necklace for P2.000,000.00. She then deposited the entire amount in her checking account with Metro Bank. Promptly, Metro Bank reported the transaction to the Anti-Money Laundering Council (AMLC). 11521. -“Section 7(1), R.A. No. 9160, as amended by R.A. No. 10365 and R.A. No. VI. HANKING 173 Given that her appropriation of the necklace was theft, may Flora be successfully prosecuted for money laundering? Explain briefly your answer.™ Flora may not be prosecuted for money laundering. Money laundering is a crime whereby the proceeds of an unlawful activity are transacted making it appear that they originated from legitimate sources. One of the ways of committing money laundering is if a person knows the cash relates to unlawful activity and transacts it. Under the rules implementing the Anti-Money Laundering law, however, only qualified theft (not simple theft) is considered an unlawful activity. In the case presented, the theft committed by Flora did not become qualified because it was not committed with grave abuse of discretion. e. Functions of the AMLC 155. What is the principal government agency tasked to implement the anti-money laundering laws? The government body tasked to carry out the implementation of the Anti-Money Laundering law is the Anti-Money Laundering Council. 156. What are the functions of the AMLC? The AMLC shall act unanimously in the discharge of its functions as defined hereunder: I 1. To require and receive covered transaction reports from covered institutions; 2. To issue orders addressed to the appropriate Supervising Authority or the covered institution to determine the true identity of the owner of any monetary instrument or property subject of a covered transaction report or request for assistance from a foreign State, or believed by the Council, on the basis of substantial evidence, to be, in whole or in part, wherever located, representing, involving, or related to, directly or indirectly, in any manner or by any means, the proceeds of an unlawful activity; “•BAR 2017. ! L J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 174 DIVINA ON ('OMMEHI’IAL LAW: A COMI’UEHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 3. To institute civil forfeiture proceedings and all other remedial proceedings through the Office of the Solicitor General: 4. To cause the filing of complaints with the Department of Justice or the Ombudsman for the prosecution of money laundering offenses; 5. To initiate investigations of covered transactions, money laundering activities and other violations of the Act; 6. To apply before the Court of Appeals, ex parte, for the freezing of any monetary instrument or property alleged to be laundered, proceeds from, or instrumentalities used in or intended for use in any unlawful activity as defined in Section 3(i) hereof; 7. To implement such measures as may be necessary and justified under the Act to counteract money laundering; 8. To receive and take action in respect of, any request from foreign states for assistance in their own anti-money laundering operations provided in the Act; 9. To develop educational programs on the pernicious effects of money laundering, the methods and techniques used in money laundering, the viable means of preventing money laundering and the effective ways of prosecuting and punishing offenders; 10. To enlist the assistance of any branch, department, bureau, office, agency or instrumentality of the government, including government-owned-and-controlled corporations, in undertaking any and all anti-money laundering operations, which may include the use of its personnel, facilities and resources for the more resolute prevention, detection and investigation of money laundering offenses and prosecution of offenders; 11. To impose administrative sanctions for the violation of laws, rules and regulations and orders and resolutions issued pursuant thereto; 12. To require the Land Registration Authority and all its Registries of Deeds to submit to the AMLC, reports on all real estate transactions involving an amount in excess of five hundred thousand pesos (P500,000.00) within 15 days from the date of registration of the transaction, in VI. BANKING 176 a form to be prescribed by the AMLC. The AMLC may also require the Land Registration Authority and all its Registries of Deeds to submit copies of relevant documents of all real estate transactions; 13. In the conduct of its investigation, the AMLC shall apply for the issuance of a search and seizure order with any competent court; 14. In the conduct of its investigation, the AMLC shall apply for the issuance of subpoena ad testificandum and/or subpoena duces tecum with any competent court; 15. To implement targeted financial sanctions in relation to proliferation of weapons of mass destruction and its financing, including ex parte freeze, without delay, against all funds and other assets that are owned and controlled, directly or indirectly, including funds and assets derived or generated therefrom, by individuals or entities designated and listed under United Nations Security Council Resolution Numbers 1718 of 2006 and 2231 of 2015 and their successor resolutions as well as any binding resolution of the Security Council; and 16. To preserve, manage or dispose assets pursuant to a freeze order, asset preservation order, or judgment of forfeiture: Provided, however, That pending their turnover to the national government, all expenses incurred in relation to the duties herein mentioned shall be deducted from the amount to be turned over to the national government.”285 f. Application for a freeze order 157. Does the Anti-Money Laundering Council have the authority to freeze deposits? Explain.285 No. The authority to freeze deposits is lodged with and based upon the order of the Court of Appeals.287 Similarly, the bank does not have the unilateral right to freeze the accounts of its clients on mere suspicion that the depositor does not have a right over them.288 J9JC9B0M “’Section 7, as amended. ’“BAR 2015. “’Section 10, R.A. No. 9160, as amended. “’Philippine Commercial Bank v. Balmaceda, September 12, 2011. J9JC9B0M 176 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 However, a bank has the authority to temporarily freeze the bank account of a deceased depositor under Section 97, R.A. No. 8424 or the Tax Reform Act of 1997. The second paragraph of Section 97 provides that, "If a bank has knowledge of the death of a person, who maintained a bank deposit account alone, or jointly with another, it shall not allow any withdrawal from the said deposit account.” The purpose of Section 97 is to ensure the payment of the estate taxes due on the transfer of the decedent’s bank deposits before they could be exhausted or withdrawn by his heirs or by any person who may have access to the said deposits. For the authority under the above-cited provision to take effect, the bank needs only two things: (1) a person is maintaining a bank deposit account; and (2) the bank has knowledge of the said person’s death. The authority applies with equal force to joint accounts even to a joint “and/or” account as the law did not make any distinction.289 It should be pointed out, however, that the TRAIN law has amended Section 97 of the Tax Code to allow any withdrawal from the deposit account of a deceased depositor but subject to a final withholding tax of 6%. For this purpose, all withdrawal slips shall contain a statement to the effect that all of the joint depositors are still living at the time of withdrawal by any one of the joint depositors and such statement shall be under oath by the said depositors. 158. Under what conditions may a freeze order be issued? Upon a verified ex parte petition by the AMLC and after determination that probable cause exists that any monetary instrument or property is in any way related to an unlawful activity as defined in Section 3(i) of the AMLA, the Court of Appeals may issue a freeze order. 159. What is the period of effectivity of the freeze order? The freeze order shall be effective immediately for a period of 20 days. Within the 20-day period, the Court of Appeals shall conduct a summary hearing, with notice to the parties, to determine whether or not to modify or lift the freeze order, or extend its ■'‘■'Allied Banking Corporation v. Elizabeth Sia, G.R. No. 195341, August 28, 2019. VI. BANKING 177 effectivity. The total period of the freeze order issued by the Court of Appeals under this provision shall not exceed six (6) months. This is without prejudice to an asset preservation order that the Regional Trial Court having jurisdiction over the appropriate anti­ money laundering case or civil forfeiture case may issue on the same account depending upon the circumstances of the case, where the Court of Appeals will remand the case and its records: Provided, that if there is no case filed against a person whose account has been frozen within the period determined by the Court of Appeals, not exceeding six (6) months, the freeze order shall be deemed ipso facto lifted; Provided further, that this new rule shail not apply to pending cases in the courts. In any case, the court should act on the petition to freeze within 24 hours from filing of the petition. If the application is filed a day before a non-working day, the computation of the 24-hour period shall exclude the non-working days. The freeze order or asset preservation order issued under the law shall be limited only to the amount of cash or monetary instrument or value of property that the court finds there is probable cause to be considered as proceeds of a predicate offense and the freeze order or asset preservation order shall not apply to amounts in the same account in excess of the amount or value of the proceeds of the predicate offense.290 WO. May the AMLC examine the bank accounts of the accused­ public officials even without seeking a prior court order? Explain.291 The AMLC cannot examine the bank accounts of the accused­ public officials without seeking a prior court order. Under the Anti­ Money Laundering law, the AMLC needs to obtain a bank inquiry order from the Court of Appeals to inquire into funds and deposits if there is probable cause they relate to unlawful activity under AMLA. Bank inquiry order is not necessary only if the predicate crime is any of hijacking, kidnapping, terrorism, murder, arson and violation of the Dangerous Drugs Law.292 Violation of the Anti-Graft and Corrupt Practices Act does not fall within the exception. J9JC9B0M ““Section 10, R.A. No. 9160, as amended by R.A. No. 10927. “‘BAR 2019. “‘Section 11, R.A. No. 9160, as amended. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 178 161. From his first term in 2007, Congressman Abner has been endorsing his pork barrel allocations to Twin Rivers in exchange for a commission of 40% of the face value of the allocation. Twin Rivers is a non-governmental organization whose supporting papers, after audit, were found by the Commission on Audit to be fictitious. Other than to prepare and submit falsified papers to support the encashment of the pork barrel checks, Twin Rivers does not appear to have done anything on the endorsed projects and Congressman Abner likewise does not appear to have bothered to monitor the progress of the projects he endorsed. The congressman converted most of the commissions he generated into US dollars, and deposited these in a foreign currency account with Banco de Plata (BDP). Based on amply-supported tips given by a congressman from another political party, the Anti-Money Laundering Council (AMLC) sent BDP an order: (1) to confirm Cong. Abner’s deposits with the bank and to provide details of these deposits; and (2) to hold all withdrawals and other transactions involving the congressman's bank accounts. As counsel for BDP, would you advise the bank to comply with the order?233 I shall advise BDP not to comply with the order of the AMLC. Without a bank inquiry order from a competent court, AMLC cannot inquire bank deposits, regardless of currency, unless there is probable cause that the predicate crime involved is hijacking, kidnapping for ransom, violations of the Dangerous Drugs act, hijacking or other violations of R.A. No. 6235, destructive arson, murder, or terrorism. Further, the AMLC cannot order BDP to hold all withdrawals and other transactions involving the accounts of Congressman Abner. The power to issue freeze order is lodged with the Court of Appeals which may issue it upon after AMLC establishes and the Court of Appeals independently determines that the account relates to unlawful activities under the AMLA. 162. Prosperous Bank is a domestic bank with head office in Makati. It handles the banking requirements of thousands of clients. The AMLC initiated a discreet investigation of the finan­ cial transactions of Lorenzo, a suspected drug trafficker based “BAR 2013. VI. BANKING 179 in Naga City. The intelligence group of the AMLC, in coordina­ tion with the counterpart group from the PDEA and the NBI, gathered ample evidence establishing Lorenzo's unlawful drug activities. The AMLC had probable cause that his deposits and investments in various banks, including Prosperous Bank, were related to money laundering. Accordingly, the AMLC now transmits to Prosperous Bank a formal demand to allow its agents to examine the banking transactions of Lorenzo, but Prosperous Bank refuses the demand. Is Prosperous answer.294 Bank’s refusal justified? Explain your Prospero’s refusal is not justified. Notwithstanding the provisions of R.A. No. 1405, R.A. No. 6426 and R.A. No. 8791, the AMLC may inquire into or examine any particular deposit or investment with any bank or non-bank financial institution if there is a probable cause that the deposits are related to unlawful activity under the Anti-Money Laundering Law, as in this case. Bank inquiry order from the court is not necessary since the predicate crime is a violation of the Dangerous Drugs Law.295 163. Through various acts of graft and bribery, Mayor Ycasiano accumulated a large amount of wealth which he converted into U.S. dollars and deposited in a Foreign Currency Deposit Unit (FCDU) account with the Yuen Bank (YB). On a tip given by the secretary of the mayor, the Anti-Money Laundering Council (AMLC) sent an order to YB to confirm the amount of U.S. dollars that Mayor Ycasiano had in his FCDU account. YB claims that, under the Foreign Currency Deposit Act (R.A. No. 6426, as amended), a written permission from the depositor is the only instance allowed for the examination of FCDU accounts. YB alleges that AMLC on its own cannot order a banking institution to reveal matters relating to bank accounts. Is the legal position of YB, in requiring written permission from the depositor, correct? Yes, the legal position of YB in requiring written permission from the depositor is correct. The AMLC cannot order the bank to J9JC9B0M “'BAR 2017. “'Section 11, R.A. No. 9160, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 180 inquire into the bank account of any depositor on mere suspicions of acts of graft and bribery without his written consent or a bank inquiry order issued by the competent court. 164. Is the authority of the AMLC to undertake an inquiry into certain bank accounts or deposits arbitrary and as such, unconstitutional? Taking into account Section 11 of the AMLA, the Court found nothing arbitrary in the allowance and authorization to AMLC to undertake an inquiry into certain bank accounts or deposits. Instead, the Court found that it provides safeguards before a bank inquiry order is issued, ensuring adherence to the general state policy of preserving the absolutely confidential nature of Philippine bank accounts: a. The AMLC is required to establish probable cause as basis for its ex-parte application for bank inquiry order; b. The CA, independent of the AMLC’s demonstration of probable, cause, itself makes a finding of probable cause that the deposits or investments are related to an unlawful activity under Section 3(i) or a money laundering offense under Section 4 of the AMLA; c. A bank inquiry court order ex-parte for related accounts is preceded by a bank inquiry court order ex-parte for the principal account which court order ex-parte for related accounts is separately based on probable cause that such related account is materially linked to the principal account inquired into; and the authority to inquire into or examine the main or principal account and the related accounts shall comply with the requirements of Article III, Sections 2 and 3 of the Constitution.290 g- Safe harbor provision 165. What is the meaning of the safe harbor provision under AMLA? No administrative, criminal, or civil proceedings shall lie against any person for having made a covered transaction or suspicious transaction report in the regular performance of his duties and in good faith, whether or not such reporting results in 2MSubido Pagente Certeza Mendoza and Binay Law Offices Appeals, G.R. No. 216914, En Banc, December 6, 2016. The Court of VI. BANKING 181 any criminal prosecution under the AMLA or any other Philippine law?' h. Forfeiture provisions 166. Other than obtaining bank inquiry order and freeze orders, what other remedy should the AMLC pursue if probable cause exists that any monetary instrument or property is related to an unlawful activity? Upon determination by the AMLC that probable cause exists that any monetary instrument or property is in any way related to an unlawful activity as defined in Section 3(i) or a money laundering offense under Section 4 hereof, the AMLC shall file with the appropriate court through the Office of the Solicitor General, a verified ex parte petition for forfeiture, and the Rules of Court on Civil Forfeiture shall apply. The forfeiture shall include those other monetary instrument or property having an equivalent value to that of the monetary instrument or property found to be related in any way to an unlawful activity or a money laundering offense, when with due diligence, the former cannot be located, or it has been substantially altered, destroyed, diminished in value or otherwise rendered worthless by any act or omission, or it has been concealed, removed, converted, or otherwise transferred, or it is located outside the Philippines or has been placed or brought outside the jurisdiction of the court, or it has been commingled with other monetary instrument or property belonging to either the offender himself or a third person or entity, thereby rendering the same difficult to identify or be segregated for purposes of forfeiture.298 The AMLC, if circumstances warrant, may initiate civil forfeiture proceedings to preserve the assets and to protect it from dissipation. No court shall issue a temporary restraining order or a writ of injunction against the freeze order, except the Court of Appeals or the Supreme Court.299 In the conduct of its investigation, the AMLC may also apply for the issuance of search and seizure order with any competent court.300 J9JC9B0M “Section 9(c), R.A. No. 9160. “Section 12, R.A. No. 9160, as amended. “Section 10, R.A. No. 9160, as amended by R.A. No. 11521. “Section 7(13), ibid. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL 1 AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 182 i. Mutual assistance among states 167. May aforeign state and the AMLC request for mutual assistance in the investigation or prosecution of a money laundering offense? Yes. a foreign state and the AMLC request for mutual assistance in the investigation or prosecution of a money laundering offense. The principles of mutuality and reciprocity shall, for this purpose, be at all times recognized. Thus, the AMLC and concerned foreign state may execute a request for assistance from each other by: (1) tracking down, freezing, restraining and seizing assets alleged to be proceeds of any unlawful activity under the procedures laid down in the Act; (2) giving information needed by the foreign State within the procedures laid down in the Act; and (3) applying for an order of forfeiture of any monetary instrument or property in the court: Provided, that the court shall not issue such an order unless the application is iccompanied by an authenticated copy of the order of a court in the equesting State ordering the forfeiture of said monetary instrument or property of a person who has been convicted of a money laundering offense in the requesting State, and a certification or an affidavit of a competent officer of the requesting State stating that the conviction and the order of forfeiture are final and that no further appeal lies in respect of either.301 168. What are the limitations on request for mutual assistance? The AMLC may refuse to comply with any request for assistance where the action sought by the request contravenes any provision of the Constitution or the execution of a request is likely to prejudice the national interest of the Philippines unless there is a treaty between the Philippines and the requesting State relating to the provision of assistance in relation to money laundering offenses.302 169. What are the requirements for Requests for Mutual Assistance from Foreign States? A request for mutual assistance from a foreign State must (1) confirm that an investigation or prosecution is being conducted “"Section 13(a), (b) and (c), R.A. No. 9160. “Section 13(d), ibid. I VI. BANKING 183 in respect of a money launderer named therein or that he has been convicted of any money laundering offense; (2) state the grounds on which any person is being investigated or prosecuted for money laundering or the details of his conviction; (3) give sufficient particulars as to the identity of said person; (4) give particulars sufficient to identify any covered institution believed to have any information, document, material or object which may be of assistance to the investigation or prosecution; (5) ask from the covered institution concerned any information, document, material or object which may be of assistance to the investigation or prosecution; (6) specify the manner in which and to whom said information, document, material or object obtained pursuant to said request, is to be produced; (7) give all the particulars necessary for the issuance by the court in the requested State of the writs, orders or processes needed by the requesting State; and (8) contain such other information as may assist in the execution of the request.303 D. Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation 1. Basic Policy 170. What is the Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation (PDIC)? PDIC is a government instrumentality created in 1963 by virtue of R.A. No. 3591 to insure deposits of all banks which are entitled to the benefits of insurance. The latest amendments to R.A. No. 3591 are contained in R.A. No. 10846 signed into law on May 23, 2016. R.A. No. 10846 empowered PDIC with stronger authority to protect the depositing public and promote financial stability.304 171. What is the declared policy of the State in relation to insurance deposit coverage? It is the declared policy of the State to strengthen the mandatory deposit insurance coverage system to generate, preserve, maintain faith and confidence in the country’s banking system, and protect it from illegal schemes and machinations. Towards this end, the Government must extend all means and mechanisms necessary for the Corporation to effectively fulfill J9JC9B0M “Section 13(e), ibid. “PDIC Frequently Asked Questions, see website of PDIC. J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 184 its vital task of promoting and safeguarding the interests of tho depositing public by way of providing insurance coverage on bank deposits and in helping develop a sound and stable banking system.™ 172. What is PDIC’s overall mandate? PDIC exists to provide deposit insurance coverage for the depositing public to help promote public confidence and stability in the economy. It ensures prompt payment of insured deposits, exercises complementary supervision of banks, adopts responsive resolution methods and applies efficient management of receivership and liquidation functions.306 2. Powers and functions of PDIC 173. What are the principal powers and functions of PDIC? The principal powers and functions of PDIC are as follows: a. Deposit Insurer; b. Co-regulator of banks; and c. Receiver and liquidator of closed banks.307 174. Are all bank members of PDIC? Membership of banks to PDIC is mandatory, hence all operating banks are members of PDIC. Insurance premium is paid by the banks, not by the depositors. The bank is assessed one-fifth (1/5) of 1% per annum of the assessment base of the bank.308 3. Concept of insured deposit 175. What is an insured deposit? The term “insured deposit” means the amount due to any bona fide depositor for legitimate deposits in an insured bank (net of any ““Section 2, R.A. No. 3591. mIbid. mIbid. ™Ibid. 1 VI. BANKING 185 loan obligation of the depositor to the insured bank)™ as of the date of the closure but not to exceed P500,000.00.al° 4. Liability to depositors 176. When does the liability of PDIC to depositors attach? Upon the designation of the PDIC as receiver of a closed bank, it shall serve a notice of closure to the highest-ranking officer of the bank present in the bank premises, or in the absence of such officer, post the notice of closure in the bank premises or on its main entrance. The closure of the bank shall be deemed effective upon the service of the notice of closure. Thereafter, the receiver shall take over the bank and exercise the powers of the receiver as provided under the PDIC charter.311 PDIC can only be liable if the insured bank actually receives deposit and the bank is ordered closed by BSP. It only covers risk of closure of banks as ordered by BSP. It does not cover bank losses due to theft, fire, or closure by reason of strike, existence of public disorder, revolution, or civil war. In one case, an investor placed his funds in a money market placement with a finance company. On maturity, the invested funds cannot be paid owing to the insolvency of the finance company, but the latter referred the investor to its bank-affiliate which thereafter issued a certificate of deposit to the same investor. The deposit was likewise not paid because the bank eventually closed. The investor filed an insurance claim covering the supposed deposit. PDIC denied it. The legality of the denial was thereafter assailed. The High Court sustained the PDIC, ruling that the liability of PDIC is statutory. It is based on the actual receipt by the bank of deposits not on a mere certification on the existence of deposit.312 In another case, PDIC also denied the insurance claim when it discovered that the money allegedly placed with the insured bank ’“While it is not included in the definition of insured deposit, it is understood that any loan obligation of the depositor should be deducted from his total deposit, given the provision of the Civil Code on legal set off where two persons are creditors and debtors of each other. ’’“Section 5(j), R.A. No. 3591, as amended. ’■'Section 14(a), ibid. ’■’FDIC v. Court of Appeals, 283 SCRA 462. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 186 was actually credited to the personal account of the bank President and the certificates of time deposit (CTD) were not duly issued by the bank hut were mere replicas of unissued CTDs in the inventory submitted by the bank with PDIC. The Supreme Court found no grave abuse of discretion on the part of PDIC, holding that PDIC's acts were consistent with law.313 a. Deposit liabilities required to be insured with PDIC 177. What are the deposit liabilities required to be insured with PDIC? The term deposit means the unpaid balance of money or its equivalent received by a bank in the usual course of business, and for which it has given or is obliged to give credit to a commercial, checking, savings, time or thrift account, evidenced by a passbook, certificate of deposit, or other evidence of deposit issued in accordance with Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas rules and regulations and other applicable laws, together with such other obligations of a bank, which, consistent with banking usage and practices. Any obligation of a bank which is payable at the office of the bank located outside of the Philippines shall not be a deposit for any of the purposes of the PDIC Charter or included as part of the total deposits or of insured deposit: Provided, further, that subject to the approval of the PDIC, any insured bank which is incorporated under the laws of the Philippines which maintains a branch outside the Philippines may elect to include for insurance its deposit obligations payable only at such branch.314 Note that the change in the definition of deposit under R.A. No. 1405 does not apply for insurance coverage purposes. A trust fund is not insured with PDIC. Inter-branch deposits refer to funds of one branch deposited in another branch and both branches are part of the same bank. As such, they are excluded from a bank’s total liabilities and do not give rise to insurable deposit liabilities.316 Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation, G.R. No. 313Spouses Chugani 230037, March 19, 2018. 314Section 5(g), R.A. No. 3591, as amended by R.A. No. 10846. 316PDIC v. Citibank, G.R. No. 170290, April 11, 2012. VI. BANKING b. 187 Commencement of liability 178. When does deposits? PDIC commence determination of insured PDIC shall commence the determination of insured deposits due the depositors of a closed bank upon its actual takeover of the closed bank. The Corporation shall give notice to the depositors of the closed bank of the insured deposits due them by whatever means deemed appropriate by the Board of Directors: Provided, that the Corporation shall publish the notice once a week for at least three (3) consecutive weeks in a newspaper of general circulation or, when appropriate, in a newspaper circulated in the community or communities where the closed bank or its branches are located.”6 c. Deposit accounts not entitled to payment 179. What are the deposit accounts not entitled to payment? PDIC shall not pay deposit insurance for the following accounts or transactions whether denominated, documented, recorded or booked as deposit by the bank; a. Investment products such as bonds and securities, trust accounts, and other similar instruments; b. Deposit accounts or transactions which are unfunded, or that are fictitious or fraudulent; c. Deposit accounts or transactions constituting unsafe and unsound banking practices as determined by PDIC, in consultation with BSP, after due notice and hearing, and publication of a cease and desist order issued by the PDIC against such deposit accounts or transactions; and d. Deposits that are determined to be the proceeds of an unlawful activity as defined under the Anti-Money Laundering Law.317 d. Extent of liability “Section 21(a) Renumbered from Section 16(a) by R.A. No. 10846, June 11, 2016; As added by R.A. No. 9302, August 12, 2004. ’’’Section 5(g), R.A. No. 3591, as amended. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 188 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 180. X is a depositor of AAA Bank. She has three (3) deposit accounts all under her name. One in a checking account, one in a savings account, and another one in a time deposit account. Each account has a balance of P250,000.00. AAA Bank became insolvent. Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation closed the Bank. X therefore is unable to withdraw from all of the accounts. She then filed her claims with the Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation. Which statement is most accurate?318 a. X can claim a total of P500,000.00 for all the three (3) accounts. b. X can only claim from one (1) account of P250,000.00. c. X can claim a total of P750,000.00 from all the three (3) accounts. d. X cannot claim anything from any of the deposit accounts. e. Determination of insured deposits and calculation of liability 181. State the rules on determination of insured deposits and calculation of liability. a. Deduct any loan of the depositor from the deposit with the insured bank to determine net insured deposit. b. In determining such amount due to any depositor, there shall be added together all deposits in the bank maintained in the same right and capacity for his or her benefit either in his or her own name or in the name of others. c. Insurance coverage is per depositor not per account. The type of account is immaterial. d. Individually owned deposit account is insured separately from joint accounts regardless of whether the conjunction “and”, “or", “and/or” is issued. In determining such amount due to the depositor, there shall be added together all deposits in the bank maintained in the same right and capacity for his benefit either in his own name or in the name of others. 31"BAR 2012. VI. HANKING 189 e. If the account is held jointly by two or more natural persons or two or more juridical entities, the maximum insured deposit shall be divided into as many equal shares as there are many individuals or juridical entities, unless a different sharing is stipulated in the deposit document. f. If the account is held by a juridical person jointly with a natural person, the maximum insured deposit shall be presumed to belong entirely to the juridical person. g. The aggregate of the interests of each co-owner over several joint accounts, whether owned by the same or different combination of individuals, juridical persons or entities shall likewise be subject to the maximum insured deposit of P500,000.00.319 h. For “in trust for account” (ITF account), like Juan in trust for Maria, while the owner of the account is Juan, Maria, the beneficiary is the one entitled to claim the insurance deposit. i. Deposits in other banks are insured separately. 182. "A" has the following accounts with ABC Bank. The Bank was subsequently closed by BSP for insolvency. How much can "A" recover from PDIC? P500.000 P500,000 P500.000 ||q Tfbwu jptaiJiKo'l P500.000 1 Pl million — Loan Insurance Coverage — P500.000 Uninsured Portion — P500.000 - Trust Fund “A” may recover P500.000.00 from PDIC. While his total deposits amount to Pl.5 million, Pl million of such deposits shall be applied against his Pl million loan obligation. The P500,000.00 trust fund is not insured with PDIC. He may, however, file a claim based on such trust fund in the liquidation proceeding. I I I K J9JC9B0M 3,sSee Section 5(j), R.A. No. 3591, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 190 183. How much can "A" recover from PDIC if he has the following joint accounts on top of his individual accounts? P500.000 JI P500.000 J i ' ” ] P5oo.ooo P500.000 Insurance - P500,000 Coverage Individual Account 500,000 - | A and/or B _________ 500,000 - A and/or C 500,000 - | A and/or D 500,000 B C D - For Joint Account P250.000 P250,000_____ P250,000 For the accounts he maintained with B,C, and D,“A” is entitled to one-half (1/2) of the insured deposit or P250,000.00 ;ach or P750,000.00. The joint accounts are insured separately from A s individual accounts but the aggregate interest of A in the various accounts is subject to the maximum insurance deposit of P500,000.00. Thus, he can recover P500,000.00 for his individual account and P500,000.00 for his various joint accounts. The P500,000.00 trust fund and P250,000.00 uninsured portion for his share in the various joint accounts should be filed as a claim in the liquidation proceeding. 184. How much can "A” recover if his joint accounts are maintained with ABC and B as follows? P500.000 """j P500.000 i P500.000 j P500.000 Insurance - P500,000 Coverage Individual Account 1,000,000- A and/or ABC 500,000 - A and/or B 500,000 A B - ABC P250.000 P250,000 VI. BANKING 191 For the joint account maintained with ABC, the maximum insured deposit is presumed to belong to ABC Corporation, there being no stipulation to the contrary. On the other hand, A is entitled to one-half (1/2) of the insured deposit for the joint account he holds with B. Thus, in addition to the P500,000.00 he may collect from PDIC for his individual account, he can also recover P250,000.00 corresponding to his interest in the joint account with B. f. Mode of payment 185. What is the mode of payment by PDIC? Whenever an insured bank shall have been closed by the Monetary Board of BSP, payment of the insured deposits shall be made by PDIC as soon as possible either by 1) cash, or 2) making available to each depositor a transferred deposit in another insured bankin an amount equal to insured deposit of such depositor, subject to submission of proof of claims.320 g- Effect of payment of insured deposit/preferred credit 186. What is the effect of payment of insured deposits? PDIC, upon the payment of any depositor, shall be subrogated to all the rights of the depositor against the closed bank to the extent of such payment. Subrogation shall include the right on the part of PDIC to receive the same dividends from the proceeds of the assets of such closed bank and recoveries on account of stockholders’ equity as would have been payable to the depositor on a claim for the insured deposits: Provided, that such depositor shall retain his or her claim for any uninsured portion of his or her deposit, which legal preference shall be the same as that of the subrogated claim of the PDIC for its payment of insured deposits. All payments by the PDIC of insured deposits in closed banks partake of the nature of public funds, and as such, must be considered a preferred credit in the order of preference under Article 2244(9) of the New Civil Code.3-1 ’“Section 19, renumbered from Section 14, R.A. No. 3591, as amended by R.A. No. 10846. ’’'Renumbered from Section 15 by R.A. No. 10846, June 11, 2016; as amended byP.D. No. 1940, June 27, 1984; R.A. No. 7400, April 13,1992; R.A. No. 10846, June 11,2016. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 192 187. What is the effect of the failure by PDIC to settle the claim of the insured depositor? The failure to settle the claim within six (6) months from date of tiling of the claim for insured deposit whether such failure was due to grave abuse of discretion, gross negligence, bad faith, or malice shall, upon conviction, subject the directors, officers or employees of PDIC responsible for the delay, to imprisonment from six (6) months to one (1) year; provided that the period shall not apply if the validity of the claim requires the resolution of issues of facts and/or law by PDIC or another office, subject further to the remedy of PDIC to require final determination of a court of competent jurisdiction if PDIC is not satisfied as to the viability of the claim for insured deposit.322 h. Failure of depositor to claim insured deposits 188. What is the effect of the failure of the depositor to file his insurance claim with PDIC? • u ^^ess otherwise waived by the Corporation, if the depositor m t e c osed bank shall fail to claim his insured deposits with the orporation within two (2) years from actual takeover of the closed bank by the receiver, or does not enforce his claim filed with the corporation within two (2) years after the two-year period to file a c ai™ as mentioned hereinabove, all rights of the depositor -against t e orporation with respect to the insured deposit shall be barred; owever, all rights of the depositor against the closed bank and its s areholders or the receivership estate to which the Corporation may ®ve become subrogated, shall thereupon revert to the depositor. ereafter the Corporation shall be discharged from any liability on the insured deposit.323 i. Examination of banks and deposit accounts 189. Does PDIC have the power to examine banks and deposit accounts? PDIC may conduct examination of banks with prior approval of the Monetary Board: Provided, that no examination can be 322Section 19, renumbered from Section 14 and amended by R.A. No. 10846, June 11, 2016. 323Section 21(e) Renumbered from Section 16(e) by R.A. No. 10846, June 11, 2016; as amended by R.A. No. 9302, August 12, 2004. VI. BANKING 193 conducted within 12 months from the last examination date: Provided, however, that PDIC may, in coordination with the Bangko Sentral, conduct a special examination as the Board of Directors, by an affirmative vote of a majority of all of its members, if there is a threatened or impending closure of a bank: Provided, further, that, notwithstanding the provisions of R.A. No. 1405, as amended, R.A. No. 6426, as amended, R.A. No. 8791, and other laws, the PDIC and/ or the Bangko Sentral, may inquire into or examine deposit accounts and all information related thereto in case there is a finding of unsafe or unsound banking practice: Provided, finally, that to avoid overlapping of efforts, the examination shall maximize the efficient use of the relevant reports, information, and findings of the Bangko Sentral, which it shall make available to PDIC.324 j. Splitting of deposits 190. What is splitting of deposits and its effect? Splitting of deposits occurs whenever a deposit account with an outstanding balance of more than the statutory maximum amount of insured deposit maintained under the name of natural or juridical persons is broken down and transferred into two or more accounts in the name/s of natural or juridical persons or entities who have no beneficial ownership on transferred deposits in their names within 120 days immediately preceding or during a bank-declared holiday or immediately preceding a closure order by the BSP for the purpose of availing of the maximum deposit insurance coverage. Such splitting of deposit is punishable by imprisonment and/or fine.325 In one case, the Supreme Court even held that monies deposited by individuals who benefitted from the unlawful splitting of deposits are considered laundered funds.320 In cases wherein the transfer into two or more accounts occurred before the 120-day period, the PDIC does not discount the possibility that there may have been a transfer for valid consideration, but in the absence of transfer documents found in the records of the bank at the time of closure, the presumption arises that the source “’Section 9(8), as amended by R.A. No. 9302, August 12, 2004; RA. No. 9576, June 1,2009. ’“Section 26(f)(1)(e); BAR 2019. Gidwani, G.R. No. 234616, ’“Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation June 20,2018. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 194 DIV1NAON COMMERCIAL Ij\W: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II account remained with the transferor. Consequently, even if the transfer into different accounts was not made within 120 days immediately preceding bank closure, the grant of deposit insurance to an account found to have originated from another deposit is not automatic because the transferee still has to prove that the transfer was for a valid consideration through documents kept in the custody of the bank. In this case, even assuming that a depositor donated the amount contained in the subject savings account, not one document evidencing the alleged donation is in the custody or possession of the bank upon takeover by PDIC. Thus, the PDIC properly relied on the records of the bank which showed that donor-depositor’s accounts remained in his name and for his account. As such, it is subject to the rule on maximum insurance deposit recovery.32’ k. Prohibition against restraining order issuances of temporary 191. State the remedies of the depositor who is aggrieved by any action taken by PDIC under its charter. The actions of PDIC with respect to determination of insured eposit accounts shall be final and executory and may not be set aside or restrained by the court except on petition for certiorari on the ground that the action was taken in excess of jurisdiction or with grave abuse of discretion as to amount to lack or excess of jurisdiction. The petition for certiorari may only be filed within 30 ays from notice of denial of claim for deposit insurance.328 The Regional Trial Court has no jurisdiction to nullify the action of PDIC in denying insurance claim.328 192. What court may issue an injunction against PDIC for any action on its part which is tainted with grave abuse of discretion? No court, except the Court of Appeals, shall issue any temporary restraining order, preliminary injunction or preliminary mandatory 32’Carlito Linsangan v. Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation, G.R. No. 228807, February 11, 2019. 328So v. Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation, G.R. No. 230020, March 19, 2018. “’Spouses Chugani v. PDIC, ibid. ! VI. BANKING 195 injunction against PDIC for any action on its part under the PDIC charter.™ This prohibition shall apply in all cases, disputes or controversies instituted by a private party, the insured bank, or any shareholder of the insured bank.331 The Supreme Court may issue a restraining order or injunction when the matter is of extreme urgency involving a constitutional issue, such that unless a temporary restraining order is issued, grave injustice and irreparable injury will arise. The party applying for the issuance of a restraining order or injunction shall file a bond in an amount to be fixed by the Supreme Court, which bond shall accrue in favor of the Corporation if the court should finally decide that the applicant was not entitled to the relief sought.332 Any restraining order or injunction issued in violation of the above rule is void and of no force and effect and any judge who has issued the same shall suffer the penalty of suspension of at least 60 days without pay.333 5. Concept of bank resolution 193. What does resolution mean in the context of the PDIC charter? The term resolution refers to the actions undertaken by the Corporation under Section 11 of the PDIC Charter to: a. Protect depositors, creditors and the Deposit Insurance Fund (DIF); b. Safeguard the continuity of essential banking services or maintain financial stability; and c. Prevent deterioration or dissipation of bank assets.™ “"Section 27, Renumbered from Section 22, R.A. No. 10846, June 11, 2016; As added by R.A. No. 9302, August 12, 2004. “'Section 27, as added by R.A. No. 9302, August 12, 2004. mIbid. mIbid. “'Section 5(s), as added by R.A. No. 10846. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 196 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 194. What is the procedure for bank resolution? The PDIC. in coordination with the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, may commence the resolution of a bank under this section upon: 1. a. Failure of prompt corrective actions as declared by the Monetary’ Board; or b. Request by a bank to be placed under resolution. 2. The Corporation shall inform the bank of its eligibility for entry into resolution.335 3. W ithin a period of 180 days from a bank’s entry into resolution, the Corporation, through the affirmative vote of at least five (5) members of the PDIC Board, shall determine whether the bank may be resolved through the purchase of all its assets and assumption of all its liabilities, or merger or consolidation with, or its acquisition, by a qualified investor. For this purpose, the PDIC may: 4. i. Determine a resolution package for the bank; ii. Identify and, with the approval of the Monetary Board, pre-qualify possible acquirers or investors; iii. Authorize pre-qualified acquirers or investors to conduct due diligence on the bank, for purposes of determining the valuation of a bank through an objective and thorough review and appraisal of its assets and liabilities, and assessment of risks or events that may affect its valuation; and iv. Conduct a bidding to determine the acquirer of the bank.336 In determining the appropriate resolution method for a bank, the PDIC shall consider the: i. Fair market value of the assets of the bank, its franchise, as well as the amount of its liabilities; ii. Availability of a qualified investor; “Section 11, ibid. “Section 11(e), ibid. VI. BANKING iii. Least cost to the DIF; and iv. Interest of the depositing public.337 197 XXXX 5. Upon a determination by the Corporation that the blank may not be resolved, the Monetary Board may act in accordance with Section 30 of R.A. No. 7653 or the New Central Bank Act. 6. The foregoing provisions on bank resolution are without prejudice to any action that the Monetary Board may take under existing laws. 6. Role of PDIC in relation to banks in distress a) Closure and takeover;338 b) Conservatorship; c) Receivership. 195. State the functions of PDIC as a receiver. The provisions of other laws, general or special, to the contrary notwithstanding, whenever it shall be appropriate for the Monetary Board of the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas to appoint a receiver of any banking institution pursuant to existing laws, the Monetary Board shall give prior notice and appoint PDIC as receiver. PDIC, as receiver, shall control, manage and administer the affairs of the closed bank. Effective immediately upon takeover as receiver of such bank, the powers, functions and duties, as well as all allowances, remunerations and perquisites of the directors, officers, and stockholders of such bank are suspended, and the relevant provisions of the Articles of Incorporation and By-laws of the closed bank are likewise deemed suspended. The assets of the closed bank under receivership shall be deemed in custodia legis in the hands of the receiver. From the time the closed bank is placed under such receivership, its assets shall not be subject to attachment, garnishment, execution, levy or any other court processes. L J9JC9B0M “’Section 11(f). “’Supra. J9JC9B0M 'I 198 niVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II In addition to the powers of a receiver pursuant to existing laws, PD1C is empowered to: 1. Bring suits to enforce liabilities to or recoveries of the closed bank; o Appoint and hire persons or entities of recognized competence in banking or finance as its deputies and assistants, to perform such powers and functions of the Corporation as receiver or liquidator of the closed bank; 3. Suspend or terminate the employment of officers and employees of the closed bank: Provided, that payment of separation pay or benefits shall be made only after the closed bank has been placed under liquidation pursuant to the order of the Monetary Board under Section 30 of R.A. No. 7653, and that such payment shall be made from available funds of the bank after deducting reasonable expenses for receivership and liquidation; 4. Pay accrued utilities, rentals and salaries of personnel of the closed bank, for a period not exceeding three (3) months, from available funds of the closed bank; 5. Collect loans and other claims of the closed bank, and for the purpose, modify, compromise or restructure the terms and conditions of such Ioans or claims as may be deemed advantageous to the interest of the creditors and claimants of the closed bank; 6. Hire or retain private counsels as may be necessary; 7. Borrow or obtain a loan, or mortgage, pledge or encumber any asset of the closed bank, when necessary to preserve or prevent dissipation of the assets, or to redeem foreclosed assets of the closed bank, or to minimize losses to the depositors and creditors; 8. If the stipulated interest on deposits is unusually high compared with the prevailing applicable interest rate, the Corporation as receiver may exercise such powers which may include a reduction of the interest rate to a reasonable rate: Provided, that any modification or reduction shall apply only to unpaid interest; and VI. BANKING 9. 199 Exercise such other powers as are inherent and necessary for the effective discharge of the duties of the Corporation as a receiver/139 d) Liquidation 196. What follows after the order of bank's closure by the BSP? Whenever a bank is ordered closed by the Monetary Board, PDIC shall be designated as receiver and it shall proceed with the takeover and liquidation of the closed bank in accordance with this Act. For this purpose, banks closed by the Monetary Board shall no longer be rehabilitated.340 TRUTH IN LENDING ACT (R.A. NO. 3765) 197. What is the purpose of the Truth in Lending Act? The purpose of the law is to complement the then Usury Law and to protect the public from lack of awareness of the true cost of credit by assuring a full disclosure of such cost with a view of preventing the uninformed use of the credit to the detriment of the national economy. The creditors’ full disclosure enables debtors to fully appreciate the true cost of their loan and properly evaluate their options in arriving a business decisions before giving full consent to the contract.341 This law, and other credit-related laws, such as Access Devices Regulation Act (R.A. No. 8484), Consumer Act of the Philippines (R.A. No. 7394), Lending Company Regulation Act of 2007 (R.A No. 9474) and the Pawnshop Regulation Act (P.D. No. 114) require disclosure of the true cost of the credit. 198. What is the obligation of creditors to person to whom credit is extended? To disclose to the borrower in writing prior to the consummation of the transaction the following information: a) the cash price “’Section 13, as added by R.A. No. 10846. “’Section 12, as added by R.A. No. 10846. “■United Coconut Planters Bank v. Spouses Beluso, G.R. No. 159912, August 17,2007. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 200 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II or delivered price of the property or service to be acquired; b) the amounts, if any. to be credited as down payment and/or trade in; c) the difference between the two items; d) the charges, individually itemized, which are to be paid in connection with the transaction but which are not incident to the extension of credit; e) the total amount to be financed: f) the finance charges expressed in terms of pesos and centavos; g) the percentage that the finance charges bear to the total amount to be financed expressed as a simple annual rate on the outstanding unpaid balance of the obligation.3'2 199. Cite example of charges that are deemed as finance charges. Penalty charges, which are liquidated damages resulting from a breach of contract, are considered as finance charges.343 Handling charges are also deemed as part of the finance charges that must be disclosed under the law.3" 200. What are the covered and excluded transactions under the law? The law does not apply to transaction on cash basis but only where there is a credit component. It is also applicable only to a creditor as defined by law, that is, a person engaged in the business of extending credit (including any person who as a regular business practice make loans or sells or rents property or services on a time, credit, or installment basis, either as principal or as agent) who requires as an incident to the extension of credit, the payment of a finance charge.345 Credit means any loan, mortgage, deed of trust, advance, or discount; any conditional sales contract; any contract to sell, or sale or contract of sale of property or services, either for present or future delivery, under which part or all of the price is payable subsequent to the making of such sale or contract; any rental-purchase contract; any contract or arrangement for the hire, bailment, or leasing of property; any option, demand, lien, pledge, or other claim against, “■“Section 4, R.A. No. 3765. 3,3Barbasa v. Tuquero, G.R. No. 163898, December 23, 2008; Bank of the Philippine Islands v. Spouses Yu, G.R. No. 184122, January 20, 2010. “"Consolidated Bank and Trust Corporation v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 91494, July 14,1995. “'“Section 3(4), R.A No. 3765. VI. BANKING 201 or for the delivery of, property or money; any purchase, or other acquisition of, or any credit upon the security of, any obligation of claim arising out of any of the foregoing; and any transaction or series of transactions having a similar purpose or effect.”8 201. What are the legal effects of non-compliance with the obligation to disclose credit charges? Even if prior disclosure is not made pursuant to the law, the contract or the transaction is not rendered void or unenforceable.”’ The creditor can still compel the debtor to perform the principal obligation and the debtor is obliged to comply with the agreement, less undisclosed charges.”8 In other words, charges not properly disclosed need not be paid and if paid, can be recovered. This is, however, without prejudice to the applicable criminal, civil, and administrative penalties that may be imposed against the erring creditor. The offender is liable to pay a penalty for an amount equal to twice the finance charge required by such creditor but not to exceed P2,000.00 on any credit transaction. The action to recover the penalty should be brought within one (1) year from the date of the occurrence of the violation. In case of willful violation of the law, the offender shall be Hable to pay a fine or imprisonment or both at the option of the court.119 II I ■ I i ’“’Section 3, R.A. No. 3765. ’’’Section 6, R.A. No. 3765; Development Bank of the Philippines v. Arcilia, Jr., G.R. No. 161397, June 30, 2005. ’’“New Sampaguita Builders Construction V. Philippine National Bank, G.R. No. 148743, July 30, 2004. ’’’Section 6, R.A. No. 3765. = J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 1 VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE A. Intellectual property rights in general a. 1. Intellectual property rights What are intellectual property rights? Intellectual property rights (IPR) are rights given to persons O' er creation of their minds. It has two (2) categories: 2. a. Industrial property which includes inventions (patents), trademarks, industrial design, and geographic indications of source; and, b. Copyright and related rights. Copyright includes literary and artistic works. Rights related to copyright include those of performing artists in their performances, producers of phonograms in their recordings, and those of broadcasters in their radio and television programs.1 What are the kinds of intellectual property rights under the Intellectual Property Code of the Philippines ("IPC")? Under the IPC,2 the term Intellectual Property Rights under the Intellectual Property Code consist of: a. Copyright and related rights - Exist over original and derivative intellectual creations in the literary and artistic domain protected from the moment of creation.3 b. Trademark and service marks—Any visible sign capable of distinguishing the goods (trademark) or services (service mark) of an enterprise and shall include a stamped or marked container of goods.4 ’Gepty: Intellectual Property Compendium citing WIPO, p. 25, 2019 edition. 2Section 4.1, R.A. No. 8293, or the Intellectual Property Code of the Philippines. Section 172, R.A. No. 8293. ‘Section 121.1, R.A. No. 8293. 202 VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE C. 203 Geographic indications - Indications which identify a good as originating from a given territory, a region or locality where a given quality, reputation or other characteristic of the good is essentially attributable to its geographic indication.6 Examples: Bordeaux (for wine), Grasse (for perfume) and Tuscany (for olive oil). d. Industrial designs — Any composition of line or colors or any three-dimensional form, whether or not associated with lines or colors; provided that such composition or form gives a special appearance to and can serve as a pattern for an industrial product or handicraft.6 e. Patents — Any technical solution of a problem with any field of human activity which is new, involves an inventive step and is industrially applicable.7 f. Lay out designs — Synonymous with topography, and it means the three-dimensional disposition, however expressed, of the elements, at least one of which is an active element and of some or all of the interconnections of an integrated circuit, or such a three-dimensional disposition prepared for an integrated circuit intended for manufacture.8 g. Integrated circuit — A product, in its final form or an intermediate form, in which the elements are integrally formed in and/or on a piece of material and which is intended to perform an electronic function.9 h. Protection of undisclosed information - Means protection of information lawfully held from being disclosed to, acquired by, or used by others without their consent in a manner contrary to honest commercial practices so long as such information: i) is secret in the sense that it is not, as a body or in the precise configuration and assembly of its components, generally known among or readily 'Article 22, TRIPS Agreement. 'Section 112, R.A. No. 8293. ’Section 21, R.A. No. 8293. 'Section 112.3, R.A. No. 8293, as amended by R.A. No. 9150; Section 112.3, IPC. J9JC9B0M ’Section 112.2, R.A. No. 8293, as amended. J9JC9B0M 204 PIVINAON COMMERCIAL LAW: ACOMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II accessible to persons within the circles that normally deal with the kind of information in question; ii) has commercial value because it is a secret; and iii) has been subject to reasonable steps under the circumstances, by the person lawfully in control of the information, to keep it secret.10 3. Describe intellectual property as a right. Intellectual Property right is statutory in nature. The rights conferred on Intellectual Property must be provided by law and can only be enjoyed on the terms specified by statute. It is also an incorporeal right which exists separate and distinct from the material object to which it is attached. Thus, ownership in one does not necessarily vest ownership in the other. The transfer of assignment of the Intellectual Property will not constitute a conveyance of the thing it covers, nor would a conveyance of the latter imply the transfer of the Intellectual Property Right.11 It is a private right, and as such, when it comes to enforcement there is a need from the rights holder or the owner of the Intellectual Property to participate or cooperate in any and all investigations and prosecutions involving violations of Intellectual Property Rights for purposes of establishing ownership of intellectual property and determining the lack of consent or authority in the commission of any act that is deemed an infringement.12 The right is also not absolute. It is subject to certain limitations and exceptions as may be provided by law depending on the kind of Intellectual Property Rights involved.13 4. Is hoarding or collection of empty bottles so that they can be withdrawn from circulation and thus impede the circulation of the bottled products a violation of IPR under the IPC? It is not a violation of the IPC. While it is contrary to good faith, hoarding does not constitute an act within the contemplation of the IPC. It does not relate to any patent, trademark, trade name, '“Article 39, TRIPS Agreement, as cited in Gepty: Intellectual Property Law Compendium, ibid., p. 26. "Distilleria Washington, Inc. v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 120961, October 17, 1996, cited in Gepty, ibid., p. 16. 12Gepty, ibid., p 16. 13Gepty, ibid., p. 17. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 205 or service mark that may have been invaded, intruded into, or used without proper authority from the registered owner of the bottles. Neither does it amount to unfair competition or pertain to mean fraudulently “passing off’ products or services as those of another or undertaking any representation or misrepresentation that would confuse or tend to confuse the goods of one with those of another, or vice versa. In this light, hoarding for purposes of destruction is closer to what another law [R.A. No. 623] covers. The latter makes it unlawful for any person, without the written consent of the manufacturer, bottler, or seller who has successfully registered the marks of ownership in accordance with Section 1 of the said law, to fill such bottles, boxes, kegs, barrels, or other similar containers so marked or stamped, for the purpose of sale, or to sell, dispose of, buy, or traffic in, or wantonly destroy the same, whether filled or not, or to use the same for drinking vessels or glasses or for any other purpose than that registered by the manufacturer, bottler or seller.14 5. Are trade secrets protected under the 1PC? The IPC protects trade secrets in the sense that the law covers protection of undisclosed information. In Air Philippines v. Pennswell,16 the Supreme Court ruled that trade and industrial secrets (pursuant to the IPC and other related laws) are exempted from compulsory disclosure. In this case, Pennswell, a corporation engaged in the business of manufacturing and selling industrial chemicals, solvents and special lubricants, filed an action for collection against Air Philippines. In its Answer, Air Philippines contended that its refusal to pay was due to the fraud that Pennswell committed on its previous sale of certain items which were accordingly misrepresented as belonging to a new line, but were in truth and in fact, identical with products Air Philippines had previously purchased from Pennswell, and that the latter merely altered the names and labels of such goods. During the pendency of the trial, Air Philippines filed a motion to compel Pennswell to give a detailed list of the ingredients and chemical components of its products for comparison. The RTC initially "Coca Cola Bottlers Philippines, Inc. Naga Plant v. Quintin Gomez, G.R. No. 154491, November 14, 2008; BAR 2016. “G.R. No. 172835, December 13, 2007. = J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 2lW granted the motion but reconsidered itself. The Court of Appeals affirmed the RTC. The Supreme Court eventually held that a trade secret is defined as a plan or process, tool, mechanism or compound known only to its owner and those of his employees to whom it is necessary to confide it. The definition also extends to a secret formula or process not patented, but known only to certain individuals using it in compounding some article of trade having a commercial value. A trade secret may consist of any formula, pattern, device, or compilation of information that: (1) is used in one’s business; and (2) gives the employer an opportunity to obtain an advantage over competitors who do not possess the information. Generally, a trade secret is a process or device intended for continuous use in the operation of the business, for example, a machine or formula, but can be a price list or catalogue or specialized customer list. It is indubitable that trade secrets constitute proprietary rights. The inventor, discoverer, or possessor of a trade secret or similar innovation has rights therein which may be treated as property, and ordinarily an injunction will be granted to prevent the disclosure of the trade secret by one who obtained the information “in confidence” or through a “confidential relationship.” The chemical composition, formulation, and ingredients of Pennswell’s special lubricants are trade secrets within the contemplation of the law. In the creation of its lubricants, Pennswell expended efforts, skills, research, and resources. What it had achieved by virtue of its investments may not be wrested on the mere pretext that it is necessary for Air Philippines defense against a collection for a sum of money. To compel its disclosure is to cripple its business, and to place it at an undue disadvantage. If the chemical composition of its lubricants is opened to public scrutiny, it will stand to lose the backbone on which its business is founded. b. 6. Differences among copyright, trademarks and patents Distinguish trademark, trade name, patent and copyright from one another. a. Definition A trademark is any visible sign capable of distinguishing the goods (trademark) or services (service mark) of an enterprise and shall include a stamped or marked container of goods.16 In relation ■'Section 121.1, IPC; Section 121.1, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 207 thereto, a trade name means the name or designation identifying or distinguishing an enterprise.” A patent is an exclusive right granted to an inventor over an invention or a utility model or industrial design to sell, use, and make the same for commerce and industry. The Supreme Court defined copyright as an intangible, incorporeal right granted by statute to the author or originator of certain literary or artistic productions, whereby he or she is invested, for a specific period, with the sole and exclusive privilege of multiplying copies of the same and publishing and selling them.18 The rights granted by copyright are, however, not limited to multiplying copies of the literary or artistic work, publishing, and selling, but also include any form of communication to the public, as well as right of attribution, right to carry out derivative work, and other moral rights. Copyright is likewise not confined to literary and artistic work but also extend to scientific and scholarly works similar to those works enumerated in Section 172.1 of the IPC. Copyright should therefore be defined then as an incorporeal and intangible property granted by law to the originator or creator of certain literary, artistic, scientific and scholarly works whereby he or she is invested for a specific period of time a collection of economic and moral rights on the terms specified by statute. b. Scope or object Trademark attaches to goods or services of an enterprise and stamped or marked containers. Copyright is confined to literary, artistic and scientific works which are original intellectual creations in the literary and artistic domain protected from the moment of their creation. On the other hand, patentable inventions refer to any technical solution of a problem in any field of human activity which is new, involves an inventive step and is industrially applicable. ’’Section 121.3, IPC, as amended. l8Kensonic v. Uni-Line Multi Resources, Inc., supra and Fernando Juan v. Roberto Juan, G.R. No. 221372, August 23, 2017 both citing Black's Law Dictionary, Centennial Edition. 6th ed. West Group, St. Paul Minnesota, USA, 1990, p. 336. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 208 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II C. Term of protection A patent is valid for 20 years from filing of the application for the grant of patent. Copyright is generally valid for 50 years.” For trademarks, a certificate of registration shall remain in force for 10 years, provided, that the registrant shall file a declaration of actual use and evidence to that effect, or shall show valid reasons based on the existence of obstacles to such use, within one (1) year from the fifth anniversary of the date of the registration of the mark. Otherwise, the mark shall be removed from the Register by the Office.20 d. Modes of acquiring the various rights Trademark is acquired solely through registration in accordance with the provisions of the Intellectual Property Code (“IPC ).21 Patent is likewise acquired through application with, and grant by, foe IPO. Copyright is acquired from the moment of ci’eation. 7. Are trademark, copyright and patent interchangeable? Trademark, copyright and patents are different intellectual property rights thatcannot be interchanged with another. These three are completely distinct and separate from one another an t e protection afforded by one cannot be used interchangeably to cover items or works that exclusively pertain to the others.22 Thus, e upreme Court ruled that the name and container of a beauty cream product are proper subjects of a trademark inasmuch as the same alls squarely within its definition. In order to be entitled to exc usively use the same in the sale of the beauty cream product, e user must sufficiently prove that she registered or used it before any ody else did. The owner’s copyright and patent registration of e name and container would not guarantee her the right to the ’’Section 54, IPC, as amended. “Section 145, IPC, as amended. 21In Zuneca Pharmaceutical v. Natrapharm, G.R. No. 211850, September 8, 2020, the Supreme Court, in an en banc decision, abandoned its previous ru ings t at registration does not confer ownership of the trademark and that the first user in good faith defeats the right of the first filer in good faith; and ruled that trademark is acquired through registration and not prior use. “Elidad Kho v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 115758, March 19, 2002. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 209 exclusive use of the same for the reason that they are not appropriate subjects of the said intellectual rights.23 In another case, eye leaf bushing is a useful article but it has no artistic value. Even though it was covered by a certificate of registration of copyright coupled with notice of deposit with the National Library, no copyright is obtained. There can be no copyright infringement despite sale by another of the same product. The owner should have obtained instead a patent for utility model.24 It was also held that light boxes which utilize specially printed posters sandwiched between plastic sheets and illuminated with backlights are not literary or artistic pieces with could be copyrighted. What is copyrightable is the pictorial or drawing contained in the light boxes. The light boxes would have been appropriate for patent, but because copyright and not patent was obtained, then, the first manufacturer of the light box could not sue another manufacturer for patent infringement.26 8, Roberto has been using the name and mark "Lavandera Ko" in his laundry business since 1994. He has a certificate of copyright over said name and mark. Overtheyears, his business expanded with numerous franchise outlets in the Philippines. Roberto then formed a corporation to handle the said business. He called it Laundromatic Corporation (Laundromatic) and it was incorporated in 1997, while "Lavandera Ko" was registered as a business name in 1998 with the Department of Trade and Industry (DTI). Later on, Roberto discovered that his brother, Fernando, was able to register the name and mark "Lavandera Ko" with the Intellectual Property Office (IPO) in 2010, the registration of which was filed in 1995. He also discovered that Fernando had been selling Roberto's franchises. Thus, Roberto filed a petition for injunction, unfair competition, infringement of copyright, cancellation of trademark and name before the RTC. The RTC dismissed the action, finding that neither party was the originator of the subject mark. The judge ruled that the mark was created by a certain Santiago Suarez in 1942 in his musical composition "Lavandera Ko.” Is the RTC correct? “Kho, supra. 24Jessie G. Ching v. William Salinas, Sr., et al., G.R. No. 161295, June 29,2005. “Pearl & Dean Phil. v. Shoemart, Inc., G.R. No. 148222, August 15, 2003. Section 109, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 210 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II No. The RTC’s riding is erroneous as it confused trade or business name with copyright. “Lavandera Ko,” the mark in question in this case is being used as a trade name or specifically, a service name since the business in which it pertains involves the rendering of laundry services. As such, the basic contention of the parties is who between them has the better right to use “Lavandera Ko” as a service name, given that the law guarantees the protection of trade names and business names prior to or even without registration, against any unlawful act committed by third parties. A cause of action arises when the subsequent use of any third party of such trade name or business name would likely mislead the public as such act is considered unlawful. Hence, the RTC erred in denying the parties the proper determination as to who has the ultimate right to use the said trade name by ruling that neither of them has the right or a cause of action since ‘Lavandera Ko” is protected by i copyright. The case was remanded to the RTC to determine who letween Roberto and Fernando has a better right over “Lavandera Co.”« 9. Can an article of commerce serve as a trademark and at the same time enjoy patent and copyright protection? Explain and give an example. A stamped or marked container of goods can be registered as a trademark. An original ornamental design or model for articles of manufacture can be copyrighted if the design can be separated from the utilitarian aspect of the product. An ornamental design cannot be patented, because aesthetic creations cannot be patented. However, it can be registered as an industrial design. Thus, a container of goods which has an original ornamental design on it can be registered as a trademark, copyrighted, and registered as an industrial design.27 B. Patents 10. What is a patent? It is an exclusive right granted to an inventor over an invention or a utility model or industrial design to sell, use, and make the same for commerce and industry. “Fernando Juan v. Roberto Juan, G.R. No. 221372, August 23, 2017. 2,BAR 2010. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE II. 211 What are the various types of patents? The following are the types of Patents: a) patentable inventions; b) industrial designs; and c) utility models. 12. What is the purpose of the patent law? The Patent law has a three-fold purpose: first, it seeks to foster and reward invention; second, it promotes disclosure of inventions to stimulate further innovation and to permit the public to practice the invention once the patent expires; and third, the stringent requirements for patent protection seek to ensure that ideas in the public domain remain there for the free use of the public and it is only after an exhaustive examination by the patent office that patent is issued.28 13. What is a utility model? It is any model of implements or tools or any industrial product, or of part of the same which is of practical utility by reason of its form, configuration or composition. An invention qualifies for registration as a utility model if it is new and industrially applicable. The same rules on patentable inventions apply to registration of utility model except the requirement of inventive step. A utility model cannot be renewed. It can only be registered for a period of seven (7) years after date of the filing of the application, without any possibility of renewal.28 The law expressly acknowledges that any new model of implements or tools of any industrial product even if not possessed of the quality of invention but which is of practical utility is entitled to a patent for utility model.30 14. Cite examples of a utility model. a. Being plain automotive spare parts that must conform to the original structural design of the components they seek to replace, the Leaf Spring Eye Bushing and Vehicle Bearing Cushion are not ornamental; they lack the decorative quality or value that must characterize “Pearl & Dean (Phil.) Inc. v. Shoemart, Inc., G.R. No. 148222, August 15, 2003. J9JC9B0M “Section 109, IPC, as amended. ’"Roberto Del Rosario v. Court of Appeals and Janito Corporation. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 212 authentic works of applied art nnd in actuality, they are utility models, useful articles, albeit with no artistic design or value.31 15. b. Audio equipment or commonly known as the sing along system or karaoke.32 a. Patentable invention What may be patented? Any technical solution of a problem in any field of human activity which is new, involves an inventive step and is industrially applicable shall be patentable. It may be, or may relate to, a product, or process, or an improvement of any of the foregoing.33 16. Cite examples of recently patented inventions. The drone, the iPhone, locomotion assisting device, 3D printer, retinal prosthesis (or bionic eye), global position system, CRISPR ene Editing, brain implant, peer-to-peer information exchange for mobile communication (or Bluetooth), self-driving car, apparatus or utilizing solar radiant energy (or solar panel), third generation wireless mobile communications, and virtual reality generator.34 17. Cite an example of patent involving improvement of a process. In Aguas u. De Leon,35 the Supreme Court ruled that an improvement of the old process of mosaic tile making is patentable. In this case, De Leon had been granted and issued a patent for his invention of certain new and useful improvements in the process of making mosaic precast tiles. He filed a complaint for patent infringement against Aguas who claimed in his answer that the patent of De Leon was secured through misrepresentation as the latter’s invention is neither inventive nor new and hence, not patentable. It was ruled that the patent of De Leon was legally issued. His process is an improvement of the old process of tile-making. The tiles produced from De Leon’s process are suitable for construction 31Jessie Ching v. William Salinas, et al., G.R. No. 161295, June 29, 2005. 32Rosario v. Court of Appeals, supra. “Section 21, IPC, as amended. “15 Patents that changed the world: Jay Bennett, April 27, 2018. “G.R. No. L-32160, January 30,1982. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 213 and ornamentation, which previously had not been achieved by tiles made out of the old process of tile-making. De Leon’s invention has therefore brought about a new and useful kind of tile. The old type of tiles was usually intended for floors although there is nothing to prevent one from using them for walling purposes. These tiles are neither artistic nor ornamental. They are heavy and massive. The improvement is indeed inventive and goes beyond the exercise of mechanical skill. De Leon has improved the old method of making tiles and precast articles which were not satisfactory because of an intolerable number of breakages, especially if deep engravings are made on the tile. He has overcome the problem of producing decorative tiles with deep engraving, but with sufficient durability. The Court also found Aguas liable for patent infringement. 18. What are the requisites for the patentability of an invention? The requisites are derived from the definition of a patentable invention itself. They are: a) novelty or newness; b) an inventive step; and c) industrial applicability. 19. Define novelty as an element of patentability. It is best defined in the negative: an invention shall not be considered new if it forms part of a prior art. Prior art, on the other hand, shall consist of: a. Everything which has been made available to the public anywhere in the world, before the filing date or the priority date of the application claiming the invention; and, b. The whole contents of a published application for a patent, utility model, or industrial design registration, filed or effective in the Philippines, with a filing or priority date that is earlier than the filing or priority date of the application.36 Thus, if the inventor makes his invention available to the public but without obtaining a patent, he cannot restrain others from using his invention. The use of the invention does not constitute patent infringement. The rule is, no patent no protection. Neither can anyone, however, from the public apply for and obtain a patent over J9JC9B0M ^Section 23, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M 21-1 niVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II same invention because the application for patent will no longer satisfy the element of novelty. It was held that a utility model shall not be considered “new" if before the application for a patent it has been publicly known or publicly used in this country or has been described in a printed publication or publications circulated within the country, or if it is substantially similar to any other utility model so known, used or described within the country.37 It has been repeatedly held that an invention must possess the essential elements of novelty, originality, and precedence; and for the patentee to be entitled to protection, the invention must be new to the world. When it was established by evidence that the powder puffs identical with that of petitioner’s patents existed and were publicly known and used as early as 1963 long before petitioner was issued the patent in question, then the presumption of correctness and validity of the patent should be set aside.38 20. What is the doctrine of prejudicial disclosure? Under the doctrine of non-prejudicial disclosure, the disclosure of information contained in the application during the 12 months preceding the filing date or priority date of the application shall not prejudice the applicant on the ground of lack of novelty if such disclosure was made by the inventor himself.39 21. Yosha was able to put together a mechanical water pump in his garage consisting of suction systems capable of drawing water from the earth using less human effort than what was then required by existing models. The water pump system provides for a new system which has the elements of novelty and inventive steps. Yosha, while preparing to have his invention registered with the IPO, had several models of his new system fabricated and sold in his province. Is Yosha's invention no longer patentable by virtue of the fact that he had sold several models to the public before the formal application for registration of patent was filed with the IPO?40 3'Angelita Manzano v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 113388, September 5,1997. “Rosario Maguan v. Court of Appeals, G.R. L-45101, November 28, 1986. "Section 25, IPC, as amended. 40BAR 2018. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 215 Yosha's invention is still patentable despite the fact he had sold several models to the public before the formal application for registration of the patent was filed with the IPO. It is true that an invention shall not be considered new if it forms part of a prior art and that prior art shall consist of everything which has been made available to the public anywhere in the world, before the filing date or the priority date of the application claiming the invention. This, however, presupposes that the one who has made available the patentable invention to the public is a person other than the applicant for patent. Under the doctrine of non-prejudical disclosure, the disclosure of information contained in the application during the 12 months preceding the filing date or priority date of the application shall not prejudice the applicant on the ground of lack of novelty if such disclosure was made by the inventor himself.41 22. What is "inventive step" as an element of patentability? An invention involves an inventive step if, having regard to prior art, it is not obvious to a person skilled in the art at the time of the filing date or priority date of the application claiming the invention.42 Only prior art made available to the public before the filing date or priority date is considered in assessing inventive step. Thus, subsequent development in technologies or invention cannot be used to discard the element of inventive step. The phrase “skilled in the art” means the criterion is only limited to a person with an average level of skill in the concerned field. It excludes the best expert available.43 In the case of drugs and medicines, there is no inventive step if the invention results from the mere discovery of a new form or new property of a known substance which does not result in the enhancement of the known efficacy of that substance, or the mere discovery of any new property or new use for a known substance, or the mere use of a known process unless such known process results in a new product that employs at least one new reactant.44 J9JC9B0M L ‘'Section 25, IPC, as amended. “Section 26.1, IPC, as amended. "Gepty, ibid., p. 258. “Section 26.2, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M 216 23. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II X Pharmaceuticals, Inc. has been manufacturing the antibiotic ointment Marvelopis, which is covered by a patent expiring in the year 2020. In January 2019, the company filed an application for a new patent for Disilopis, which although constituting the same substance as Marvelopis, is no longer treated as an antibiotic but is targeted and marketed for a new use, i.e., skin whitening. Should X Pharmaceuticals, Inc.'s patent application for Disilopis be granted? Explain.46 No, the patent application for Disilopis should not be granted. The use of the existing patent although for a different purpose will not satisfy the elements of novelty and inventive step. Moreover, under Section 22 of the Intellectual Property Code, as amended, discoveries, scientific theories and mathematical methods, and in the case of drugs and medicines, the mere discovery »f a new form or new property of a known substance which does not esult in the enhancement of the known efficacy of that substance, r the mere discovery of any new property or new use for a known substance, or the mere use of a known process unless such known process results in a new product that employs at least one new reactant, are non-patentable inventions. 24. What is industrial applicability as an element of patentability? An invention that can be produced and used in any industry shall be industrially applicable.46 25. Cezar works in a car manufacturing company owned by Joab. Cezar is quite innovative and loves to tinker with things. With the materials and parts of the car, he was able to invent a gas-saving device that will enable cars to consume less gas. Francis, a co-worker, saw how Cezar created the device and likewise came up with a similar gadget, also using scrap materials and spare parts of the company. Thereafter, Francis filed an application for registration of his device with the Bureau of Patents. Eighteen (18) months later, Cezar filed his application for the registration of his device with the Bureau of Patents. Is the gas-saving device patentable? Explain. 45BAR 2019. 46Section 27, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 217 Yes, it is patentable because it is new, it involves an inventive step, and it is industrially applicable.47 b. Non-patentable invention 26. What are the non-patentable inventions? These are inventions that are excluded from patent protection, to wit: Discoveries, scientific theories and mathematical a. methods, and in the case of drugs and medicines, the mere discovery of a new form or new property of a known substance which does not result in the enhancement of the known efficacy of that substance, or the mere discovery of any new property or new use for a known substance, or the mere use of a known process unless such known process results in a new product that employs at least one new reactant; Schemes, rules and methods of performing mental acts, b. playing games or doing business, and programs for computers; Methods for treatment of the human or animal body by c. surgery or therapy and diagnostic methods practiced on the human or animal body; Plant varieties or animal breeds or essentially biological d. process for the production of plants or animals; Aesthetic creations; and e. f. 27. Anything which is contrary to public order or morality.48 Supposing Albert Einstein were alive today and he filed with the Intellectual Property Office (IPO) an application for patent for his theory of relativity expressed in the formula E = me2. The IPO disapproved Einstein's application on the ground that his theory of relativity is not patentable. Is the IPO's action correct? Yes. The IPO’s action is correct because the theory of relativity is not patentable. Under Section 22.1 of the IPC, “discoveries, scientific theories and mathematical methods” are non-patentable.49 J9JC9B0M "BAR 2005. ’’Section 22, IPC, as amended. ’’BAR 2006. J9JC9B0M 218 28. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 X invented a method of improving the tenderness of meat by injecting an enzyme solution into the live animal shortly before a slaughter. Is the invention patentable? No. A process or improvement of process that is related to any field of human activity, having an inventive activity and is industrially applicable may be patented. While the elements of novelty and inventive step are present, the element of industrial applicability is lacking. To be patentable, the processes must be directed to making or improving a commercial or industrial product.50 29. X invented a bogus coin detector which can be used exclusively on self-operating gambling devices otherwise known as onearmed bandits. Can X apply for a patent? Reasons. No. X may not apply for a patent since the gambling device referred to in the problem is itself prohibited and against public order. But if the machine is used in legalized gambling, such device can be patented.51 30. C. Ownership of a patent i. Right to a patent Who has a right to a patent? The right to a patent belongs to the inventor, his heirs, or assigns. When two (2) or more persons have jointly made an invention, the right to a patent shall belong to them jointly.52 31. Che-che invented a device that can convert rainwater to automobile fuel. She asked Macon, a lawyer, to assist in getting her invention patented. Macon suggested that they form a corporation with other friends and have the corporation apply for a patent, 80% of the shares of stock thereof to be subscribed by Che-che and 5% by Macon. The corporation was formed and the patent application was filed. However, Che-che died three (3) months later of a heart attack. “BAR 1989. 5IBAR 1989. “Section 28, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 219 Franco, the estranged husband of Che-che, contested the application of the corporation and filed his own patent application as the sole surviving heir of Che-che. Decide the issue with reasons. The estranged husband can successfully contest the application. There is really no assignment here but subscription to shares of stock of the corporation with the patent as the consideration. Patent can only be issued to the inventor, heirs or assigns. There being no assignment in accordance with the provisions of the IPC, the husband, as heir, is entitled to the patent. 32. What happens if the inventor never secured a patent on a patentable product but a copyright was secured instead? In one case, a corporation was engaged in the manufacture of advertising display units simply referred to as light boxes. These units utilize specially printed posters sandwiched between plastic sheets and illumined by back lights. The manufacturer was able to secure a certificate of copyright registration over these illuminated display units. On the issue of whether there is a patent infringement if another person manufactures the same light boxes, it was held that (assuming these fight boxes are patentable)when an inventor never secured a patent for the fight boxes, it therefore acquired no patent rights which could have protected its invention. The ultimate goal of a patent system is to bring new designs and technologies into the public through disclosure; hence, ideas, once disclosed to the public without protection of a valid patent, are subject to appropriation without significant restraint.63 And so, in that case, the Court ruled that the copyright protection extended only to the technical drawings and not to the light box itself as the latter does not fall under the category of “prints, pictorial illustrations, advertising copies, labels, tags and box wraps.” The light box was not a literary or artistic piece which could be copyrighted under the copyright law; and no less clearly, neither could the lack of statutory authority to make the light box copyrightable be remedied by the simplistic act of entitling the copyright certificate issued by the National Library as “Advertising Display Units.” J9JC9B0M “Pearl & Dean (Phil.) v. Shoemart, Inc., G.R. No. 148222, August 15, 2003. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 220 ii. 33. First-to-file rule What is the "First to File Rule" under the law on patent? If two (2) or more persons have made the invention separately and independently of each other, the right to the patent shall belong to the person who filed an application for such invention, or where two or more applications are filed for the same invention, it shall belong to the applicant who has the earliest filing date or, the earliest priority date.54 iii. 34. Invention created pursuant to a commission Who owns inventions created pursuant to a commission but not under an employer-employee relationship? The person who commissions the work shall own the patent, unless otherwise provided in the contract.56 This is different from copyright where the work is owned by the one who commissioned it but the copyright belongs to the author or creator. 35. How about those inventions created by an employee? In case the employee made the invention in the course of his employment contract, the patent shall belong to: a) the employee, if the inventive activity is not a part of his regular duties even if the employee uses the time, facilities and materials of the employer; b) the employer, if the invention is the result of the performance of his regularly-assigned duties, unless there is an agreement, express or implied, to the contrary.60 36. Cezar works in a car manufacturing company owned by Joab. Cezar is quite innovative and loves to tinker with things. With the materials and parts of the car, he was able to invent a gas-saving device that will enable cars to consume less gas. Francis, a co-worker, saw how Cezar created the device and “Section 29, IPC, as amended. 55Section 30.1, IPC, as amended. “Section 30.2, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 221 likewise came up with a similar gadget, also using scrap materials and spare parts of the company. Thereafter, Francis filed an application for registration of his device with the Bureau of Patents. Eighteen months later, Cezar filed his application for the registration of his device with the Bureau of Patents. Assuming that it is patentable, who is entitled to the patent? What, if any, is the remedy of the losing party?57 Francis is entitled to the Patent, because he had the earlier filing date under the “First to File Rule.”68 The remedy of Cezar is to file a petition in court for the cancellation of the patent of Francis on the ground that he is the true and actual inventor, and ask for his substitution as patentee.59 37. Supposing in the same question above, Joab got wind of the inventions of his employees and also laid claim to the patents, asserting that Cezar and Francis were using his materials and company time in making the devices, will his claim prevail over those of his employees? Explain. No. The claim of Joab will not prevail over those ofhis employees, even if they used his materials and company time in making the gas­ saving device. The invention of the gas-saving device is not part of their regular duties as employees of a car manufacturing company.60 iv. Right of Priority 38. What is the "Right of Priority"? An application for patent filed by any person who has previously applied for the same invention in another country which by treaty, convention or law affords similar privileges to Filipino citizens, shall be considered as filed as of the date of the filing of the foreign application; provided, that: a) the local application expressly claims priority; b) it is filed within 12 months from the date of the earliest foreign application was filed; and c) certified copy of the foreign J9JC9B0M "BAR 2005. “Section 29, IPC, as amended. “Sections 67 and 68, IPC, as amended. “Section 30.2, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M 1 222 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II application together with an English translation is filed within six (6) months from the date of filing in the Philippines.61 A patent applicant with the right of priority is given preference in the grant of a patent when there are two or more applicants for the same invention. Since both the United States and the Philippines are signatories to the Paris Convention for the Protection of Industrial Property, an applicant who has filed a patent application in the United States may have a right of priority over the same invention in a patent application in the Philippines. However, this right of priority does not immediately entitle a patent applicant the grant of a patent. A right of priority is not equivalent to a patent. Otherwise, a patent holder of any member-state of the Paris Convention need not apply for patents in other countries where it wishes to exercise its patent. It was, therefore, inaccurate for petitioner to argue that its prior patent application in the United States removed the invention from the public domain in the Philippines. It should have complied with the other requirements of the actual grant of the patent. In this case, the applicant for patent was declared abandoned by’ the Intellectual Property Office for failure to comply with strict procedural rules. The right of priority of the patent applicant was therefore lost.62 d. 39. Grounds for cancellation of a patent What are the grounds for cancellation of patents? The following are the grounds for the cancellation of a patent, a) the invention is not new or patentable; b) the patent does not disclose the invention in a manner sufficiently clear and complete for it to be carried out by any person skilled in the art; or c) the patent is contrary to public order or morality,63 or granted when the product or the process is non-patentable. Once cancelled, the rights conferred by the patent shall terminate. That the patent is granted not in favor of the true and actual inventor is not a ground for cancellation of patent. 61Section 31, IPC, as amended. “E.I. Dupont De Nemours and Co. v. Director Emma C. Francisco, et al., G.R. No. 174379, August 31, 2016. “Section 61.1, IPC. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE e. 223 Remedy of the true and actual inventor 40. What are the remedies of a person declared by final court order as having the right to the patent? If a person referred to in Section 29 [First to File Rule] other than the applicant, is declared by final court order or decision as having the right to the patent, such person may, within three (3) months after the decision has become final: a) prosecute the application as his own application in place of the applicant; b) file a new patent application in respect of the same invention; c) request that the application be refused; or d) seek cancellation of the patent, if one has already been issued.64 41. What are the remedies of the true and actual inventor deprived of the patent? If a person, who was deprived of the patent without his consent or through fraud, is declared by final court order or decision to be the true and actual inventor, the court shall order for his substitution as patentee, or at the option of the true inventor, cancel the patent, and award actual and other damages in his favor if warranted by the circumstances.65 Even the true and actual inventor, who is not a patent holder, cannot file an action for patent infringement. Such remedy is available only to the patentee or his successors-in-interest.“ The remedy available to the inventor who is not issued the patent is not to file a petition for cancellation of patent with the IPO but institute the appropriate court action to be declared the patentee and only after he has obtained judgment that he can ask the IPO to cancel the patent of the holder. If the inventor was deprived of patent through fraud or without his consent, he can ask for the cancellation of patent of the holder upon finality of the favorable court decision; whereas, if the patent is issued not to the first filer but no fraud attended the patent issuance, the inventor must wait for three (3) “Section 67, IPC. “Section 68, IPC, as amended. Court of Appeals and Floro International “Creser Precision Systems, Inc. Group, G.R. No. 118708, February 2, 1998. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 224 months from finality of the favorable court decision before he can seek for the cancellation of patent. 42. "I" has invented a certain device, which when attached to the engine of a motor vehicle would cut the consumption of gasoline by 50%. Without securing a patent therefor, he started manufacturing the gadget in large quantities and promoted its sales. An ingenious "J” bought one gadget, dismantled and studied it, and in due time was himself manufacturing an identical device. Before offering it for sale, "J" secured a patent for his device which he called "Gasopid" "I" learns of the patent and desires to secure his own patent but fearing that he might be sued for infringement of patents, seeks your legal advice. How can you help him? Explain briefly.67 T, being the first, true and actual inventor, may file an action in court to be declared as the one entitled to the patent and upon finality of the favorable judgment, ask the IPO to have the patent granted to “J” cancelled and T be issued the patent. I may also ask for actual and other damages as may be warranted under the circumstances. f. 43. Rights conferred by a patent What are the rights conferred by a patent? A patent shall confer on its owner the following exclusive rights: a) where the subject matter of a patent is a product, to restrain, prohibit and prevent any unauthorized person or entity from making, using, offering for sale, selling or importing that product; b) where the subject matter of a patent is a process, to restrain, prevent or prohibit any unauthorized person or entity from using the process, and from manufacturing, dealing in, using, selling or offering for sale, or importing any product obtained directly or indirectly from such process.68 Patent owners shall also have the right to assign, or transfer by succession the patent, and to conclude licensing contracts for the same.69 G,BAR 1981. “Section 71.1, IPC, as amended. “Section 71.2 IPC, as amended. J VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 225 44. What is the term of patent? The term of a patent shall be 20 years from the filing date of the application. The term is not subject to extension. 45. What is the significance of the term of patent? A patentee shall have the exclusive right to make, use and sell the patented machine, article or product, and to use the patented process for the purpose of industry or commerce, throughout the territory of the Philippines for the term of the patent; and such making, using, or selling by any person without the authorization of the patentee constitutes infringement of the patent.70 The patentee’s exclusive rights exist only during the term of the patent, hence, after the cut-off date, the exclusive rights no longer exist.71 g- Limitations of patent rights 46. What are the limitations to patent rights? The owner of a patent has no right to prevent third parties from performing without his authorization the acts of making, using, offering to sell, selling and importing the patented product or process in the following circumstances:72 a. Using a patented product which has been put on the market in the Philippines by the owner of the product, or with his express consent, insofar as such use is performed after that product has been so put on the said market: provided, that, with regard to drugs and medicines, the limitation on patent rights shall apply after a drug or medicine has been introduced in the Philippines or anywhere else in the world by the patent owner, or by any party authorized to use the invention: provided, further, that the right to import the drugs and medicines contemplated in this section shall be available to any government agency or any private third party.73 ’“Roberto del Rosario v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 115106, March 15,1996. ’'Philippine Pharmawealth, Inc. v. Pfizer, Inc., G.R. No. 167715, November 17,2010. ’’Section 72, IPC, as amended ’“Section 72.1, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 226 b. Where the act. is done privately and on a non-commercial scale or for a non-commercial purpose: Provided, that it does not significantly prejudice the economic interests of the owner of the patent;” c. Where the act consists of making or using exclusively for experimental use of the invention for scientific purposes or educational purposes and such other activities directly related to such scientific or educational experimental use;’5 d. In the case of drugs and medicines, where the act includes testing, using, making or selling the invention including any data related thereto, solely for purposes reasonably related to the development and submission of information and issuance of approvals by government regulatory agencies required under any law of the Philippines or of another country that regulates the manufacture, construction, use or sale of any product: Provided, That, in order to protect the data submitted by the original patent holder from unfair commercial use provided in Article 39.3 of the Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights (TRIPS Agreement), the Intellectual Property Office, in consultation with the appropriate government agencies, shall issue the appropriate rules and regulations necessary therein not later than 120 days after the enactment of this law;76 e. Where the act consists of the preparation for individual cases, in a pharmacy or by a medical professional, of a medicine in accordance with a medical prescription or acts concerning the medicine so prepared;77 and f. Where the invention is used in any ship, vessel, aircraft, or land vehicle of any other country entering the territory of the Philippines temporarily or accidentally: provided, ’’Section 72.2, IPC, as amended. ’‘Section 72.3, IPC, as amended. ’‘Section 72.4, IPC, as amended. ’’Section 72.5, IPC, as amended. L J9JC9B0M VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 227 that such invention is used exclusively for the needs of the ship, vessel, aircraft, or land vehicle and not used for the manufacturing of anything to be sold within the Philippines.78 g- Any prior user, who, in good faith, was using the invention or has undertaken serious preparations to use the invention in his enterprise or business, before the filing date or priority date of the application on which a patent is granted, shall have the right to continue the use thereof as envisaged in such preparations within the territory where the patent produces its effect.79 h. A government agency or third person authorized by the Government may exploit the invention even without agreement of the patent owner where:80 i. The public interest, in particular, national security, nutrition, health or the development of other sectors, as determined by the appropriate agency of the government, so requires;81 or ii. Mere determination of an appropriate government agency on the existence of a ground based on public interest would suffice for the exploitation of the invention.82 This is different from the situation of national emergency or extreme urgency where the determination is made by the President of the Philippines.83 iii. A judicial or administrative body has determined that the manner of exploitation, by the owner of the patent or his licensee, is anti-competitive;84 or ’’Section 72.6, IPC, as amended. ’’Section 73.1, IPC, as amended. “Section 74, IPC, as amended. •'Section 74.1(a), IPC, as amended. “Gepty, ibid., p. 303. “Section 74.2(g), IPC, as amended. “Section 74.1(b), IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M PIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 228 iv. In the case of drugs and medicines, there is a national emergency or other circumstance of extreme urgency requiring the use of the invention;"’ or In the case of drugs and medicines, there is a public non-commercial use of the patent by the patentee, without satisfactory reason.86 47. Yosha was able to put together a mechanical water pump in his garage consisting of suction systems capable of drawing water from the earth using less human effort than what was then required by existing models. The water pump system provides for a new system which has the elements of novelty and inventive steps. Yosha, while preparing to have his invention registered with the IPO, had several models of his new system fabricated and sold in his province. If Yosha is able to properly register his patent with the IPO, can he prevent anyone who has possession of the earlier models from using them?87 Yosha can no longer prevent anyone who has possession of the earlier models from using them even if Yosha is able to properly register the patent with the IPO. One of the limitations of patent rights is the use of the patented product which has been put on the market in the Philippines by the owner of the product insofar as such use is performed after the product has been so put on the said market.88 48. Under what conditions can the government, or third person authorized by the government, exploit the invention? The use by the Government, or third person authorized by the Government shall be subject, mutatis mutandis, to the conditions “Section 74.1(c), IPC, as amended. “Section 74.1(d), IPC, as amended. “’BAR 2018. “Section 72, IPC. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 229 specified in Sections 95 to 97H9 and 100 to 1O290 of the IPC.01 In particular — 89Section 95. Requirement to Obtain a License on Reasonable Commercial Terms. 95.1. The license will only be granted after the petitioner has macle efforts to obtain authorization from the patent owner on reasonable commercial terms and conditions but such efforts have not been successful within a reasonable period of time. 95.2. The requirement under Subsection 95.1 shall not apply in any of the fol­ lowing cases: (a) Where the petition for compulsory license seeks to remedy a practice deter­ mined after judicial or administrative process to be anti-competitive; (b) In situations of national emergency or other circumstances of extreme ur­ gency; (c) In cases of public non-commercial use; and (d) In cases where the demand for the patented drugs and medicines in the Philippines is not being met to an adequate extent and on reasonable terms, as deter­ mined by the Secretary of the Department of Health. 95.3. In situations of national emergency or other circumstances of extreme urgency, the right holder shall be notified as soon as reasonably practicable. 95.4. In the case of public non-commercial use, where the government or con­ tractor, without making a patent search, knows or has demonstrable grounds to know that a valid patent is or will be used by or for the government, the right holder shall be informed promptly, (n) 95.5. Where the demand for the patented drugs and medicines in the Philip­ pines is not being met to an adequate extent and on reasonable terms, as determined by the Secretary of the Department of Health, the right holder shall be informed promptly. Section 96. Compulsory Licensing of Patents Involving Semi-Conductor Tech­ nology. In the case of compulsory licensing of patents involving semi-conductor tech­ nology, the license may only be granted in case of public non-commercial use or to remedy a practice determined after judicial or administrative process to be anti-com­ petitive. (n) Section 97. Compulsory License Based on Interdependence of Patents. If the invention protected by a patent, hereafter referred to as the “second patent,” within the country cannot be worked without infringing another patent, hereafter referred to as the “first patent,” granted on a prior application or benefiting from an earlier priority, a compulsory license may be granted to the owner of the second patent to the extent necessary for the working of his invention, subject to the following conditions: 97.1. The invention claimed in the second patent involves an important technical advance of considerable economic significance in relation to the first patent; 97.2. The owner of the first patent shall be entitled to a cross-license on reasonable terms to use the invention claimed in the second patent; 97.3. The use authorized in respect of the first patent shall be non-assignable except with the assignment of the second patent; and 97.4. The terms and conditions of SECTION s 95, 96 and 98 to 100 of this Act. (Section 34-C, R.A. No. 165a) “Section 100. Terms and Conditions of Compulsory License. The basic terms and conditions including the rate of royalties of a compulsopr license shall be fixed by the Director of Legal Affairs subject to the following conditions: 100.1. The scope and duration of such license shall be limited to the purpose for which it was authorized; J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 230 1. The scope and duration of the such use shall be limited to the purpose for which it was authorized;92 2. Such use should be non-exclusive;93 3. The right holder shall be informed promptly whenever any of the foregoing circumstances occurs;94 100.2. The license shall be non-exclusive; 100.3. The license shall be non-assignable, except with that part of the enterprise or business with which the invention is being exploited; 100.4. Use of the subject matter of the license shall be devoted predominantly for the supply of the Philippine market: Provided, That this limitation shall not apply where the grant of the license is based on the ground that the patentee’s manner of exploiting the patent is determined by judicial or administrative process, to be anti­ competitive. 100.5. The license may be terminated upon proper showing that circumstances which led to its grant have ceased to exist and are unlikely to recur: Provided, That adequate protection shall be afforded to the legitimate interest of the licensee; and 100.6. The patentee shall be paid adequate remuneration taking into account the economic value of the grant or authorization, except that in cases where the license was granted to remedy a practice which was determined after judicial or administrative process, to be anti-competitive, the need to correct the anti-competitive practice may be taken into account in fixing the amount of remuneration. (Section 35B, R.A. No. 165a) Section 101. Amendment, Cancellation, Surrender of Compulsory License. 101.1. Upon the request of the patentee or the licensee, the Director of Legal Affairs may amend the decision granting the compulsory license, upon proper showing of new facts or circumstances justifying such amendment. 101.2. Upon the request of the patentee, the said Director may cancel the compulsory license: (a) If the ground for the grant of the compulsory license no longer exists and is unlikely to recur; (b) If the licensee has neither begun to supply the domestic market nor made serious preparation therefor; (c) If the licensee has not complied with the prescribed terms of the license; 101.3. The licensee may surrender the license by a written declaration submitted to the Office. 101.4. The said Director shall cause the amendment, surrender, or cancellation in the Register, notify the patentee, and/or the licensee, and cause notice thereof to be published in the IPO Gazette. (Section 35-D, R.A. No. 165a) Section 102. Licensee’s Exemption from Liability. Any person who works a patented product, substance and/or process under a license granted under this Chapter, shall be free from any liability for infringement: Provided, however, That in the case of voluntary licensing, no collusion with the licensor is proven. This is without prejudice to the right of the rightful owner of the patent to recover from the licensor whatever he may have received as royalties under the license. (Section 35-E, RA. No. 165a) 91Section 74, IPC, as amended. 92Section 74.2(d), IPC, as amended. 93Section 74.2(e), IPC, as amended. 91Section 74.2(b), IPC, as amended. I L VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 231 4. The right holder shall be paid adequate remuneration in the circumstances of each case, taking into account the economic value of the authorization."1' h. Patent infringement 49. What constitutes civil action for patent infringement? Intellectual property infringement basically means performing any act in violation of the rights granted by law to the owner or holder of the intellectual property right. The making, using, offering for sale, selling, or importing a patented product or a product obtained directly or indirectly from a patented process, or the use of a patented process without the authorization of the patentee constitutes patent infringement: provided, that, this shall not apply to instances covered by Sections 72.1 and 72.4 (Limitations of Patent Rights); Section 74 (Use of Invention by Government); Section 93.6 (Compulsory Licensing); and Section 93-A (Procedures on Issuance of a Special Compulsory License under the TRIPS Agreement) of the IPC.96 There can be no infringement of a patent until a patent has been issued, since whatever right one has to the invention covered by the patent arises alone from the grant of patent. An inventor has no common law right to a monopoly of his invention. He has the right to make use of and vend his invention, but if he voluntarily discloses it, such as by offering it for sale, the world is free to copy and use it with impunity. A patent, however, gives the inventor the right to exclude all others. To be able to effectively and legally preclude others from copying and profiting from the invention, a patent is a primordial requirement. No patent, no protection.97 50. When will importation of the patented product not amount to patent infringement? Generally, importation of the patented product without the patentee’s authorization amounts to infringement. However, with regard to drugs and medicines, the law allows importation by the “Section 74.2(f), IPC, as amended. “Section 76.1, IPC, as amended. "Creser Precision Systems, Inc. v. Court of Appeals, G.R, No. 118708, February 2,1998; Pearl & Dean (Phil.) Incorporated v. Shoemart Incorporated, G.R. No. 148222, August 15, 2003. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 232 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II government or any private third party once the drug or medicine has been introduced in the Philippines or anywhere else in the world by the patent owner, or by any party authorized to use the invention in the Philippines.” 51, Who may file an action for patent infringement? Any patentee, or anyone possessing any right, title or interest in and to the patented invention, whose rights have been infringed, may bring an action for patent infringement before a court of competent jurisdiction." Only the patent holder can file an action for infringement. The inventor, who was not issued the patent, cannot file such action nor even apply for injunction to enjoin the use or making or sale of the patented product.100 The Supreme Court further ruled that the phrase “anyone possessing any right, title or interest in and to the patented invention, whose rights have been infringed” may bring an action for infringement does not refer to the inventor not issued the patent but to the patentee’s successors-in-interest and assignee.101 The remedy of the inventor but who was deprived of the patent is to file an action in court that he be declared the patentee and not to file an action for infringement.102 52. Who has the burden of proof in an action for infringement? The burden of proof to substantiate a charge of infringement is with the plaintiff. But where the plaintiff introduces the patent in evidence, and the same is in due form, there is created a prima facie presumption of its correctness and validity. The decision of the Director of Patent (now, of the IPO) in granting the patent is presumed to be correct. The burden of going forward with the evidence (burden of evidence) then shifts to the defendant to overcome by competent evidence this legal presumption.103 "Section 72.1, IPC, as amended. "Section 76, IPC, as amended. ‘“Creser, supra. ’“‘Creser, supra. >02Supra. '"Rosario Maguan v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. L-45101, November 28,1986. 1 VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE i. 53. 233 Tests in patent infringement What are the tests to determine infringement of patent? The tests to determine infringement of patent are: a) literal infringement; and b) the doctrine of equivalents. 54. How is the literal infringement test used vis-a-vis the doctrine of equivalents? In using literal infringement as a test, resort must be had, in the first instance, to the words of the claim. If accused matter clearly falls within the claim, infringement is made out and that is the end of it. The Court must juxtapose the claims of the patent and the accused product within the context of the claims and specifications to determine whether there is exact identity of all material elements. Under the doctrine of equivalents, infringement also occurs when a device appropriates a prior invention by incorporating its innovative concept and albeit with some modifications and change, performs substantially the same function in substantially the same way to achieve substantially the same result. It requires satisfaction of the function-means-and-result test.10,1 Applying both tests, the Supreme Court held in one case that viewed from any perspective or angle, the floating power tiller of petitioner is identical and similar to that of the turtle power tiller of defendant in form, configuration, design and appearance. In operation, the floating power tiller operates also in similar manner as the turtle power tiller. The patent issued by the Patent Office referred to a “farm implement but more particularly to a turtle hand tractor having a vacuumatic housing float on which the engine drive is held in place, the operating handle, the harrow housing with its operating handle and the paddy wheel protective covering.” It appears from the foregoing observation of the trial court that these claims of the patent and the features of the patented utility model were copied by petitioner. The Supreme Court is compelled to arrive at no other conclusion but that there was infringement.105 In applying this test in another case, the Supreme Court ruled that while both compounds have the effect of neutralizing parasites 101Pascua Godines v. Court of Appeals and SV-Agro Enterprises, Inc., G.R. No. 97343, September 13, 1993; BAR 2015. 105Godines, supra. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 234 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II in animals, identity of result does not amount to infringement of patent unless the accused product operates in substantially the same way or by substantially the same means as the patented compound, even though it performs the same function and achieves the same result. In other words, the principle or mode of operation must be the same or substantially the same. The doctrine of equivalents thus requires satisfaction of the function-means-and result test. In the case at bar. apart from the fact the Albendozole is an anthelmintic agent like methyl5propylthio-2-benzimidazole carbamate, nothing is more asserted regarding the method or means by which Albendozole weeds out parasites in animals, thus giving no information on whether that method is substantially the same as the manner by which the accused’s compound works.106 In Del Rosario v. Court of Appeals,107 a case involving patent for utility model covering an audio equipment, commonly known as the sing along system or karaoke, the Supreme Court, in ruling that there was patent infringement under the doctrine of equivalents, observed: (a) both are used by a singer to sing a amplify his voice; (b) both are used to sing with a minus-one or multiplex tapes, or that both are used to play minus-one or standard cassette tapes for singing or for listening to; (c) both are used to sing a minus-one tape and multiplex tape and to record the singing and the accompaniment; (d) both are used to sing with live accompaniment; (d) both are used to sing with live accompaniment and to record the same; (e) both are used to enhance the voice of the singer using echo effect, treble, bass and other controls; (g) both are equipped with cassette tape decks which are installed with one being used for playback and the other, for recording the singer and the accompaniment, and both may also be used to record a speaker’s voice or instrumental playing, like the guitar and other instruments; (h) both are encased in box-like cabinets; and (i) both can be used with one or more microphones. Clearly, therefore, both models involve substantially the same modes of operation and produce substantially the same if not identical results when used. 55. What’s the rationale of the doctrine of equivalents? The reason for the doctrine of equivalents is that to permit the imitation of a patented invention which does not copy any literal laiSmith Kline Beckman Corporation V. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 126627, August 14, 2003. mSupra. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 235 detail would be to convert the protection of the patent grant into a hollow and useless thing. Such imitation would leave room for, and indeed encourage, the unscrupulous copyist to make unimportant and insubstantial changes and substitutions in the patent which, though adding nothing, would be enough to take the copied matter outside the claim, and hence outside the reach of the law.108 ii. Civil and criminal action 56. What are the remedies of the patent owner in case of patent infringement? The remedies of the patentee in case of patent infringement are as follows: a. Civil action Any patentee, or anyone possessing any right, title or interest in and to the patented invention, whose rights have been infringed, may bring a civil action before a court of competent jurisdiction, to recover from the infringer such damages sustained thereby, plus attorney’s fees and other expenses of litigation, and to secure an injunction for the protection of his rights.'"9 If the damages are inadequate or cannot be readily ascertained with reasonable certainty, the court may award by way of damages a sum equivalent to reasonable royalty."0 The court may, according to the circumstances of the case, award damages in a sum above the amount found as actual damages sustained: provided, that the award does not exceed three (3) times the amount of such actual damages.'" Anyone who actively induces the infringement of a patent or provides the infringer with a component of a patented product or of a product produced because of a patented process knowing it to be especially adopted for infringing the patented invention and not suitable for substantial non-infringing use shall be liable as a contributory infringer and shall be jointly and severally liable with the infringer."2 J9JC9B0M '“’Godines, supra. ■“Section 76.2, IPC, as amended. ■‘“Section 76.3, ibid. '“Section 76.4, ibid. ■“Section 76.6, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 236 b. Criminal action If infringement is repeated by the infringer or by anyone in connivance with him after finality of the judgment of the court against the infringer, the offender shall, without prejudice to the institution of a civil action for damages, be criminally liable."3 Unlike trademark and copyright infringement, the first act of patent infringement does not give rise to criminal liability. A person can only be held criminally liable if he repeats the commission of the same infringing acts after finality of the court judgment (in a civil action for infringement) against him. The repeated acts of infringement will then give rise to both criminal and civil liabilities. c. Provisional remedies The patent holder may secure a preliminary injunction to restrain acts of infringement during the pendency of the action for patent infringement?" Relevantly, under the 2020 Rules of Procedure for Intellectual Property Cases, at any time after the filing of the complaint, a motion for the disposal and/or destruction of the seized infringing goods, or materials and implements predominantly used in the infringement, may be filed by the right-holder before the court?16 There is destruction when the infringing goods are completely destroyed and are put beyond further use. There is disposal when the infringing goods are effectively prohibited from re-entry into the channels of commerce but may be reused for some other lawful purpose.116 The court may, in its discretion, order that the infringing goods, materials and implements predominantly used in the infringement be disposed of outside the channels of commerce or destroyed, without compensation.11’ Generally, unless restrained by the Supreme Court or the Court of Appeals, any order issued by the court in cases involving intellectual property rights is immediately executory except, among "“Section 84.IPC, as amended. ‘"Section 76.2, IPC, as amended. '"Rule 20, Section 1. mIbid. "’Section 76.5, ibid. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 237 others, an order of destruction where a motion for reconsideration is filed.118 57. Nestor Dionisio invented a space age revolutionary mini room air-conditioner and was able to secure the registration patent and issuance of patent certificate for said invention by the Philippines' Patent Office. He immediately went into commercial production and sale of his invention. Later, Carlos Asistio, who used to be Nestor's plant manager, organized his own company, and engaged in the manufacture of exactly the same mini-room air-conditioners for his own outfit and which he sold for his own benefit. As counsel of Dionisio, what legal steps would you take to protect his rights and interests? Discuss.1,9 As counsel for Dionisio, I will take the following legal steps: Within four (4) years from the commission of acts of infringement, I will bring a civil action for infringement of patent before the proper court to recover from the infringer damages sustained by reason of the infringement. The amount of damages is based on the profits which he would have made without the infringement and if the same cannot be determined, reasonable royalty. If the circumstances warrant, I will also ask for other damages but not to exceed three times (3x) the amount of actual damages. In the same civil action, I will also pray for attorney’s fees, costs of suit and the issuance of writ of preliminary injunction to restrain further acts of infringement during the pendency of the case. An order to seize and impound tools, equipment and paraphernalia used in connection with the infringement may also be prayed for. If after a final judgment is rendered by the Court against the infringer, he repeated the infringement, I will again institute a civil action for damages with the same above stated provisional remedies, as well as criminal action for the repetition of infringement. After finality of the court judgment, the preliminary injunction shall be converted into a final injunction and the seized tools, equipment and paraphernalia used to commit the acts of infringement may be destroyed and declared outside the channels of commerce. 118Rule 1, Section 4 of the 2020 Rules of Procedure for Intellectual Property Cases. J9JC9B0M 1,9BAR 1985; 1977; 1993. J9JC9B0M 1 238 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II If the infringer commits the same acts of infringement, I will file criminal and civil actions for the repeated acts of infringement, iii. 58. Prescriptive period What is the prescriptive period of a patent infringement suit? No damages can be recovered for acts of infringement committed more than four (4) years before the institution of the action for infringement.120 The IPC, as amended, provides: Damages cannot be recovered for acts of infringement committed before the infringer had known, or had reasonable grounds to know of the patent. It is presumed that the infringer had known of the patent if on the patented product, or on the container or package in which the article is supplied to the public, or on the advertising material relating to the patented product or process, are placed the words “Philippine Patent” with the number of the patent.121 iv. 59. Defenses in action for infringement What are the defenses that can be asserted in a patent infringement suit?122 The following are defenses that can be asserted in a patent infringement suit: a. The patent or any claim thereof is invalid; b. Any of the grounds on which petition for cancellation can be brought; c. The patent is not new or patentable;123 d. Specification of the invention does not comply with the law; e. The patent was issued not to the true and actual inventor, or the plaintiff did not derive his rights from the true and actual inventor; and f. Prescription. l20Section 79, IPC, as amended. ‘“‘Section 80, IPC, as amended. ‘“BAR 1993. "“Section 81 in relation to Section 161, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 239 In one case, when a patent is sought to be enforced, the questions of invention, novelty or prior use, and each of them, are open to judicial examination; in cases of infringement of patent no preliminary injunction will be granted unless the patent is valid and infringed beyond question and the record conclusively proves the defense is sham. In other words, the competent court has jurisdiction to declare a patent invalid. Upon certification that the judgment has become final, it is the ministerial duty of the Patent Office (now the IPO) to execute the judgment.124 In fact, under the IPC, in an action for infringement, if the court shall find the patent or any claim to be invalid, it shall cancel the same, and the Director of Legal Affairs upon receipt of the final judgment of cancellation by the court, shall record that fact in the register of the Office and shall publish a notice to that effect in the IPO Gazette.126 60. In an action for infringement of patent, the alleged infringer defended himself by stating (1) that the patent issued by the Patent Office was not really an invention which was patentable; (2) that he had no intent to infringe so that there was no actionable case for infringement; and (3) that there was no exact duplication of the patentee’s existing patent but only a minor improvement. With those defenses, would you exempt the alleged violator from liability? Why?120 I would not exempt the alleged violator from liability for the following reasons: J9JC9B0M a. A patent once issued by the Patent Office raises a presumption that the article is patentable. The validity of the patent and the question over the inventiveness, novelty and usefulness of the product are matters which are better determined by the Patent Office. There is a presumption that the Philippine Patent Office has correctly determined the patentability of the model and such action must not be interfered with in the absence of '“Rosario Maguan v. Court of Appeals, G.R. L-45101, November 28,1986. '“Section 82, IPC, as amended. '“BAR 1992. J9JC9B0M DlVINzV ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 240 competent evidence to the contrary.127 A mere statement or allegation is not enough to destroy that presumption; 61. b. An intention to infringe is not necessary nor an element in a case for infringement of a patent; c. There is no need of exact duplication of the patentee’s existing patent such as when the improvement made by another is merely minor. Under the doctrine of equivalents, infringement is committed if the accused product introduced only minor innovations or improvement but performs the same function in the same way to accomplish the same result. Exact duplication of the patentee’s existing patent is not necessary for infringement to lie. v. Licensing What are the kinds of licensing agreements? a. Voluntary Licensing b. Compulsory Licensing 62. What is voluntary license in patent? A voluntary license is an authorization given by the patent holder to another person allowing him to produce the patented article. The license usually fixes the amount of royalties, sets quality requirements and defines the markets in which the licensee can sell the product. The licensee shall be entitled to exploit the subject matter of the technology transfer arrangement during the whole term of the technology transfer arrangement.128 To encourage the transfer and dissemination of technology, prevent or control practices and conditions that may in particular cases constitute an abuse of intellectual property rights having an adverse effect on competition and trade, all technology transfer arrangements shall comply with the provisions of voluntary licensing under the IPC.129 | 12,Manzano v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 113388, September 5, 1997. I28Section 90, IPC, as amended. 129Section 85, IPC, as amended. - 241 VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 63. Enumerate three (3) stipulations that are technology transfer agreements.1 “ prohibited in The following stipulations are prohibited in technology transfer agreements: J9JC9B0M a. Those which impose upon the licensee the obligation to acquire from a specific source capital goods, intermediate products, raw materials, and other technologies, or of permanently employing personnel indicated by the licensor; b. Those pursuant to which the licensor reserves the right to fix the sale or resale prices of the products manufactured on the basis of the license; and, c. Those that contain restrictions regarding the volume and structure of production. Other prohibited clauses are as follows:131 a. Those that prohibit the use of competitive technologies in a non-exclusive technology transfer agreement; b. Those that establish a full or partial purchase option in favor of the licensor; c. Those that obligate the licensee to transfer for free to the licensor the inventions or improvements that may be obtained through the use of the licensed technology; d. Those that require payment of royalties to the owners of patents for patents which are not used; e. Those that prohibit the licensee to export the licensed product unless justified for the protection of the legitimate interest of the licensor such as exports to countries where exclusive licenses to manufacture and/or distribute the licensed product(s) have already been granted; f. Those which restrict the use ofthe technology supplied after the expiration of the technology transfer arrangement, except in cases of early termination of the technology transfer arrangement due to reason(s) attributable to the licensee; 1MBAR 2010. 131Section 87.4 to 87.15, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M 242 64. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II E- Those which require payments for patents and other industrial property rights after their expiration, termination arrangement; h. Those which require that the technology recipient shall not contest the validity of any of the patents of the technology’ supplier; i. Those which restrict the research and development activities of the licensee designed to absorb and adapt the transferred technology to local conditions or to initiate research and development programs in connection with new products, processes or equipment; j. Those which prevent the licensee from adapting the imported technology to local conditions, or introducing innovation to it, as long as it does not impair the quality standards prescribed by the licensor; k. Those which exempt the licensor for liability for non­ fulfillment of his responsibilities under the technology transfer arrangement and/or liability arising from third party suits brought about by the use of the licensed product or the licensed technology; and 1. Other clauses with equivalent effects. What contractual stipulations are required in all technology transfer agreements? The following stipulations are required in all technology transfer agreements: a. The laws of the Philippines shall govern its interpretation and in the event of litigation, the venue shall be the proper court in the place where the licensee has its principal place of business; b. Continued access to improvements in techniques and processes related to the technology shall be made available during the period of the technology transfer arrangement; c. In case it shall provide for arbitration, the Procedure of Arbitration of the Arbitration Law of the Philippines or the Arbitration Rules of the International Chamber of Commerce (ICC) shall apply and the venue of arbitration shall be the Philippines or any neutral country; VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE d. 243 The Philippine taxes on all payments relating to the technology transfer agreement shall be borne by the licensor. 132 65. What is compulsory licensing? Compulsory licensing is when the government allows another person to produce the patented product or process without the consent of the patent owner or plans to use the patented invention itself. 66. What are the grounds for compulsory licensing of a patent? The Director General of the Intellectual Property Office may grant a license to exploit a patented invention, even without the agreement of the patent owner, in favor of any person who has shown his capability to exploit the invention, under any of the following circumstances:133 J9JC9B0M a. National emergency or other circumstances of extreme urgency;134 b. Where the public interest, in particular, national security, nutrition, health or the development of other vital sectors of the national economy as determined by the appropriate agency of the Government, so requires;135 or c. Where a judicial or administrative body has determined that the manner of exploitation by the owner of the patent or his licensee is anti-competitive;136 or d. In case of public non-commercial use of the patent by the patentee, without satisfactory reason;'37 e. If the patented invention is not being worked in the Philippines on a commercial scale, although capable of being worked, without satisfactory reason: provided, that ■“Section 88, IPC, as amended; BAK 2010. '“Section 93, IPC, as amended. ■’■Section 93.1, ibid. '“Section 93.2, ibid. '“Section 93.3, ibid. '“Section 93.4, ibid. J9JC9B0M 2-1-1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II the importation of the patented article shall constitute working or using the patent;'"" and f. Where the demand for patented drugs and medicines is not being met to an adequate extent and on reasonable terms, as determined by the Secretary of the Department of Health.'39 A compulsory license shall also be available for the manufacture and export of drugs and medicines to any country having insufficient or no manufacturing capacity in the pharmaceutical sector to address public health problems: provided, that, a compulsory license has been granted by such country or such country has, by notification or otherwise, allowed importation into its jurisdiction of the patented drugs and medicines from the Philippines in compliance with the TRIPS Agreement.140 67. Super Biology Corporation (Super Biology) invented and patented a miracle medicine for the cure of AIDS. Being the sole manufacturer, Super Biology sold the medicine at an exorbitant price. Because of the sudden prevalence of AIDS cases in Metro Manila and other urban areas, the Department of Health (DOH) asked Super Biology for a license to produce and sell the AIDS medicine to the public at a substantially lower price. Super Biology, citing the huge costs and expenses incurred for research and development, refused. Assuming you are asked your opinion as the legal consultant of DOH, discuss how you will resolve the matter. DOH may file a petition for compulsory license with the Director of Legal Affairs of the Intellectual Property Office to exploit the patented medicine even without the agreement of the patent owner on the ground of public interest, in particular, health.141 Once granted, the DOH may then produce and sell the AIDS medicines for a cheaper price subject to payment of reasonable royalties to Super Biology.142 ‘"“Section 93.5; Sections 34, 34-A, 34-B, R.A. No. 165a, ibid. ‘“Section 93.6, ibid. '“Section 93-A.2, ibid. "'Section 193, R.A. No. 8293, as amended. ‘“BAR 2017. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 245 68. What is the period to file a petition for compulsory license? A compulsory license may not be applied for before the expiration of a period of four (4) years from the date of filing of the application or three (3) years from the date of the patent whichever period expires last.1'13 Compulsory license may be applied for at any time after the grant of the patent in the following cases:144 a. Where the public interest, in particular, national security, nutrition, health or the development of other vital sectors of the national economy as determined by the appropriate agency of the Government, so requires; or b. Where a judicial or administrative body has determined that the manner of exploitation by the owner of the patent or his licensee is anti-competitive; or c. In case of public non-commercial use of the patent by the patentee, without satisfactory reason; and, d. If the invention protected by a patent, hereafter referred to as the “second patent,” within the country cannot be worked without infringing another patent, hereafter referred to as the “first patent,” granted on a prior application or benefiting from an earlier priority, a compulsory license may be granted to the owner of the second patent to the extent necessary for the working of his invention. 69. What are the terms and conditions of compulsory license? The basic terms and conditions including the rate of royalties of a compulsory license shall be fixed by the Director of Legal Affairs subject to the following conditions: J9JC9B0M a. The scope and duration of such license shall be limited to the purpose for which it was authorized; b. The license shall be non-exclusive; ‘“Section 94, IPC, as amended. “‘Section 94.2, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M D1VINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 2-16 C. The license shall be non-assignable, except with that part of the enterprise or business with which the invention is being exploited; d. Use of the subject matter of the license shall be devoted predominantly for the supply of the Philippine market: provided, that this limitation shall not apply where the grant of the license is based on the ground that the patentee’s manner of exploiting the patent is determined by judicial or administrative process, to be anti­ r competitive; e. The license may be terminated upon proper showing that circumstances which led to its grant have ceased to exist and are unlikely to recur: provided, that adequate protection shall be afforded to the legitimate interest of the licensee; and f. The patentee shall be paid adequate remuneration taking into account the economic value of the grant or authorization, except that in cases where the license was granted to remedy a practice which was determined after judicial or administrative process, to be anti-competitive, the need to correct the anti-competitive practice may be taken into account in fixing the amount of remuneration.1” Relevantly, in Price v. United Laboratories,146 the Supreme Court held that a compulsory license may be granted over the entire patented invention for there is no law requiring that the license be limited to a specific embodiment of the invention or to a particular claim. 70. Does compulsory licensing amount to deprivation of the property right of the patent holder without due process of law? There is no deprivation of property without due process of law because the compulsory license acknowledges the patentee as the owner of the patent and he will be paid reasonable royalties for the exploitation of his invention by the licensee.147 ■‘‘Sections 100,100.1 to Section 100.6, IPC, as amended. ,,6Barry John Price V. United Laboratories, G.R. No. 82542, September 29, 1988. 1,1Ibid. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE vi. 247 Assignment and transmission of rights 71. How are rights, title or interest in and to patents and invention assigned? Inventions and any right, title or interest in and to patents and inventions covered thereby, may be assigned or transmitted by inheritance or bequest or may be the subject of a license contract.'*’ 72. What are the formalities prescribed by the IPC for the assignment of rights over a patent? The law prescribes the following formalities for the assignment of rights over a patent and the invention to which the patent relates: a. The assignment must be in writing, acknowledged before a notary public or other officer authorized to administer oath or perform notarial acts, and certified under the hand and official seal of the notary or such other officer.'*9 b. The IPO shall record assignments, licenses and other instruments relating to the transmission of any right, title or interest in and to inventions, and patents or application for patents or inventions to which they relate.160 c. Such instruments shall be void as against any subsequent purchaser or mortgagee for valuable consideration and without notice, unless, it is so recorded in the Office, within three (3) months from the date of said instrument, or prior to the subsequent purchase or mortgage.161 C. Trademarks a. Definition of Marks, Collective Marks, Trade Names 73. What is a trademark? A “trademark” is any word, name, symbol, emblem, sign or device or any combination thereof adopted and used by a manufacturer or merchant to identify his goods and distinguish J9JC9B0M '“Section ‘“Section '“Section “'Section 104, IPC, as amended. 105, IPC, as amended. 106.1, ibid. 106.2, ibid. J9JC9B0M 248 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II them from those manufactured, sold or dealt in by others; it is any visible sign capable of distinguishing goods.162 74. What is a collective mark? "Collective Mark” means any visible sign designated as such in the application for registration and capable of distinguishing the origin or any other common characteristic, including the quality of goods or services of different enterprises which use the sign under the control of the registered owner of the collective mark.163 75. Differentiate a trademark from a service mark. “Mark” means any visible sign capable of distinguishing the goods (trademark) or services (service mark) of an enterprise and shall include a stamped or marked container of goods.164 Thus, the name and container of a beauty cream product and LPG cylinder tank bearing a stamp or mark are proper subjects of a trademark. 76. What is a trade name? A trade name means the name or designation identifying or distinguishing an enterprise.165 A name or designation may not be used as a trade name if by its nature or the use to which such name or designation may he put, it is contrary to public order or morals and if, in particular, it is liable to deceive trade circles or the public as to the nature of the enterprise identified by that name.166 In one case, it was ruled that while “San Francisco” is just a proper name referring to the famous city in California and that “coffee” is simply a generic term, the respondent in that case has acquired an exclusive right to the use of the trade name “SAN FRANCISCO COFFEE & ROASTERY, INC.” since the registration of the business name with the Department of Trade and Industry. Thus, respondent’s use of its trade name from then on must be free from any infringement by similarity.167 ‘“Pribhdas J. Marpuri v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 114508, November 19, 1999. ‘“Section 121.2, IPC, as amended. '“Section 121.1, IPC, as amended ‘“Section 121.3, IPC, as amended. ‘“Section 165.1, IPC, as amended. 167Coffee Partners v. San Francisco Coffee and Roastery, Inc., G.R. No. 169504, March 3, 2010. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 77. 249 Is registration with the IPO a prerequisite in an infringement suit of a trade name? No. A trade name previously used in trade or commerce in the Philippines need not be registered with the IPO before an infringement suit may be filed by its owner against the owner of an infringing trademark. The IPC eliminated such requirement.158 78. What is the objective of the law in protecting trademarks? The purpose of the law in protecting trademarks has a two­ fold objective; to protect the owner of his property and to protect the public from being deceived by reason of a misleading claim.169 Trademarks have several functions: they indicate the origin or ownership of the articles or services in which they are used; they guarantee that the articles or services comes up to a certain standard of quality; and they advertise the articles and services they symbolize.160 79. What are the territorial limits of a trademark? Trademarks acknowledge no territorial boundaries of states or nations, but extend to every market where the trader’s goods have become known and identified by his use of the mark.161 80. Does the owner of a trademark have a right of property to prevent others from manufacturing, producing, or selling the same article to which it is attached? No. The owner of a trademark has no right of property to prevent others from manufacturing, producing or selling the same article to which it is attached. In other words, the trademark confers no exclusive rights in the goods to which the mark has been applied.162 The owner of the trademark can have it registered with '“Coffee Partners v. San Francisco Coffee and Roastery, Inc., G.R. No. 169504, March 3, 2010. '“63 C.J. Section 5; BAR 1982. '“Zuneca Pharmaceutical v. Natrapharm, Inc., G.R. No. 211850, September 8,2020. 16163 C.J. Section 12; BAR 1982. IK63 J.C. Section 12. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 250 the IPO and after registration, preclude others from adopting the same trademark for same and similar goods.163 b. 81. Acquisition of ownership of mark How is trademark acquired? The rights in a mark shall be acquired through registration made validly in accordance with the provisions of the law. The applicant or the registrant shall file a declaration of actual use of the mark with evidence to that effect, within three (3) years from the filing date of the application. Otherwise, the application shall be refused or the mark shall be removed from the Register by the Director unless non-use is caused by circumstances arising independently of the will of the trademark owner. Lack of funds shall not excuse non-use of a mark.164 In Zuneca Pharmaceutical v. Natrapharm, Inc.,'65 the Supreme Court abandoned its previous rulings166 that registration does not confer ownership of the trademark and that the first user in good faith defeats the right of the first filer in good faith. Instead, it was held that trademarks are acquired solely through registration. In this case, the two competing marks involved were “ZYNAPS” and “ZYNAPSE.” They were admitted by both parties to be confusingly similar with each other. “ZYNAPS” (without an E) is owned by Zuneca. It is a drug for the treatment of seizures like epilepsy. On the other hand, Natrapharm owns “ZYNAPSE” (with an E), which is also a medicine, but for stroke. Zuneca never registered its trademark “ZYNAPS” with the Intellectual Property (IP) Office, but it has been using it since 2004. Meanwhile, Natrapharm has registered its trademark “ZYNAPSE” on September 24, 2007. 163BAR 1982. 16iSection 152.1, IPC, as amended. ™Ibid. 166These are the cases of: Mattel, Inc. v. Emma Francisco, etal., G.R. No. 166886, July 30, 2008; E.Y. Industrial Sales v. Shien Dar Electricity and Machinery Co., G.R. No. 184850, October 20, 2010; Berris Agricultural Co., Inc v. Norvy Abyadang, G.R. No. 183404, October 13, 2010; Birkenstock Orthopaedia GMBH v. Philippine Shoe Expo Marketing Corporation, G.R. No. 194307, November 20, 2013; Ecole de Cuisine Manille v. Renaud Cointreau, G.R. No. 185830, June 5, 2013. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 251 With that, Natrapharm sued Zuneca for trademark infringement for using a confusingly similar trademark in the same field of drugs or medicine. Zuneca counter-sued and alleged that Natrapharm was the one in bad faith since it (Natrapharm) knows Zuneca’s usage of “ZYNAPS” as a mark since 2004 considering that they both presented their products in the same pharmaceutical convention years prior. The trial court found Zuneca liable for trademark infringement, essentially saying that Natrapharm was the first one to register the trademark in good faith. The trial court found no bad faith on the part of Natrapharm either since Zuneca failed to prove that Natrapharm actually knew the existence of Zuneca’s “ZYNAPS.” The Court of Appeals affirmed this decision. The Supreme Court partly affirmed the lower courts’ decision. It definitively ruled that the only mode of acquiring ownership of a trademark is through registration (and not use). According to the Supreme Court: “(i) the language of the IP Code provisions clearly conveys the rule that ownership of a mark is acquired through registration; (ii) the intention of the lawmakers was to abandon the rule that ownership of a mark is acquired through use; and (iii) the rule on ownership used in Berris and E. Y. Industrial Sales, Inc. [cases] is inconsistent with the IP Code regime of acquiring ownership though registration.” Indeed, Section 122 of the IP Code states “[t]he rights in a mark shall be acquired through registration made validly in accordance with, the provisions of this law. ” In short, the Supreme Court held that Natrapharm’s “ZYNAPSE” must prevail over Zuneca’s “ZYNAPS” since the former was first registered. The Supreme Court, however, absolved Zuneca from being liable for trademark infringement because it found Zuneca to be a prior user in good faith. Accordingly, the IP Code contemplates that a prior user in good faith may continue to use its mark even after the registration of the mark by the first to file registrant in good faith. 82. Did the Supreme Court abandon the first-to-file rule? By ruling that trademark is acquired solely through registration, the Supreme Court did not, nevertheless, abandon the first the file rule. While it is the fact of registration which confers ownership of the mark and enables the owner thereof to exercise J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 252 BIVINA ON COMMERCIAL IAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II the rights expressed in the IP Code, the first to file rule nevertheless prioritizes the first filer of the trademark application and operates to prevent any subsequent applicant from registering the mark.1,1 83. Is the registrant still required to declare actual use of the trademark? Yes, the applicant or registrant must declare actual use of the trademark. The applicant or the registrant shall file a declaration of actual use of the mark with evidence to that effect within three (3) years from the filing date of the application. Otherwise, the application shall be refused or the mark shall be removed from the Register by the Director.108 In Mattel v. Francisco,169 it was held that an admission in a pleading (Comment and Memorandum) that the party has not filed declaration of actual use within three (3) years from application may be construed as an abandonment or withdrawal of any right or interest in his trademark. The registrant is also required to file a declaration of actual use and evidence to that effect within one (1) year from the fifth anniversary of the date of the registration of the mark.170 The Supreme Court, however, held that while the registrant should declare actual use, this does not imply that actual use is the recognized mode of acquisition of ownership. Rather, it must be understood as provision requiring actual use of the mark in order for the registered owner of a mark to maintain his ownership.171 84. What is the significance of the certificate of registration of a trademark? A certificate of registration of a mark shall be prima facie evidence of the validity of the registration, the registrant’s ownership of the mark, and of the registrant’s exclusive right to use the same in connection with the goods or services and those that are related thereto specified in the certificate.172 lo'Zuneca Pharmaceuticals, supra. ’“Section 124.2, IPC, as amended. 169G.R. No. 166886, July 30, 2008. 1'"Section 145, IPC, as amended. ’’’Zuneca Pharmaceuticals, supra. 172Section 138, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 253 The rule on the prima facie validity of a certificate of registration is merely meant to recognize the instances when such certificate is not reflective of ownership such as when the registration was done contrary to the IP Code.173 C. Acquisition of ownership of trade name Trade name is acquired by use. Notwithstanding any laws or regulations providing for any obligation to register trade names, such names shall be protected, even prior to or without registration, against any unlawful act committed by third parties.174 In particular, any subsequent use of the trade name by a third party, whether as a trade name or a mark or collective mark, or any such use of a similar trade name or mark, likely to mislead the public, shall be deemed unlawful.176 The remedies provided for infringement of trademark in shall apply mutatis mutandis in case of trade name infringement.176 d. Non-registrable marks 85. What are the so-called "unregistrable marks"? J9JC9B0M A mark cannot be registered if it: a. Consists of immoral, deceptive or scandalous matter, or matter which may disparage or falsely suggest a connection with persons, living or dead, institutions, beliefs, or national symbols, or bring them into contempt or disrepute; b. Consists of the flag or coat of arms or other insignia of the Philippines or any of its political subdivisions, or of any foreign nation, or any simulation thereof; c. Consists of a name, portrait or signature identifying a particular living individual except by his written consent, or the name, signature, or portrait of a deceased President of the Philippines, during the life of his widow, if any, except by written consent of the widow; l73Zuneca Pharmaceuticals, supra. 174Section 165.2, (a) IPC, as amended. 176Section 165.2 (b), IPC, as amended. l76Section 165.3, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 254 d. Is identical with a registered mark belonging to a different proprietor or a mark with an earlier filing or priority date, in respect of: i. The same goods or services; or ii. Closely related goods or services, or iii. If it nearly resembles such a mark as to be likely to deceive or cause confusion (confusing similarity); e. Is identical with, or confusingly similar to, or constitutes a translation of a mark which is considered by the competent authority of the Philippines to be well-known internationally and in the Philippines, whether or not it is registered here, as being already the mark of a person other than the applicant for registration, and used for identical or similar goods or services: provided, that in determining whether a mark is well-known, account shall be taken of the knowledge of the relevant sector of the public, rather than of the public at large, including knowledge in the Philippines which has been obtained as a result of the promotion of the mark; f. Is identical with, or confusingly similar to, or constitutes a translation of a mark considered well-known in accordance with the preceding paragraph, which is registered in the Philippines with respect to goods or services which are not similar to those with respect to which registration is applied for: provided, that use of the mark in relation to those goods or services would indicate a connection between those goods or services, and the owner of the registered mark: provided, further, that the interests of the owner of the registered mark are likely to be damaged by such use; S- Is likely to mislead the public, particularly as to the nature, quality, characteristics or geographical origin of the goods or services; h. Consists exclusively of signs that are generic for the goods or services that they seek to identify; L Consists exclusively of signs or of indications that have become customary or usual to designate the goods or services in everyday language or in bona fide and established trade practice; VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 255 j. Consists exclusively of signs or of indications that may serve in trade to designate the kind, quality, quantity, intended purpose, value, geographical origin, time or production of the goods or rendering of the services, or other characteristics of the goods or services; k. Consists of shapes that may be necessitated by technical factors or by the nature of the goods themselves or factors that affect their intrinsic value; 1. Consists of color alone, unless defined by a given form; or m. Is contrary to public order or morality.1” Immoral, deceptive, scandalous matter or falsely suggesting a connection with person, belief, institution or symbol 86. Fredco Manufacturing Corporation (Fredco), filed a Petition for Cancellation of Registration No. 56561 before the Bureau of Legal Affairs of the Intellectual Property Office (IPO) against President and Fellows of Harvard College (Harvard University), a corporation organized and existing under the laws of Massachusetts, United States of America. J9JC9B0M Fredco alleged that Registration No. 56561 was issued to Harvard University for the mark "Harvard Veritas Shield Symbol” for decals, tote bags, serving trays, sweatshirts, t-shirts, hats and flying discs under Classes 16, 18, 21, 25 and 28 of the Nice International Classification of Goods and Services. Fredco alleged that the mark "Harvard" for t-shirts, polo shirts, sandos, briefs, jackets and slacks was first used in the Philippines by New York Garments Manufacturing & Export Co., Inc. (New York Garments), Fredco's predecessor­ in-interest. Harvard University, on the other hand, alleged that it is the lawful owner of the name and mark "Harvard" in numerous countries worldwide, including the Philippines. Fredco made use of the mark "Harvard" for jeans coupled with a claim that it originated in Cambridge. Was Fredco's registration of such mark valid? ’’’Section 123.1, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 256 No. Fredco’s registration of the mark “Harvard” should not have been allowed because the law prohibits the registration of a mark "which may disparage or falsely suggest a connection with persons, living or dead, institutions, beliefs. Fredco’s use of the mark “Harvard,” coupled with its claimed origin in Cambridge, Massachusetts, obviously suggests a false connection with Harvard University. On this ground alone, Fredco’s registration of the mark "Harvard” should have been disallowed. Moreover, the Philippines and the United States of America are both signatories to the Paris Convention for the Protection of Intellectual Property.”8 The Philippines is obligated to assure nationals of countries of the Paris Convention that they are afforded an effective protection against violation of their intellectual property rights in the Philippines in the same way that their own countries are obligated to accord similar protection to Philippine nationals. Thus, under Philippine law, a trade name of a national of a State that is a party to the Paris Convention, whether or not the trade name forms part of a trademark, is protected “without the obligation of filing or registration.””9 Name, portrait, signature of living individual 87. Can the name of spouses of deceased Presidents be registered as a trademark? Yes. What the law prohibits is the registration of marks that consist of a name, portrait or signature identifying a particular living individual except by his written consent, or the name, signature, or portrait of a deceased President of the Philippines, during the life of his widow, if any, except by written consent of the widow.180 Identical mark 88. What is the first to file rule in trademarks? The first to file rule in trademarks means that the filing of the application for registration of trademark in good faith precludes registration of the same trademark for the same goods or services or closely related goods and services. ’’’Paris Convention. 1,9Fredco Manufacturing Corporation College, G.R. No. 185917, June 1,2011. '“Section 123.1(c), IPC, as amended. President and Fellows of Harvard VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 257 89. Under the first to file rule in trademarks, a mark that nearly resembles a previously registered mark, such that it is likely to deceive or cause confusion, cannot be registered. How may confusion arise? There are two types of confusion arising from the use of similar or colorable imitation marks, namely confusion of goods (product confusion) and confusion of business (source of origin confusion). Thus, while there is confusion of goods when the products are competing, confusion of business exists when the products are non­ competing but related enough to produce confusion of affiliation. Thus, while there is confusion of goods when the products are competing, confusion of business exists when the products are non­ competing but related enough to produce confusion of affiliation.'81 In one case,182 the Supreme Court held that confusion of business or source may also include confusion of reputation. Thus: “similarity in the general appearance of respondent’s trademark and that of petitioner would evidently create a likelihood of confusion among the purchasing public. But even assuming, arguendo, that the trademark sought to be registered by respondent is distinctively dissimilar from those of the petitioner, the likelihood of confusion would still subsist, not on the purchaser’s perception of the goods but on the origins thereof. By appropriating the word “CONVERSE,” respondent’s products are likely to be mistaken as having been produced by petitioner. The risk of damage is not limited to a possible confusion of goods but also includes confusion of reputation if the public could reasonably assume that the goods of the parties originated from the same source.” Tests to determine confusing similarity between marks 90. What are the tests in determining likelihood of confusion? Likelihood of confusion is the gravamen of the' offense of trademark infringement. In determining likelihood of confusion, jurisprudence has developed two tests, the dominancy test and the '“'McDonald’s Corporation v. L.C. Big Mak Burger, Inc., G.R. No. 143993, August 18,2004. '““Converse Rubber Corporation v. Universal Rubber Products, Inc., G.R. No. 1-27906, January 8, 1987. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 258 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II holistic test. As to what test should be applied depends entirely on the set of facts availing in each case. That is the reason why in trademark cases, jurisprudential precedents should be applied only to a case if they are specifically in point. In determining likelihood of confusion, jurisprudence has developed two tests, the dominancy test and the holistic test. 91. What is the dominancy test? The test of dominancy focuses on the similarity of the prevalent features of the competing trademarks which might cause confusion or deception. It is explicitly incorporated into law under Section 155.1 of the IPC which defines infringement as the “colorable imitation of a registered mark or the same container or a dominant feature thereof.” Under the dominancy test, if the competing trademark contains the main or essential or dominant features of another, and confusion and deception is likely to result, infringement takes place. As the Supreme Court asserted time and again, actual confusion is not required. Duplication or imitation is not necessary; nor is it necessary that the infringing label should suggest an effort to imitate. Similarity in size, form and color, while relevant, is not conclusive. Only likelihood of confusion on the part of the buying public is necessary so as to render two marks confusingly similar so as to deny the registration of the junior mark.183 92. What is the holistic test? The Holistic Test entails a consideration of the entirety of the marks as applied to the products, including labels and packaging, in determining confusing similarity. The scrutinizing eye of the observer must focus not only on the predominant words but also on the other features appearing in both labels so that a conclusion may be drawn as to whether one is confusingly similar to the other.181 93. Cite jurisprudence where the Supreme Court applied the dominancy test. Yes. The Supreme Court applied the dominancy test in the following cases: le8UFC Philippines, Inc. (Now Merged with Nutri-Asia, Inc., with Nutri-Asia, Inc. as the Surviving Entity) v. Fiesta Barrio Manufacturing Corporation, G.R. No. 198889, January 20, 2016; BAR 1996. 1&1Dermaline, Inc. v. Myra Pharmaceuticals, G.R. No. 190065, August 1,2010. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 259 a. “Philippine Planters Cordial Peanuts” brand as opposed to “Planters Cocktail Peanuts”, confusingly similar with respect to their dominant word “Planters.”185 b. The Sunshine Tomato catsup label was a colorable imitation of the Del Monte trademark due to prominent similarities in their general design although there are some differences. It is not difficult to see that the Sunshine label is a colorable imitation of the Del Monte trademark; the predominant colors used in the Del Monte label are green and red-orange, the same with Sunshine; the word “catsup” in both bottles is printed in white and the style of the print/letter is the same; and although the logo of Sunshine is not a tomato, the figure nevertheless approximates that of a tomato.186 c. “Universal Converse and Device” and “Converse Chuck Taylor” and “All Star Device” where Converse was held to be the dominant word.187 d. CFC’s FLAVOR MASTER and Nestle’s MASTER ROAST and MASTER BLEND188 where the word “Master” was held to be the dominant feature of the competing marks. e. Gold Toe v. Gold Top.189 It was held that a resort to either the Dominancy Test or the Holistic Test shows that colorable imitation exists between respondent’s “Gold Toe” and petitioner’s “Gold Top.” A glance at petitioner’s mark shows that it definitely has a lot of similarities and in fact looks like a combination of the trademark and devices that respondent has already registered; namely, “Gold Toe,” the representation of a sock with a magnifying glass, the “Gold Toe” representation and “linenized.” ’“Philippine Nut Industry v. Standard Brands, G.R. No. L-23035, July 31, 1975. Court of ’“Del Monte Corporation and Philippine Packing Corporation Appeals, G.R. No. L-78325, January 25, 1990. mSupra. 188Societe Des Produits Nestle, S.A. and Nestle Philippines v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 112012, April 4, 2001, 356 SCRA 207 (2001). '“Amigo Manufacturing, Inc. v. Cluett Peabody Co., Inc., G.R. No. 139300, March 14, 2001. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 260 f. "Big Milk" mark for hamburger of LC Big Mak Burger, Inc. is confusingly similar with the registered “Big Mac” mark for the same food product of McDonald’s Corporation.191 Applying the dominancy test, the Court finds that respondents’ use of the “Big Mak” mark results in likelihood of confusion. First, “Big Mak” sounds exactly the same as "Big Mac.” Second, the first word in “Big Mak" is exactly' the same as the first word in “Big Mac.” Third, the first two letters in “Mak” are the same as the first two letters in “Mac.” Fourth, the last letter in “Mak” while a “k” sounds the same as “c” when the word “Mak” is pronounced. Fifth, in Filipino, the letter “k” replaces “c” in spelling, thus “Caloocan” is spelled “Kalookan.” The Court also noted that respondents have adopted in “Big Mak” not only the dominant but also almost all the features of “Big Mac.” Applied to the same food product of hamburgers, with both marks aurally and visually the same, it will likely result in confusion in the public. g- “MCDONALD’S” and “MACJOY”.191 Applying the dominancy test, the Court finds that herein petitioner’s “MCDONALD’S” and respondent's “MACJOY’ marks are confusingly similar with each other such that an ordinary purchaser can conclude an association or relation between the marks. To begin with, both marks use the corporate “M” design logo and the prefixes “Me” and/or “Mac” as dominant features. The first letter “M” in both marks puts emphasis on the prefixes “Me” and/or “Mac” by the similar way in which they are depicted i.e., in an arch-like, capitalized and stylized manner. For sure, it is the prefix “Me,” an abbreviation of “Mac,” which visually and aurally catches the attention of the consuming public. Verily, the word “MACJOY’ attracts attention the same way as did “McDonalds,” “MacFries,” “McSpaghetti,” “McDo,” “Big Mac” and the rest of the MCDONALD’S marks which all use the prefixes Me and/or Mac. '“McDonalds’ Corporation v. L.C. Big Mak Burger, G.R. No. 143993, August 18, 2004. ""McDonald’s Corporation v. MacJoy Fastfood Corporation, G.R. No. 166115, February 2, 2007. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 261 Besides and most importantly, both trademarks are used in the sale of fastfood products. h. Pcynogenol v. PCO-GENOLS.102 Both the word[s] PYCNOGENOL and PCO-GENOLS have the same suffix “GENOL” which on evidence, appears to be merely descriptive and furnish no indication of the origin of the article and hence, open for trademark registration by the plaintiff thru combination with another word or phrase such as PYCNOGENOL, Furthermore, although the letters “Y” between P and C, “N” between O and C and “S” after L are missing in the [petitioner’s] mark PCO-GENOLS, nevertheless, when the two words are pronounced, the sound effects are confusingly similar not to mention that they are both described by their manufacturers as a food supplement and thus, identified as such by their public consumers. i. Dermaline and Dermalin.103 Dermaline’s insistence that its applied trademark “DERMALINE, INC.” had differences “too striking to be mistaken” from Myra’s “DERMALIN’ cannot be sustained. While it is true that the two marks are presented differently — Dermaline’s mark is written with the first “DERMALINE” in script going diagonally upwards from left to right, with an upper case “D” followed by the rest of the letters in lower case, and the portion “DERMALINE, INC.” is written in upper case letters, below and smaller than the long-hand portion; while Myra’s mark “DERMALIN’ is written in an upright font, with a capital “D” and followed by lower case letters — the likelihood of confusion is still apparent. This is because they are almost spelled in the same way, except for Dermaline’s mark which ends with the letter “E,” and they are pronounced practically in the same manner in three (3) syllables, with the ending letter “E” in Dermaline’s mark pronounced silently. Thus, when an ordinary purchaser, for example, hears an advertisement 192Prosource International v. Horphag Research, G.R. No. 180073, November 25,2009. 193Dermaline, Inc. v. Myra Pharmaceuticals, G.R. No. 190065, August 1, 2010. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 262 of Dermaline’s applied trademark over the radio, chances are he will associate it with Myra’s registered mark. j. "NANNY’ is confusingly similar to “NAN.”19J Applying the dominancy test in the present case, the Court finds that “NANNY’ is confusingly similar to "NAN.” “NAN” is the prevalent feature of Nestle’s line of infant powdered milk products. It is written in bold letters and used in all products. The line consists of PRENAN, NAN-H.A., NAN-1, and NAN-2. Clearly, “NANNY contains the prevalent feature “NAN.” The first three letters of “NANNY’ are exactly the same as the letters of “NAN.” When “NAN” and “NANNY’ are pronounced, the aural effect is confusingly similar. k. Comparing Berris’ mark D-10 80 WP with Abyadang’s mark NS D-10 PLUS, as appearing on their respective packages, one cannot but notice that both have a common component which is D-10. Admittedly, D-10 is the dominant feature of the mark.195 1. The use of the stylized “S” in Strong Rubber shoes infringes on the mark already registered by Sketchers. While it is undisputed that Sketcher’s stylized “S” is with an oval design and the other party did not use the oval design, the dominant feature of the trademark is the stylized “S” as it is the one that catches the eye of the purchaser.196 m. OK Hotdog Inasal Cheese Hotdog Flavor Mark for curl snack product is a colorable imitation of the Mang Inasal mark for marinated chicken.19’ It is undisputed that the OK Hotdog Inasal mark copied and adopted as one of its dominant features the “INASAL” element of the Mang Inasal mark. Given that the “INASAL”element is, at the same time, the dominant 191Societe Des Produits Nestle, SA v. Dy, G.R. No. 172276, August 8, 2010. 195Berris Agricultural Co., Inc. v. Norvy Abyadang, G.R. No. 183404, October 13,2010. 196Sketchers USA Inc. v. Inter Pacific Industrial Trading, G.R. No. 164321, March 23, 2011; BAR 2014. 197Mang Inasal Philippines, Inc. v. IFP Manufacturing Corporation, G.R No. 221717, June 19, 2017. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 263 and most distinctive feature of the Mang Inasal mark, the said elements incorporation in the OK Hotdog Inasal mark, thus, has the potential to project the deceptive and false impression that the latter mark is somehow linked or associated with the former mark. n. PHILIPS v. PHILITES for fluorescent bulb, incandescent light, starter and ballast.'98 Applying both the dominancy and holistic test, the Supreme Court ruled that the consuming public does not have the luxury of time to ruminate the phonetic sounds of the trademarks, to find out which one has a short or long vowel sound. At bottom, the letters “PHILI” visually catch the attention of the consuming public and the use of respondent’s trademark will likely deceive or cause confusion. Most importantly, both trademarks are used in the sale of the same goods, which are light bulbs. A comparison between petitioner’s registered trademark “PHILIPS” as used in the wrapper or packaging of its light bulbs and that of respondent’s applied for trademark “PHILITE” as depicted in the container or actual wrapper/ packaging of the latter’s light bulbs will readily show that there is a strong similitude and likeness between the two trademarks that will likely cause deception or confusion to the purchasing public. The fact that the parties’ wrapper or packaging reflects negligible differences considering the use of a slightly different font and hue of the yellow is of no moment because taken in their entirety, respondent’s trademark “PHILITES” will likely cause confusion or deception to the ordinary purchaser with a modicum of intelligence. 0. The word “Metro” for magazine publication.199 It was held that “the dominant feature of the applicant mark is the word “METRO” which is identical, both visually and aurally, to the cited marks already registered 198Dy v. Koninklijke Philips Electronics, N.V., G.R. No. 186088, March 22, 2017. 199ABS-CBN v. Director of the Bureau of Trademarks, G.R. No. 217916, June 20,2018. L J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 264 with the IPO. Even if the second cited mark owned by Metro International contains an accompanying device, and the third cited mark contains the terms “Philippine Daily Inquirer", (sic) the dominant feature of the subject and cited marks is still clearly the word “Metro”, (sic) spelled and pronounced in exactly the same way. The identity between the marks would indubitably result in confusion of origin as well as goods.” P- “CITY CASH WITH GOLDEN LION’S HEAD” for Bank ATM service and “CITI” marks for various banking services.2® The Supreme Court said that applying the dominancy test, the prevalent feature of CITYSTATE SAVING’S BANK’S mark, the golden lion’s head device, is not present at all in any of CITIGROUP’S marks. The only similar feature between respondent’s mark and petitioner’s collection of marks is the word “CITY” in the former, and the “CITI” prefix found in the latter. The Court concluded that this similarity alone is not enough to create a likelihood of confusion. 94. Cite jurisprudence where the Supreme Court applied the holistic test. a. When it comes to pants/jeans, the Supreme Court has consistently applied the holistic test. Thus, it was held that the trademark “Stylistic Mr. Lee” for maong pants cannot be deemed confusingly similar with the trademark “Lee.” The test of fraudulent simulation is to be found in the likelihood of the deception of some persons in some measure acquainted with an established design and desirous of purchasing the commodity with which that design has been associated. When the casual buyer is predisposed to be more cautious in his purchase, as in this case where the products concerned are not inexpensive, the likelihood of confusion is absent. Further, maong pants and jeans are not inexpensive and as the casual buyer is predisposed to be more cautious and discriminating in “‘’Citigroup, Inc. 2018. Citystate Savings Bank, Inc., G.R. No. 205409, June 13, VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 265 and would prefer to mull over his/her purchase, confusion and deception is less likely.201 b. The Court also ruled that the jeans trademarks of Levi’s Philippines and Diaz’s “made-to-order” ones must be considered as a whole in determining the likelihood of confusion between them. The consuming public could easily discern if the jeans were original or fake or were manufactured by other brands of jeans. Confusion and deception were remote since maong jeans are expensive and the casual buyer is predisposed to be more cautious and discriminating in and would prefer to mull over his purchase. Further, Diaz used the trademark “LS JEANS TAILORING” for the jeans he produced and sold. His trademark was visually and aurally different from the trademark “LEVI STRAUSS & CO” appearing on the patch of original jeans. Diaz also aptly noted that the design used by LEVIS was an image of two horses but the evidence will show that there was no such design in the seized jeans, instead, what is shown is a ‘buffalo design.”202 C. The trademarks FRUIT OF THE LOOM and FRUIT FOR EVE, for hang tags do not resemble each other as to confuse or deceive an ordinary purchaser, who must be thought of as having, and credited with, at least a modicum of intelligence to be able to see the obvious differences between the two trademarks in question.203 d. Based on the distinct visual and aural differences between LOLANE and ORLANE, there is no confusing similarity between the two marks. The suffix LANE is not the dominant feature of petitioner’s mark. Neither can it be considered as the dominant feature of ORLANE which would make the two marks confusingly similar. First, an examination of the appearance of the marks would show that there are noticeable differences in the way they are “'Emerald Garment Manufacturing Corporation v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 100098, December 29, 1995. “2Diaz v. People of the Philippines and Levi Strauss (Phil.), G.R. No. 180677, February 18, 2013. 203Fruit of the Loom, Inc. v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. L-32747, November 29, 1984. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 266 written or printed. There are visual differences between LOLANE and ORLANE since the mark ORLANE is in plain block upper case letters while the mark LOLANE was rendered in stylized word with the second letter “L” and the letter “A" co-joined. Second, as to the aural aspect of the marks, LOLANE and ORLANE do not sound alike. Appeals to the ear in pronouncing ORLANE and LOLANE are dissimilar. The first syllables of each mark, i.e., OR and LO do not sound alike, while the proper pronunciation of the last syllable LANE — “LEYN” for LOLANE and “LAN” for ORLANE, being of French origin, also differ.2" e. Although the perceived offending word “MARK’ is itself prominent in petitioner’s trademarks “MARK VII” and “MARK TEN,” the entire marking system should be considered as a whole and not dissected, because a discerning eye would focus not only on the predominant word but also on the other features appearing in the labels; only then would such discerning observer draw his conclusion whether one mark would be confusingly similar to the other and whether or not sufficient differences existed between the marks.205 It should be noted that the Supreme Court has often applied the dominancy test when it comes to “inexpensive and common” household items bought off the shelf by “undiscerningly rash” purchasers. As such, if the ordinary purchaser is “undiscerningly rash”, then he would not have the time nor the inclination to make a keen and perceptive examination of the physical discrepancies in the trademarks of the products in order to exercise his choice.200 When it comes to products that require discernment or mulling things over, like jeans, the Supreme Court has applied the holistic test. The Philip Morris case is a rare exception. f. There are distinct visual and aural differences between Great White Shark’s Greg Norman Logo and Caralde’s Shark and Logo Mark. There being no confusing 2<MSeri Somboonsakdikul v. Orlane S.A., G.R. No. 188996, February 1, 2017. ““Philip Morris, Inc. v. Fortune Tobacco Corporation, G.R. No. 158589, June 27, 2006. ““Societe Des Produits Nestle v. Court of Appeals, April 4, 2001, supra. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 267 similarity between the subject marks, the matter of Great White Shark’s mark has gained recognition becomes necessary.207 Idem sonans 95. What is the idem sonans rule in trademark? The rule on idem sonans is also a test to resolve the confusing similarity of trademarks. A mark with a different spelling but is similar in sound with a registered trademark when read may be ruled as being confusingly similar with the said registered mark. 96. Is there a clear-cut rule in the use of both dominancy and holistic tests? None. There is no objective test for determining whether the confusion is likely. Likelihood of confusion must be determined according to the particular circumstances of each case.208 In the history of trademark cases in the Philippines, there are no hard and fast rules in ascertaining whether one trademark is confusingly similar to or is a colorable imitation of another. While Section 155.1 of the IPC explicitly refers to the dominancy test in determining trademark infringement, still, each case must be decided on its own merits. In fact, in certain cases, the Supreme Court applied both dominancy and holistic tests to determine likelihood of confusion.209 The ultimate question in cases of trademark infringement is “whether the use of the marks involved would be likely to cause confusion or mistakes in the mind of the public or deceive purchasers”, regardless of whether the dominancy or the holistic test is applied. The universal test has been said to be whether the public is likely to be deceived. 2O7Great White Shark Enterprises v. Caralde, G.R. No. 192294, November 21, 2012. ““CITIGROUP v. Citystate, supra. ““Berris Agricultural Co., Inc. v. Norvy Abyadang, G.R. No. 183404, October 13,2010 involving the trademark D-10 80 WP and NS D-10 PLUS for fungicide; Amigo Manufacturing, Inc. v. Cluett Peabody Co., Inc., G.R. No. 139300, March 14, 2001 involving the trademark Gold Toe and Gold Top for socks; Prosource International, Inc. v. Horphag Research Management SA, G.R. No. 180073, November 25, 2009 involving the trademarks PYCNOGENOL and PCO-GENOLS for food supplement; Coffee Partners v. San Francisco Coffee and Roastery, Inc., G.R. No. 169504, March 3, 2010 involving the trademarks SAN FRANCISCO COFFEE and SAN FRANCISCO COFFEE & ROASTERY for coffee products. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 268 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II In another case, the Court also prevented the registration of a trademark based on similarity of sound, explaining that both the words PYCNOGENOL and PCO-GENOLS have the same suffix "GENOL" which appears to be merely descriptive and furnish no indication of the origin of the article and hence, open for trademark registration by the plaintiff thru combination with another word or phrase such as PYCNOGENOL. Although there were dissimilarities in the trademark due to the type of letters used as well as the size, color, and design employed on their individual packages/bottles, still the close relationship of the competing products’ name in sounds as they were pronounced, clearly indicates that purchasers could be misled into believing that they are the same and/or originates from a common source and manufacturer.210 Similarly, the Court also used the aural effect of a trademark when it ruled that ‘NANNY1 is confusingly similar to ‘NAN,’ the prevalent feature of Nestle’s fine of infant powdered milk products which is written in bold letters and used in all products. The first three letters of‘NANNY1 are exactly the same as the letters of‘NAN’ and when ‘NAN’ and ‘NANNY1 are pronounced, the aural effect is confusingly similar.211 97. What is the scope of protection afforded to registered trademark owners? The scope of protection afforded to registered trademark owners is not limited to protection from infringers with identical goods. It also extends to protection from infringers with related goods, and to market areas that are the normal expansion of business of the registered trademark owners. This means that the registered trademark owner may use his mark on the same or similar products, in different segments of the market, and at different price levels depending on variations of the products for specific segments of the market. The Supreme Court has recognized that the registered trademark owner enjoys protection in product and market areas that are the normal potential expansion of his business.2'2 210Prosource International, Inc. v. Horphag Research Management SA, G.R. No. 180073, November 25, 2009. 211Societe Des Produits Nestle, S.A. v. Dy, Jr., G.R. No. 172276, August 8, 2010. 212Sketchers USA, Inc. v. Inter Pacific Industrial Trading, G.R. No. 164321, March 23, 2011; Societe Des Produits Nestle, SA v. Dy, G.R. No. 172276, August 8, 2010. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 269 In Societe Des Produits Nestle, S.A. u Martin Dy, Jr.,m the Supreme Court held that while there are differences between NAN and NANNY, (1) NAN is intended for infants while NANNY is intended for children past their infancy and for adults; and (2) NAN is more expensive than NANNY, the registered owner of the “NAN” mark, Nestle should be free to use its mark on similar products, in different segments of the market, and at different price levels. The same principle was applied in Sketchers, U.S.A., Inc. v. Inter Pacific Industrial Trading Corporation.2" The use of the stylized “S” by the manufacturer of its Strong rubber shoes infringes on the mark of Sketchers. It is no defense that the Strong rubber shoes are cheaper and cater to different market segments. Sketchers should be free to expand its product offering in different segments of the market. In a relevant case, it was held that “PAPA BOY& DEVICE” is confusingly similar with the previously registered mark “PAPA” even though they refer to different products, PAPA BOY is for lechon sauce while PAPA is for catsup. The Supreme Court stated that since petitioner’s product, catsup, is also a household product found on the same grocery aisle, in similar packaging, the public could think that petitioner had expanded its product mix to include lechon sauce, and that the “PAPA BOY’ lechon sauce is now part of the “PAPA” family of sauces. Thus, if allowed registration, confusion of business may set in, and petitioner’s hard-earned goodwill may be associated to the newer product introduced by respondent.215 In Mang Inasal Philippines v. IFP Manufacturing Corpora­ tion,2'6 the Supreme Court ruled that the mark “Ok Hotdog Inasal Cheese Flavor” for curl snack product is confusingly similar with the mark “Mang Inasal” for marinated chicken. The Supreme Court also conclude that average buyer who comes across the curls marketed under the OK Hotdog Inasal mark is likely to be confused as to the true source of such curls. To our mind, it is not unlikely that such buyer would be led into the assumption that the curls are of petitioner and that the latter has ventured into snack manufacturing or, if mSupra. 2"Supra. 2ISUFC Philippines, Inc. (Now Merged with Nutri-Asia, Inc., with Nutri-Asia, Inc. as the Surviving Entity) v. Fiesta Barrio Manufacturing Corporation, G.R. No. 198889, January 20, 2016. 1,6 Supra. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 270 not. that the petitioner has supplied the flavorings for respondent’s product. Either way, the reputation of petitioner would be taken advantage of and placed at the mercy of respondent.217 98. What is the doctrine of unrelated goods? One who has adopted, used and registered a trademark on his goods cannot prevent the adoption, use and registration of the same trademark by others on unrelated articles of a different kind. 99. What is the basis of the doctrine? The certificate of registration entitles the registrant to use the trademark only for the goods specified in the certificate or goods related thereto. Therefore, the registrant cannot preclude others from adopting and registering the trademark for totally unrelated goods. It was also held that the prohibition under Section 123 of the Intellectual Property Code extends to goods that are related to the registered goods, not to goods that the registrant may produce in the future. To allow the expansion of coverage is to prevent future registrants of goods from securing a trademark on the basis of mere possibilities and conjectures that may or may not occur at all. Surely, the right to a trademark should not be made to depend on mere possibilities and conjectures.218 100. Cite jurisprudence where the Supreme Court applied the doctrine of unrelated goods. a. The registered owner of the trademark “Brut” for toilet articles cannot oppose the registration of the trademark “Brute” for briefs, since the two products are unrelated, even if the former has a pending application for the registration. A purchaser who is out in the market for the purposes of buying Brute brief would definitely be not mistaken or misled into buying BRUT after shave lotion or deodorant.219 21,Mang Inasal Philippines, Inc. v. IFP Manufacturing Corporation, G.R. No. 221717, June 19, 2017. 2iaKenaonic, Inc. v. Uni-Line Multi Resources, Inc., G.R. Nos. 211820-21 and 211834-35, June 6, 2018. 219Faberge, Inc. v. Intermediate Appellate Court, 215 SCRA 316 (1992); BAR 1994. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 271 b. The owner of the registered trademark “Hickok” for its diverse articles of men’s wear such as wallets, belts and men’s briefs which are all manufactured here in the Philippines by a licensee Quality House, Inc. but are so labeled as to give the misimpression that the said goods are of foreign (stateside) manufacture cannot preclude the registration of the same trademark exclusively for shoes.220 c. There is no infringement when the trademark “CANON” is used for paints, chemical products, toner and dyestuff while it is used by another for footwear (sandals).221 d. The trademark registration of LOTUS for soy sauce was granted and upheld, although the trademark LOTUS is already registered in favor of another for its product, edible oil.222 e. The GALLO trademark registration certificates in the Philippines and in other countries expressly state that they cover wines only, without any evidence or indication that registrant Gallo Winery expanded or intended to expand its business to cigarettes. Thus, Gallo Winery, as registered owner of the trademark GALLO, cannot prevent the registration of the trademark GALLO for tobacco products.223 f; Kolin Electronics, the registered owner of the mark “Kolin”, for goods falling under Class 9 of the Nice Classification, such as amplifier, booster, converter, voltage regulator and similar electronic products, can not preclude the adoption, use and registration of the trademark “Kolin” on a combination of goods, including colored televisions, refrigerators, window-type and split-type air conditioners, electric fans and water dispensers with Taiwan Kolin even though they belong to the same Class 9, because they are unrelated products. The Supreme Court held that whether or not the products covered by the trademark ““Hickok Manufacturing, Co., Inc. v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. L-44707, August 31, 1982. “'Canon Kabushiki Kaisha Court of Appeals, G.R, No. 120900, July 20, 2004. “Acoje Mining Co., Inc. v. Director of Patents, 38 SCRA 480; BAR 1978. “’Mighty Corporation v. E.& J Gallo Winery, G.R. No. 154342, July 14, 2004. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 272 sought to be registered by Taiwan Kolin, on the one hand, and those covered by the prior issued certificate of registration in favor of Kolin Electronics, on the other, fall under the same categories in the NCL is not the sole and decisive factor in determining a possible violation of Kolin Electronics’ intellectual property right should Taiwan Koiin’s application be granted. It is hornbook doctrine that emphasis should be on the similarity of the products involved and not on the arbitrary classification or general description of their properties or characteristics. Reiterating the doctrine in Mighty Corporation v. E & J Gallo Winery,224 the Supreme Court ruled that the goods should be tested against several factors before arriving at a sound conclusion on the question of relatedness. Among these are: (a) the business (and its location) to which the goods belong; (b) the class of product to which the goods belong; (c) the product’s quality, quantity, or size, including the nature of the package, wrapper or container; (d) the nature and cost of the articles; (e) the descriptive properties, physical attributes or essential characteristics with reference to their form, composition, texture or quality; (f) the purpose of the goods; (g) whether the article is bought for immediate consumption, that is, day-to-day household items; (h) the fields of manufacture; (i) the conditions under which the article is usually purchased; and (j) the channels of trade through which the goods flow, how they are distributed, marketed, displayed and sold. The Supreme Court then gave credence to the arguments of Taiwan Kohn that — • Taiwan Koiin’s goods are classified as home appliances as opposed to Kohn Electronics’ goods which are power supply and audio equipment accessories; • Taiwan Kohn’s television sets and DVD players perform a distinct function and purpose from Kolin Electronics’ power supply and audio equipment; and • Taiwan Kohn sells and distributes its various home appliance products on wholesale and to accredited dealers, whereas Kohn Electronics’ goods are sold and flow through electrical and hardware stores.226 22<G.R. No. 154342, July 14, 2004. 226Taiwan Kolin Corporation, LTD. v. Kolin Electronics Co., Inc., G.R. No. 209843, March 15, 2015. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE g. 273 Television sets, stereo components, DVD and VCD players as against voltage regulators, portable generators, switch breakers and fuses because the latter’s registration only covered electronic audio-video products, not electrical home appliances. The two classifications of goods are unrelated. For one, the first pertained to goods which belong to the information technology and audiovisual equipment subclass while the latter pertained to the apparatus and devices for controlling the distribution of electricity sub-class. Also, the goods of the first registrant were final products but the latter’s products were spare parts.226 Author’s note. When does one apply the doctrine of unrelated goods and doctrine of normal or potential expansion of business? For sure, jurisprudence which applied the doctrine of unrelated goods could have been arguably ruled as falling under the opposite doctrine of normal expansion of business, and vice-versa. For academic discussion, your answer to any such bar question will depend on the similarity of facts to the foregoing jurisprudence. Well-known marks 101. What is a well-known mark? A well-known mark is a mark which is considered by the competent authority of the Philippines to be well-known internationally and in the Philippines, whether or not it is registered here, as being already the mark of a person other than the applicant for registration. If the well-known mark is registered in the Philippines, any mark identical with, confusingly similar to, or constitutes a translation of such well-known mark, cannot be used for identical goods or services or be registered in the Philippines with respect to goods or services which are not similar to those with respect to which registration is applied for: provided, that use of the mark in relation to those goods or services would indicate a connection between those goods or services, and the owner of the registered mark: provided further, that the interests of the owner of the registered mark are likely to be damaged by such use.227 J9JC9B0M 226Kensonic, supra. “’Section 123.1(e), IPC. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 27-1 If the well-known mark is not registered in the Philippines, the scope of protection only extends to marks used for identical goods or services."'8 102. What are the remedies of the owner of a well-known mark that is not registered in the Philippines? Without prejudice to other remedies under the law, the owner of the well-known mark may: a. Oppose the application for registration of a mark which is identical with or confusingly similar or constitutes a translation of such well-known mark; b. Petition for cancellation of the registration, if one has been granted; and, c. Unfair competition if the goods are being passed off by another as the goods of the owner of the well-known mark. 103. Is the knowledge of the general public of the mark taken into account in determining whether it is a well-known mark? No, in determining whether a mark is well-known, account shall be taken of the knowledge of the relevant sector of the public, rather than of the public at large, including knowledge in the Philippines which has been obtained as a result of the promotion of the mark. The power to determine whether a trademark is well-known lies in the “competent authority of the country of registration or use.” This competent authority would be either the registering authority if it has the power to decide this, or the courts of the country in question if the issue comes before a court.229 104. What is the role of the Paris Convention on the protection of trademarks? Under the IPC and the Paris Convention, any foreign national or juridical person has the legal capacity to sue for the protection of its trademarks, albeit he or it is not doing business in the Philippines. ^Supra. 229Sehwani Incorporated v. In-N-Out Burger, Inc., G.R. No. 171053, October 15, 2007; Fredco Manufacturing Corporation v. President and Fellows of Harvard College, G.R. No. 185917, June 1, 2011. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 275 Article 6 of the Paris Convention which governs the protection of well-known trademarks, is a self-executing provision and does not require legislative enactment to give it effect in the member country. It may be applied directly by the tribunals and officials of each member country by the mere publication or proclamation of the Convention, after its ratification according to the public law of each state and the order for its execution. The essential requirement under this Article is that the trademark to be protected must be “well-known” in the country where protection is sought.230 Applying this principle in one case, the Court ruled that in upholding the right of the petitioner to maintain a suit for unfair competition or infringement of trademarks of a foreign corporation before the Philippine courts, the duties and rights of foreign states under the Paris Convention for the Protection of Industrial Property to which the Philippines and France Eire parties are upheld.231 105. Does the protection afforded by the Paris Convention extend to trade names? Yes. The Philippines is obligated to assure nationals of countries of the Paris Convention that they are afforded an effective protection against violation of their intellectual property rights in the Philippines in the same way that their own countries are obligated to accord similar protection to Philippine nationals. Thus, under Philippine law, a trade name of a national of a State that is a party to the Paris Convention, whether or not the trade name forms part of a trademark, is protected “without the obligation of filing or registration.”232 This ruling is reiterated by the Court in a later case, explaining that under the Paris Convention to which the Philippines is a signatory, a trade name of a national of a State that is a party to the Paris Convention, whether or not the trade name forms part of a trademark, is protected without the obligation of fifing or registration.233 “Sehwani Incorporated v. In-N-Out Burger. Inc., 536 SCRA 227 (2007). 2,lMelbarose R. Sasot and Allandale R. Sasot v. People of the Philippines, G.R. No. 143193, June 29, 2005. 232Fredco Manufacturing Corporation v. President and Fellows of Harvard CoDege, G.R. No. 185917, June 1, 2011. 233Ecole De Cuisine Manille (Cordon Bleu of the Philippines), Inc. v. Renaud Cointreau & Cie and Le Cordon Bleu Inti, B.V., G.R. No. 185830, June 5, 2013. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 276 106. Cite examples of cases involving well-known marks. a. The word "Barbizon” cannot be registered as a trademark for ladies’ underwear, since it is an internationally wellknown trademark for lingerie.234 b. In the case of Sehwani v. In-N-Out Burger, the Supreme Court held that “In-N-Out Burger” is a well-known mark, given its registration in various countries around the world and comprehensive advertisements. As such, the mark is entitled to protection even though there is no actual use of such mark in the Philippines.235 c. “Harvard” is the trade name of the world-famous Harvard University, and it is also a trademark of Harvard University. Under the Paris Convention, Harvard University is entitled to protection in the Philippines of its trade name “Harvard” even without registration of such trade name in the Philippines. This means that no educational entity in the Philippines can use the trade name “Harvard” without the consent of Harvard University. “Harvard” is a well-known name and mark not only in the United States but also internationally, including the Philippines. It is internationally known as one of the leading educational institutions in the world. As such, even before Harvard University applied for registration of the mark “Harvard” in the Philippines, the mark was already protected under the Paris Convention.“ It should be noted though in that in the case of Fredco, the “Harvard” mark was not for the use of an educational institution but for t-shirts, polo shirts, sandos, briefs, jackets and slacks. Fredco filed a petition for cancellation of the mark “Harvard” against the President and Fellows of Harvard College alleging that the mark Harvard for said merchandise was first used in the Philippines by the New York Garments, Fredco’s predecessor-in-interest. The Supreme Court, as previously pointed out, ruled that it was a mistake to register in favor of Fredco’s predecessor-in-interest the trademark “Harvard” for slacks and similar merchandise because it suggested a connection with Harvard University. ^Pribhdas J. Mirpuri Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 114508, November 19, 1999. a5Ibid. ^Fredco Manufacturing Corporateion v. President and Fellows of Harvard College, G.R. No. 185917, June 1, 2011. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 277 It is interesting to note that in one case, the Supreme Court did not consider “GALLO” a “well-known” mark within the contemplation and protection of the Paris Convention.2'” 107. What is the theory of dilution? Trademark dilution is the lessening of the capacity of a famous mark to identify and distinguish goods or services, regardless of the presence or absence of competition between the owner of the famous mark and other parties; or likelihood of confusion, mistake or deception. Subject to the principles of equity, the owner of a famous mark is entitled to injunction against another person’s commercial use in commerce of a mark or trade name, if such use begins after the mark has become famous and causes dilution of the distinctive quality of the mark. This is intended to protect famous marks from subsequent uses that blur distinctiveness of the mark or tarnish or disparage it. Applying this theory, it was held that Dockers and Design has not acquired a strong degree of distinctiveness yet to be able to get an injunction against the use of the trademark Paddocks and Design.238 108. What are generic marks? Generic marks are those which constitute “the common descriptive name of an article or substance,” or comprise the “genus of which the particular product is a species,” or are “commonly used as the name or description of a kind of goods,” or “imply reference to every member of a genus and the exclusion of individuating characters,” or “refer to the basic nature of the wares or services provided rather than to the more idiosyncratic characteristics of a particular product,” and are not legally protectable.239 109. Is generic mark prohibited? Section 123(h) of the Intellectual Property Code prohibits the registration of a trademark that consists exclusively of signs that are “’Mighty Corporation and La Campana Fabrica De Tabaco, Inc. v. E. & J. Gallo Winery and the Andresons Group, Inc., G.R. No. 154342, July 14, 2004. “Levi Strauss & Co v. Clinton Apparelle, G.R. No. 138900, September 20, 2005. “Societe Des Produits Nestle v. Court of Appeals, April 4, 2001 citing Federal Unfair Competition: Lanham Act s 43 (a), p. 3-22.1; See De La Salle Montessori International of Malolos v. De La Salle Brothers, el al., G.R. No. 205548, February U018. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 278 generic for the goods or services that they seek to identify. It is clear from the law itself, therefore, that what is prohibited is not having a generic mark but having such generic mark being identifiable to the good or service. In one case, it was held that although SAKURA refers to the Japanese flowering cherry and is, therefore, of a generic nature, the manufacturer’s DVD or VCD players and other products could not be identified with cherry blossoms. Hence, the mark can be appropriated.-’10 110. What is a descriptive mark? A term is descriptive and therefore invalid as a trademark if, as understood in its normal and natural sense, it “forthwith conveys the characteristics, functions, qualities or ingredients of a product to one who has never seen it and does not know what it is,” or “if it forthwith conveys an immediate idea of the ingredients, qualities or characteristics of the goods,” or if it clearly denotes what goods or services are provided in such a way that the consumer does not have to exercise powers of perception or imagination.241 Under the IPC, these are marks that consist exclusively of signs or of indications that may serve in trade to designate the kind, quality, quantity, intended purpose, value, geographical origin, time or production of the goods or rendering of the services, or other characteristics of the goods or services.242 Under the IPC, descriptive marks are those that consist exclusively of signs or of indications that may serve in trade to designate the kind, quality, quantity, intended purpose, value, geographical origin, time or production of the goods or rendering of the services, or other characteristics of the goods or services.213 111. Are the following terms generic or descriptive and as such, non-registrable? a) Lyceum (for school) The word “Lyceum” generally refers to a school or an institution of learning. While the Latin word “lyceum” has been incorporated 210Kensonic, Inc. v. Uni-Line Multi-Resources, Inc., G.R. Nos. 211820-21 and 211834-35, June 6, 2018. 21,Societe Des Produits Nestle, ibid. 212Section 123.1(j), IPC, as amended. “Section 123.l(j), IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 279 into the English language, the word is also found in Spanish (liceo) and in French (lycee). “Lyceum” is in fact as generic in character as the word “university.” Since “Lyceum” or “Liceo” denotes a school or institution of learning, it is not unnatural to use this word to designate an entity which is organized and operating as an educational institution.214 b) Master (for coffee) The word MASTER is neither generic nor descriptive and as such, it cannot be invalidated as a trademark. It is instead a suggestive term brought about by the advertising scheme of Nestle. Suggestive terms are those which, in the phraseology of one court, require “imagination, thought and perception to reach a conclusion as to the nature of the goods.” Such terms, “which subtly connote something about the product,” are eligible for protection in the absence of secondary meaning. While suggestive marks are capable of shedding “some light” upon certain characteristics of the goods or services in dispute, they nevertheless involve “an element of incongruity,” “figurativeness,” or “imaginative effort on the part of the observer.” This is evident from the advertising scheme adopted by Nestle in promoting its coffee products. In this case, Nestle has, over time, promoted its products as “coffee perfection worthy of masters.”245 c) Marlboro (for cigarette) The trademark “Marlboro” is not only valid for being neither generic nor descriptive, but because it is also owned exclusively by PMPI as evidenced by the certificate of registration issued by the IPO. It was held that the counterfeit cigarettes seized from petitioner’s possession were intended to confuse and deceive the public as to the origin of the cigarettes intended to be sold, as they not only bore PMPI’s mark, but they were also packaged almost exactly as PMPI’s products.246 d) Papa (for catsup) It is not a generic mark. The Merriam-Webster dictionary defines “Papa” simply as “a person’s father.” True, a person’s father 2,,Lyceum of the Philippines v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 101897, March 5, 1993. 2,5Societe Des Produits Nestle, S.A. v. Court of Appeals and CFC Corporation, G.R. No. 112012, April 4, 2001. 2,80ng v. People of the Philippines, G.R. No. 169440, November 23, 2011. L J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M D1V1NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 280 has no logical connection with catsup products, and that precisely makes "PAPA" as an arbitrary mark capable of being registered, as it is distinctive, coming from a family name that started the brand several decades ago. What was registered was not the word “Papa” as defined in the dictionary, but the word “Papa” as the last name of the original owner of the brand. In fact, being part of several of petitioner's marks, there is no question that the IPO has found "PAPA" to be a registrable mark.24’ e) La Salle (for educational institution) The word salle only means “room” in French. The word la, on the other hand, is a definite article (“the”) used to modify salle. Thus, since salle is nothing more than a room, the use of the tennis actually suggestive. A suggestive mark is therefore a word, picture, or other symbol that suggests, but does not directly describe something about the goods or services in connection with which it is used as a mark and gives a hint as to the quality or nature of the product. Suggestive trademarks therefore can be distinctive and are registrable. The appropriation of the term “la salle" to associate the words with the lofty ideals of education and learning is in fact suggestive because roughly translated, the words only mean “the room.” Thus, the room could be anything—a room in a house, a room in a building, or a room in an office. In fact, the appropriation by the De La Salle Brothers is fanciful, whimsical and arbitrary because there is no inherent connection between the words la salle and education, and it is through their painstaking efforts that the term has become associated with one of the top educational institutions in the country. Even assuming arguendo that la salle means “classroom” in French, imagination is required in order to associate the term with an educational institution and its particular brand of service. The phrase “De La Salle” is not merely a generic term. De La Salle Brothers’ use of the phrase being suggestive and may properly be regarded as fanciful, arbitrary and whimsical, it is entitled to legal protection.248 Fiesta Barrio Manufacturing Corporation, G.R. No. Z4’UFC Philippines 198889, January 20, 2016. z4BDe La Salle Montessori, supra. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE f) 281 San Francisco Coffee (for coffee products) In one case, the petitioner’s argument that “San Francisco” is just a proper name referring to the famous city in California and that “coffee” is simply a generic term was held by the Court to be untenable. The respondent has acquired an exclusive right to the use of the trade name “SAN FRANCISCO COFFEE & ROASTERY, INC.” since the registration of the business name with the DTI in 1995. Thus, respondent’s use of its trade name from then on must be free from any infringement by similarity. Of course, this does not mean that the respondent has exclusive use of the geographic word “San Francisco” or the generic word “coffee.” Geographic or generic words are not, per se, subject to exclusive appropriation. It is only the combination of the words “SAN FRANCISCO COFFEE,” which is respondent’s trade name in its coffee business, that is protected against infringement on matters related to the coffee business to avoid confusing or deceiving the public.219 g) COFFEE-MATE (for coffee) 112. Puregold filed an application for the registration of the trademark "COFFEE MATCH" for use on coffee, tea, cocoa, sugar, artificial coffee, flour and preparations made from cereals, bread, pastry and confectionery, and honey. However, Nestle opposed the same alleging that it is the exclusive owner of the "COFFEE-MATE" trademark and that there is confusing similarity between its "COFFEE-MATE" trademark and Puregold's "COFFEE MATCH" application. Nestle alleged that "COFFEE-MATE" has been declared an internationally wellknown mark and Puregold’s use of "COFFEE MATCH" would indicate a connection with the goods covered in Nestle's "COFFEE-MATE" mark because of its distinct similarity. Is there confusing similarity between COFFEE MATCH and COFFEE­ MATE? No. The word “COFFEE” is the common dominant feature between Nestle’s mark “COFFEE-MATE” and Puregold’s mark “COFFEE MATCH.” However, following the IPC’s prohibition of registration of generic marks, the word “COFFEE” cannot be exclusively appropriated by either Nestle or Puregold since it is generic or descriptive of the goods they seek to identify. The distinctive features of both marks are sufficient to warn the 219Coffee Partners, Inc. v. San Francisco Coffee and Roastery, G.R. No. 169504, March 3,2010. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 282 purchasing public which are Nestle’s products and which are Puregold's products. While both “-MATE” and “MATCH” contain the same first three letters, the last two letters in Puregold’s mark, “C” and “H,” rendered a visual and aural character that made it easily distinguishable from Nestle’s mark. Also, the distinctiveness of Puregold's mark with two separate words with capital letters “C" and “M" made it distinguishable from Nestle’s mark which is one word with a hyphenated small letter “-m” in its mark. In addition, there is a phonetic difference in pronunciation between Nestle’s “-MATE” and Puregold’s “MATCH.” As a result, the eyes and ears of the consumer would not mistake Nestle’s product for Puregold's product. Hence, likelihood of confusion between Nestle’s product and Puregold’s product does not exist.250 h) PALE PILSEN (for beer) The words pale pilsen as part of Asia Brewery’s (ABI) trademark does not constitute an infringement of San Miguel Corporation’s (SMC)trademark: SAN MIGUEL PALE PILSEN, for “pale pilsen” are generic words descriptive of the color (“pale”), of a type of beer (“pilsen”), which is a light bohemian beer with a strong hops flavor that originated in the City of Pilsen in Czechoslovakia and became famous in the Middle Ages. Moreover, ABI’s use of the steinie bottle, similar but not identical to the SAN MIGUEL PALE PILSEN bottle, is not unlawful as SMC did not invent but merely borrowed the steinie bottle from abroad and it has not claimed neither patent nor trademark protection for that bottle shape and design.251 Author’s note: In the case of Coffee Partners, the Supreme Court held that while generic and descriptive terms are not registrable, a combination of such terms to refer to a product is registrable. Yet, the Supreme Court ruled differently in the Puregold and Asia Breuiery/San Miguel Corporation cases. Indeed, there is no hard and fast rule in trademark cases. i) Sakura (for cherry flowers) Sakura is the generic term for Japanese cherry blossom flowers and as such, cannot be registered as a trademark for flowers but it can be registered as a trademark for electronic appliances.252 Puregold Price Club, Inc., G.R. No. 250Societe Des Produits, Nestle, S.A. 217194, September 6, 2017. 251 Asia Brewery, Inc. v. Court of Appeals and San Miguel Corporation, G.R. No. 103543, July 5, 1993. ^Sakura, supra. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 283 113. What are genericidal marks? These are marks that consist exclusively of signs or of indications that have become customary or usual to designate the goods or services in everyday language or in bona fide and established trade practice.253 114. What is a descriptively misleading mark? It is a mark that is likely to mislead the public, particularly as to the nature, quality, characteristics or geographical origin of the goods or services.264 115. In 1988, the FDA approved the labels submitted by Turbo Corporation for its new drug brand name, "Axilon." Turbo is now applying with the Bureau of Patents, Trademarks and Technology Transfer for the registration of said brand name. It was subsequently confirmed that "Accilonne" is a generic term for a class of anti-fungal drugs and is used as such by the medical professional and the pharmaceutical industry, and that it is used as generic chemical name in various scientific and professional publications. A competing drug manufacturer asks you to contest the registration of the brand name "Axilon" by Turbo. What will be your advice? The application for registration by Turbo Corporation may be contested. The Trademark Law would not allow the registration of a trademark which, when applied to or used in connection with his products, is merely descriptive or deceptively mis-descriptive of them. Confusion can result from the use of “Axilon” as the generic product itself.255 116. What is the doctrine of secondary meaning? Under the doctrine of secondary meaning, a word or phrase originally incapable of exclusive appropriation with reference to an article in the market, because it is geographical or otherwise descriptive, might nevertheless have been used so long and so exclusively by one producer with reference to his article that, in J9JC9B0M ^Section 123. l(i), IPC, as amended. “'Section 123.1(g), IPC, as amended. “BAR 1990. J9JC9B0M 284 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II the trade and to that branch of the purchasing public, the word or phrase has come to mean that the article was his produce.250 Thus, a generic or descriptive term which has acquired a secondary meaning may be appropriated and registered as a trademark. For instance, Ang Tibay is a descriptive mark. It means durable in English. But, Ang Tibay had been used so long and the public had associated the mark with the manufacturer of combat shoes. Thus, it was held that the descriptive mark can be registered as trademark for shoes. However, in another case, the Court considered “Lyceum” as a generic name but the number alone of institutions using “Lyceum” as part of their school name suggests strongly that the use of the word "Lyceum” has not been attended with exclusivity for applicability of the doctrine of secondary meaning.257 117. What is the basis of the doctrine of secondary meaning? Section 123.2 of the IPC. It provides that nothing shall prevent the registration of a device (such as color, shape, signs, generic marks) which has become distinctive in relation to the goods for which registration is requested as a result of the use that have been made of it in commerce in the Philippines. The Office may accept as prima facie evidence that the mark has become distinctive, as used in connection with the applicant’s goods or services in commerce, proof of substantially exclusive and continuous use thereof by the applicant in commerce in the Philippines for five (5) years before the date on which the claim of distinctiveness is made. 118. St. Francis Development Corporation (SFDC), a domestic corporation engaged in the real estate business and the developer of St. Francis Square Commercial Center in Ortigas Center, filed complaint for trademark infringement against Shang Properties Realty Corporation (Shang) before the IPO - Bureau of Legal Affairs due to Shang’s use and filing of applications for the registration of the marks "THE ST. FRANCIS TOWER" and "THE ST. FRANCIS SHANGRILA PLACE" for use relative to Shang’s business, particularly the construction of 2SGAna Ang v. Toribio Teodoro, 74 Phil. 56, as cited in Lyceum of the Philippines v. Court of Appeals, 219 SCRA 610 (1993). “’Lyceum of the Philippines v. Court of Appeals, 219 SCRA 610 (1993). VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 285 permanent buildings or structures for residential and office purposes. SFDC alleged that (1) it used "ST. FRANCIS" to identify numerous property development projects in Ortigas Center; and (2) as a use of its continuous projects in Ortigas Center and real estate business, it has gained substantial goodwill with the public that consumers and traders closely identify the mark with its property development projects. On the other hand, Shang contended that the mark with its property cannot be exclusively owned by SFDC since the mark is geographically descriptive of the goods or services for which it is intended to be used. Has SFDC acquired a secondary meaning and, thereby, an exclusive right to the ST. FRANCIS mark? While it is true that SFDC had been using the mark “ST. FRANCIS” since 1992, its use thereof has been merely confined to its realty projects within the Ortigas Center. As its use of the mark is clearly limited to a certain locality, it cannot be said that there was substantial commercial use of the same recognized all throughout the country. Neither is there any showing of a mental recognition in buyers’ and potential buyers’ minds that products connected with the mark “ST. FRANCIS” are associated with the same source — that is, the enterprise of SFDC. Thus, absent any showing that there exists a clear goods/service-association between the realty projects located in the aforesaid area and SFDC as the developer thereof, the latter cannot be said to have acquired a secondary meaning as to its use of the “ST. FRANCIS” mark.258 e. Rights conferred by registration 119. What rights are conferred by the registration of trademark? Except in cases of importation of drugs and medicines which has been introduced in the Philippines or anywhere else in the world by the patent owner, or by any party authorized to use the invention and of off-patent drugs and medicines, the owner of a registered mark shall have the exclusive right to prevent all third parties 258Shang Properties Realty Corporation tion, G.R. No. 190706, July 21, 2014. J9JC9B0M St. Francis Development Corpora- J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 286 not having the owner's consent from using in the course of trade identical or similar signs or containers for goods or services which are identical or similar to those in respect of which the trademark is registered, where such use would result in a likelihood of confusion. In case of the use of an identical sign for identical goods or services, a likelihood of confusion shall be presumed. There shall be no infringement of trademarks or trade names of imported or sold patented drugs and medicines allowed under the IPC, as well as imported or sold off-patent drugs and medicines: provided, hat, said drugs and medicines bear the registered marks that have not been tampered, unlawfully modified, or infringed upon.259 120. When do these rights terminate? The rights conferred by trademark registration end upon cancellation of the certificate of registration by the IPO in the cases allowed by law. 121. When may the IPO cancel the certificate of trademark registration? The certificate of registration may be cancelled in the following cases: a. Failure to file declaration of actual use within one (1) year from the fifth anniversary of the trademark registration;260 b. Failure to file declaration of actual use within three (3) years from filing of the application for trademark registration;261 A petition to cancel a registration of a mark may also be filed with the Bureau of Legal Affairs of the IPO by any person who believes that he is or will be damaged by the registration of a mark under the IPC as follows: i. Within five (5) years from the date of the registration of the mark; ii. At any time, if the registered mark becomes the generic name for the goods or services, or a “’Section 147, in relation to Section 72.1, IPC, as amended. ““Supra. “'Supra. I VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 287 portion thereof, for which it is registered, or has been abandoned, or its registration was obtained fraudulently or contrary to the provisions of the IPC, or if the registered mark is being used by, or with the permission of, the registrant so as to misrepresent the source of the goods or services on or in connection with which the mark is used. C. At any time, if the registered owner of the mark without legitimate reason fails to use the mark within the Philippines, or to cause it to be used in the Philippines by virtue of a license during an uninterrupted period of three (3) years or longer.262 122. In 2005, W Hotels, Inc., a multinational corporation engaged in the hospitality business, applied for and was able to register its trademark "W" with the Intellectual Property Office of the Philippines (IPO) in connection with its hotelsfound in different parts of the world. In 2009, a Filipino corporation, RST Corp., filed before the IPO a Petition for cancellation of W Hotels, Inc.'s "W" trademark on the ground of non-use, claiming that W Hotels, Inc. failed to use its mark in the Philippines because it is not operating any hotel in the country which bears the "W" trademark. In its defense, W Hotels, Inc. maintained that it has used its "W" trademark in the Philippine commerce, pointing out that while it did not have any hotel establishment in the Philippines, it should still be considered as conducting its business herein because its hotel reservation services, albeit for its hotels abroad, are made accessible to Philippine residents through its interactive websites prominently displaying the "W" trademark. W Hotels, Inc also presented proof of actual booking transactions made by the Philippine residents through such websites. Is W Hotels, Inc.'s defense against the petition for cancellation of trademark tenable? Explain.263 The defense of W Hotel is tenable. Having a hotel establishment in the Philippines with the trademark W is not the only way to J9JC9B0M L ^Section 151.1, IPC. !S3BAR 2019. J9JC9B0M 288 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II prove actual use of the trademark. In one case, the Supreme Court ruled that the use of the mark on an interactive website sufficiently showing an intent towards realizing a within-State commercial activity or interaction is considered actual use to keep the trademark registration in force. That W Hotel was able to present proof of actual booking transactions made by the Philippine residents though such website proves that the use of its “W” mark through its interactive website is intended to produce a discernible commercial effect or activity within the Philippines, or at the very least, seeks to establish commercial interaction with local consumers. This is enough to keep it trademark registration in force.264 In the WLand Holdings case, Starwood filed before the IPO an application for registration of the trademark “W” for use in its hotel business which was eventually granted. However, W Land applied for the registration of its own “W” mark which thereby prompted Starwood to oppose the same. The BLA ruled that W Land’s “W" mark is confusingly similar with Starwood’s mark, which had an earlier filing date. Unperturbed, on May 29, 2009, W Land filed a Petition for Cancellation of Starwood’s mark for non-use under Section 151.1 of the Intellectual Property Code of the Philippines, claiming that Starwood has failed to use its mark in the Philippines because it has no hotel or establishment in the Philippines rendering the services covered by its registration. In ruling against the cancellation of Starwood’s “W” mark, the Supreme Court held: “Use” as contemplated by law is genuine use - that is, a bona fide kind of use tending towards a commercial transaction in the ordinary course of trade. Since the internet creates a borderless marketplace, it must be shown that the owner has actually transacted, or at the very least, intentionally targeted customers of a particular jurisdiction in order to be considered as having used the trademark in the ordinary course of his trade in that country. A showing of an actual commercial link to the country is therefore imperative. The use of the mark on an interactive website, for instance, may be said to target local customers when they contain specific details regarding or pertaining to the target State, sufficiently showing an intent towards realizing a within-State commercial activity or 26,W Land Holdings, Inc. v. Starwood Hotels and Resorts Worldwide, Inc., G.R. No. 222366, December 4, 2017. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 289 interaction. These details may constitute a local contact phone number, specific reference being available to local customers, a specific local webpage, whether domestic language and currency is used on the website, and/or whether domestic payment methods are accepted. In this case, Starwood has proven that it owns Philippine registered domain names, provides a phone number for Philippine consumers, the prices for its hotel accommodations and/or services can be converted into the local currency or the Philippine Peso, among others. Taken together, these facts and circumstances show that Starwood’s use of its “W” mark through its interactive website is intended to produce a discernable commercial effect or activity within the Philippines, or at the very least, seeks to establish commercial interaction with local consumers. Accordingly, Starwood’s use of the “W” mark in its reservation services through its website constitutes use of the mark sufficient to keep its registration in force. Finally, it deserves pointing out that Starwood submitted in 2008 its DAU with evidence of use which the IPO, through its Director of Trademarks and later by the IPO DG in the January 10, 2014 Decision, had accepted and recognized as valid. The Court finds no reason to disturb this recognition.265 f. Trademark Infringement 123. What is and when is there trademark infringement? Any person who shall, without the consent of the owner of the registered mark:266 1. Use in commerce any reproduction, counterfeit, copy, or colorable imitation of a registered mark or the same container or a dominant feature thereof in connection with the sale, offering for sale, distribution, advertising of any goods or services including other preparatory steps necessary to carry out the sale of any goods or services on or in connection with which such use is likely to cause confusion, or to cause mistake, or to deceive;267 or 2MW Land Holdings, Inc. v. Starwood Hotels and Resorts Worldwide, Inc., G.R. No. 222366, December 4, 2017, Second Division, Perlas-Bernabe, J. “’'Section 155, IPC, as amended. “’Section 155.1, ibid. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 290 2. Reproduce, counterfeit, copy or colorably imitate a registered mark or a dominant feature thereof and apply such reproduction, counterfeit, copy or colorable imitation to labels, signs, prints, packages, wrappers, receptacles or advertisements intended to be used in commerce upon or in connection with the sale, offering for sale, distribution, or advertising of goods or services on or in connection with which such use is likely to cause confusion, or to cause mistake, or to deceive, shall be liable in a civil action for infringement by the registrant for the remedies hereinafter set forth: provided, that the infringement takes place at the moment any of the acts stated in Subsection 155.1 or this subsection are committed regardless of whether there is actual sale of goods or services using the infringing material.268 124. What are the elements of trademark infringement? There are five (5) elements, to wit: a. The trademark being infringed is registered in the Intellectual Property Office; b. The trademark is reproduced, counterfeited, copied, or colorably imitated by the infringer; c. The infringing mark is used in connection with the sale, offering for sale, or advertising of any goods, business or services; or the infringing mark is applied to labels, signs, prints, packages, wrappers, receptacles or advertisements intended to be used upon or in connection with such goods, business or services; d. The use or application of the infringing mark is likely to cause confusion or mistake or to deceive purchasers or others as to the goods or services themselves or as to the source or origin of such goods or services or the identity of such business; and e. The use or application of the infringing mark is without the consent of the trademark owner or the assignee thereof.269 26BSection 155.2, ibid. 269Diaz v. People of the Philippines and Levi Strauss (Phil.), G.R. No. 180677, February 18, 2013. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 291 In the case of Pearl & Dean,™ it was held that assuming arguendo that “Poster Ads” could validly qualify as a trademark, the failure of Pearl & Dean to secure a trademark registration for specific use on the light boxes meant that there could not have been any trademark infringement since registration was an essential element thereof.271 g- Remedies 125. What are the rights of the trademark owner? a. He may use the trademark in trade and commerce. If he is the first user, he cannot be sued for trademark infringement even though the trademark is registered by the first filer. b. He may register the trademark. c. He may sue for infringement in case of unauthorized use of his registered mark in connection with the sale of the same goods or similar goods which is likely to cause confusion to the public. 126. What are the remedies of the owner of the registered trademark if his rights to the trademark are infringed? He may file a civil action for trademark infringement to recover damages from any person who infringes his rights, and the measure of the damages suffered shall be either the reasonable profit which the complaining party would have made, had the defendant not infringed his rights, or the profit which the defendant actually made out of the infringement, or in the event such measure of damages cannot be readily ascertained with reasonable certainty, then the court may award as damages a reasonable percentage based upon the amount of gross sales of the defendant or the value of the services in connection with which the mark or trade name was used in the infringement of the rights of the complaining party.272 In cases where actual intent to mislead the public or to defraud the complainant is shown, in the discretion of the court, the damages may be doubled.273 ™Supra. ^'Pearl & Dean (Phil.), Inc. Shoemart, Inc., G.R. No. 148222, August 15, 2003. ^Section 156.1, IPC, as amended. ^Section 156.3, IPC, as amended. .. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 292 He may also recover attorney's fees and the costs of suit. The civil action for trademark infringement may include an application with the court for the issuance of an order to impound during the pendency of the action, sales invoices and other documents evidencing sales274 and to grant a preliminary injunction to restrain acts of infringement while the action is pending.276 He may also ask the court to issue an order that goods found to be infringing be, without compensation of any sort, disposed of outside the channels of commerce in such a manner as to avoid any harm caused to the right holder, or destroyed; and all labels, signs, prints, packages, wrappers, receptacles and advertisements in the possession of the defendant, bearing the registered mark or trade name or any reproduction, counterfeit, copy or colorable imitation thereof, all plates, molds, matrices and other means of making the same, shall be delivered up and destroyed.276 He may also file a criminal action for trademark infringement. 127. Is the issuance of an order granting provisional reliefs to the complainant in a trademark infringement suit immediately executory? Under the 2020 Revised Rules of Procedure for Intellectual Property Rights Cases,277 unless restrained by the Supreme Court or the Court of Appeals, as the case may be, any order issued by the court under said Rules is immediately executory, except in the following: a. Order of destruction where a motion for reconsideration is filed; and b. Order of release of seized goods where a search warrant is quashed. 128. What rules govern the issuance of a search and seizure order in cases of trademark or trade name infringement? Court Administrative Matter A.M. No. 02-1-06-SC (TheRuleon Search and Seizure in Civil Actions for Infringement of Intellectual 274Section 156.2, IPC, as amended. z76Section 156.4, IPC, aa amended. 2,6Section 157.1., IPC, as amended. 277A.M. No. 10-3-10-SC. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 293 Property Rights) governs the issuance of a writ of search and seizure in a civil action for infringement filed by an intellectual property right owner against the supposed infringer of his trademark or name. The Rules on the Issuance of the Search and Seizure in Civil Actions for Infringement of Intellectual Property Rights are not applicable in a case where the search warrants were applied in anticipation of criminal actions for violation of intellectual property rights under R.A. No. 8293. Rule 126 of the Revised Rules of Court would apply and a warrant shall be validly issued upon finding the existence of probable cause.278 129. What is the remedy of the owner of the goods in case of wrongful and illegal seizure of goods and materials? The owner may recover damages. The claim for damages should be filed with the same court that issued the writ of search and seizure. However, if the goods were seized pursuant to a search and seizure warrant under the Rules on Criminal Procedure, in anticipation of a criminal offense, the owner has the right to seek damages, if the circumstances warranted, by a separate civil action for the wrong inflicted on them by an improperly obtained or enforced search warrant. The proceeding under Rule 126, a limited criminal one, does not provide for the filing of counterclaims for damages against those who may have improperly sought the issuance of the search warrant.279 130. What are the other remedies available the owner of the registered mark to protect his rights to the trademark? He may oppose any other application for registration of the same trademark, or a dominant feature thereof, for the same goods and services or good and services related thereto. In case of issuance of a certificate of trademark registration in favor of another, he may file a petition for cancellation of trademark with the IPO. 2"Century Chinese Medicine Co., et al. v. People of the Philippines, G.R. No. 188526, November 11, 2013. 2,8Del Rosario, et al. v. Doanto, Jr., et al., G.R. No. 180595, March 4, 2010. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 294 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 131. Does the application for administrative cancellation of a registered trademark preclude the registrant from filing an action for trademark infringement? The application for administrative cancellation of a registered trademark does not preclude the first registrant from filing an action for trademark infringement. Such application cannot per se have the effect of restraining or preventing the courts from the exercise of their lawfully conferred jurisdiction. A contrary rule would unduly expand the doctrine of primary jurisdiction which, simply expressed, would merely behoove regular courts, in controversies involving specialized disputes, to defer to the findings of resolutions of administrative tribunals on certain technical matters.280 However, if the IPO cancels the registered trademark and such resolution has attained finality, the action for trademark infringement will have no more legal stand on. The cancellation of registration of a trademark has the effect of depriving the registrant of protection from infringement from the moment the judgment or order of cancellation has become final.281 The first trademark registrant may however file an action for trademark infringement independently of any application for the administrative cancellation of the trademark of the second registrant. 132. May the defendant in an action for trademark infringement file a petition for administrative cancellation of the registrant's trademark? No, his remedy is to file an answer and invoke as a defense that the plaintiff is not entitled to the trademark registration. This is consistent with Section 151.2 of the IPC that the court or the administrative agency vested with jurisdiction to hear and adjudicate any action to enforce the rights to a registered mark shall likewise exercise jurisdiction to determine whether the registration of said mark may be cancelled in accordance with the Act. The filing of a suit to enforce the registered mark with the proper court or agency ^Conrad and Company v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 115115, July 10, 1995; Shangri-La International Hotel Management v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 111580, June 21, 2001. ■“'Superior Commercial Enterprises, Inc. v. Kunnan Enterprises Ltd. and Sports Concept & Distributor, Inc., G.R. No. 169974, April 20, 2010. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 295 shall exclude any other court or agency from assuming jurisdiction over a subsequently filed petition to cancel the same mark. On the other hand, the earlier filing of petition to cancel the mark with the Bureau of Legal Affairs shall not constitute a prejudicial question that must be resolved before an action to enforce the rights to same registered mark may be decided. 133. What are the limitations to an action for infringement? J9JC9B0M a. The owner shall not be entitled to recover profits or damages unless the acts were committed with knowledge that such imitation is likely to cause confusion. Knowledge is presumed when the registrant gives notice that his mark is registered by displaying with the mark the word “registered mark” or the letter “R” with a circle. Note that good faith is not a defense in a criminal suit for trademark infringement; b. The registered mark shall have no effect against any person who, in good faith before filing or priority date, was using the mark for the purpose of his business; c. Where the infringer who is engaged solely in the business of printing the mark or other infringing materials for others is an innocent infringer, the owner of the right infringed shall only be entitled to injunction against future printing; d. Where the infringement is part of a paid advertisement in a newspaper or magazine or similar periodical or in an electronic communication, the remedy of the owner of the right infringed as against the publishers or distributor shall be limited to injunction against the presentation of such advertising matter in future issues of such papers. Such injunctive relief is not available where restraining the dissemination would delay the delivery of such issue or transmission of such electronic communication, if customarily conduced in accordance with sound business practice.282 h. Unfair Competition “Section 159, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 296 134. Define unfair competition. Unfair competition has been defined as the passing off (or palming off) or attempting to pass off upon the public of the goods or business of one person as the goods or business of another with the end and probable effect of deceiving the public. Passing off (or palming off) takes place where the defendant, by imitative devices on the general appearance of the goods, misleads prospective purchasers into buying his merchandise under the impression that they are buying that of his competitors. Thus, the defendant gives his goods the general appearance of the goods of his competitor with the intention of deceiving the public that the goods are those of his competitor.283 135. When is a person liable for unfair competition? Any person who shall employ deception or any other means contrary to good faith by which he shall pass off the goods manufactured by him or in which he deals, or his business, or services for those of the one having established such goodwill, or who shall commit any acts calculated to produce said result, shall be guilty of unfair competition, and shall be subject to an action therefor.284 In particular, and without in any way limiting the scope of protection against unfair competition, the following shall be deemed guilty of unfair competition: a. Any person, who is selling his goods and gives them the general appearance of goods of another manufacturer or dealer, either as to the goods themselves or in the wrapping of the packages in which they are contained, or the devices or words thereon, or in any other feature of their appearance, which would be likely to influence purchasers to believe that the goods offered are those of a manufacturer or dealer, other than the actual manufacturer or dealer, or who otherwise clothes the goods with such appearance as shall deceive the public and defraud another of his legitimate trade, or any subsequent vendor of such goods or any agent of any vendor engaged in selling such goods with a like purpose; 2S3Republic Gas Corporation v. Patron Corporation, G.R. No. 194062, June 17, 2013; BAR 2019. '^Section 168.2, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 297 b. Any person who by any artifice, or device, or who employs any other means calculated to induce the false belief that such person is offering the services of another who has identified such services in the mind of the public; or C. Any person who shall make any false statement in the course of trade or who shall commit any other act contrary to good faith of a nature calculated to discredit the goods, business or services of another.286 It was held that unfair competition is a transitory or continuing offense. Search warrant may be applied for in any court where any element of the alleged offense was committed.286 136. St. Francis Development Corporation (SFDC), a domestic corporation engaged in the real estate business and the developer of St. Francis Square Commercial Center in Ortigas Center, filed complaint for unfair competition against Shang Properties Realty Corporation (Shang) before the IPO - Bureau of Legal Affairs due to Shang's use and filing of applications for the registration of the marks "THE ST. FRANCIS TOWER" and "THE ST. FRANCIS SHANGRILA PLACE" for use relative to Shang's business, particularly the construction of permanent buildings or structures for residential and office purposes. Is Shang Properties guilty of unfair competition? Shang Properties is not guilty of unfair competition in using the marks ‘THE ST. FRANCIS TOWERS” and THE ST. FRANCIS SHANGRI-LA PLACE.” The “true test” of unfair competition has thus been “whether the acts of the defendant have the intent of deceiving or are calculated to deceive the ordinary buyer making his purchases under the ordinary conditions of the particular trade to which the controversy relates.” It is therefore essential to prove the existence of fraud, or the intent to deceive, actual or probable, determined through a judicious scrutiny of the factual circumstances attendant to a particular case. Here, the element of fraud is wanting; hence, there can be no unfair competition.287 ’“Section 168.3, IPC, as amended. Supergreen, Inc., 518 SCRA 750 ’“Sony Computer Entertainment, Inc. (2007). St. Francis Development 28,Shang Properties Realty Corporation Corporation, G.R. No. 190706, July 21, 2014. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 298 DIVINA (IN COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 137. X, a dealer of low-grade oil, to save on expenses, uses the containers of different companies. Before marketing to the public his low-grade oil, X totally obliterates and erases the brands or marks stenciled on the containers. Y brings an action against X for unfair competition upon its discovery that its containers have been used by X for his low-grade oil. Is there unfair competition? State briefly your reasons. There is no unfair competition. Unfair competition is passing off of one's goods as those of another and requires fraudulent intent on the part of the user. These elements are not present in the problem.288 138. Distinguish trademark infringement from unfair competition. There are four basic distinctions, as follows: a. Infringement of trademark is the unauthorized use of a trademark whereas unfair competition is the passing off one’s goods as those of another; b. In infringement of trademark, fraudulent intent in unnecessary, whereas in unfair competition fraudulent intent is essential;289 In infringement of trademark, prior registration of the trademark is a prerequisite to the action whereas in unfair competition, registration is not necessary;290 d. There is no trademark infringement if the registered trademark is used for totally unrelated to the goods specified in the certificate of trademark registration but there can be unfair competition even if two products are not related if there is passing off of one’s product as that of another manufacturer. 139. Does the act of refilling empty LPG gas cylinder tank bearing a registered trademark amount to infringement or unfair competition or BOTH? The act of refilling empty LPG gas cylinder tank bearing a registered trademark amounts to both trademark infringement and unfair competition. 288BAR 1988. “’BAR 2014. “°Del Monte Corporation 1996; BAR 2015. Court of Appeals, 181 SCRA 410 (1990); BAR VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 299 The mere unauthorized use of a container bearing a registered trademark in connection with the sale, distribution or advertising of goods or services which is likely to cause confusion, mistake or deception among the buyers or consumers can be considered as trademark infringement. The petitioners in this case actually committed trademark infringement when they refilled, without the respondents’ consent, the LPG containers bearing the registered marks of the respondents. There is likewise unfair competition. Petitioners’ acts will inevitably confuse the consuming public, since they have no way of knowing that the gas contained in the LPG tanks bearing respondents’ marks is in reality not the latter’s LPG product after the same had been illegally refilled. The public will then be led to believe that petitioners are authorized refillers and distributors of respondents’ LPG products, considering that they are accepting empty containers of respondents and refilling them for resale. Unfair competition has been defined as the passing off (or palming off) or attempting to pass off upon the public of the goods or business of one person as the goods or business of another with the end and probable effect of deceiving the public. Passing off (or palming off) takes place where the defendant, by imitative devices on the general appearance of the goods, misleads prospective purchasers into buying his merchandise under the impression that they are buying that of his competitors. Thus, the defendant gives his goods the general appearance of the goods of his competitor with the intention of deceiving the public that the goods are those of his competitor. In the present case, respondents pertinently observed that by refilling and selling LPG cylinders bearing their registered marks, petitioners are selling goods by giving them the general appearance of goods of another manufacturer. Obviously, the mere use of those LPG cylinders bearing the trademarks “GASUL” and “SHELLANE” will give the LPGs sold by REGASCO the general appearance of the products of the petitioners.291 In another case, it has been established that the parties conspired in the sale/distribution of counterfeit Greenstone products to the public, which were even packaged in bottles identical to ’’’Republic Gas Corporation v. Petron Corporation, G.R. No. 194062, June 17, 2013. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 300 that of the original, thereby giving rise to the presumption of fraudulent intent. Although there is unfair competition, there can be no trademark infringement considering that the registration of the trademark "Greenstone” - essential as it is in a trademark infringement case - was not proven to have existed during the time the acts complained of were committed.292 Note that in another case, the sale of counterfeit Fundador products had been held to constitute trademark infringement.283 140. Is an action for cancellation of trademark a prejudicial question in a criminal action for unfair competition? It is not. An action for the cancellation of trademark is a remedy available to a person who believes that he is or will be damaged by the registration of a mark. On the other hand, the criminal actions for unfair competition involved the determination of whether or not the respondent had given his goods the general appearance of the goods of the petitioner, with the intent to deceive the public or defraud the petitioner as his competitor. In the suit for the cancellation of trademark, the issue of lawful registration should necessarily be determined, but registration is not a consideration necessary in unfair competition. Indeed, unfair competition is committed if the effect of the act is to pass off to the public the goods of one man as the goods of another; it is independent of registration. One may be declared an unfair competitor even if his competing trademark is registered.294 h. Registration of marks under the Madrid Protocol 141. What is the Madrid Protocol? It is a treaty that allows natural or juridical persons of member countries to file international registrations through their respective trademark offices (as office of origin) designating other member countries to be covered by the international registration. The Madrid System for the International Registration of Marks (Madrid System), which is the centralized system providing a onezwRoberto Co v. Keng Huan, Jerry Yeung and Emma Yeung, G.R. No. 212705, September 10, 2014. a3Juno Batistis v. People of the Philippines, G.R. No. 181571, December 16, 2009. zs’Caterpillar, Inc. v. Manolo P. Samson, G.R. No. 205972 and G.R. No. 164352, November 9, 2016. VIL INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 301 stop solution for registering and managing marks worldwide, allows the trademark owner to file one application in one language, and to pay one set of fees to protect his mark in the territories of up to 97 member-states. The Madrid System is governed by the Madrid Agreement, concluded in 1891, and the Madrid Protocol, concluded in 1989. The Madrid Protocol, which was adopted in order to remove the challenges deterring some countries from acceding to the Madrid. Agreement, has two objectives, namely: (1) to facilitate securing protection for marks; and (2) to make the management of the registered marks easier in different countries.295 142. The Intellectual Property Office of the Philippines (IPOPHL) recommended to the Department of Foreign Affairs (DFA) that the Philippines should accede to the Madrid Protocol. After its own review, the DFA endorsed to the President the country's accession to the Madrid Protocol. Conformably with its express authority under Section 9 of Executive Order No. 459 (Providing for the Guidelines in the Negotiation of International Agreements and its Ratification) dated November 25,1997, the DFA determined that the Madrid Protocol was an executive agreement. President Benigno C. Aquino III ratified the Madrid Protocol through an instrument of accession. The Madrid Protocol entered into force in the Philippines on July 25,2012. The Intellectual Property Association of the Philippines (IPAP) filed a special civil action for certiorari and prohibition to challenge the validity of the President's accession to the Madrid Protocol without the concurrence of the Senate. Furthermore, the IPAP argued that the implementation of the Madrid Protocol, specifically the processing of foreign trademark applications, conflicts with the IP Code considering that Article 2 of the Madrid Protocol means that foreign trademark applicants may file their applications through the International Bureau or the WIPO, and their applications will be automatically granted trademark protection without the need for designating their resident agents in the country. Was the President's ratification of the Madrid Protocol valid and constitutional? I “Intellectual Property Association of the Philippines v. Hon. Paquito Ochoa, In His capacity as Executive Secretary, et al., G.R. No. 204605, July 19,2016. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 302 The President's ratification was valid and constitutional because the Madrid Protocol, being an executive agreement as determined by the Department of Foreign Affairs, does not require the concurrence of the Senate.-’91' 143. Is the Madrid Protocol in conflict with the IPC? There is no conflict between the Madrid Protocol and the IP Code. The IPAP also rests its challenge on the supposed conflict between the Madrid Protocol and the IP Code, contending that the Madrid Protocol does away with the requirement of a resident agent under Section 125 of the IP Code; and that the Madrid Protocol is unconstitutional for being in conflict with the local law, which it cannot modify. The IPAP’s contentions stand on a faulty premise. The method of registration through the IPOPHL, as laid down by the IP Code, is distinct and separate from the method of registration through the WIPO, as set in the Madrid Protocol. Comparing the two methods of registration despite their being governed by two separate systems of registration is thus misplaced In arguing that the Madrid Protocol conflicts with Section 125 of the IP Code, the IPAP highlights the importance of the requirement for the designation of a resident agent. It underscores that the requirement is intended to ensure that non-resident entities seeking protection or privileges under Philippine Intellectual Property Laws will be subjected to the country’s jurisdiction. It submits that without such resident agent, there will be a need to resort to costly, time consuming and cumbersome extraterritorial service of writs and processes. The IPAP misapprehends the procedure for examination under the Madrid Protocol. The difficulty, which the IPAP illustrates, is minimal, if not altogether inexistent. The IPOPHL actually requires the designation of the resident agent when it refuses the registration of a mark. Local representation is further required in the submission of the Declaration of Actual Use, as well as in the submission of the license contract. The Madrid Protocol accords with the intent and spirit of the IP Code, particularly on the subject of the registration of trademarks. The Madrid Protocol does not 2XSupra. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 303 amend or modify the IP Code on the acquisition of trademark rights considering that the applications under the Madrid Protocol are still examined according to the relevant national law. In that regard, the IPOPHL will only grant protection to a mark that meets the local registration requirements.297 1. Coverage 144. Who may use the Madrid registration of trademarks? System for the international An application for international registration (international application) may be filed only by a natural person or legal entity having a connection through establishment, domicile or nationality with a Contracting Party to the Madrid Agreement or the Protocol. A mark may be the subject of an international application only if it has already been registered with the trademark office of the Contracting Party with which the applicant has the necessary connections (referred to as the office of origin). However, where all the designations are effected under the Protocol (see below), the international application may be based simply on an application for registration filed with the office of origin. An international application must be presented to the International Bureau of WIPO through the intermediary of the office of origin.298 2. Rights conferred 145. What are the rights conferred upon international registration of trademark under the Madrid Protocol? From the date of the international registration (or, in the case of a Contracting Party designated subsequently, from the date of that designation), the protection of the mark in each of the designated Contracting Parties is the same as if the mark had been the subject of an application for registration filed directly with the Office of that Contracting Party. If no provisional refusal is notified to the International Bureau within the relevant time limit, or if any such refusal is subsequently withdrawn, the protection of the mark in each designated Contracting Party is the same as if it had been registered by the Office of that Contracting Party. 2'J1Ibid. “•Summary of the Madrid Agreement Concerning the International Registration of Marks (1891) and the Protocol Relating to that Agreement (1989) as prepared by the WIPO. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 304 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II An international registration is therefore equivalent to a bundle of national registrations. Although it is a single registration, protection may be refused by some of the designated Contracting Parties, or the protection may be limited or renounced with respect to only some of the designated Contracting Parties. Likewise an international registration may be transferred to a new owner with respect to only some of the designated Contracting Parties. An international registration may also be invalidated (for example, for non-use) with respect to one or more of the designated Contracting Parties. Moreover, any action for infringement of an international registration must be brought separately in each of the Contracting Parties concerned. 146. What are the requirements for registration under the Madrid Protocol? An application for international registration must designate one or more Contracting Parties in which protection is sought. Further designations can be effected subsequently. A Contracting Party may be designated only if it is party to the same treaty as the Contracting Party whose office is the office of origin. The latter cannot itself be designated in the international application. The designation of a given Contracting Party is made either under the Agreement or the Protocol, depending on which treaty is common to the Contracting Parties concerned. If both Contracting Parties are party to the Agreement and the Protocol, the designation will be governed by the Protocol. International applications can be filed in English, French or Spanish, irrespective of which treaty or treaties govern the application, unless the office of origin restricts that choice to one or two of these languages. Once the International Bureau receives an international application, it carries out an examination for compliance with the requirements of the Protocol and its Regulations. This examination is restricted to formalities, including the classification and comprehensibility of the list of goods and/or services. If there are no irregularities in the application, the International Bureau records the mark in the International Register, publishes the international registration in the WIPO Gazette of International Marks and notifies it to each designated Contracting Party. Any matter of substance, such as whether the mark qualifies for protection or whether it is in conflict with a mark registered previously in a VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 305 particular Contracting Party, is determined by that Contracting Partyts trademark office under the applicable domestic legislation. The office of each designated Contracting Party shall issue a statement of grant of protection under the pertinent Regulations. However, when designated Contracting Parties examine the international registration for compliance with their domestic legislation, and if some substantive provisions are not complied with, they have the right to refuse protection in their territory. Any such refusal, including an indication of the grounds on which it is based, must be communicated to the International Bureau, normally within 12 months from the date of notification. However, a Contracting Party to the Protocol may declare that, when it is designated under the Protocol, this time Emit is extended to 18 months. That Contracting Party may also declare that a refusal based on an opposition may be communicated to the International Bureau even after the 18-month time Emit.299 3. Term of protection 147. What is the term of protection of international registration under the Madrid Protocol? An international registration is effective for 10 years. It may be renewed for further periods of 10 years on payment of the prescribed fees.300 D. Copyright 1. Basic Principles 148. What is a copyright? It is an intangible, incorporeal right granted by statute to the author or originator of certain literary or artistic productions, whereby he or she is invested, for a specific period, with the sole and exclusive privilege of multiplying copies of the same and pubhshing and selling them.301 mSupra. mIbid. “‘Kensonic v. Uni-Line Multi Resources, Inc., supra and Fernando Juan v. Roberto Juan, G.R. No. 221372, August 23, 2017 both citing Black’s Law Dictionary, Centennial Edition. 6th ed. West Group, St. Paul Minnesota, USA, 1990, p. 336. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: z\ COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 306 The rights granted by copyright are, however, not limited to multiplying copies of the literary or artistic work, publishing and selling but also include any form of communication to the public, as well as right of attribution, right to carry out derivative work and other moral rights. Copyright is likewise not confined to literary and artistic work but also extend to scientific and scholarly works similar to those works enumerated in Section 172.1 of the IPC. As previously mentioned, copyright should be defined then as an incorporeal and intangible property granted by law to the originator or creator of certain literary, artistic, scientific and scholarly works whereby he or she is invested for a specific period of time a collection of economic and moral rights on the terms specified by statute. 149. What are the characteristics of a copyright? a. It is granted to the creator or originator of the copyrightable work. But being a right, copyright can be assigned; b. The object is original intellectual creation in the literary, artistic and scientific domains; c. It is not indefinite. The economic and moral rights are exclusive to the creator or originator of the work during the term specified by law, except for the moral right of attribution which is in perpetuity. d. Being a statutory grant, the rights derived from such grant may only be obtained and enjoyed with respect to the works and on the terms and conditions, specified in the statute. The “works” must fall within the statutory enumeration or description. For example, eye bushing is a useful article but it has no artistic value. Even though it was covered by a certificate of registration and there was notice of deposit with the National Library, no copyright is obtained. There can be no infringement of copyright likewise despite sale by others of such article.302 Other examples of items were there is no copyright: a. Light boxes. They are not in the nature of pictorials or drawings. Light boxes—units which utilize specially “Jessie G. Ching v. William M. Salinas, Sr., et al., G.R. No. 161295, June 29, 2005. - VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 307 printed posters sandwiched between plastic sheets and illuminated with backlights—are not literary or artistic pieces which could be copyrighted under the copyright law;303 b. Medical creams and the name and container of a beauty cream product;30* c. There is no copyright on goods because they are not intellectual creations. They should be covered by trademark instead.305 2. Copyrightable Works 150. When is the starting point of protection of a Copyright? Works are protected by the sole fact of their creation, irrespective of their mode or form of expression, as well as of their content, quality and purpose.306 151. What are the classifications of protected works? There are two: Original and literary works; and a. b. Derivative works. 152. What are considered original literary and artistic works? Literary and artistic works are original intellectual creations in the literary and artistic domain protected from the moment of their creation and shall include in particular: a. Books, pamphlets, articles and other writings; b. Periodicals and newspapers; c. Lectures, sermons, addresses, dissertations prepared for oral delivery, whether or not reduced in writing or other material form;307 “Pearl & Dean Phil. v. Shoemart, 409 SCRA 231 (2003). “Elidad C. Kho, doing business under the name and style of KEC Cosmetics Laboratory v. Court of Appeals, Summerville General Merchandising and Company, andAngTiam Chay, G.R. No. 115758, March 19, 2002. “Manly Sportwear Manufacturing, Inc. v. Dadodette Enterprises and/or Hermes Sports Center, G.R. No. 165306, September 20, 2005. “Section 172.2, IPC, as amended. “BAR 2011. ! J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 308 d. e. f. g- h. i. Letters: Dramatic or dramatico-musical compositions; choreo­ graphic works or entertainment in dumb shows; Musical compositions, with or without words; Works of drawing, painting, architecture, sculpture, engraving, lithography or other works of art; models or designs for works of art; Original ornamental designs or models for articles of manufacture, whether or not registrable as an industrial design, and other works of applied art; Illustrations, maps, plans, sketches, charts and threedimensional works relative to geography, topography, architecture or science; j. Drawings or plastic works of a scientific or technical character; k. Photographic works including works produced by a process analogous to photography; lantern slides; Audiovisual works and cinematographic works and works produced by a process analogous to cinematography or any process for making audio-visual recordings; 1. m. n. o. Pictorial illustrations and advertisements; Computer programs; and Other literary, scholarly, scientific, and artistic works.308 153. Diana and Piolo are famous personalities in show business who kept their love affair secret. They use a special instant messaging service which allows them to see one another's typing on their own screen as each letter key is pressed. When Greg, the controller of the service facility, found out their identities, he kept a copy of all the messages Diana and Piolo sent each other and published them. Is Greg liable for copyright infringement? Reason briefly. Yes, Greg is liable for copyright infringement. Under the law, text messages are not expressly enumerated as among the copyrightable works. In the context of the problem, however, these messages are akin to letters or may at least fall under “other literary, “’Section 172.1, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 309 artistic, scientific and scholarly works.” They are therefore protected from the moment of creation. ™ The publication of the messages without the consent of their writers constitutes infringement of copyright.310 154. Is the name "Charlie Brown" and its pictorial representation copyrightable? Yes, as provided for under Section 172.1 of the IPC. Since copyright was obtained thereon, the owner can prevent its use as trademark by somebody else.3” 155. Is a hatch door, which is defined as a small door, small gate or an opening that resembles a window equipped with an escape for use in case of fire or emergency, copyrightable? Hatch door is not copyrightable. It is by nature, functional and utilitarian serving as egress access during emergency. It is not primarily an artistic creation but rather an object of utility designed to have aesthetic appeal. It is intrinsically a useful article, which, as a whole, is not eligible for copyright. Thus, the first fabricator of the hatch door cannot sue for copyright infringement all other fabricators of the same article. What is copyrightable is the drawing or the sketch of the hatch door itself. Reproduction of the drawing or sketch without the consent of the creator constitutes copyright infringement.312 There is also no copyright infringement even if the hatch door is fabricated based on the copyrighted drawing or- sketch. Unlike a patent, a copyright gives no exclusive right to the art disclosed; protection is given only to the expression of the idea not the idea itself.”3 156. Isa useful article copyrightable? A “useful article” defined as an article “having an intrinsic utilitarian function that is not merely to portray the appearance ’“’Section 172.1, IPC, as amended; Columbia Pictures, Inc. v. Court of Appeals, 261 SCRA 144 (1996). ’’“BAR 2007. ’’’United Features v. Munsingwear Creation, 179 SCRA 260 (1989). ”2Sison Olano, et al. v. Lim Eng Co., G.R. No. 195835, March 14, 2016. ™Ibid. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 310 of the article or to convey information” is excluded from copyright eligibility. The only instance when a useful article may be the subject of copyright protection is when it incorporates a design element that is physically or conceptually separable from the underlying product. This means that the utilitarian article can function without the design element. In such an instance, the design element is eligible for copyright protection. The design of a useful article shall be considered a pictorial, graphic, or sculptural work only if, and only to the extent that, such design incorporates pictorial, graphic, or sculptural features that can be identified separately from, and are capable of existing independently of, the utilitarian aspects of the article. A belt, being an object utility with the function of preventing one’s pants from falling down, is in itself not copyrightable. However, an ornately designed belt buckle which is irrelevant to or did not enhance the belt’s function hence, conceptually separable from the belt, is eligible for copyright. It is copyrightable as a sculptural work with independent aesthetic value, and not as an integral element of the belt’s functionality. A table lamp is not copyrightable because it is a functional object intended for the purpose of providing illumination in a room. The general shape of a table lamp is likewise not copyrightable because it contributes to the lamp’s ability to illuminate the reaches of a room. But, a lamp base in the form of a statue of male and female dancing figures made of semi vitreous china is copyrightable as a work of art because it is unrelated to the lamp’s utilitarian function as a device used to combat darkness.314 Based on this test, hatch doors may become copyrightable if they bear design elements that are physically and conceptually separable, independent and distinguishable from the hatch door itself. 157. TRUE or FALSE. The Denicola Test in intellectual property law states that if design elements of an article reflect a merger of aesthetic and functional considerations, the artistic aspects of the work cannot be conceptually separable from the utilitarian aspects; thus, the article cannot be copyrighted. 3uIbid. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 311 True. Applying the Denicola Test in Brandir International, Inc. v. Cascade Pacific Lumber Co.,™ the United State Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit held that if there is any aesthetic element which can be separated from the utilitarian elements, then the aesthetic element may be copyrighted.316 158. What are derivative works? The following are considered derivative works and shall also be protected by copyright: a. Dramatizations, translations, adaptations, abridgments, arrangements, and other alterations of literary or artistic works; and b. Collections of literary, scholarly or artistic works, and compilations of data and other materials which are original by reason of the selection or coordination or arrangement of their contents.317 159. What is the treatment over derivative works? They shall be protected as new works: provided however, that such new work shall not affect the force of any subsisting copyright upon the original works employed or any part thereof, or be construed to imply any right to such use of the original works, or to secure or extend copyright in such original works.318 One of the economic rights of the author is to carry out, prevent or authorize derivative work.319 Thus, no one carry out a work derived from the original work except the author or without his authorization. 160. Does a publisher have a right over the published edition of the copyrighted work? Yes. In addition to the right to publish granted by the author, his heirs, or assigns, the publisher shall have a copyright consisting merely of the right of reproduction of the typographical arrangement of the published edition of the work.320 J9JC9B0M “834 F.2d 1142, 1988 Copr.L.Dec. p. 26. “BAR 2009. “Section 173.1, IPC, as amended. “Section 173.2, IPC, as amended. “Section 177, IPC, as amended. “Section 174, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 312 Typographical arrangement covers the layout, composition, style and general appearance of a page of a published work.321 In other words, the visual appearance of the printed page is independently copyrightable from the contents of the published work. 161. What are considered as unprotected subject matter or noncopyrightable work? a. Idea, procedure, system, method or operation, concept, principle, discovery or mere data as such, even if they are expressed, explained, illustrated or embodied in a work; b. News of the day and other miscellaneous facts having the character of mere items of press information; c. Any official text of a legislative, administrative or legal nature, as well as any official translation thereof;322 d. Any work of the Government of the Philippines. However, prior approval of the government agency or office wherein the work is created shall be necessary for exploitation of such work for profit. Such agency or office may, among other things, impose as a condition the payment of royalties; e. Statutes, rules and regulations, and speeches, lectures, sermons, addresses, and dissertations, pronounced, read or rendered in courts of justice, before administrative agencies, in deliberative assemblies and in meetings of public character.323 However, the author of speeches, lectures, sermons, addresses, and dissertations of these works shall have the exclusive right of making a collection of his works.324 a. Idea, procedure, system, method or operation, concept, principle, discovery or mere data as such, even if they are expressed, explained, illustrated or embodied in such work. 321Gepty, ibid., p. 155 citing Carol Tullo, Controller, HMSO Queen’s Printer, Guidance-Copyright in Typographical Arrangement. 322Section 175, IPC, as amended. “'‘Section 176.1, IPC, as amended. 324Section 176.2, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 313 The format or mechanics of a television show is not included in the list of protected works in Section 2 of P.D. No. 49, which is substantially the same as Section 172 of the Intellectual Property Code (R.A. No. 8293). The subject of copyright refers to finished works and not to concepts. For this reason, the protection afforded by the law cannot be extended to cover format or mechanics of a television show. The audio-visual recording of the show, however, is copyrightable.325 While an idea is not copyrightable, the expression of an idea is protected by copyright. Thus, there can be a copyright of a book which expounded on a new accounting system the author had developed but the system itself is not copyrightable. 162. An amateur astronomer, stumbled upon what appeared to be massive volcanic eruption in Jupiter while peering at the planet through his telescope. The following week, X, without notes, presented a lecture on his findings before the Association of Astronomers of the Philippines. To his dismay, he later read an article in a science journal written by Y, a professional astronomer, repeating exactly what X discovered without any attribution to him. Has Y infringed on X's copyright, if any?326 a. No, since X did not reduce his lecture in writing or other material form; b. Yes, since the lecture is considered X’s original work; c. No, since no protection extends to any discovery, even if expressed, explained, illustrated, or embo­ died in a work; d. Yes, since Y7s article failed to make any attribution to X. 163. X came up with a new way of presenting a telephone directory in a mobile phone, which he dubbed as the "iTel" and which uses lesser time for locating names and telephone numbers. May X have his "iTel" copyrighted in his name?327 a. No. because it is a mere system or method; ’“Francisco Joaquin, Jr. v. Franklin Drilon, et al., G.R. No. 108946, January 28,1999. “BAR 2011. “BAR 2011. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 314 b. Yes. because it is an original creation; C. Yes, because it entailed the application of X’s intellect; d. No. because it did not entail any application of X’s intellect. b. News of the day 164. Overseas Filipino worker Angelo dela Cruz was kidnapped by Iraqi militants and as a condition for his release, a demand was made for the withdrawal of Filipino troops in Iraq. After negotiations, he was released by his captors and was scheduled to return to the country. Occasioned by said homecoming and the public interest it generated, both GM A Network, Inc. and ABS-CBN made their respective broadcasts and coverage of the live event. ABS-CBN conducted live audio-video coverage of and broadcasted the event. ABS-CBN allowed Reuters Television Service (Reuters) to air the footages it had taken earlier under a special embargo agreement. ABS-CBN alleged that under the special embargo agreement, no other Philippine subscriber of Reuters would be allowed to use ABS-CBN footage without the latter's consent. GMA-7 subscribes to Reuters. It received a live video feed of the coverage of Angelo dela Cruz's arrival from Reuters. GMA-7 immediately carried the live newsfeed in its program "Flash Report," together with its live broadcast. Allegedly, GMA-7 did not receive any notice or was not aware that Reuters was airing footages of ABS-CBN. ABS-CBN filed the Complaint for copyright infringement under Sections 177and 211 of the Intellectual Property Code against Felipe Gozon and other officers of GMA 7. Is the news footage of ABS CBN copyrightable? The event itself is not copyrightable because that is the newsworthy event. However, any footage created from the event itself is an intellectual creation which is copyrightable. While news of the day and other miscellaneous facts having the character of “mere items of press information” are considered unprotected subject matter, the Code does not state that expression of the news VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 315 of the day, particularly when it underwent a creative process, is not entitled to protection.328 Stated otherwise, copyright protection does not extend to news “events” or the facts or ideas which are the subject of news reports. But it is equally well-settled that copyright protection does extend to the reports themselves, as distinguished from the substance of the information contained in the reports. Copyright protects the manner of expression of news reports, “the particular form or collocation of words in which the writer has communicated it.”329 3. Rights of the copyright owner 165. What is the scope of protection of a copyright? It is immediate. The aforementioned literary and artistic works are protected from the moment of their creation. Works are protected by the sole fact of their creation, irrespective of their mode or form of expression, as well as of their content, quality and purpose.330 Ownership of copyrighted material is shown by proof of originality and copyrightability.331 166. What then is the effect of registration and deposit with the National Library? The certificates of registration and deposit issued by the National Library serve merely as a notice of recording and registration of the work but do not confer any right or title upon the registered copyright owner or automatically put his work under the protective mantle of the copyright law; it is not a conclusive proof of copyright ownership. Hence, it was held that when there is sufficient proof that the copyrighted products are not original creations but are readily available in the market under various brands, as in one case, validity and originality will not be presumed.332 ’“ABS-CBN Corporation v. Felipe Gozon, el al., G.R. No. 195956, March 11, 2015. ’“Ibid. ““Section 172.1, IPC, as amended. “'Sison Olano, ibid. ““Manly Sportwear Manufacturing, Inc. v. Dadodette Enterprises and/or Hermes Sports Center, G.R. No. 165306, September 20, 2005. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 316 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II It was held that the Intellectual Property Code does not require registration of the work to fully recover in an infringement suit.333 A copyright certificate nevertheless creates a presumption of the validity and ownership of the copyright and as such, is useful in support of the claim of infringement. This presumption, however, is rebuttable and it cannot be sustained where other evidence in the record casts doubt on the question of ownership.331 Moreover, the presumption of validity to a certificate of copyright registration merely orders the burden of proof. The applicant should not ordinarily be forced, in the first instance, to prove all the multiple facts that underline the validity of the copyright unless the respondent, effectively challenging them, shifts the burden of doing so to the applicant.335 167. Rudy is a fine arts student in a university. He stays in a boarding house with Bernie as his roommate. During his free time, Rudy would paint and leave his finished works lying around the boarding house. One day, Rudy saw one of his works, an abstract painting entitled Manila Traffic Jamon display at the university cafeteria. The cafeteria operator said he purchased the painting from Bernie who represented himself as its painter and owner. Rudy and the cafeteria operator immediately confronted Bernie. While admitting that he did not do the painting, Bernie claimed ownership of its copyright since he had already registered it in his name with the National Library as provided in the Intellectual Property Code. Who owns the copyright to the painting? Explain. Rudy owns the copyright to the painting because he was the one who actually created it. His rights existed from the moment of its creation. The registration of the painting by Bernie with the National Library did not confer copyright upon him. The registration is merely for the purpose of completing the records of the National Library and creating a presumption of ownership and validity of the copyright.336 333ABS-CBN v. Gozon, March 11, 2015. 331Sison Olano, ibid. ^Supra. 336BAR 2013. V1L INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 317 168. Juan Xavier wrote and published a story similar to an unpublished copyrighted story of Manoling Santiago. It was, however, conclusively proven that Juan Xavier was not aware that the story of Manoling Santiago was protected by copyright. Manoling Santiago sued Juan Xavier for infringement of copyright. Is Juan Xavier liable? Yes. Juan is liable for infringement of copyright. It is not necessary that Juan is aware that the story of Manoling was protected by copyright. The work of Manoling is protected from the time of its creation.337 169. What rights are derived from a Copyright? There are two classifications of rights derived from a copyright: a. Economic rights; and b. Moral rights. 170. What are economic rights? Copyright or economic rights shall consist of the exclusive right to carry out, authorize or prevent the following acts:338 J9JC9B0M a. Reproduction of the work or substantial portion of the work; b. Dramatization, translation, adaptation, abridgment, arrangement or other transformation of the work; c. The first public distribution of the original and each copy of the work by sale or other forms of transfer of ownership; d. Rental of the original or a copy of an (i) audiovisual, or (ii) cinematographic work, (iii) a work embodied in a sound recording, (iv) a computer program, (v) a compilation of data and other materials, or (vi) a musical work in graphic form, irrespective of the ownership of the original or the copy which is the subject of the rental; e. Public display of the original or a copy of the work; f. Public performance of the work; and & Other communication to the public of the work. 337BAR 1998. ““Section 177, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 318 Reproduction 171. What is the test of substantiality? To constitute infringement, it is not necessary that the whole or even a large portion of the work shall have been copied. If so much is taken that the value of the original is sensibly diminished, or the labors of the original author are substantially and to an injurious extent appropriated by another, that is sufficient in point of law to constitute piracy. In cases of infringement, copying alone is not what is prohibited. The copying must produce an injurious effect.3” 172. What are the instances when reproduction of the work is legally permissible? a. Quotations from a published work if they are compatible with fair use and only to the extent justified for the purpose, including quotations from newspaper articles and periodicals in the form of press summaries: provided, that the source and the name of the author, if appearing on the work, are mentioned;340 b. The reproduction or communication to the public by mass media of (i) articles on current political, social, economic, scientific or religious topics; (ii) lectures, addresses and other works of the same nature, which are delivered in public if such use is for information purposes and has not been expressly reserved: provided, that the source is clearly indicated;341 c. The reproduction and communication to the public of literary, scientific or artistic works as part of reports of current events by means of photography, cinematography or broadcasting to the extent necessary for the purpose;311 d. The private reproduction of a published work in a single copy, where the reproduction is made by a natural person exclusively for research and private study, shall be permitted, without the authorization of the owner of ’’’Pacita, et al. ■ Felicidad Robles and Goodwill Trading Co., Inc., G.R. No. 131522, July 19, 1999. ^“Section 184.1(b), IPC, as amended. ’"Section 184.1(C), as amended. ’"Section 184.1(D), as amended. I r J9JC9B0M VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 319 copyright in the work. The permission granted under this section shall not extend to the reproduction of:"’ iii. A work of architecture in the form of building or other construction; An entire book, or a substantial part thereof, or of a musical work in graphic form by reprographic means; A compilation of data and other materials; iv. A computer program. i. ii. e. Any library or archive whose activities are not for profit may, without the authorization of the author of copyright owner, make a single copy of the work by reprographic reproduction:344 i. Where the work by reason of its fragile character or rarity cannot be lent to users in its original form; ii. Where the works are isolated articles contained in composite works or brief portions of other published works and the reproduction is necessary to supply them, when this is considered expedient, to persons requesting their loan for purposes of research or study instead of lending the volumes or booklets which contain them; and iii. Where the making of such a copy is in order to preserve and, if necessary in the event that it is lost, destroyed or rendered unusable, replace a copy, or to replace, in the permanent collection of another similar library or archive, a copy which has been lost, destroyed or rendered unusable and copies are not available with the publisher. f. Every library which, by law, is entitled to receive copies of a printed work, shall be entitled, when special reasons so require, to reproduce a copy of a published work which is considered necessary for the collection of the library but which is out of stock.346 “Section 187, IPC, as amended. ’"Section 188, IPC, as amended. “Section 13, P.D. No. 49a. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 320 g- The reproduction in one (1) back-up copy or adaptation of a computer program shall be permitted, without the authorization of the author of, or other owner of copyright in. a computer program, by the lawful owner of that computer program: provided, that the copy or adaptation is necessary for:340 The use of the computer program in conjunction i. with a computer for the purpose, and to the extent, for which the computer program has been obtained; and Archival purposes, and, for the replacement of the ii. lawfully owned copy of the computer program in the event that the lawfully obtained copy of the computer program is lost, destroyed or rendered unusable. Derivative right 173. How many works are protected if the author, or another person with the consent of the author, makes a transformation of the original work? There are two works protected and covered by copyright, the original and the derivative work. However, if the transformation of the original work was done after the term of the copyright, then, only one copyright subsists—that of the derivative work. 174. Who can carry out derivative work on the original work of the author? The author has the exclusive privilege to carry out derivative work of his original work. During the term of the copyright, the author may authorize person to carry out the derivative work. First public distribution 175. What is the first sale doctrine? The first sale doctrine provides that an individual who knowingly purchases a copy of a copyrighted work from the copyright holder receives the right to sell, display or otherwise dispose of that particular copy, notwithstanding the interests of the copyright owner. 31cSection 189, IPC, as amended. r VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 321 The copyright holder’s right to control the distribution of his work goes away after the “first sale” of the work. The “First Sale Doctrine” is codified in U.S. copyright law at 17 U.S.C. Section 109. The doctrine is mirrored in our own copyright laws. This principle is also called the “exhaustion” principle. It also applies to patent. 176. KK is from Bangkok, Thailand. She studies medicine in the Pontifical University of Santo Tomas (UST). She learned that the same foreign books prescribed in UST are 40-50% cheaper in Bangkok. So she ordered 50 copies of each book for herself and her classmates and sold the books at 20% less than the price in the Philippines. XX, the exclusive licensed publisher of the books in the Philippines, sued KK for copyright infringement. Decide. KK did not commit copyright infringement. Under the “first sale” doctrine, the economic rights of the author relevant to the question extend only to the first public distribution of each original copy. After the first sale of the original copies, the owner may use and re-sell the same. Hence, there is no infringement by KK since the said doctrine permitted resale without the publisher’s further permission.347 177. What is the right of Droite de Suite? Droite de Suite means right to follow. This means that in every sale or lease of an original work of painting or sculpture or of the original manuscript of a writer or composer, subsequent to the first disposition thereof by the author, the author or his heirs shall have an inalienable right to participate in the gross proceeds of the sale or lease to the extent of five percent (5%). This right shall exist during the lifetime of the author and for 50 years after his death. 178. May the purchaser of a copyrighted book reproduce it or create a derivative work out of it? No, the purchaser may only distribute the work, without incurring liability, but cannot reproduce or carry out derivative "’BAR 2014; Kirtsaeng v. John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 568 U.S 319, 213 WL 1104736 (U.S Mar. 19, 2013), cited in Gepty, ibid., p. 179. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 322 work out of it. The rights of reproduction and transformation are distinct from the right of first public distribution. Renta! right 179. May the buyerorassigneeofan audiovisual or cinematographic work, work embodied in a sound recording, a computer program, or musical work lease or rent such work without the consent of its creator following the first sale doctrine? No, the above-enumerated works cannot be rented out to others without the consent of the copyright holder. The right of rental is a distinct economic right which is not covered by the first sale doctrine. However, works not covered by the foregoing enumeration, like books, may be leased out for profit by the buyer, without the consent of the copyright owner. Right of public display 180. Raphael is an internationally well-known and award-winning painter. Alvaro is the President of world-wide organization devoted to works of charity and the spread of the norms of hope, fortitude, and serenity in the face of a global pandemic that has brought desolation to humanity. Alvaro's mother Maricor is the Chairperson. Alvaro commissioned Raphael to do a painting with a theme of inspiring mankind to be filled with faith and hope amid difficulties. After eight (8) months, he finished the work of art. Despite the painstaking effort that went with it, he is not proud of his opus. He showed it to his friends, Javier, Gabriel and Michael who were all in tremendous awe and considered it a magnum opus-comparable to, if not better than, the works of the Masters. May Alvaro organize an open for all exhibit to display the great work of Raphael? Under Section 178.4 of the IPC, as amended, the person who commissioned the work shall have ownership of the work but the copyright thereto pertains to the creator unless there is stipulation to the contrary. Therefore, while Alvaro owns the painting, the copyright belongs to Raphael. The right to display is one of the economic rights of the creator. Thus, unless Raphael allows it, Alvaro cannot publicly display the painting of Raphael. r VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 323 If Raphael did not transfer the copyright to Alvaro, may Alvaro organize an exhibit among his close friends and display the painting of Raphael? Yes, Alvaro may display the painting to his close friends. What is prohibited is the public display of the copyrighted work. A public display is generally accepted to mean a display at a place open to the public or where a substantial number of persons outside of a normal circle of family or its social acquaintances are gathered.348 flig/it of public performance 181. What is public performance? “Public performance”, in the case of a work other than an audiovisual work, is the recitation, playing, dancing, acting or otherwise performing the work, either directly or by means of any device or process; in the case of an audiovisual work, the showing of its images in sequence and the making of the sounds accompanying it audible; and, in the case of a sound recording, making the recorded sounds audible at a place or at places where persons outside the normal circle of a family and that family’s closest social acquaintances are or can be present, irrespective of whether they are or can be present at the same place and at the same time, or at different places and/or at different times, and where the performance can be perceived without the need for communication within the meaning of Subsection 171.3 of the Intellectual Property Code.349 Right of communication to the public 182. What does communication to the public, as an economic right, mean? “Communication to the public” or “communicate to the public” means the making of a work available to the public by wire or wireless means in such a way that members of the public may access these works from a place and time individually chosen by them.350 318Gepty, ibid., p.181 citing Nimmer on Copyright and Amador, Copyright under the Intellectual Property Code. “Section 171.6, IPC, as amended. “Section 171.3, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 321 183. What are the so-called moral rights of a copyright holder? The author of a work shall, independently of the economic rights or the grant of an assignment or license with respect to such right, have the following moral rights:361 a. To require that the authorship of the works be attributed to him. in particular, the right that his name, as far as practicable, be indicated in a prominent way on the copies, and in connection with the public use of his work; (“Right of attribution”) b. To make any alterations of his work prior to, or to withhold it from publication; c. To object to any distortion, mutilation or other modification of, or other derogatory action in relation to, his work which would be prejudicial to his honor or reputation; (“Right of integrity”) and d. To restrain the use of his name with respect to any work not of his own creation or in a distorted version of his work.352 (“Right against false attribution”) 184. SJ, a computer genius, commissioned Wl, former managing editor of the largest publishing company in the world, to write SJ's autobiography. SJ, preoccupied by his overwhelming ambition to grow his company to be able to offer technological products that will benefit mankind, did not get to spend much time with his children. His intention in having the autobiography is for his children to get to know the real SJ—his virtues and frailties. Wl accepted the engagement on one condition—it will be a no holds barred account of SJ's life. SJ agreed. But after the finishing the book, Wl is not happy with it and refuse to publish it. May SJ compel Wl to publish the book? The copyright to the book belongs to Wl unless otherwise stipulated. Therefore, it is within his moral rights to withhold the book from publication. Also, an author cannot be compelled to perform his contract to create a work or for the publication of his work already in existence. “‘Section 193, IPC, as amended. ““Section 34, P.D. No. 49; BAR 1995. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 325 However, he may be held liable for damages for breach of such contract.3*3 185. May the moral rights to a copyright be waived? An author may waive his rights by a written instrument, but no such waiver shall be valid where its effect is to permit another:364 a) To use the name of the author, or the title of his work, or otherwise to make use of his reputation with respect to any version or adaptation of his work which, because of alterations therein, would substantially tend to injure the literary or artistic reputation of another author;356 or b) To use the name of the author with respect to a work he did not create.356 Also, when an author contributes to a collective work, his right to have his contribution attributed to him is deemed waived unless he expressly reserves it.367 186. What is the term of moral right? All moral rights shall be coterminous with the economic rights of the author or creator of the work except the right of attribution, which is in perpetuity.358 4. Rules on Ownership of Copyright 187. What rules govern copyright ownership? Copyright ownership shall be governed by the following rules: J9JC9B0M a. In the case of original literary and artistic works, copyright shall belong to the author of the work;369 b. In the case of works of joint authorship, the co-authors shall be the original owners of the copyright and in the absence of agreement, their rights shall be governed by ’“Section 194, IPC, as amended. 35'Section 195, IPC, as amended. “’Section 195.1, ibid. “Section 195.2, ibid. “’Section 196, IPC, as amended. “’Section 198.1 as amended by R.A. No. 10372. “’Section 178.1, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 326 the rules on co-ownership. If, however, a work of joint authorship consists of parts that can be used separately and the author of each part can be identified, the author of each part shall be the original owner of the copyright in the part that he has created;”0 c. d. e. f. In the case of work created by an author during and in the course of his employment, the copyright shall belong to: i. The employee, if the creation of the object of copyright is not a part of his regular duties even if the employee uses the time, facilities and materials of the employer. ii. The employer, if the work is the result of the performance of his regularly-assigned duties, unless there is an agreement, express or implied, to the contrary.361 In the case of a work commissioned by a person other than an employer of the author, and who pays for it, and the work is made in pursuance of the commission, the person who so commissioned the work shall have ownership of the work, but the copyright thereto shall remain with the creator, unless there is a written stipulation to the contrary;”2 In the case of audiovisual work, the copyright shall belong to the producer, the author of the scenario, the composer of the music, the film director, and the author of the work so adapted. However, subject to contrary or other stipulations among the creators, the producer shall exercise the copyright to an extent required for the exhibition of the work in any manner, except for the right to collect performing license fees for the performance of musical compositions, with or without words, which are incorporated into the work;363 In respect of letters, the copyright shall belong to the writer subject to the provisions of Article 723 of the Civil Code.364 The publishers shall be deemed to represent the ““Section “'Section “"Section “’Section “‘Section 178.2, ibid. 178.3, ibid. 178.4, ibid. 178.5, ibid. 178.6, ibid. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 327 authors of articles and other writings published without the names of the authors or under pseudonyms, unless the contrary appears, or the pseudonyms or adopted name leaves no doubt as to the author’s identity, or if the author of the anonymous works discloses his identity.366 188. Eloise, an accomplished writer, was hired by Petong to write a bimonthly newspaper column for Diario de Manila, a newlyestablished newspaper of which Petong was the editor-inchief. Eloise was to be paid P1,000 for each column that was published. In the course of two (2) months, Eloise submitted three (3) columns which, after some slight editing, were printed in the newspaper. However, Diario de Manila proved unprofitable and closed only after two (2) months. Due to the minimal amounts involved, Eloise chose not to pursue any claim for payment from the newspaper, which was owned by New Media Enterprises: J9JC9B0M a. Does Eloise have to secure authorization from New Media Enterprises to be able to publish her Diario de Manila columns in her own anthology? Explain fully. b. Assume that New Media Enterprises plans to publish Eloise's columns in its own anthology entitled, "The Best of Diario de Manila" Eloise wants to prevent the publication of her columns in that anthology since she was never paid by the newspaper. Name one irrefutable legal argument Eloise could cite to enjoin New Media Enterprises from including her columns in its anthology. Answer: a. Eloise does not have to secure the authorization of New Media, because as the author, she owns the copyright to her columns. b. Eloise could invoke that under the IPC, as the owner of the copyright to the columns, she can either “authorize or prevent” reproduction of the work, including the public distribution of the original and each of the work ‘by sale or other forms of transfer of ownership”. While the anthology as a derivative work is protected as a new work, it does not affect the force of the copyright of Eloise upon her columns and does not imply any right to New ’“Section 179, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 328 Media to use the columns without the consent of Eloise. (Bar 2008) 189. While vacationing in Boracay, Valentino surreptitiously took photographs of his girlfriend Monaliza in her skimpy bikini. Two (2) weeks later, her photograph appeared in the Internet and in a national celebrity magazine. Monaliza found out that Valentino had sold the photograph to the magazine and, adding insult to injury, uploaded them to his personal blog on the Internet. Monaliza filed a complaint against Valentino for damages based on, among other grounds, violation of her intellectual property rights: a. Does she have any cause of action? Explain; b. Valentino's friend Francesco stole the photographs and duplicated them and sold them to a magazine publication. Valentino sued Francesco for infringement and damages. Does Valentino have any cause of action? Explain, c. Does Monaliza have any cause of action against Franceso? Explain. a. No. Monaliza cannot sue Valentino for violation of her intellectual property rights, because she was not the one who took the pictures. She may sue Valentino instead for violation of her right to privacy. He surreptitiously took photographs of her and then sold the photographs to a magazine and uploaded them to his personal blog in the Internet. b. No. Valentino cannot sue Francesco for infringement, because he has already sold the photographs to a magazine. c. Yes. Monaliza can also sue Francesco for violation of her right to privacy.366 190. T, an associate attorney in XYZ Law Office, wrote a newspaper publisher a letter disputing a columnist's claim about an incident in the attorney's family. T used the law firm's letterhead and its computer in preparing the letter. T also requested the firm's messenger to deliver the letter to the publisher. Who owns the copyright to the letter?367 366BAR 2010. “’BAR 2011. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 329 a. T, since he is the original creator of the contents of the letter; b. Both T and the publisher, one wrote the letter to the other who has possession of it; c. The law office since it was an employee and he wrote it on the firm’s letterhead; d. The publisher to whom the letter was sent. 191. BR and CT are noted artists whose paintings are highly prized by collectors. Dr. DL commissioned them to paint a mural at the main lobby of his new hospital for children. Both agreed to collaborate on the project for a total fee of two million pesos to be equally divided between them. It was also agreed that Dr. DL had to provide all the materials for the painting and pay for the wages of technicians and laborers needed for the work on the project. Assume that the project is completed and both BR and CT are fully paid the amount of P2M as artists' fee by DL. Under the law on Intellectual Property, who will own the mural? Who will own the copyright in the mural? Why? Explain. Under Section 178.4 of the IPC, as amended, in case of commissioned work, the creator (in the absence of a written stipulation to the contrary) owns the copyright, but the work itself belongs to the person who commissioned its creation. Accordingly, the mural belongs to DL. However, BR and CT own the copyright, since there is no stipulation to the contrary.368 192. The widow of a former President commissioned Matalino to write a biography of her late husband for a fee. Upon completion of the work, the widow paid Matalino the agreed price. The biography was copyrighted. The widow, however, changed her mind upon reading the book and decided not to have it published. Can the President's widow sell the property without the consent of Matalino? Explain. The President’s widow can sell the property without the consent of Matalino. The widow was the owner of the work that was done by Matalino pursuant to their agreement.369 J9JC9B0M ’“BAR 1995 and 2004. “’BAR 1986. J9JC9B0M 330 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II Can the President's widow transfer the copyright without the consent of Matalino? Under the law. in case of commissioned work, the work belongs to the one who commissioned it but the copyright belongs to the author, unless otherwise stipulated. Thus, unless otherwise stipulated, the President’s widow cannot transfer the copyright since it belongs to the author. 193. What is the general term of copyright protection? Subject to the other rules below, the copyright of both original and derivative works shall be protected during the life of the author and for 50 years after his death. This rule also applies to posthumous works.370 194. How about in cases of joint authorship? In case of works of joint authorship, the economic rights shall be protected during the life of the last surviving author and for 50 years after his death.371 195. If today a person is granted a copyright for a book, for how long will the copyright be valid? If said person uses a pseudonym, how would this affect the length of the copyright? A copyright endures during the lifetime of the creator and for 50 years after his death. In case he uses a pseudonym, the copyright shall last until the end of 50 years following the date of the first publication of the work, unless the author is identified, in which case, the copyright subsists during his lifetime and for 50 years after his death.372 196. Are there other kinds of works with protection? different terms of Yes. In case of works of applied art, the protection shall be for a period of 25 years from the date of making.373 37oSection 213.1, IPC, as amended. 371Section 213.2, IPC, as amended. 372BAR 1975. 373Section 213.4, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 331 In case of photographic works, the protection shall be for 50 years from publication of the work and, if unpublished, 50 years from the making.374 In case of audio-visual works including those produced by process analogous to photography or any process for making audio­ visual recordings, the term shall be 50 years from date of publication and, if unpublished, from the date of making.376 The rights granted to performers and producers of sound recordings under this law shall expire: a. For performances not incorporated in recordings, 50 years from the end of the year in which the performance took place; and b. For sound or image and sound recordings and for performances incorporated therein, 50 years from the end of the year in which the recording took place.376 For example, Juan dela Cruz composed a song. He asked Pedro to sing the musical composition. Because of his excellent rendition of the song, it became a hit. Juan has a copyright to the musical composition. It subsists during his lifetime and 50years after his death. Pedro has the copyright to his performance. This is an example of a neighboring right to copyright. It has a term of 50 years following the end of the year in which the performance took place. In case of broadcasts, the term shall be 20 years from the date the broadcast took place. The extended term shall be applied only to old works with subsisting protection under the prior law. 197. Is there a special rule on the calculation of the term? Yes. The term of protection subsequent to the death of the author provided in the above rules shall run from the date of his death or of publication, but such terms shall always be deemed to begin on the first day of January of the year following the event which gave rise to them.377 J9JC9B0M 5. Limitations on Copyright 374Section ^Section ^Section ^’Section 213.5, IPC, as amended. 213.6, IPC, as amended. 215, IPC, as amended. 214, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M niVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 332 198. What are the limitations on copyright? Notwithstanding the provisions of Chapter V of the IPC, the following acts shall not constitute infringement of copyright:™ a. The recitation or performance of a work, once it has been lawfully made accessible to the public, (i) if done privately and free of charge or (ii) if made strictly for a charitable or religious institution or society; Example: Students singing popular songs to entertain a professor celebrating his birthday. b. The making of quotations from a published work if they are compatible with fair use and only to the extent justified for the purpose, including quotations from newspaper articles and periodicals in the form of press summaries: provided, that the source and the name of the author, if appearing on the work, are mentioned; Example: Lifting an insignificant portion of a book and incorporating it in another book, with proper attribution. c. The reproduction or communication to the public by mass media of (i) articles on current political, social, economic, scientific or religious topic, (ii) lectures, addresses and other works of the same nature, which are delivered in public if such use is for information purposes and has not been expressly reserved: provided, that the source is clearly indicated; Example: News story printing a substantial part of the speech of a public official. d. The reproduction and communication to the public of literary, scientific or artistic works as part of reports of current events by means of photography, cinematography or broadcasting to the extent necessary for the purpose; Example: Taking a photo of paintings in art gallery exhibit as part of report of current events. e. The inclusion of a work in a publication, broadcast, or other communication to the public, sound recording or film, if such inclusion is made by way of illustration for teaching purposes and is compatible with fair use: ■’’“Section 184.1, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE f. g- h. 333 provided, that the source and of the name of the author, if appearing in the work, are mentioned; Example: Slides presentation of comparative works of architecture as illustration for teaching purposes of the different types of architecture throughout the decades. The recording made in schools, universities, or educational institutions of a work included in a broadcast for the use of such schools, universities or educational institutions; provided, that such recording must be deleted within a reasonable period after they were first broadcast: provided, further, that such recording may not be made from audiovisual works which are part of the general cinema repertoire of feature films except for brief excerpts of the work; Example: The recording made in a university of UAAP basketball games for the viewing of the university students. The making of ephemeral recordings by a broadcasting organization by means of its own facilities and for use in its own broadcast; Example: The recording by a broadcasting organization of current events as part of a newscast. The use made of a work by or under the direction or control of the Government, by the National Library or by educational, scientific or professional institutions where such use is in the public interest and is compatible with fair use; Example: The application of the must-carry rule of the National Telecommunications Commission which obligates cable provides to carry the signals and shows of free TV stations to afford the public wider viewing options. i. The public performance or the communication to the public of a work, in a place where no admission fee is charged in respect of such public performance or communication, by a club or institution for charitable or educational purpose only, whose aim is not profit making, subject to such other limitations as may be provided in the Regulations; Example: Poetry reading competition among students where no admission fee is charged in respect of such public performance. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 334 j- Public display of the original or a copy of the work not made by means of a film, slide, television image or otherwise on screen or by means of any other device or process: provided, that either the work has been published, or, that the original or the copy displayed has been sold, given away or otherwise transferred to another person by the author or his successor in title; Example: Public display of a painting after its purchase from the owner. k. Any use made of a work for the purpose of any judicial proceedings or for the giving of professional advice by a legal practitioner. Example: Copying portions of a book for inclusion in a pleadings to be filed with the court or in an opinion to be given to a client. 1. The reproduction or distribution of published articles or materials in a specialized format exclusively for the use of the blind, visually- and reading-impaired persons: Provided, That such copies and distribution shall be made on a nonprofit basis and shall indicate the copyright owner and the date of the original publication; and,”9 Example: The non-commercial reproduction of books under the Braille system for the use of the blind. m. In case of fair use of the copyrighted work.380 Private Performance of a work 199. The Filipino Society of Composers (FCT) is a non-profit association of authors, composers and publishers. Said association is the owner of certain musical compositions among which are the songs entitled: "Dahil Sa lyo," "Sapagkat Ikaw Ay Akin," "Sapagkat Kami Ay Tao Lamang" and "The Nearness Of You." BT is the operator of a restaurant known as "Alex Soda Foundation and Restaurant" where a combo with professional singers, hired to play and sing musical compositions to entertain and amuse customers therein, were playing and _________ ’’’Section 184, IPC, as amended. ’“Section 185, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 335 singing the above-mentioned compositions without any license or permission from FCT to play or sing the same. It is admitted that the patrons of the restaurant in question pay only for the food and drinks and apparently not for listening to the music. Was the playing and singing of the musical compositions of FCT inside the establishment of BT constitute a public performance for profit within the meaning and contemplation of the Copyright Law? The music provided is for the purpose of entertaining and amusing the customers in order to make the establishment more attractive and desirable. It will be noted that for the playing and singing the musical compositions involved, the combo was paid as independent contractors. It is therefore obvious that the expenses entailed thereby are added to the overhead of the restaurant which are either eventually charged in the price of the food and drinks or to the overall total of additional income produced by the bigger volume of business which the entertainment was programmed to attract. Consequently, it is beyond question that the playing and singing of the combo in BT’s restaurant constituted performance for profit contemplated by the Copyright Law.381 Incidentally, in a similar case, it was ruled that “(t)he Performance in a restaurant or hotel dining room, by persons employed by the proprietor, of a copyrighted musical composition, for the entertainment of patrons, without charge for admission to hear it, infringes the exclusive right of the owner of the copyright.”382 Making of Quotations 200. What are the criteria to be observed such that making quotation from a published work does not amount to copyright infringement? The criteria are as follows: a) It is compatible with fair use; b) The extent of the use is justifiable for the purpose intended; and, “‘Filipino Society of Composers v Benjamin Tan, G.R. No. L-36402, Second Division, March 16, 1987. x2Ibid. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 336 c) The source and author of the work are mentioned 201, Johnny Cruz is a staunch conservative and a loyal member of the Republican Party. He is pro-life, believes in the second amendment that protects the right to keep and bear arms and advocates former POTUS Trump’s basic philosophy—America First. He wrote an 88-page thought-provoking article about the second impeachment of Trump. Echoing many legal scholars, he argued that the impeachment is unconstitutional because the impeachment process only applies to a sitting President; the objective of impeachment is to remove an incumbent President and since Trump has left the POTUS office, the impeachment has no legal leg to stand on. He concluded that the impeachment is nothing but a hoax and part of the continuing prosecution of Trump by the left and the media mob. Pearly Ivory is an avid fan of the Democratic Party. She believes in all its liberal ideas and progressive policies. Anti­ abortion for her is really not against life but simply means pro-choice. She gushes with admiration on the prominent Democrats—Bill Clinton, Barack Obama, and the like. She wrote a critique on the work of Johnny Cruz which literally copied 90% of Johnny's article but made the proper attribution. Ten percent (10%) of the article is in support of her conclusion that Trump is a threat to society and democracy and should be permanently barred from seeking elective office.383 Is Pearly Ivory liable for copyright infringement? Yes, Pearly Ivory is liable for copyright infringement. Making quotations from a published work is permissible. However, to constitute as a valid limitation on copyright, the quotation must be compatible with fair use. One of the factors to be considered in determining whether the use made of a work in any particular case is fair use is the amount and substantiality of the portion used in relation to the copyrighted work as a whole. Copying 90% of the work, even though with proper attribution, is not compatible with fair use. 383Patterned after a 1989 Bar Exams but based on contemporary news as of the date of writing. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 337 202. Does the lifting of a portion of a book by another author constitute copyright infringement? The lifting of substantial portions of a book by the author constitutes infringement of the copyright of the authors of the first book. If so much is taken that the value of the original works is substantially diminished, there is an infringement of copyright and to an injurious extent, the work is appropriated.™ In cases of infringement, copying alone is not what is prohibited. The copying must produce an injurious effect. In the Habana case, the Supreme Court held that the injury consists in that the second author lifted from the first author’s book materials that were the result of the latter’s research work and compilation and misrepresented them as her own. The infringer circulated the book for commercial use and did not acknowledge the first author as her source.385 It should be noted that in the Habana case, the number of pages copied did not even account for more than 50% of the book. It seems that had the second author made the proper author attribution, there would have been no infringement. Information purposes 203. Cite example of "addresses and other works of the same nature” which can be reproduced to the public by mass media without infringement. In Rappier, Inc. v. Andres Bautista,366 it was held that presidential and vice presidential debates fall under “addresses and other works of the same nature.” Thus, the copyright conditions for the debates are: (1) the reproduction or communication to the public by mass media of the debates is for information purposes; (2) the debates have not been expressly reserved by the copyright holders); and (3) the source is clearly indicated. The Supreme Court allowed the debates to be shown or live streamed unaltered on Rappier’s and other websites subject to the foregoing copyright conditions. ™Pacita Habana, et al. v. Felicidad Robles and Goodwill Trading Co., Inc., G.R. No. 131522, July 19, 1999. ^Supra. 186G.R. No. 222702, April 5, 2016. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 338 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II Under the direction and control of the government 204. What do you understand by the must-carry rule? The must-carry rule is a regulation of the National Telecommunications Commission which obligates cable TV networks to carry the signals of local TV stations and show in full the freelocal TV programs. The improved broadcast signals offered by a cable TV may infringe or encroach upon the audience or viewer market of the freesignal TV. This is so because the latter’s signal may not reach the remote areas or reach them with poor signal quality. To foreclose this possibility and protect the free-TV market (audience market), the must-carry rule was adopted to level the playing field. This, in turn, benefits the public who would have a wide-range of choices of programs or broadcast to watch. This also benefits the free-TV signal as their broadcasts are carried under cable TV’s much-improved broadcast signals thus expanding their viewer’s share.387 Hence, it was ruled that the carriage by cable TV providers of ABS-CBbTs signals and the showing in full of the local TV programs do not constitute copyright infringement.388 This is based on Sectionl84.1 (h) of the IPC, as amended, the use made of a work by or under the direction or control of the Government, by the National Library or by educational, scientific or professional institutions where such use is in the public interest and is compatible with fair use will not constitute copyright infringement. It was further held that while the Memorandum Circular of the NTC on the must-carry rule refers to cable television, it should be understood as to include direct-to-home via satellite TV (DTK) which provides essentially the same services. In GMA Network v. Central CATV,339 the Supreme Court further ruled that under the must-carry rule, the cable TV networks are required to carry and show in full the free-local TVs programs, including advertisements, without alteration or deletion. The act of showing advertisements does not constitute an infringement of the “television and broadcast markets” under Section 2 of E.O. No. 205. 3B7GMA Network, Inc. v. Central CATV, Inc., G.R. No. 176694, July 18, 2014. 388ABS-CBN Broadcasting Corporation v. Philippine Multi-Media System, Inc., G.R. Nos. 175769-70, January 19, 2009. 3ft9GMA Network, supra. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 339 205. Is carrying the signals of the local TV station as form of re­ broadcasting? No, the cable TV provider is not the origin nor does it claim to be the origin of the programs broadcasted by the ABS-CBN; the former did not make and transmit on its own but merely carried the existing signals of the latter and when the cable provider subscribers new ABS-CBN’s programs in Channels 2 and 23, they know that the origin thereof was the latter.390 Judicial proceedings or professional advice 206. May a person have photocopies of some pages of the book of Professor Rosario made without violating the copyright law? No, the private reproduction of a published work in a single copy, where the reproduction is made by a natural person exclusively for research and private study, is permitted, without the authorization of the owner of the copyright in the work does not apply to a book. Reproduction of a book is covered by a separate provision. If the pages copied amount to a substantial portion, there is infringement of copyright. 207. In a written legal opinion for a client on the difference between apprenticeship and learnership, Liza quoted without permission a labor law expert's comment appearing in his book entitled "Annotations on the Labor Code." Can the labor law expert hold Liza liable for infringement of copyright for quoting a portion of his book without his permission? No. The labor law expert cannot hold Liza liable for infringement of copyright. Under Section 184. l(k) of the IPC, as amended, “Any use made of a work for the purpose of any judicial proceeding or for giving of professional advice by a legal practitioner” shall not constitute infringement of a copyright.391 The use made of a work for the purpose of giving professional advice is a limitation on copyright and does not require the consent of the author. 3S0ABS-CBN Broadcasting Corporation Ine.,G.R. Nos. 175769-70, January 19, 2009. “'BAR 2006. J9JC9B0M Philippine Multi-Media System, J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 310 208. May Liza be held criminally liable if she did not attribute the portion of the work she quoted in her opinion to the labor law author? The law does not require attribution when it comes to the use of the work for judicial proceeding or giving professional advice and as such. Liza cannot be sued for copyright infringement despite lack of attribution. However, Liza may be held liable for plagiarism which is broader in scope than copyright. To plagiarize means to steal and pass off the ideas or words of another as one’s own. It is basically a literary theft.392 a. Doctrine of fair use 209. What is fair use? Fair use is “a privilege to use the copyrighted material in a reasonable manner without the consent of the copyright owner or as copying the theme or ideas rather than their expression.”393 Fair use is an exception to the copyright owner>s monopoly of the use of the work to avoid stifling “the very creativity which that law is designed to foster”.393 Under this doctrine, the fair use of a copyrighted work for: (1) criticism and comment; (2) news reporting; (3) teaching, including multiple copies for classroom use; and (4) scholarship, research, and similar purposes is not an infringement of copyright. 210. What are the factors to be considered in determining fair use? Determining fair use requires application of the four-factor test. Section 185 of the Intellectual Property Code lists four (4) factors to determine if there was fair use of a copyrighted work: 392Webster’s online dictionary. 393ABS CBN case citing Habana v. Robles, 369 Phil. 764 (1999) [Per J. Pardo, First Division], citing 18 AM JUR2D §109, in turn citing Toksvig v. Bruce Pub. Co., (CA7Wis) 181 F2d 664 [1950]; Bradbury v. Columbia Broadcasting System, Inc., (CA9 Cal) 287 F2d 478, cert den 368 US 801, 7 L ed 2d 15, 82 S Ct 19 [1961]; Shipman v. R.K.O. Radio Pictures, Inc., (CA2 NY) 100 F2d 533 [1938]. 393ABS CBN case citing Matthew D. Bunker, TRANSFORMING THE NEWS: COPYRIGHT AND FAIR USE IN NEWS-RELATED CONTEXTS, 52 J. COPYRIGHT SOCY U.S.A. 309, 311 (2004-2005), citing Iowa St. Univ. Research Found., Inc. v. Am. Broad. Cos., 621 F.2d 57, 60 (2d Cir. 1980). The four factors are similarly codified under the United States Copyright Act of 1976, Section 107. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 341 a. The purpose and character of the use, including whether such use is of a commercial nature or is for non-profit educational purposes; b. The nature of the copyrighted work; c. The amount and substantiality of the portion used in relation to the copyrighted work as a whole; and d. The effect of the use upon the potential market for or value of the copyrighted work. First, the purpose and character of the use of the copyrighted material must fall under those listed in Section 185, thus: “criticism, comment, news reporting, teaching including multiple copies for classroom use, scholarship, research, and similar purposes.” The purpose and character requirement is important in view of copyright’s goal to promote creativity and encourage creation of works. Hence, commercial use of the copyrighted work can be weighed against fair use. The “transformative test” is generally used in reviewing the purpose and character of the usage of the copyrighted work. The court must look into whether the copy of the work adds “new expression, meaning or message” to transform it into something else. “Meta-use” can also occur without necessarily transforming the copyrighted work used. Second, the nature of the copyrighted work is significant in deciding whether its use was fair. If the nature of the work is more factual than creative, then fair use will be weighed in favor of the user. Third, the amount and substantiality of the portion used is important to determine whether usage falls under fair use. An exact reproduction of a copyrighted work, compared to a small portion of it, can result in the conclusion that its use is not fan’. There may also be cases where, though the entirety of the copyrighted work is used without consent, its purpose determines that the usage is still fair. For example, a parody using a substantial amount of copyrighted work may be permissible as fair use as opposed to a copy of a work produced purely for economic gain. Lastly, the effect of the use on the copyrighted work’s market is also weighed for or against the user. If this court finds that the J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 342 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II use had or will have a negative impact on the copyrighted work's market, then the use is deemed unfair.™5 Interestingly, in the ABS-CBN case, the respondents from GMA-7 invoked as of one of their defenses the doctrine of fair use since footage was only aired for five (5) seconds. It was held that whether the alleged five-second footage may be considered fair use is a matter of defense as the case involves determination of probable cause at the preliminary investigation stage only. GMA-7’s rebroadcast of ABS-CBN’s news footage without the latter’s consent is not an issue. The mere act of rebroadcasting without authority from the owner of the broadcast gives rise to the probability that a crime was committed under the Intellectual Property Code. The fair use of a copyrighted work for (i) criticism and comment; (ii) news reporting; (iii) teaching, including limited number of copies for classroom use; and (iv) scholarship, research, and similar purposes is not an infringement of copyright. Decompilation, which is understood here to be the reproduction of the code and translation of the forms of a computer program to achieve the interoperability of an independently created computer program with other programs may also constitute fair use to the extent that such decompilation is done for the purpose of obtaining the information necessary to achieve such interoperability.396 211. Virtucio was a composer of llocano songs who has been quite popular in the llocos Region. Pascuala is a professor of music in a local university with special focus on indigenous music. When she heard the musical works of Virtucio, she purchased a CD of his works. She copied the CD and sent the second copy to her Music class with instructions for the class to listen to the CD and analyze the works of Virtucio. Did Pascuala thereby infringe Virtucio's copyright? Explain your answer. Pascuala did not infringe on the rights of Virtucio. The fair use of a copyrighted work for criticism, comment, news reporting, teaching including limited number of copies for classroom use, scholarship, research and similar purposes is not an infringement 395ABS-CBN, ibid. 396Section 185.1, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 343 of copyright.3” In this case, Pascuala’s reproduction of the limited number of CDs was for classroom use and educational purposes thus negating copyright infringement.398 212. KLM Printers, Inc. operated a mall outlet located at the ground floor of university building in Quezon City. It possessed soft copies of certain textbooks on file, and would print "bookalikes" of these textbooks (or in other words, reproduced the entire textbooks) upon order and for a fee. It would even display samples of such "book-alikes" in its stall for sale to the public. Upon learning of KLM Printers, Inc.'s activities, the authors of the textbooks filed a suit against it for copyright infringement. In its defense, KLM Printers, Inc. invoked the doctrine or fair use, contending that the "book-alikes" are being used for educational purposes by those who avail of them. a. What is the doctrine of fair use? Under this doctrine, the fair use of a copyrighted work for (1) criticism, comment, (2) news reporting, (3) teaching including multiple copies for classroom use, (4) scholarship, research, and similar purposes is not an infringement of copyright. b. Is KLM Printers, Inc.'s invocation of the doctrine of fair use proper in this case? Explain. No, the invocation is improper. In determining whether the use made of a work in any particular case is fair use, the factors to be considered shall include: a) the purpose and character of the use, including whether such use is of a commercial nature or is for non­ profit educational purposes; b) The nature of the copyrighted work; c) the amount and substantiality of the portion used in relation to the copyrighted work as a whole; and d) the effect of the use upon the potential market for or value of the copyrighted work.399 J9JC9B0M 6. Copyright Infringement “’Section 185, IPC, as amended. “BAR 2017. “Section 185.1, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL IAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 344 213. What is copyright infringement? Infringement of a copyright is a trespass on a private domain owned and occupied by the owner of the copyright, and, therefore, protected by law, and infringement of copyright, or piracy, which is a synonymous term in this connection, consists in the doing by any person, without the consent of the owner of the copyright, of anything the sole right to do which is conferred by statute on the owner of the copyright.400 The gravamen of copyright infringement is not merely the unauthorized “manufacturing” of intellectual works but rather the unauthorized performance of any of the rights exclusively granted to the copyright owner. Hence, any person who performs any of such acts without obtaining the copyright owner’s prior consent renders himself civilly and criminally liable for copyright infringement. It was held that the copying of the genuine Microsoft software to produce computer system hard disk or read-only memory (CDROMs) containing fake Microsoft software and their distribution are illegal even if the copier or distributor is a Microsoft licensee."1 Absolute similarity of the purported pirated works to the copyrighted works is not required. The essence of a copyright infringement is the similarity or at least substantial similarity of the purported pirated works to the copyrighted work.402 214. When is copyright infringement committed? Copyright infringement is committed by any person who shall use original literary or artistic works, or derivative works, without the copyright owner’s consent in such a manner as to violate the foregoing economic and moral rights of the author. A person infringes a right protected under the IPC when one: a. Directly commits an infringement; b. Benefits from the infringing activity of another person who commits an infringement if the person benefiting has been given notice of the infringing activity and has 400ABS-CBN, supra. 401NBI-Microsoft Corporation v. Judy Hwang, et al., G.R. No. 147043, June 21, 2005. 402Francisco G. Joaquin, Jr., and BJ Productions, Inc. v. Honorable Franklin Drilon, et al., G.R. No. 108946, January 28, 1999. r VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 345 the right and ability to control the activities of the other person; C. With knowledge of infringing activity, induces, causes or materially contributes to the infringing conduct of another.403 215. May the author or creator of the work sue for copyright infringement if he fails to deposit a copy of his work to the National Library (or the IPO as deputized by the National Library)? Yes, he may sue for copyright infringement notwithstanding the lack of deposit and registration with the National Library. Artistic and Literary works are now protected by its mere creation under the new Copyright Law. Under P.D, No. 49, failure to comply with registration and deposit does not deprive the copyright owner of the right to sue for infringement but merely limits the remedies available to him because the copyright for a work is granted from the moment of creation. This means that the author whose work was infringed can only secure an injunction against infringement but cannot sue for damages.404 However, under the IPC, the copyright owner may not only obtain an injunction but may also ask for damages and exercise other remedies provided by the law even though his work is not deposited and registered with the IPO. 216. What are the elements of copyright infringement? For a claim of copyright infringement to prevail, the evidence on record must demonstrate: a. Ownership of a validly copyrighted material by the complainant; and b. Infringement of the copyright by the respondent.405 ‘“Section 216, IPC, as amended. “'Columbia Pictures, Inc., el al. v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 110318, August 28,1996. "“Ching v. Salinas, Sr., 500 Phil. 628, 639 (2005). J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 346 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 217. May corporate infringement? officers be held liable for copyright Section 217 of the Intellectual Property Code states that “any person" may be found guilty of infringement. It also imposes the penalty of both imprisonment and fine. It has been ruled that corporate officers and/or agents may be held individually liable for a crime committed under the Intellectual Property Code:106 The existence of the corporate entity does not shield from prosecution the corporate agent who knowingly and intentionally caused the corporation to commit a crime. A corporate officer cannot protect himself behind a corporation where he is the actual, present and efficient actor.107 However, the criminal liability of a corporation's officers or employees stems from their active participation in the commission of the wrongful act. The principle applies whether or not the crime requires the consciousness of wrongdoing. It applies to those corporate agents who themselves commit the crime and to those, who, by virtue of their managerial positions or other similar relation to the corporation, could be deemed responsible for its commission, if by virtue of their relationship to the corporation, they had the power to prevent the act. An accused’s participation in criminal acts involving violations of intellectual property rights is the subject of allegation and proof. The showing that the accused did the acts or contributed in a meaningful way in the commission of the infringements is certainly different from the argument of lack of intent or good faith. Active participation requires a showing of overt physical acts or intention to commit such acts. Intent or good faith, on the other hand, are inferences from acts proven to have been or not been committed. It was held in the ABS-CBN case that the Department of Justice committed grave abuse of discretion when it resolved to file the Information against certain respondents despite lack of proof of their actual participation in the alleged crime. “Republic Gas Corporation v. Petron Corporation, G.R. No. 194062, June 17, 2013, cited in ABS-CBN case. ,tnSupra. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 347 218. In an action for damages on account of an infringement of a copyright, the defendant (the alleged pirate) raised the defense that he was unaware that what he had copied was a copyright material. Would this defense be valid? No. An intention to pirate is not an element of infringement. Infringement under the Intellectual Property Code is malum prohibitum. The Intellectual Property Code is a special law. Copyright is a statutory creation: Malice or criminal intent is completely immaterial. Hence, an honest intention is no defense to an action for infringement.408 A copy of a piracy is an infringement of the original, and it is no defense that the pirate, in such cases, did not know whether or not he was infringing any copyright; he at least knew that what he was copying was not his, and he copied at his peril. Thus, unless clearly provided in the law, offenses involving infringement of copyright protections should be considered malum prohibitum. It is the act of infringement, not the intent, which causes the damage. To require or assume the need to prove intent defeats the purpose of intellectual property protection. Nevertheless, proof beyond reasonable doubt is still the standard for criminal prosecutions under the Intellectual Property Code.409 In one case, however, the Supreme Court found no grave abuse of discretion on the part of the Department of Justice when it dismissed the complaint against the respondent who had possession of a product after purchase from legitimate sources but which turned out to be a counterfeit, without the knowledge of the purchaser/ possessor.410 219. What are the remedies of the copyright owner against an infringer? The copyright owner may exercise the following remedies in case of infringement: J9JC9B0M a. He may file a civil action for copyright infringement to obtain any or all of the following reliefs: “BAR 1988 and 1997. “ABS-CBN supra, citing Habana v. Robles. 410Sanrio Company Ltd. v. Lim, G.R. No. 168662, February 19,2008. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 348 i. Damages. The court can order the defendant to pay to the copyright proprietor or his assigns or heirs such actual damages, including legal costs and other expenses, as he may have incurred due to the infringement as well as the profits the infringer may have made due to such infringement, and in proving profits the plaintiff shall be required to prove sales only and the defendant shall be required to prove every element of cost which he claims, or, in lieu of actual damages and profits, such damages which to the court shall appear to be just and shall not be regarded as penalty.411 The amount of damages to be awarded shall be doubled against any person who: (i) Circumvents effective technological measures; or (ii) Having reasonable grounds to know that it will induce, enable, facilitate or conceal the infringement, remove or alter any electronic rights management information from a copy of a work, sound recording, or fixation of a performance, or distribute, import for distribution, broadcast, or communicate to the public works or copies of works without authority, knowing that electronic rights management information has been removed or altered without authority.412 ‘Technological measure’ means any technology, device or component that, in the normal course of its operation, restricts acts in respect of a work, performance or sound recording, which are not authorized by the authors, performers or producers of sound recordings concerned or permitted by law.413 ‘Rights management information’ means information which identifies the work, sound recording or performance; the author of the work, producer of the sound recording or performer of the performance; the owner of any right in the work, sound recording or performance; or information about the terms and conditions of the use of the work, sound recording "■Section 216.1(b), IPC, as amended. 412Section 216.1(b), IPC, as amended. "3Section 171.12, IPC, as amended. r J9JC9B0M VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 349 or performance; and any number or code that represent such information, when any of these items is attached to a copy of the work, sound recording or fixation of performance or appears in conjunction with the communication to the public of a work, sound recording or performance.111 Moral and exemplary damages may likewise be awarded as court may deem proper, wise and equitable.116 However, no damages may be recovered after the lapse of four years from the time the cause of action arose.1'6 ii. Preliminary injunction. The court may also order the defendant to desist from committing any infringement and/or to prevent the entry into the channels of commerce of imported goods that involve an infringement, immediately after customs clearance of such goods.117 iii. Search and seizure order. This may include the seizure and impounding of sales invoices and other documents evidencing sales, all articles and their packaging alleged to infringe a copyright and implements for making them which may serve as evidence in court proceedings in accordance with the rules on search and seizure involving violations of intellectual property rights issued by the Supreme Court.118 iv. Order of Destruction. The court can also order the destruction without any compensation all infringing copies or devices, as well as all plates, molds, or other means for making such infringing copies as the court may order.119 The destruction of infringing copies of the work may be ordered even in the event of acquittal in a criminal case.120 ‘■‘Section 171.13, IPC, as amended. ‘■’Section 216.1(e), IPC, as amended. ‘‘"Section 226, IPC, as amended. ‘■’Section 216.1(a), as amended. ‘■“Section 216.2, and 216.1(c), IPC, as amended. ‘■“Section 216.1(d), IPC, as amended. ‘“Section 216.1, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 350 The order of destruction is however not executory if defendant files a motion for reconsideration.421 The foregoing remedies shall not preclude an independent suit for relief by the injured party by way of damages, injunction, accounts or otherwise.121 V. He may also file a criminal action for copyright infringement.423 Thecopyright owner may elect, at any time before final judgment is rendered, to recover instead of actual damages and profits, an award of statutory damages for all infringements involved in an action in a sum equivalent to the filing fee of the infringement action but not less than fifty thousand pesos (P50,000.00). In awarding statutory damages, the court may consider the following factors: (1) The nature and purpose of the infringing act; (2) The flagrancy of the infringement; (3) Whether the defendant acted in bad faith; (4) The need for deterrence; (5) Any loss that the plaintiff has suffered or is likely to suffer by reason of the infringement; and (6) Any benefit shown to have accrued to the defendant by reason of the infringement. In case the infringer was not aware and had no reason to believe that his acts constitute an infringement of copyright, the court in its discretion may reduce the award of statutory damages to a sum of not more than P10,000.00.424 The amount of damages to be awarded shall be doubled against any person who circumvents effective technological measures and/ or alters or removes electronic rights management information.421 220. Jose Santos has written many poems, some of which have been published in Panorama Magazine but never registered with the Copyright Office. Among his published works was the poem 4212020 Rules, supra. 4z2Section 216.2, IPC, as amended. 423Section 217.1, IPC, as amended. ™Supra. ’“Section 216.1, IPC VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE 351 entitled “In a Rose Garden." About a year from its publication, Jose was surprised to hear over the radio a song whose lyrics were copied from his poem. It appears that music sheets of the song have been published and sold under the name of the composer, without any acknowledgment in favor of Jose. Jose wants to know what his rights are and whether he can secure an injunction against the composer and/or the publisher, perhaps with damages. How will you advise him? Explain. I would tell Santos that he has a right to file an injunction proceeding to restrain the composer and/or his publisher from further committing any act of infringement of his copyright. Under the present law, copyright is acquired from the moment of creation of the work. Registration and deposit of the work are no longer necessary for its acquisition. The moment Santos wrote his poem, he acquired the right to restrain any infringement on his copyright, as well as the right to have the infringing copies and devices impounded. He may recover actual damages, including legal costs and other expenses, as he may have incurred due to the infringement as well as the profits the infringer may have made due to such infringement, and in proving profits the plaintiff shall be required to prove sales only and the defendant shall be required to prove every element of cost which he claims, or, in lieu of actual damages and profits, such damages which to the court shall appear to be just and shall not be regarded as penalty. He may also recover moral and exemplary damages, which the court may deem proper, wise and equitable.426 221. What are the defenses available against an action for copyright infringement? J9JC9B0M The defenses are as follows: a. b. The work is not copyrightable; C. The use of the work falls within the limitations on copyright; d. e. The plaintiff/complainant is not the owner of the copyright; The term of the copyright has expired; Non-participation in the commission of the infringing activities; ,!6BAR 1981 but answered under the IPC. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 352 f. If the basis of the complaint is the benefit derived from the infringing activity, lack of notice thereof and/or did not have the ability to control the infringement; gh. Prescription; and Lack of evidence to support the allegations of the complaint. 222. Is there copyright infringement in the following cases?’” a. Sale of illicit copies of software programs. Yes. The mere sale of illicit copies of software programs is enough by itself to show the existence of probable cause for copyright infringement.428 b. Importation of DVDs and CDs of music, movies, and foreign books into the Philippines by an individual for personal purpose. There is no infringement as long as the foregoing items are not pirated and the number of copies is compatible with fair use. The economic rights of the author do not include the right to prevent importation or exportation of the copyrighted work. R.A. No. 10372 removed the limitation on the number of copies that may be imported into the Philippines by an individual but this should not mean without any limit. c. Public display of a painting after its purchase from the artist. Yes, this is one of the limitations on copyright.429 d. Reproduction of the entire copy of a thesis by a person other than the author. There is no infringement provided that the reproduction is only for a single copy, made by a natural person exclusively for research and private study.430 427The assumption is that the copyright owner did not give his consent to any of the acts enumerated. 428Microsoft Corporation v. Manansala, G.R. No. 166391, October 21, 2015. 429Section 184. l(j), IPC, as amended. 430Section 187, IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE e. 353 Use of layout or appearance of book without the consent of the author. There is no infringement as long as the use is with the permission of the publisher. The copyright to the layout belongs to the publisher and not to the author.431 f. Use of an ornamental design embossed in a coffee mug as a design for T-shirt. There is infringement. The design can be detached from the usefulness of the product and as such, it is copyrightable under the Denicola test. 9- Removing restrictions on what and how apps content can be stored and used or "jail breaking’! Circumvention of technological measure does not amount to copyright infringement but is only an aggravating circumstance which may cause the imposition of the maximum penalty or doubling the award of damages.432 h. Receipt of rentals by the owner of a mall or lessor of an establishment where the lessee commits acts of infringement. The owner of the mall or lessor of the establishment is Hable for infringement if he has been given notice of infringing activity but did not stop the infringement. Benefiting from infringing activity is a form of copyright infringement.433 i. The composer of a song assigned his right to the composition. Fifty years after the composer's death, the assignee changed the tempo from ballad to rock and claimed to be the owner of the musical composition. By claiming to be the owner of the original composition, the assignee violated the moral right of attribution of the original composer and therefore infringed copyright. The right of attribution of an author shall last during his lifetime and in perpetuity after his death.434 J9JC9B0M “'Section 174, IPC, as amended. “"Based on Section 216.1, IPC, as amended. “Section 216, IPC, as amended. “Section 198, IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL I .AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 354 j- Purchase of a book and then selling it for a price higher than cost of acquisition. There is no infringement of copyright. The first sale doctrine provides that an individual who knowingly purchases a copy of a copyrighted work from the copyright holder receives the right to sell, display or otherwise dispose of that particular copy, notwithstanding the interests of the copyright owner. The copyright holder’s right to control the distribution of his work goes away after the “first sale” of the work. k. The buyer of a copyrighted book reproduced it in its entirety and shared it with his classmate for their private study. There is infringement of copyright. The person who photocopied the book violated the economic right of reproduction of the work of the copyright owner. The law excludes books from the right granted by law to an individual allowing a single-copy-private-reproduction of a published work.435 I. Commercial reproduction of published articles in a specialized format for the use of the blind, visually and reading-impaired persons indicating the copyright owner and date of publication. There is copyright infringement. The reproduction of published articles in a specialized format for the use of the blind, visually and reading-impaired persons is a limitation on copyright only if the distribution of the copies is done on a non-profit basis.438 m. Cover song or new performance or recording of a contemporary or previously recorded, commercially released song or popular song by someone other than the original artist without modification on the lyrics and melody, then uploading it on the YouTube. There is no infringement of copyright because cover song assumes that the song, as a copyrightable work, has been lawfully made accessible to the public, provided that the singer, (other than the original artist), did not receive any royalty from YouTube or did not gain any profit for the cover song.437 ’“Section 187.1, IPC, as amended. ’“Section 184.1(1), IPC, as amended. ’37Based on Section 184.1(a), IPC, as amended. VII. INTELLECTUAL PROPERTY CODE n. 356 CD burning. To “burn” a CD simply means to copy or write information into a compact disc. There is copyright infringement because distributing a copy of the copyrighted material (like the music CD) can only be done with the permission of the copyright holder. o. Reprinting by a private library of a book that has gone out of stock. There is copyright infringement because only a library allowed by law to receive copies of a printed work is entitled to reproduce copy of a published work which is necessary for the collection of the library but which out of stock.-138 A private library has no such privilege. P- Legislative bill pirated by another congressman and introduced as his own. There is no copyright infringement. Copyright does not subsist on works of government.-139 A legislative bill is a work of government. q- Reproduction of a collection of classical books on literature (those which have been published more than 50 years after death of the authors) by someone other than the person who made the compilation and arrangement. There is copyright infringement. While the classical books have become public dominion in view of the expiration of the term of the copyright, the collection of the classical books, as a derivative work, is independently copyrighted from the original works by reason of the selection or coordination or arrangement of its contents.410 r. Reproducing back-up copies or adaptation of a licensed computer program for archival purposes. There is copyright infringement. The law only allows reproduction of one (1) back-up copy of a computer program for archival purposes■1■1, except when reproduction of more than one adaptation is allowed by the terms of the license agreement with the copyright owner. J9JC9B0M “Section 188.2, IPC, as amended. “’Based on Section 176, IPC, as amended. “’Based on Section 173.1(b), IPC, as amended. “'Based on Section 189.1(b), IPC, as amended. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 356 S. Rebroadcast of a radio program after 25 years from the date the broadcast took place without the consent of the broadcasting organization which owns the copyright. No copyright infringement. The term of broadcast is only 20 years from the date the broadcast took place.442 t. Reproduction of the photograph by the owner without the consent of the person, subject of the photograph. No copyright infringement. The photographer, not the subject, has the copyright to the photograph and as such, enjoys the economic right of reproduction. u. X's painting of Madonna and Child was used by her mother to print some personalized gift wrapper. As part of her mother's efforts to raise funds for Bantay Bata, the mother of X sold the wrapper to friends. Y, an entrepreneur, liked the painting in the wrapper and made many copies and sold the same through National Bookstore. There is infringement because artistic works are protected from the moment of creation. 442Section 215.2, IPC, as amended. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS I. Guaranty 1. What is a contract of guaranty? It is a contract whereby a person, called the guarantor, binds himself to the creditor to fulfill the obligation of the principal debtor in case the latter should fail to do so. A guaranty may be conventional, legal or judicial, gratuitous, or by onerous title. It may also be constituted, not only in favor of the principal debtor, but also in favor of the other guarantor, with the latter’s consent, or without his knowledge, or even over his objection.1 2. What are the characteristics of a contract of guaranty? Characteristics of a contract of guaranty: Nominate a. Consensual — the contract is between the creditor and the b. guarantor. Generally, it is gratuitous. Exception: when there is a c. stipulation to the contrary. d. Accessory — it cannot exist without a valid principal obligation. Can be given as security for future debts e. Governed by the Statute of Frauds - it must be in writing f. to be enforceable.2 3. Can a married woman guarantee an obligation? Yes. A married woman may guarantee an obligation without the husband’s consent, but shall not thereby bind the conjugal partnership, except in cases provided by law.3 J9JC9B0M ‘Articles. 2047, 2051, Civil Code. “Articles 2047, 2048, 2052, 2053, 1403(2)(b), Civil Code. 3 Article 2049, Civil Code. 357 J9JC9B0M 358 4. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II What is the scope of the obligation of a guarantor? A guarantor may bind himself for less, but not for more than the principal debtor, both as regards the amount and the onerous nature of the conditions. Should he have bound himself for more, his obligations shall be reduced to the limits of that of the debtor.4 5. What is the extent of a contract of guaranty? A guaranty is not presumed; it must be express and cannot extend to more than what is stipulated therein. If it be simple or indefinite, it shall comprise not only the principal obligation, but also alt its accessories, including the judicial costs, provided with respehcto the latter, that the guarantor shall only be Hable for those costs incurred after he has been judicially required to pay.6 6. Who may act as a guarantor? A person who possesses integrity, capacity to bind himself, and sufficient property to answer for the obligation which he guarantees.' What is the benefit of excussion? The guarantor cannot be compelled to pay the creditor unless the latter has exhausted all the property of the debtor, and has resorted to all the legal remedies against the debtor.7 8. What are the conditions for the exercise of the benefit of excussion? The conditions for the exercise of the benefit of excussion are as follows: (1) The case does not fall under any of the instances enumerated in Article 2059 Excussion shall not take place: • If the guarantor renounced it; has expressly • If he has bound himself solidarily with the debtor; ■ In case of insolvency of the debtor; 4Article 2054, Civil Code. 'Article 2055, Civil Code. 'Article 2056, Civil Code. ’Article 2058, Civil Code. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS (2) The guarantor complies with Article 2060 359 • When he has absconded, or cannot be sued within the Philippines unless he has left a manager or representative; " If it may be presumed that an execution on the property of the principal debtor would not result in the satisfaction of the obligation. He must set it up against the creditor upon the latter’s demand for payment from him, and point out to the creditor available property of the debtor within Philippine territory, sufficient ttecover the amount of the debt. v'/* ------------- - --------- k---9. What happens if the creditor is negligent in exhausting the property pointed out by the guarantor? The creditor who is negligent in exhausting the property pointed out shall suffer the loss, to the extent of said property, for the insolvency of the debtor resulting from such negligence.9 10. In the event that the benefit of excussion is available, how should the creditor proceed? The creditor shall ask the court to notify the guarantor of the action. The guarantor may appear so that he may, if he so desire, set up such defenses as are granted him by law.10 11. What is the effect, if any, of a compromise between the creditor and principal debtor? What about a compromise between the guarantor and creditor? A compromise between the creditor and the principal debtor benefits the guarantor but does not prejudice him. That which is entered into between the guarantor and the creditor benefits but does not prejudice the principal debtor.11 J9JC9B0M “Articles 2059, 2060, Civil Code. “Article 2061, Civil Code. ’“Article 2062, Civil Code. “Article 2063, Civil Code. J9JC9B0M 360 12. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II Is there a sub-guarantor's right to excussion? Yes. The guarantor of a guarantor shall enjoy the benefit of excussion, both with respect to the guarantor and to the principal debtor.12 13. What is the benefit of division? Should there be several guarantors of only one debtor and for the same debt, the obligation to answer for the same is divided among all. The creditor cannot claim from the guarantors except the shares which they are respectively bound to pay, unless solidarity has been expressly stipulated. The benefit of division against the co­ guarantors ceases in the same cases and for the same reasons as the benefit of excussion against the principal debtor.13 14. What right does a guarantor who pays for a debtor acquire against the latter? The guarantor who pays for a debtor must be indemnified by the latter. The indemnity comprises: (i) the total amount of the debt; (ii) the legal interests thereon from the time the payment was made known to the debtor, even though it did not earn interest for the creditor; (iii) the expenses incurred by the guarantor after having notified the debtor that payment had been demanded of him; (iv) damages, if they are due. Note, however, that if the debt was for a period and the guarantor paid it before it became due, he cannot demand reimbursement of the debtor until the expiration of the period unless the payment has been ratified by the debtor.1' 15. Does the guarantor who pays for a debtor acquire a right to subrogation? Yes. The guarantor who pays is subrogated by virtue thereof to all the rights which the creditor had against the debtor. If the guarantor has compromised with the creditor, he cannot demand of the debtor more than what he has really paid.16 ‘“Article 2064, Civil Code. ‘’Article 2065, Civil Code. ■'Articles 2066, 2069, Civil Code. ‘“Article 2067, Civil Code. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 16. 361 What happens if the guarantor pays without notifying the debtor? If the guarantor should pay without notifying the debtor, the latter may enforce against him all the defenses which he could have set up against the creditor at the time the payment was made. Also, if the guarantor has paid without notifying the debtor, and the latter not being aware of the payment, repeats the payment, the former has no remedy whatever against the debtor, but only against the creditor. Nevertheless, in case of a gratuitous guaranty, if the guarantor was prevented by a fortuitous event from advising the debtor of the payment, and the creditor becomes insolvent, the debtor shall reimburse the guarantor for the amount paid.16 17. What are the instances when the guarantor, even before having paid, may proceed against the principal debtor? The guarantor, even before having paid, may proceed against the principal debtor: a. when he is sued for the payment; b. in case of insolvency of the principal debtor; c. when the debtor has bound himself to relieve him from the guaranty within a specified period, and this period has expired; d. when the debt has become demandable, by reason of the expiration of the period for payment; e. after the lapse of 10 years, when the principal obligation has no fixed period for its maturity, unless it be of such nature that it cannot be extinguished except within a period longer than 10 years; f. if there are reasonable grounds to fear that the principal debtor intends to abscond; g. if the principal debtor is in imminent danger of becoming insolvent. In all these cases, the action of the guarantor is to obtain release from the Guaranty, or to demand a security that shall protect J9JC9B0M 16Articles 2068, 2070, Civil Code. J9JC9B0M 362 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II him from any proceedings by the creditor and from the danger of insolvency of the debtor.” 18. In case the payment has been made in virtue of a judicial demand, or when the principal debtor or one of the guarantors is insolvent, what are the effects of guaranty as between co­ guarantors? In case the payment has been made in virtue of a judicial demand, or when the principal debtor or one of the guarantors is insolvent, the effects of Guaranty as between co-guarantors are as follows: a. When there are two (2) or more guarantors of the same debtor and for the same debt, the one who has paid may demand of each of the others the share which is proportionally owing from him. To illustrate: Gl, G2, and G3 are D’s guarantors of a P30 Million loan obtained from C. If D becomes insolvent, guarantors Gl, G2, and G3 loses the benefit of division as far as C is concerned. C may demand payment of the entire P30 Million from any of the guarantors. [Arts. 2065, par.2, 2059(3), Civil Code] If Gl pays the entire loan of P30 Million, she can later demand from G2 and G3 PIO Million each. b. If any of the guarantors should be insolvent, his share shall be borne by the others, including the payer, in the same proportion. To illustrate: Using our previous example, if G2 is insolvent, her share shall be borne by Gl and G3 proportionately. Thus, Gl can demand P15 Million from G3. c. A sub-guarantor, in case of the insolvency of the guarantor for whom he bound himself, is responsible to the co­ guarantors in the same terms as the guarantor. ’’Article 2071, Civil Code. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 363 To illustrate: Using our previous example, if SG is the guarantor of G3, and G3 becomes insolvent, SG is liable to G1 for PIO Million, or P15 Million if G2 is also insolvent. d. 19, The co-guarantors may set up against the one who paid, the same defenses which would have pertained to the principal debtor against the creditor, and which are not purely personal to the debtor.18 What are the causes for extinguishment of Guaranty? Causes for extinguishment of guaranty: a. Principal obligation is extinguished; b. Same causes as all other obligations;’9 c. If creditor voluntarily accepts immovable or other properties in payment of the debt (even if he should afterwards lose the same through eviction or conveyance of property); d. Release in favor of one of the guarantors, without consent of the others, benefits all to the extent of the share of the guarantor to whom it has been granted; e. Extension granted to the debtor by the creditor without the consent of guarantor; or f. When by some act of the creditor, the guarantors even though they are solidarily Hable cannot be subrogated to the rights, mortgages, and preferences of the former.20 ’’Articles 2073-2075, Civil Code. ’’Article 1231, Civil Code. Obligations are extinguished: (1) By payment or performance; (2) By the loss of the thing due; (3) By the condonation or remission of the debt; (4) By the confusion or merger of the rights of creditor and debtor; (5) By compensation; (6) By novation. Other causes of extinguishment of obligations, such as annulment, rescission, fulfillment of a resolutory condition, and prescription, are governed elsewhere in this Code. “Articles 2076-2081, Civil Code. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 364 20. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II What is a bond? A bond, when required by law, is commonly understood to mean an undertaking that is sufficiently secured, and not cash or currency. Whenever surety bonds are submitted, they are subject to any objections as to their sufficiency or as to the solvency of the bondsman.21 21. What is a bondsman? A bondsman is a surety offered in virtue of a provision of law or a judicial order. He must have the qualifications required of a guarantor under Article 2056 of the Civil Code and special laws (like the Rules of Court).22 22. Is a judicial bondsman and sub-surety entitled to excussion? No. A judicial bondsman cannot demand the exhaustion of the property of the principal debtor. Likewise, a sub-surety in the same case, cannot demand the exhaustion of the property of the debtor or of the surety.23 23. Chabs Inc. issued a guaranty in favor of DSD, which among others, provides that should DSD default on its obligations to X Co., Chabs Inc. shall be liable to pay P5,000,000.00 pesos and for any interest and expenses relating to the default of DSD. During the term of the contract, DSD defaulted and X Co. came after Chabs Inc. as the guarantor to collect the damages totaling to P7,000,000.00 pesos including all the interests and expenses. Chabs, Inc. responded that they should not be made to pay more than the fixed amount written in their guaranty agreement. X Co. countered that the guaranty agreement provided for liability for interest and expenses. Who is correct? Decide. X Co. is correct. It can collect from Chabs Inc. the entire amount notwithstanding the fixed amount written on the guaranty 21Comm. of Customs v. Alikpala, G.R. No. L-32542, November 26, 1970. “Article 2082, Civil Code. “Article 2084, Civil Code. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 365 agreement. The limit of Chabs Inc.’s liabilities must be determined from the suretyship agreement it had signed. It is undoubtedly true that the law looks upon the contract of suretyship with a jealous eye, and the rule is settled that the obligation of the surety cannot be extended by implication beyond its specified limits. To the extent, and in the manner, and under the circumstances pointed out in his obligation, he is bound, and no farther. The law is clear that a guarantor may bind himself for less, but not for more than the principal debtor, both as regards the amount and the onerous nature of the conditions. However, in this case, the agreement provides for liability for interest and expenses, then Chabs Inc. is bound by this agreement and should be liable for the entire P7,000,000.00.24 24. BSB obtained a 10-year credit facility from XYZ Bank in the amount of PI Billion. ABC Guaranty Inc. issued a guaranty to secure the obligations of BSB. In year five (5), the loan released to BSB increased to P1.5 Billion. Can the guaranty issued by ABC Guaranty Inc. sufficiently secure the obligations of BSB currently amounting to P1.5 Billion already? Yes. A guaranty may be given to secure future debts. The Supreme Court in the case Atok Finance Corp. v. Court of Appeals, et al.,15 stated, “It is clear to us that the Rizal Commercial Banking Corporation26 and the NARIC11 cases rejected the distinction which the Court of Appeals in the case at bar sought to make with respect to Article 2053, that is, that the ‘future debts’ referred to in that Article relate to ‘debts already existing at the time of the constitution of the agreement but the amount [of which] is unknown,’ and not to debts not yet incurred and existing at that time. Of course, a surety is not bound under any particular principal obligation until that principal obligation is born. But there is no theoretical or doctrinal difficulty inherent in saying that the suretyship agreement itself is valid and binding even before the principal obligation intended to be secured thereby is born, any more that there would be in saying that obligations which are subject to a condition precedent are valid and binding before the occurrence of the condition precedent.” 21Dino & Uy v. Court of Appeals and Metropolitan Bank & Trust Company, G.R. No. 89775, November 26, 1992. “G.R. No. 80078, May 18, 1993. 2«115SCRA 777. 27103 Phil. 1131. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 366 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 25. What is the extent of the "right to indemnification" of the guarantor against the principal debtor? As a rule, a guarantor who pays for a debtor should be indemnified by the latter and would be legally subrogated to the rights which the creditor has against the debtor. However, a person who makes payment without the knowledge or against the will of the debtor has the right to recover only insofar as the payment has been beneficial to the debtor. If the obligation was subject to defenses on the part of the debtor, the same defenses which could have been set up against the creditor can be set up against the paying guarantor.2* 26. In 2011, Veterans Bank granted a five (5)-year 10 million-peso loan with XYZ, Inc. To secure payment, ABC Corp, executed a Guarantee Agreement agreeing to guarantee payment of XYZ Inc.'s entire loan obligation. The Guarantee Agreement, however, states that ABC Corp, waives its right of excussion under Article 2058 of the Civil Code and that, consequently. Veterans Bank can claim under the Guarantee Agreement directly against ABC Corp, without having to exhaust all the properties of XYZ, Inc. and without need of any prior recourse against XYZ, Inc. In 2013, a huge storm destroyed XYZ, Inc.'s facilities indefinitely halting its business operations. In 2014, XYZ Inc. filed a Petition for Voluntary Rehabilitation under the Financial Rehabilitation and Insolvency Act of 2010 ("FRIA") before the RTC which, acting as a Rehabilitation Court, issued a Stay Order in favor of XYZ Inc. In 2015, Veterans Bank demanded payment of the entire loan from ABC Corp. Invoking the RTC's Stay Order, ABC Corp, denied Veterans Bank's claim. Veterans Bank filed a collection suit against ABC Corp, before the RTC. Decide. The Stay Order issued by the Rehabilitation Court does not preclude the RTC from hearing and deciding Veterans Bank's complaint. “Philippine Export and Foreign Loan Guarantee Corporation v. V.P. Eusebio Construction, Inc., el al., G.R. No. 140047, July 13, 2004. F VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 367 The Stay Order relied upon by ABC Corp, merely ordered the staying and suspension of enforcement of all claims and proceedings against XYZ, Inc. and not against other persons or entities solidarity liable with the debtor. Section 18(c) of the FRIA explicitly states that a stay order shall not apply “to the enforcement of claims against sureties and other persons solidarity liable with the debtor, and third party or accommodation mortgagors as well as issuers of letters of credit, x x x”. In addition, under Rule 4, Section 6 of A.M. No. 00-8-10-SC or the Interim Rules of Procedure on Corporate Rehabilitation, a stay order has the effect of staying enforcement only with respect to claims made against the debtor, its guarantors and persons not solidarity liable with the debtor: Section 6. Stay Order. - If the court finds the petition to be sufficient in form and substance, it shall, not later than five (5) working days from the filing of the petition, issue an order: (a) appointing a rehabilitation receiver and fixing his bond; (b) staying enforcement of all claims, whether for money or otherwise and whether such enforcement is by court action or otherwise, against the debtor, its guarantors and persons not solidarity Hable with the debtor x x x. The Guarantee Agreement, however, shows that ABC, Corp, waived its right of excussion under Article 2058 of the Civil Code. In effect, the nature of the guarantee obligation assumed by ABC, Corp, under the Guarantee Agreement was transformed into a suretyship thus solidarity binding itself with XYZ, Inc. Under a normal contract of guarantee, the guarantor binds himself to the creditor to fulfill the obligation of the principal debtor in case the latter should fail to do so. The guarantor who pays for a debtor, in turn, must be indemnified by the latter. However, the guarantor cannot be compelled to pay the creditor unless the latter has exhausted all the property of the debtor and resorted to all the legal remedies against the debtor. This is what is otherwise known as the benefit of excussion. Conversely, if this benefit of excussion is waived, the guarantor can be directly compelled by the creditor to pay the entire debt even without the exhaustion of the debtor’s properties. In other words, a guarantor who engages to directly shoulder the debt of the debtor, waiving the benefit of excussion and the requirement of prior presentment, demand, protest, or notice of any kind, undoubtedly makes himself/herself solidarity Hable to the creditor. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 368 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II Veterans Bank can thus claim under the Guarantee Agreement DIRECTLY against ABC, Corp, without having to exhaust all the properties of XYZ, Inc. and without need of any prior recourse against XYZ, Inc.89 II. Surety 27. What is the concept and nature of suretyship? If a person binds himself solidarily with the principal debtor, the contract is called a Suretyship.30 A Contract of Suretyship is an agreement whereby a party, called the surety, guarantees the performance by another party, called the principal or obligor, of an obligation or undertaking in favor of another party, called the obligee. Although the Contract of a Surety is secondary only to a valid principal obligation, the surety becomes liable for the debt or duty of another although it possesses no direct or personal interest over the obligations nor does it receive any benefit therefrom. The surety’s obligation is not an original and direct one for the performance of his own act, but merely accessory or collateral to the obligation contracted by the principal. Nevertheless, although the contract of a surety is in essence secondary only to a valid principal obligation, his liability to the creditor or promisee of the principal is said to be direct, primary, and absolute; in other words, he is directly and equally bound with the principal.31 28. is there a required form for a contract of suretyship? Yes. A contract of suretyship is a special promise to answer for the debt, default, or miscarriage of another; hence, pursuant to the Statute of Frauds, it must in writing and subscribed by the party charged or by the latter’s duly authorized agent. Otherwise, it would be unenforceable.32 29. Distinguish surety from guaranty. By a guaranty a person, called the guarantor, binds himself to the creditor to fulfill the obligation of the principal debtor in case 29Trade and Investment Development Corporation of the Philippines also known as Philippine Export-Import Credit Agency v. Philippine Veterans Bank, G.R. No. 233850, July 1, 2019. 30Article 2084, Civil Code. 31Lim v. Security Bank Corporation, G.R. No. 188539, March 12, 2014. “Article 1403(2)(b), Civil Code. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 369 the latter fails to do so. On the other hand, if a person himself is solidarity liable with the principal debtor, the contract is called a suretyship. Guaranty ____________ Surety Guarantor is secondarily liable. Surety is primarily liable. Insurer of solvency of debtor Insurer of the debt (a guarantor agrees that the credi­ tor, after proceeding against the principal, may proceed against the guarantor if the principal is unable to pay) (a surety promises to pay the prin­ cipal’s debt if the principal will not pay) s 30. Distinguish surety from solidary co-debtor. A suretyship requires a principal debtor to whom the surety is solidarity bound by way of an ancillary obligation of segregate identity from the obligation between the principal debtor and the creditor. Further, solidarity signifies that the creditor can compel any one of the joint and several debtors or the surety alone to answer for the entirety of the principal debt. The difference lies with regard the right to seek reimbursement for the sums paid out to the creditor.34 Surety _______ Solidary co-debtor not a party to the obligation; and does not benefit from the transaction between the creditor and the solidary debtors a party to the obligation entitled to obtain indemnification for the entire amount right for reimbursement is subject to deductions pertaining to his share or at times even pertaining to his proportionate share in the portion that should have been paid by an insolvent solidary debtor “Article 2047, Civil Code; Gateway Electronics Asian Bank, G.R. No. 172041, December 18, 2008. 31Articles 2047,1217, Civil Code; Escano, el al. v. Ortigas, Jr., G.R. No. 151953, June 29, 2007. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 370 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 31. Distinguish an "accommodation surety" from a "compensated surety" The Supreme Court has clarified on the distinction between an accommodation surety and a compensated surety and the reasons for treating them differently: The law has authorized the formation of corporations for the purpos^ of conducting surety business, and the corporate surety differieignificantly from the individual private surety. First, unlike the private surety, the corporate surety signs for cash and not for friendship. The private surety is regarded as someone doing a rather foolish act for praiseworthy motives; the corporate surety, to the contrary, is in business to make a profit and charges a premium depending upon the amount of guaranty and the risk involved. Second, the corporate surety, like an insurance company, prepares the instrument, which is a type of contract of adhesion whereas the private surety usually does not prepare the note or bond which he signs. Third, the obligation of the private surety often is assumed simply on the basis of the debtor’s representations and without legal advice, while the corporate surety does not bind itself until a full investigation has been made. For these reasons, the courts distinguish between the individual gratuitous surety and the vocational corporate surety. In the case of the corporate surety, the rule afcstrictissimi juris is not applicable, and courts apply the rules of interpretation of appertaining to contracts of insurance. Consequently, the rule of strict construction of the surety contract is commonly applied to an accommodation surety but is not extended to favor a compensated corporate surety. The rationale of this doctrine is reasonable; an accommodation surety acts without motive of pecuniary gain and, hence, should be protected against unjust pecuniary impoverishment by imposing on the principal duties akin to those of a fiduciary. This cannot be said of a compensated corporate surety which is a business association organized for the purpose of assuming classified risks in large numbers, for profit and on an impersonal basis, through the me’dium of standardized written contractual forms drawn by its oye^representatives with the primary aim of protecting its own interns.35 “Erma Industries, Inc. December 6, 2017. A Security Bank Corporation, G.R. No. 191274, VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 371 32. Does a change in the terms of the principal contract automatically cancel the surety contract? The liabilities of an insurer under the surety bond are not extinguished when the modifications in the principal contract do not substantially or materially alter the principal’s obligations. A suretyship consists of two (2) different contracts: (1) the surety contract and (2) the principal contract which it guarantees. Since the insurer’s liability is strictly based only on the terms stated in the surety contract in relation to the principal contract, any. Change in the principal contract, which materially alters the principal’s obligations would, in effect, constitute an implied novation of the surety contract. A surety is released from its obligation when there is a material alteration of the contract in connection with which the bond is given, such as a change which imposes a new obligation on the promising party, or which takes away some obligation already imposed, or one which changes the legal effect of the original contract and not merely its form. A surety, however, is not released by a change in the contract which does not have the effect of making its obligation more onerous.36 33. Can a surety agreement secure an obligation in the absence of a written contract evidencing the principal obligation? Yes. Section 175 of P.D. No. 612 (Insurance Code, as amended) defined suretyship as an agreement where a party called the surety guarantees the performance by another party called the principal or obligor of an obligation or undertaking in favor of a third person called the obligee. Under Section 176 of the Insurance Code, the nature and extent of a surety’s liability are as follows: SEC. 176. The liability of the surety or sureties shall be joint and several with the obligor and shall be limited to the amount of the bond. It is determined strictly by the terms of the contract of suretyship in relation to the principal contract between the obligor and the obligee.37 ■ _________ “People’s Trans-East Asia Insurance Corporation, a.k.a. People’s General In­ surance Corporation v. Doctors of New Millennium Holdings, Inc., G.R. No. 172404, August 13, 2014. 37Emphasis supplied. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 372 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II Thus, the surety’s liability is joint and several with the obligor, limited to the amount of the bond, and determined strictly by the terms of the contract of suretyship in relation to the principal contract between the obligor and the obligee. Article 1356 of the Civil Code provides that contracts shall be obligatory in whatever form they may have been entered into, provided all the essential requisites for their validity are present. Thus, an oral agreement which has all the essential requisites for validity may be guaranteed by a surety contract. To rule otherwise contravenes the clear import of Article 1356 of the Civil Code.39 34. Can a surety become liable to pay the legal interest thereby making its liability more than the amount of its issued bonds? Yes. As early as Tagawa v. Aldanese and Union Guarantee Co. and reiterated in Plaridel Surety & Insurance Co., Inc. v. P.L. Galang Machinery Co., Inc., and more recently, in Republic v. Court of Appeals and R & B Surety and Insurance Company, Inc., the Supreme Court has sustained the principle that if a surety upon demand fails to pay, he can be held liable for interest, even if in thus paying, its liability becomes more than the principal obligation. The increased liability is not because of the contract but because of the default and the necessity of judicial collection. A surety’s liability under the suretyship contract is different from its liability under the law. There is no question that a surety should not be made to pay more than its assumed obligation under the surety bonds. However, a surety’s liability for the payment of interest is not by reason of the suretyship agreement itself but because of the delay in the payment of its obligation under the said agreement.39 III. Real Estate Mortgage Law 35. What is a Real Estate Mortgage ("REM")? A REM is a contract whereby the debtor secures to the creditor the fulfillment of the principal obligation, specially subjecting to The Solid Guaranty, Inc., G.R. No. 226731, “Cellpage International Corp. June 17, 2020. “Commonwealth Insurance v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 130886, January 29, 2004. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 373 such security immovable property or real rights over immovable property, in case the principal obligation is not fulfilled at the time stipulated.40 36. What are the characteristics of a REM? Characteristics of REM: 37. a. it is a real right; b. it is an accessory contract; C. it is indivisible [each and every parcel under mortgage answers for the totality of the debt]; d. it is inseparable [a mortgage directly and immediately subjects the property upon which it is imposed, whoever the possessor may be, to the fulfillment of the obligation for whose security it was constituted; the mortgage adheres to the property, regardless of who its owner may subsequently be]; and e. the object of the contract is immovable property or alienable real rights over immovable property.41 Can a valid REM be constituted on the building erected on the land belonging to another? Yes. The Supreme Court has ruled that the inclusion of “building” as separate and distinct from the land in the enumeration in Article 415 of the Civil Code can only mean that a building is by itself an immovable property. Thus, while it is true that a mortgage of land necessarily includes, in the absence of stipulation of the improvements thereon, buildings, still a building by itself may be mortgaged apart from the land on which it has been built. Such a mortgage would still be a real estate mortgage for the building would still be considered immovable property even if dealt with separately and apart from the land. In the same manner, possessory rights over said properties before title is vested on the grantee, may be validly transferred or conveyed as in a deed of mortgage?2 <012 Manreaa 467. Mallorca, 128 SCRA 747; “Articles 2089, 2124, 2126, Civil Code; PNB McCullough v. Veloso, 46 Phil. 1. “Prudential Bank v. Panis, 153 SCRA 390 citing Lopez v. Orosa, Jr., et a!., G.R. No. L-10817-18, February 28,1958; Leung Yee v. Strong Machinery Co., 37 Phil. 644, and Vda. de Bautista v. Marcos, 3 SCRA 438 (1961). J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 374 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL I .AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 38. Explain the "inseparable" characteristic of a real estate mortgage. It is a real right, following the property, such that in subsequent transfers by the mortgagor, the transferee must respect the mortgage. A registered mortgage lien is considered inseparable from the property inasmuch as it is a right in rem. The mortgage creates a real right or a lien which, after being recorded, follows the chattel wherever it goes. The mortgage on the property may still be foreclosed despite the transfer.43 39. Is a stipulation forbidding the owner from alienating the mortgaged immovable valid? No. A stipulation forbidding the owner from alienating the mortgaged immovable is void.44 40. Can mortgage credit be alienated or assigned? Yes. The mortgage credit may be alienated or assigned to a third person, in whole or in part, with the formalities required by law." 41. What are the requisites for a valid constitution of a REM? The following requisites are essential for the constitution of a REM: 1. It is constituted to secure the fulfillment of a principal obligation; 2. The mortgagor must be the absolute owner of the real estate mortgaged; 3. The mortgagor has the free disposal of the property, and in the absence thereof, that he is legally authorized for the purpose. Third persons who are not parties to the principal obligation may secure the latter mortgaging their own property.48 I “Article 2126, Civil Code; PNB v. RBL Enterprises, Inc., G.R. No. 149569, May 28, 2004. "Article 2130, Civil Code. "Article 2128, Civil Code. "Article 2085, Civil Code VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 375 In relation thereto, Article 2125 of the Civil Code further provides: In addition to the requisites stated in Article 2085, it is indispensable, in order that a mortgage may be validly constituted, that the document in which it appears be recorded in the Registry of Property. If the instrument is not recorded, the mortgage is nevertheless binding between the parties.47 Thus, as between the parties to a mortgage, the non-registration of a REM deed is immaterial to its validity. Recording in the Registry of Property is only necessary in order to bind third persons.43 42. Is a REM valid if the deed evidencing the same was notarized without authority and compliance with the prescribed form under Section 112 of P.D. No. 1529 (Property Registration Decree). The defective notarization of a REM agreement merely strips it of its public character and reduces it to a private document. Although Article 1358 of the New Civil Code requires that the form of a contract transmitting or extinguishing real rights over immovable property should be in a public document, the failure to observe such required form does not render the transaction invalid. The necessity of a public document for the said contracts is only for convenience; it is not essential for its validity or enforceability. When there is a defect in the notarization of a document, the clear and convincing evidentiary standard originally attached to a dulynotarized document is dispensed with, and the measure to test the validity of such document is preponderance of evidence.49 43. What are the remedies available to the mortgagee in case of non-payment of the loan secured by the real estate mortgage or violation of the terms and conditions of the loan agreement? The mortgagee may either file an action for specific performance to compel payment of the loan or he may foreclose the mortgagee, extra-judicially, in accordance with Act No. 3135, as amended (An Act to Regulate the Sale of Property under Special Powers Inserted J9JC9B0M ’’Emphasis supplied. “Articles 2124, 2125, Civil Code. “Coca-Cola Bottlers v. Soriano, G.R. No. 211232, April 11, 2018. J9JC9B0M 376 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II in or Annexed to Real Estate Mortgages) or judicially, either Rule 68 of the Rules of Court. 44. What is the effect of the filing of an action for specific performance on the right of the mortgagee to foreclose the real estate mortgage? The mere filing of action for specific performance to collect the loan is tantamount to a waiver or abandonment of the mortgage lien. Thus, should the mortgagee obtain adverse judgment in the collection case, he can no longer foreclose the real estate mortgage. Should the mortgagee opt to foreclose the mortgage, he may still file an action for collection to enforce payment of the deficiency if the sale proceeds realized during the foreclosure are not sufficient to satisfy the loan secured by the real estate mortgage. The mortgagee, however, is not entitled to recover deficiency if the person who constituted the mortgage is an accommodation mortgagor. The accommodation mortgagor is liable only up the extent of the value of the property, unless otherwise stipulated or when he acted also as a surety.50 45. To secure a loan, the Sps. Santos mortgaged their property covered by TCT No. 1234 to Standard Bank. The Sps. Santos defaulted in their loan payments causing Standard Bank to extrajudicially foreclose on the mortgage with ABC Corp, getting the highest bid. For failure to redeem the property during the redemption period, TCT No. 1234 was cancelled and a new title was issued in favor of ABC Corp. The Sps. Santos leased the subject property to others and collected rentals thereon. ABC Corp, filed before the RTC a petition for the issuance of a writ of possession. The RTC issued two (2) Orders: the first, issued the writ of possession; the second, ordered the Sps. Santos to deliver to ABC Corp, and/or deposit with the Court the monthly rentals of the subject property covering the period after expiration of the redemption up to the time they surrender the possession thereof to ABC Corp. Can back rentals be awarded in an ex parte application for writ of possession under Act No. 3135, as amended? “Corodan v. China Bank Corporation, G.R. No. 210542, February 24, 2016. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 377 Yes. When the redemption period expired, ABC Corp, became the owner of the subject property and was, from then on, entitled to the fruits thereof. The Sps. Santos ceased to be the owners of the subject property, and had no right to the same as well as to its fruits. Under Section 32, Rule 39 of the Rules of Court, on Execution, Satisfaction, and Effect of Judgments, all rents, earnings, and income derived from the property pending redemption shall belong to the judgment obligor, but only until the expiration of his period of redemption. After the redemption period expired without the Sps. Santos redeeming the subject property, ABC Corp, became the absolute owner thereof, and the Sps. Santos lost all their rights thereto, including the right to lease out the same and collect rentals on said lease. The Sps. Santos simply hold the amounts collected in trust -with the obligation to return the same to their rightful owners.61 46. Does the mortgagor lose ownership of the mortgaged property after extra-judicial foreclosure of the real estate mortgage under Act No. 3135, as amended? The mortgagor does not lose ownership of the mortgaged property after foreclosure because he has redemption right under the law. It is only when he fails to redeem the real estate mortgage within the period prescribed by law that the mortgagee may consolidate title to the property, resulting in the mortgagor’s loss of ownership thereof. As a consequence, the mortgagor may sell the property or constitute a second mortgage thereon, but subject to the preferred rights and lien of the mortgagee. 47. Is the validity of a mortgage contract that was constituted to secure a loan obligation affected by the validity of the loan contract? Yes. The validity of accessory contracts mainly flows from the validity of the principal contracts. A real estate mortgage is in the nature of an accessory contract; thus, its validity depends on the validity of the loan contract.62 6lSps. Teves v. Integrated Credit and Corporate Services, Inc., G.R. No. 216714, April 4, 2018. 62Luntao v. BAP Credit Guaranty Corporation, G.R. No. 204412, September 20,2017. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 378 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 48. What is a blanket mortgage or dragnet clause in a real estate mortgage contract? It is the stipulation extending the coverage of a mortgage to advances or loans other than those already obtained or specified in the contract.63 Thus, if a mortgagor obtains a loan for Pl Million secured by a real estate mortgage which contains a dragnet clause, loans incurred subsequent to the execution of the mortgage agreement are covered by the mortgage even though no amendment to the existing mortgage contract or a fresh mortgage agreement is signed by the parties when the future loans are actually obtained. 49. A Real Estate Mortgage Agreement provides: "That, for and in consideration of certain loans, and other credit accommodations obtained from the Mortgagee, and to secure the payment of the same and those that may hereafter be obtained, a real estate mortgage is hereby constituted on the real property, more particularly described under TCT No. 123456, registered in the name of Juan dela Cruz." Does the Real Estate Mortgage Agreement secure past obligations? Although a blanket mortgage or a dragnet clause is generally recognized as valid, these other obligations, past or future, secured by the real estate contract must be specifically described within the terms of the mortgage contract. It is clear that the agreement does not cover obligations incurred prior to the execution of the mortgage instrument.61 IV. Personal Property Security Act (R.A. No. 11057) 50. Define the following terms: a. b. c. d. Commodity contract Competing claimant Consumer goods Control agreement “Panacan Lumber Co. v. Solidbank Corporation, G.R. No. 226272, September 16, 2020. 61Panacan Lumber Co., ibid. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS e. f. gh. i. jk. Default Deposit-taking institution Equipment Future property Grantor Intangible asset l. m. n. Intermediary Intermediated securities Lien Non-intermediated securities o. Notice P- Proceeds Purchase money security interest Registry Secured creditor Security interest55 qs. t. 379 Commodity contract - refers to a commodity futures contract, an option on a commodity futures contract, a commodity option, or another contract if the contract or option is: (i) traded on or subject to the rules of a board of trade that has been designated as a contract market for such a contract; or (ii) traded on a foreign commodity board of trade, exchange, or market, and is carried on the books of a commodity intermediary for a commodity customer. Competing claimant - refers to a creditor of a grantor or other person with rights in an encumbered asset that may be in competition with the rights of a secured creditor in the same encumbered asset. Consumer goods - refer to goods that are used or acquired for use primarily for personal, family, or household purposes. Control agreement - an agreement in writing between the grantor and the secured creditor which perfects the security interests over an intangible asset. J9JC9B0M “Section 3. R.A. No. 11057; Section 1.05, IRR. J9JC9B0M 380 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II i. With respect to intermediated securities, the control agreement is among the issuer or the intermediary, the grantor and the secured creditor, according to which the issuer or the intermediary agrees to follow instructions from the secured creditor with respect to the security, without further consent from the grantor. ii. With respect to rights to a deposit account, the control agreement is among the deposit-taking institution, the grantor, and the secured creditor, according to which the deposit-taking institution agrees to follow instructions from the secured creditor with respect to the payment of funds credited to the deposit account without further consent from the grantor. iii. With respect to commodity contracts, the control agreement is among the grantor, secured creditor, and intermediary, according to which the commodity intermediary will apply any value distributed on account of the commodity contract as directed by the secured creditor without further consent by the commodity customer or grantor. Default - the failure of a debtor to pay or otherwise perform a secured obligation, and any other event that constitutes default under the terms of an agreement between the grantor and the secured creditor. Deposit-taking institution - refers to a bank under R.A. No. 8791 or the General Banking Law, a nonstock savings and loan association as defined under R.A. No. 8367 or the Revised Nonstock Savings and Loan Association Act of 1997, or a cooperative as defined under R.A. No. 9520 or the Philippine Cooperative Code. Equipment - means a tangible asset other than inventory or consumer goods, or livestock, that is primarily used or intended to be used by the grantor in the operation of its business. Future property - refers to any movable property which does not exist or which the grantor does not have rights in or the power to encumber at the time the security agreement is concluded. Grantor - refers to (i) the person who grants a security interest in collateral to secure its own obligation or that of another person; (ii) a buyer or other transferee of a collateral that acquires VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 381 its right subject to a security interest; (iii) a transferor in an outright transfer of an accounts receivable; or (iv) a lessee of goods. Intangible asset - means any movable property other than a tangible asset including, but not limited to, investment property, deposit accounts, commodity contracts and receivables. Intermediary - refers to a person, including but not limited to, a bank, trust entity, depositary, broker, or central securities depositary, that in the ordinary course of business or regular activity maintains an account for such securities or assets, for another person, and is acting in that capacity. Intermediated securities — means securities credited to a securities account and rights in securities resulting from the credit of securities to a securities account. Lien - refers to a qualified right or a proprietary interest, which may be exercised over the property of another. Non-intermediated securities - means securities other than intermediated securities. Notice - refers to a statement of information that is registered in the Registry relating to a security interest or lien. This includes initial notice, amendment notice, and termination notice. Proceeds - any property received upon sale, lease or other disposition of collateral, or whatever is collected on or distributed with respect to collateral, claims arising out of the loss or damage to the collateral, as well as a right to insurance payment or other compensation for loss or damage of the collateral. Purchase money security interest - refers to a security interest in goods taken by the seller to secure the price or by a person who gives value to enable the grantor to acquire the goods to the extent that the credit is used for that purpose. Registry - refers to the centralized and nationwide electronic registry established in the Land Registration Authority (“LRA”) where notice of a security interest and a Hen in personal property may be registered. Secured creditor - refers to a person that has a security interest. For purposes of registration and priority, it includes a buyer of an account receivable and a lessor of goods under an operating lease for not less than one (1) year. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 382 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II Security interest - refers to a property right in collateral that secures payment or other performance of an obligation, regardless of whether the parties have denominated it as a security interest, and regardless of the type of asset, the status of the grantor or secured creditor, or the nature of the secured obligation; including the right of a buyer of accounts receivable and a lessor under an operating lease for not less than one (1) year. 51. What is the scope of application of Personal Property Security Act ("PPSA")? The PPSA applies to all transactions of any form that secure an obligation with personal property, whether it is a tangible or an intangible asset, except interests in aircraft subject to R.A. No. 9497 or the Civil Aviation Authority Act of 2008, and interests in ships subject to P.D. No. 1521 or the Ship Mortgage Decree of 1978.“ 52. Is there a prescribed form of a security agreement? Yes. A security agreement must be contained in a written (including electronic) contract signed by the parties. It must identify the collateral and the secured obligation. It may consist of one (1) or more writings that, taken together, establish the intent of the parties to create a security interest.67 53. What constitutes a sufficient description of collateral? A description of collateral shall be considered sufficient, whether it is specific or general, if it reasonably identifies the collateral. A description such as “all personal property,” “all equipment,” “all inventory,” or “all personal property within a generic category” of the grantor shall be sufficient.68 54. Can a security agreement provide for the creation of a security interest in future property? Yes. A security agreement may provide for the creation of a security interest in future property or after-acquired assets, but the security interest in that property is created only when the grantor “Section 4, R.A. No. 11057. fi7Section 6, R.A. No. 11057. “Section 7, R.A. No. 11057. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 383 acquires rights in it or the power to encumber it. It may provide that a security interest in a tangible asset that is transformed into a product extends to the product, but such interest shall be limited to the value of the encumbered asset immediately before it became part of the product. A security agreement may also provide that a security interest in a tangible asset extends to its replacement, but such interest shall be limited to the value of the encumbered asset immediately before it was replaced.09 55. What is the extent of security interests over right to proceeds and commingled funds? A security interest in personal property shall extend to its identifiable or traceable proceeds. Where proceeds in the form of funds credited to a deposit account or money are commingled with other funds or money: (i) the security interest shall extend to the commingled money or funds, notwithstanding that the proceeds have ceased to be identifiable to the extent they remain traceable; (ii) the security interest in the commingled funds or money shall be limited to the amount of the proceeds immediately before they were commingled; and (iii) if at any time after the commingling, the balance credited to the deposit account or the amount of the commingled money is less than the amount of the proceeds immediately before they were commingled, the security interest against the commingled funds or money shall be limited to the lowest amount of the commingled funds or money between the time when the proceeds were commingled and the time the security interest in the proceeds is claimed.00 56. What is the extent of security interest over tangible assets commingled in a mass? A security interest in a tangible asset that is commingled in a mass extends to the mass, but such interest shall be limited to the same proportion of the mass as the quantity of the encumbered asset bore to the quantity of the entire mass immediately after the commingling.01 J9JC9B0M •’Section 3.05, IRR of R.A. No. 11057. “Section 3.06, IRR of R.A. No. 11057. •'Section 3.07, IRR of R.A. No. 11057. J9JC9B0M 384 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 57. Can a security agreement provide for security interest in accounts receivables? Yes. A security agreement may provide for security interest in accounts receivable arising from: (i) a contract for the supply or lease of goods or services other than financial services; (ii) a construction contract or contract for the sale or lease of real property; and (iii) a contract for the sale, lease, or license of intellectual property.62 58. Can there be a stipulation limiting the grantor's right to create a security interest in accounts receivables? No. Any stipulation limiting the grantor’s right to create a security interest shall be void. A security interest in an account receivable shall be effective notwithstanding any agreement between the grantor and the account debtor or any secured creditor limiting in any way the grantor’s right to create a security interest.63 59. Will the creation of a security interest in a receivable affectthe rights and obligations of the debtor of the receivable? No. The creation of a security interest in a receivable does not, without the consent of the debtor of the receivable, affect its rights and obligations, including the payment terms contained in the contract giving rise to the receivable. However, a payment instruction may change the person, address, or account to which the debtor of the receivable is required to make payment.61 60. When and how can a security interest be perfected? A security interest shall be perfected when it has been created and the secured creditor has taken one of the following actions: (i) registration of a notice with the Registry; (ii) possession, whether actual or constructive, of the collateral either by the secured creditor or a depositary acting for the secured creditor; or (iii) control [conclusion of a control agreement] of investment property and deposit account. A security interest in any tangible asset may be perfected by registration or possession, while a security interest in investment property and deposit account may be perfected by registration or conclusion of a control agreement.06 “Section 3.08(d), IRR of R.A. No. 11057. “Section 3.08, IRR of R.A. No. 11057. “Section 3.09, IRR of R.A. No. 11057. “Sections 11, 12, and 13, R.A. No. 11057. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 61. 385 Who are the parties to, and what are the form and contents of a Control Agreement? A Control Agreement shall: Parties _____ Form/Contents______ Intermediated Securities Executed in writing by the issuer or the inter­ mediary, the grantor and the secured creditor Stipulate that the issuer or the intermediary agrees to follow instructions from the secured creditor with respect to the security, without fur­ ther consent from the grantor Deposit Account writing Executed in deposit­ the among taking institution, the grantor and the secured creditor Stipulate that the deposit­ taking institution agrees to follow instructions from the secured creditor with respect to the payment of funds cre­ dited to the deposit account without further consent from the grantor Commodity Contracts Executed writing in among the grantor, se­ cured creditor and inter­ mediary Stipulate that the commodity intermediary will apply any value distributed on account of the commodity contract as directed by the secured credi­ tor without further consent by the commodity customer or grantor es 62. For purposes of registration of security interest, what constitutes as a sufficient notice? An initial notice of security interest is deemed sufficient if: (i) it identifies the grantor by an identification number; (ii) it identifies the secured creditor or an agent of the secured creditor by name; (iii) it provides an address for the grantor and secured creditor or its agent; (iv) it describes the collateral; and (v) the prescribed fee has been tendered, or an arrangement has been made for payment of fees by other means. If the grantor is a natural person, that grantor shall be identified through the name appearing in any of the grantor’s governmentissued identification. If the grantor is a juridical person, that grantor J9JC9B0M “Section 4.07, IRR of R.A. No. 11057. J9JC9B0M 386 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II shall be identified through its name in the most recently registered articles of incorporation, or in an agreement constituting the legal person.67 63. Can the notice be registered even before a security agreement is concluded? Yes. A notice may be registered before a security agreement is concluded. Once a security agreement is concluded, the date of registration of the notice shall be reckoned from the date the notice was registered.68 64. When does the notice take effect? A notice shall be effective at the time it is discoverable on the records of the Registry, and shall remain effective for the duration of the term indicated in the notice unless a continuation notice is registered before the term lapses. The period of effectiveness of a notice may be continued by registering an amendment notice that identifies the initial notice by its registration number. Continuation of notice may be registered only within six (6) months before the expiration of the effective period of the notice.69 65. Can a registered notice be amended? Yes. A notice may be amended by the registration of an amendment notice that identifies the initial notice by its registration number and provides new information. The amendment notice may be filed: (i) by the secured creditor alone, if the changes to the security interest can be effected with the sole consent of the secured creditor; or (ii) by the grantor, if the changes to the security interest requires the grantor’s consent. If the amendment notice adds collateral that is not proceeds, it must be authorized by the grantor in writing. If the amendment notice adds a grantor, it must be authorized by the added grantor in writing. Such amendment notices shall be effective as to the added collateral or grantor from the date of its registration and shall be effective only as to each secured creditor who authorizes it. If a secured creditor assigns a perfected security interest, an amendment notice may be registered to reflect the assignment.70 ’’Section 28(a), R.A. No. 11057; Section 5.05(a), IRR. “Section 28(d), R.A. No. 11057. “Sections 30 and 33, R.A. No. 11057. ’’Sections 32, R.A. No. 11057; Section 5.08, IRR. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 387 66. When can the grantor demand amendment or termination of notice? A grantor may give a written demand to the secured creditor to amend or terminate the effectiveness of the notice if: (i) all the obligations under the security agreement to which the registration relates have been performed and there is no commitment to make future advances; (ii) the secured creditor has agreed to release part of the collateral described in the notice; (iii) the collateral described in the notice includes an item or kind of property that is not a collateral under a security agreement between the secured creditor and the grantor; (iv) no security agreement exists between the parties; or (v) the security interest is extinguished in accordance with law.” 67. Can the effectiveness of a notice be terminated? Yes. The effectiveness of a notice may be terminated by registering a termination notice that identifies the initial notice by its registration number and each secured creditor who authorizes the registration of the termination notice. The notice is terminated from the date and time when the information in the notice is no longer accessible to searchers of the public registry record.72 68. What are the rules with respect to priority of security interest? The priority of security interests and hens in the same collateral shall be determined according to the time of registration of a notice or perfection by other means, without regard to the order of creation of the security interests and liens or to the mode of perfection, except as provided below: Priority Rules for Intangible Assets (Investment property and deposit accounts) J9JC9B0M a) A security interest in a deposit account with respect to which the secured creditor is the deposit-taking institution or the intermediary shall have priority over a competing security interest perfected by any method. ’'Section 39, R.A. No. 11057. ’’Section 34, R.A. No. 11057; Section 5.11, IRR. J9JC9B0M 388 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II b) A security interest in a deposit account or investment property that is perfected by a control agreement shall have priority over a competing security interest except a security interest of the deposit-taking institution or the intermediary. c) The order of priority among competing security interests in a deposit account or investment property that were perfected by the conclusion of control agreements shall be determined on the basis of the time of conclusion of the control agreements. d) Any rights to set-off that the deposit-taking institution may have against a grantor’s right to payment of funds credited to a deposit account shall have priority over a security interest in the deposit account. e) A security interest in electronic non-intermediated securities perfected by a notation of the security interests in the books maintained for that purpose by or on behalf of the issuer shall have priority over a security interest in the same securities perfected by any other method. f) A security interest in electronic securities not held with an intermediary perfected by the conclusion of a control agreement shall have priority over a security interest in the same securities perfected by registration of a notice in the Registry. g) A security interest in electronic securities held with an intermediary and perfected by the conclusion of a control agreement shall have priority over a security interest in the same securities perfected by any other method. h) The order of priority among competing security interests in electronic securities not held with an intermediary perfected by the conclusion of control agreements is determined on the basis of the time of conclusion of the control agreements. r VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 389 Priority Rules for Tangible Assets Embodied in Instruments a) A security interest in a security certificate perfected by the secured creditor’s possession of the certificate shall have priority over a competing security interest perfected by registration of a notice in the Registry. b) A security interest in an instrument or negotiable document that is perfected by possession of the instrument or the negotiable document shall have priority over a security interest in the instrument or negotiable document that is perfected by registration of a notice in the Registry. c) A perfected security interest in livestock securing an obligation incurred to enable the grantor to obtain food or medicine for the livestock shall have priority over any other security interest in the livestock, except for a perfected purchase money security interest in the livestock, if the secured creditor providing credit for food or medicine gives written notification to the holder of the conflicting perfected security interest in the same livestock before the grantor receives possession of the food or medicine. Priority and Right of Retention a) A person who provides services or materials with respect to the goods, in the ordinary course of business, and retains possession of the goods shall have priority over a perfected security interest in the goods until payment thereof. Priority Rules on Purchase Money Security Interest J9JC9B0M a) A purchase money security interest in equipment and its proceeds shall have priority over a conflicting security interest, if a notice relating to the purchase money security interest is registered within three (3) business days after the grantor receives possession of the equipment. J9JC9B0M 390 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II b) A purchase money security interest in consumer goods that is perfected by registration of notice not later than three (3) business days after the grantor obtains possession of the consumer goods shall have priority over a conflicting security interest. c) A purchase money security interest in inventory, intellectual property, or livestock shall have priority over a conflicting perfected security interest in the same inventory, intellectual property, or livestock if: d) (i) The purchase money security interest is perfected when the grantor receives possession of the inventory or livestock, or acquires rights to intellectual property; and (ii) Before the grantor receives possession of the inventory or livestock, or acquires rights in intellectual property, the purchase money secured creditor gives written notification to the holder of the conflicting perfected security interest in the same types of inventory, livestock, or intellectual property. The notification sent to the holder of the conflicting security interest may cover multiple transactions between the purchase money secured creditor and the grantor without the need to identify each transaction. The purchase money security interest in equipment or consumer goods perfected timely in accordance with subsections (a) and (b), shall have priority over the rights of a buyer, lessee, or lien holder which arise between delivery of the equipment or consumer goods to the grantor and the time the notice is registered.’3 69. How can the secured creditor enforce its security interest? The secured creditor may enforce its security interest whether through a judicial process or through an extrajudicial process, including the sale of the secured assets through either a public or private disposition. "Sections 17-24, R.A. No. 11057; Sections 6.01-6.05, IRR. VIH. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 391 Expedited Repossession of the Collateral With Judicial Process Without Judicial Process ■ The secured creditor may take possession of the collateral without judicial process if the security agreement so stipulates, provided, that possession can be taken without a breach of the peace. If, upon default, the secured creditor cannot take possession of collateral without breach of the peace, the secured creditor may proceed as follows: ■ [Breach of the peace shall include: entering the private residence of the grantor without permission, resorting to physical violence or intimidation, or being accompanied by a law enforcement officer when taking possession or confronting the grantor] ■ If the collateral is a fixture, the secured creditor, if it has priority over all owners and mortgagees, may remove the fixture from • the real property to which it is affixed without judicial process. The secured creditor shall exercise due care in removing the fixture. J9JC9B0M The secured creditor shall be entitled to an expedited hearing upon application for an order granting the secured creditor possession of the collateral. Such application shall include a statement by the secured creditor, under oath, verifying the existence of the security agreement attached to the application and identifying at least one (1) event of default by the debtor under the security agreement; The secured creditor shall provide the debtor, grantor, and, if the collateral is a fixture, any real estate mortgagee, a copy of the application, including all supporting documents and evidence for the order granting the secured creditor possession of the collateral; and ■ The secured creditor is entitled to an order granting possession of the collateral upon the court finding that a default has occurred under the security agreement and that the secured creditor has a right to take possession of the collateral. The court may direct the grantor to take such action as the court deems necessary and appropriate so that the secured creditor may take possession of the collateral.’4 ’'Sections 7.01-7.03, IRRof R.A. No. 11057. J9JC9B0M 392 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 70. Can a higher-ranking secured creditor take over enforcement? Yes. Even if another secured creditor or a lien holder has commenced enforcement, a secured creditor whose security interest has priority over that of the enforcing secured creditor or lien holder shall be entitled to take over the enforcement process. This right may be invoked at any time before the collateral is sold or otherwise disposed of, or retained by the secured creditor or until the conclusion of an agreement by the secured creditor for that purpose.75 71. What are the rules on recovery in special cases (such as security interest in Accounts Receivable, Negotiable document, Deposit Account)? Upon default, the secured creditor may, without judicial process: a. Accounts Receivable. Instruct the account debtor of an accounts receivable to make payment to the secured creditor, and apply such payment to the satisfaction of the obligation secured by the security interest after deducting the secured creditor’s reasonable collection expenses. On request of the account debtor, the secured creditor shall provide evidence of its security interest to the account debtor when it delivers the instruction to the account debtor; b. Negotiable document. In a negotiable document where the security interest is perfected by possession, proceed as to the negotiable document or goods covered by the negotiable document; c. Deposit account. In a deposit account maintained by the secured creditor, apply the balance of the deposit account to the obligation secured by the deposit account; and In other cases of a security interest in a deposit account perfected by a control agreement, instruct the deposit-taking institution to pay the balance of the deposit account to the secured creditor’s account by providing: (i) a copy of the security agreement that creates or ,5Section 46, R.A. No. 11057; Section 7.04, IRR. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 393 provides for a security interest; and (ii) the secured party’s affidavit stating that a default has occurred, and that the secured party is entitled to enforce the security interest non-judicially.7' 72. Does the secured creditor have a right to sell or dispose of the collateral? Yes. After default, a secured creditor may sell or otherwise dispose of the collateral, publicly or privately, in its present condition or following any commercially reasonable preparation or processing. A disposition is commercially reasonable if the secured creditor disposes of the collateral in conformity with commercial practices among dealers in that type of property.77 73. What are the notification requirements prior to disposition of the collateral? Not later than ten (10) days before disposition of the collateral, the secured creditor shall notify: (i) the grantor; (ii) any other secured creditor or lien holder who, five (5) days before the date notification is sent to the grantor, held a security interest or lien in the collateral that was perfected by registration; and (iii) any other person from whom the secured creditor received notification of a claim of an interest in the collateral if the notification was received before the secured creditor gave notification of the proposed disposition to the grantor. J9JC9B0M a. The grantor may, after default, waive the right to be notified. b. A notification of disposition is sufficient if it identifies the grantor and the secured creditor; describes the collateral; states the method of intended disposition; and states the time and place of a public disposition or the time after which other disposition is to be made. C. The secured creditor shall notify the persons entitled to notification via registered mail, private courier, electronically, or through any means where receipt of the notice can be established by a disinterested third party. ’'Section 48, R.A. No. 11057; Section 7.05, IRR. ’’Sections 49 and 50, R.A. No. 11057; Sections 7.06 and 7.07, IRR. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 394 d. 74. The requirement to send a notification shall not apply if the collateral is perishable or threatens to decline speedily in value or is of a type customarily sold on a recognized market.” What are the guidelines on private or public disposition? The secured creditor may dispose of the collateral through sale open to participation by the general public. Moreover, the secured creditor may buy the collateral at any public disposition, or at a private disposition but only if the collateral is of a kind that is customarily sold on a recognized market or the subject of widely distributed standard price quotations. Judicial disposition Extra-judicial disposition • The secured creditor may, sub­ ject to the guidelines below, se­ lect the method, manner, time, place, and other aspects of the sale or other disposition, lease or license, including whether to sell or otherwise dispose of, lease or license encumbered assets indi­ vidually, in groups or altogether, provided, that the disposition is undertaken in good faith and satisfies the commercial reason­ ableness requirement. ■ Judicial dispositions shall be governed by rules promulgated by the Supreme Court. ■ If a method of disposition of collateral has been approved in any legal proceeding, whether judicial or administrative, it is conclusively commercially reasonable. ■ The secured creditor shall, no later than ten (10) days before the extra-judicial disposition of the collateral, cause the posting with the Registry of a notice that sufficiently describes the collateral to be sold and specifies the method, manner, time, place, and other details of the sale. The Registry shall ensure that all such notices posted are publicly accessible and searchable. [In adherence with the com­ mercial reasonableness require­ ment, the secured creditor may 78 Section 51, R.A. No. 11057; Section 7.08, IRR. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS also cause the advertisement of the disposition through any other means or medium as the secured creditor may deem as suitable, to maximize awareness of the sale among dealers in the type of property to which the collateral belongs.] • All collateral shall be disposed through auction. Below are the indicators that must be taken into account in determining whether the sale satisfies the good faith and commercial rea­ sonableness requirement: (i) that the person or entity who presides over the auction is an experienced dealer in the type of property sold; (ii) that the participating bid­ ders do not engage in collu­ sive practices that prevent free and open competition; (iii) that the records of the pro­ ceedings, including the iden­ tities and respective sub­ missions of the bidders, are documented in writing and subsequently maintained; and (iv) that the highest bidder is duly awarded the collateral. • The winning bidder must fully pay the bid price at the conclusion of the auction. Otherwise, the collateral may be awarded to the next highest bidder. • Any government agency that regularly undertakes public auc­ tions in the course of its regular activities may be engaged by any secured creditor to preside over public auctions over securitized movable collateral, through rules J9JC9B0M 395 J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 396 and regulations that must be submitted to the Department of Finance for prior approval. entities Private such as industry auction houses, groups of secured creditors, or organizations of recognized dealers of specific movables may likewise adopt rules and regulations for the conduct of public auctions, subject to the approval of the Department of Finance. Any public auction of movable collateral conducted by any government agency or private entity under rules duly approved by the Department of Finance shall be conclusively presumed to be commercially reasonable. T9 75. How will the proceeds from the sale be applied? The proceeds of disposition shall be applied in the following order: i. the reasonable expenses of taking, holding, preparing for disposition, and disposing of the collateral, including reasonable attorney’s fees and legal expenses incurred by the secured creditor; ii. the satisfaction of the obligation secured by the security interest of the enforcing secured creditor; and iii. the satisfaction of obligations secured by any subordinate security interest or lien in the collateral if a written demand and proof of the interest are received before distribution of the proceeds is completed. a. The secured creditor shall account to the grantor for any surplus, and, unless otherwise agreed, the debtor is liable for any deficiency. ’“Section 7.09, IRR of R.A. No. 11057. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS 397 b. The reasonable expenses of holding the collateral shall include all expenses incurred by the secured creditor in the preservation and care of the collateral in his possession with the diligence of a good father of a family. c. The secured creditor shall be liable to the grantor for the value of the loss and deterioration that may be suffered due to his failure to preserve and care for the collateral.81 76, Is there a right of redemption? Yes. Any person who is entitled to receive a notification of disposition3' is entitled to redeem the collateral by paying or otherwise performing the secured obligation in full, including the reasonable cost of enforcement. The right of redemption may be exercised, unless: (i) the person entitled to redeem has, after the default, waived in writing the right to redeem; (ii) the collateral is sold or otherwise disposed of, acquired, or collected by the secured creditor, or when an agreement with those effects on the collateral is concluded by the secured creditor; or (iii) the secured creditor has retained the collateral.82 77. Can the secured creditor retain the collateral? Yes. After default, the secured creditor may propose to the debtor and grantor to take all or part of the collateral in total or partial satisfaction of the secured obligation, and shall send a proposal to: a. the debtor and the grantor; b. any other secured creditor or lien holder who, five (5) days before the proposal is sent to the debtor and the grantor, perfected its security interest or lien by registration; and “Section 52, R.A. No. 11057; Section 7.11, IRR. •‘(1) The grantor; (2) Any other secured creditor or lien holder who, five (5) days before the date notification is sent to the grantor, held a security interest or lien in the collateral that was perfected by registration; and (3) Any other person from whom the secured creditor received notification of a claim of an interest in the collateral if the notification was received before the secured creditor gave notification of the proposed disposition to the grantor. “Section 45, R.A. No. 11057; Section 7.10, IRR. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 398 C. any other person with an interest in the collateral who has given a written notification to the secured creditor before the proposal is sent to the debtor and the grantor. The secured creditor may retain the collateral in the case of; 78. a. A proposal for the acquisition of the collateral in full satisfaction of the secured obligation, unless the secured creditor receives an objection in writing from any person entitled to receive such a proposal within 20 days after the proposal is sent to that person; or b. A proposal for the acquisition of the collateral in partial satisfaction of the secured obligation, only if the secured creditor receives the affirmative consent of each addressee of the proposal in writing within 20 days after the proposal is sent to that person.83 What are the rules on security interest created or provided for by an agreement or other transaction that was made or entered into before the effectivity of the PPSA and that had not been terminated before the effectivity of the PPSA (Prior Interest)? a. A prior interest that was perfected under any law that existed or in force before the effectivity of the PPSA (‘Prior Law") continues to be deemed perfected under the PPSA until the earlier of: (i) the time the prior interest would cease to be perfected under prior law; and (ii) the beginning of full implementation of the PPSA. b. The priority of a prior interest as against the rights of a competing claimant is determined by the prior law if: (i) the security interest and the rights of all competing claimant arose before the effectivity of the PPSA; and (ii) the priority status of these rights has not changed since the effectivity of the PPSA. For this purpose, the priority status of a prior interest has changed only if: i. It was perfected when the PPSA took effect, but ceased to be perfected; or ^Section 54, R.A. No. 11057; Section 7.13, IRR. r VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS ii. c. 399 It was not perfected under prior law when the PPSA took effect, and was only perfected under the PPSA. The enforcement of all existing security interests during the transitional period™ shall be governed by the PPSA.M Concurrence and Preference of Credit 79. How are credits classified in the context of the laws on concurrence and preference of credit? The credits are classified into three (3) general categories, namely, “(a) special preferred credits listed in Articles 2241 and 2242, (b) ordinary preferred credits listed in Article 2244[,] and (c) common credits under Article 2245.” The special preferred credits enumerated in Articles 2241 (with respect to movable property) and 2242 (with respect to immovable property) are considered as mortgages or pledges of real or personal property, or liens within the purview of Act No. 1956. These credits, which enjoy preference with respect to a specific movable or immovable property, exclude all others to the extent of the value of the property. If there are two (2) or more Hens on the same specific property, the lienholders divide the value of the property involved pro rata, after the taxes on the same property are fully paid. “Credits which are specially preferred because they constitute liens (tax or non-tax) in turn, take precedence over ordinary preferred credits so far as concerns the property to which the Hens have attached. The specially preferred credits must be discharged first out of the proceeds of the property to which they relate, before ordinary preferred creditors may lay claim to any part of such proceeds.” “In contrast with Articles 2241 and 2242, Article 2244 creates no liens on determinate property which follow such property. What Article 2244 creates are simply rights in favor of certain creditors to have the cash and other assets of the insolvent applied in a certain sequence or order of priority.” “The transitional period shall begin on February 9, 2019, which is the date of effectivity of the PPSA. “Sections 8.01-8.04, IRR of R.A. No. 11057. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M -100 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II It was held that concurrence and preference of credits can only be ascertained in the context of a general liquidation proceeding that is in rem, such as an insolvency proceeding, where properties of the debtor are inventoried and liquidated and the claims of all the creditors may be bindingly adjudicated. The application of this order of priorities established under the Civil Code in insolvency proceedings assures that priority of claims is respected and credits belonging to the same class are equitably treated.86 80. During the pendency of the civil case with the RTC of Pasig City, Fil-Agro was placed under the receivership of the PDIC pursuant to Resolution No. 1486 of the Monetary Board of the BSP. Thereafter, the RTC of Malolos City was constituted as the liquidation court tasked to adjudicate disputed claims against Fil-Agro and assist the PDIC in undertaking its liquidation. Antonio, however, insists that his claim against Fil-Agro is not a disputed claim within the purview of Section 30 of R.A. No. 7653 because ownership of the mortgaged property has not yet vested on Fil-Agro. He maintains that the Court’s ruling in Vda. de Ballesteros cannot be applied here where foreclosure of the subject properties was not made by the insolvent bank. Decide. Jurisprudentially, it has long been resolved that “disputed claims” covers all claims whether they be against the assets of the insolvent bank, for specific performance, breach of contract, damages, or whatever. The term is defined in an all-encompassing and broad manner so as to include any cause of action against the insolvent bank, regardless of its nature or character, irrespective of whether the relief sought would directly affect the property of the bank under liquidation. In fact, Section 30(2) of R.A. No. 7653 authorizes the receiver to defend any action against the insolvent bank. Section 30 of R.A. No. 7653 reads: SEC. 30. Proceedings in Receivership and Liquidation. - Whenever, upon report of the head of the supervising or examining department, the Monetary Board finds that a bank or quasi-bank: “Metrobank v. Naguiat, G.R. No. 178407, March 18, 2015. VIII. CREDIT TRANSACTIONS a. is unable to pay its liabilities as they become due in the ordinary course of business: Provided, that this shall not include inability to pay caused by extraordinary demands induced by financial panic in the banking community; b. has insufficient realizable assets, as determined by the Bangko Sentral, to meet its liabilities; or c. cannot continue in business without involving probable losses to its depositors or creditors; or d. has willfully violated a cease and desist order under Section 37 that has become final, involving acts or transactions which amount to fraud or a dissipation of the assets of the institution, in which cases, the Monetary Board may summarily and without need for prior hearing forbid the institution from doing business in the Philippines and designate the Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation as receiver of the banking institution. 401 For a quasi-bank, any person of recognized competence in banking or finance may be designated as receiver. XXX The above legal provision recognizes the exclusive jurisdiction of the liquidation court to adjudicate disputed claims against the closed bank, assist in the enforcement of individual liabilities of the stockholders, directors, and officers, and decide on all other issues as may be material to implement the distribution plan adopted by the PDIC for general application to all closed banks. Simply put, if there is a judicial liquidation of an insolvent bank, all claims against the bank should be filed in the liquidation proceeding. This holds true regardless of whether or not the claim is initially disputed in a court or agency before it is filed with the liquidation court.87 ”Fil-Agro Rural Bank, Inc. v. Villasenor, Jr., G.R. Nos. 226761 and 226889, July 28,2020. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M -102 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 81. If a bank which has been ordered closed by the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas (Bangko Sentral) and is placed under the receivership of the Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation, how can a secured creditor enforce its claim on the basis of the preference and concurrence of credit under the law? As a consequence of the receivership, the closed bank may sue and be sued only through its receiver, the Philippine Deposit Insurance Corporation. Any action filed by the closed bank without its receiver may be dismissed.88 “Banco Filipino Savings and Mortgage Bank G.R. No. 200678, June 4, 2018. Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas, IX. SPECIAL LAWS 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 A. Policy of Law 1. What is the state policy for the enactment of the Foreign Investment Act of 1991? It is the policy of the State to attract, promote, and welcome productive investments from foreign individuals, partnerships, including their political governments, and corporations, subdivisions, in activities which significantly contribute to national industrialization and socio-economic development to the extent that foreign investment is allowed in such activity by the Constitution and relevant laws. Foreign investments shall be encouraged in enterprises that significantly expand livelihood and employment opportunities for Filipinos; enhance economic value of farm products; promote the welfare of Filipino consumers; expand the scope, quality, and volume of exports and their access to foreign markets; and/or transfer relevant technologies in agriculture, industry, and support services. Foreign investments shall be welcome as a supplement to Filipino capital and technology in those enterprises serving mainly the domestic market. As a general rule, there are no restrictions on extent of foreign ownership of export enterprises. In domestic market enterprises, foreigners can invest as much as 100% equity except in areas included in the negative fist. Foreign owned firms catering mainly to the domestic market shall be encouraged to undertake measures that will gradually increase Filipino participation in their businesses by taking in Filipino partners, electing Filipinos to the board of directors, implementing transfer of technology to Filipinos, generating more employment for the economy and enhancing skills of Filipino workers.1 J9JC9B0M 'Section 2, R.A. No. 7042. 403 J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 404 2. Who qualifies as Philippine nationals? The term Philippine national shall mean: a. b. a citizen of the Philippines; or a domestic partnership or association wholly owned by citizens of the Philippines; or c. a corporation organized under the laws of the Philippines of which at least sixty percent (60%) of the capital stock outstanding and entitled to vote is owned and held by citizens of the Philippines; or d. a corporation organized abroad and registered as doing business in the Philippines under the Corporation Code of which one hundred percent (100%) of the capital stock outstanding and entitled to vote is wholly owned by Filipinos; or e. a trustee of funds for pension or other employee retirement or separation benefits, where the trustee is a Philippine national and at least sixty percent (60%) of the fund will accrue to the benefit of Philippine nationals. Provided, That where a corporation and its non-Filipino stockholders own stocks in a Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) registered enterprise, at least sixty percent (60%) of the capital stock outstanding and entitled to vote of each of both corporations must be owned and held by citizens of the Philippines and at least sixty percent (60%) of the members of the Board of Directors, in order that the corporation shall be considered a Philippine national.1 3. Can a foreign National? corporation be considered a Philippine The term "Philippine National" is defined under Section 3 of the R.A. No. 7042, as amended by R.A. No. 8179, to wit: “Philippine national shall mean a citizen of the Philippines or a domestic partnership or association wholly owned by the citizens of the Philippines; or a corporation organized under the laws of the Philippines of which at least sixty percent (60%) of the capital stock 2Amen<iing the Foreign Investment Act of 1991 (R.A. No. 7042), R.A. No. 8179, March 28,1996. 405 IX. SPECIAL LAWS 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 outstanding and entitled to vote is owned and held by citizens of the Philippines; or a corporation organized abroad and registered as doing business in the Philippines under the Corporation Code of which 100% of the capital stock outstanding and entitled to vote is wholly owned by Filipinos or a trustee of funds for pension or other employee retirement or separation benefits, where the trustee is a Philippine national and at least sixty percent (60%) of the fund will accrue to the benefits of the Philippine nationals ,.(Emphasis supplied) Under the foregoing provisions, two (2) conditions have to be met before a foreign corporation can be considered a "Philippine National": 4. a. One hundred percent (100%) of the capital stock outstanding and entitled to vote is wholly owned by Filipinos; and b. The corporation should be registered as doing business in the Philippines under the Corporation Code.3 For public utility corporations, the equity ownership of Philippine citizens or Philippine nationals must not go lower than 60%, thereby imposing 40% foreign equity limitation. How should the compliance with the required Filipino ownership of a corporation be determined? Compliance with the required Filipino ownership of a corporation shall be determined on the basis of outstanding capital stock whether fully paid or not, but only such stocks which are generally entitled to vote are considered. For stocks to be deemed owned and held by Philippine citizens or Philippine nationals, mere legal title is not enough to meet the required Filipino ownership. Full beneficial ownership of the stocks, coupled with appropriate voting rights is essential. Thus, stocks, the voting rights of which have been assigned or transferred to aliens, cannot be considered held by Philippine citizens or Philippine nationals.4 3Suarez and Reyes Law Offices, SEC-OGC Opinion No. 05-07, April 26, 2007. ^Amendments to the Implementing Rules and Regulations of R.A. No. 7042, IRRof R.A. No. 7042. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M •106 5. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II What are the tests to corporation? determine the nationality of a There are two (2) acknowledged tests in determining the nationality of a corporation: the control test and the grandfather rule. Paragraph 7 of DOJ Opinion No. 020, Series of 2005, adopting the 1967 SEC Rules which implemented the requirement of the Constitution and other laws pertaining to the controlling interests in enterprises engaged in the exploitation of natural resources owned by Filipino citizens, provides: Shares belonging to corporations or partnerships at least 609'0 of the capital of which is owned by Filipino citizens shall be considered as of Philippine nationality, but if the percentage of Filipino ownership in the corporation or partnership is less than 60%, only the number of shares corresponding to such percentage shall be counted as of Philippine nationality. Thus, if 100,000 shares are registered in the name of a corporation or partnership at least 60% of the capital stock or capital, respectively, of which belong to Filipino citizens, all of the shares shall be recorded as owned by Filipinos. But if less than 60%, or say, 50% of the capital stock or capital of the corporation or partnership, respectively, belongs to Filipino citizens, only 50,000 shares shall be counted as owned by Filipinos and the other 50,000 shall be recorded as belonging to aliens. The first part of paragraph 7, DOJ Opinion No. 020, stating “shares belonging to corporations or partnerships at least 60% of the capital of which is owned by Filipino citizens shall be considered as of Philippine nationality,” pertains to the control test or the liberal rule. On the other hand, the second part of the DOJ Opinion which provides, “if the percentage of the Filipino ownership in the corporation or partnership is less than 60%, only the number of shares corresponding to such percentage shall be counted as Philippine nationality,” pertains to the stricter, more stringent grandfather rule.5 6. What is the prevailing mode of determining the nationality of a corporation? The “control test” is still the prevailing mode of determining whether or not a corporation is a Filipino corporation. When in the 5Narra Nickel Mining & Development Corp. v. Redmont Consolidated Mines Corp., G.R. No. 195580, April 21, 2014. IX. SPECIAL LAWS 407 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 mind of the Court there is doubt, based on the attendant facts and circumstances of the case, in the 60-40 Filipino-equity ownership in the corporation, then it may apply the “grandfather rule.”6 7. Cite instances where grandfather rule should supplement the control test to determine the nationality of the corporation. Department of Justice Opinion No. 165, Series of 1984, identified the following “significant indicators” or badges of “dummy status”: a. That the foreign investor provides practically all the funds for the joint investment undertaken by Filipino businessmen and their foreign partner. b. That the foreign investors undertake to provide practically all the technological support for the joint venture. c. That the foreign investors, while being minority stock­ holders, manage the company and prepare all economic viability studies. In instances where methods are employed to disable Filipinos from exercising control and reaping the economic benefits of an enterprise, the ostensible control vested by ownership of 60% of a corporation’s capital may be pierced. Then, the Grandfather Rule allows for a further, more exacting examination of who actually controls and benefits from holding such capital.7 8. When can a corporation own a public land in the Philippines? Under R.A. No. 7042, particularly in Section 3 thereof, a corporation organized under the laws of the Philippines of which at least 60% of the capital stock outstanding and entitled to vote is owned and held by citizens of the Philippines, is considered a Philippine national. As such, the corporation may acquire disposable lands in the Philippines.8 'Supra. ''Ibid. 8Unchuan v. Lozada, G.R. No. 172671, April 16, 2009. I J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 408 B. Definition of Terms 9. Define "foreign investment'! The term “foreign investment” shall mean an equity investment made by a non-Philippine national in the form of foreign exchange and/or other assets actually transferred to the Philippines and duly registered with the Central Bank which shall assess and appraise the value of such assets other than foreign exchange.9 10. When can an entity be deemed “doing business" in the Philippines? “Doing business” shall include: 11. a. soliciting orders, service contracts, whether Raison offices or branches; b. appointing representatives or distributors, operating under full control of the foreign corporation, domiciled in the Philippines or who in any calendar year stay in the country for a period or periods totaling 180 days or more; c. participating in the management, supervision, or control of any domestic business, firm, entity, or corporation in the Philippines; and d. any other act or acts that imply a continuity of commercial dealings or arrangements, and contemplate to that extent the performance of acts or works, or the exercise of some of the functions normally incident to and in progressive prosecution of commercial gain or of the purpose and object of the business organization.10 opening offices, When can an entity not be deemed "doing business" in the Philippines? The following acts shall not be deemed “doing business” in the Philippines: a. Mere investment as a shareholder by a foreign entity in domestic corporations duly registered to do business, and/ or the exercise of rights as such investor; ’Section 3(c), R.A. No. 7042. “Section 3(d), R.A. No. 7042. 409 IX. SPECIAL LAWS 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 b. Having a nominee director or officer to represent its interest in such corporation; c. Appointing a representative or distributor domiciled in the Philippines which transacts business in the representative’s or distributor’s own name and account; d. The publication of a general advertisement through any print or broadcast media; e. Maintaining a stock of goods in the Philippines solely for the purpose of having the same processed by another entity in the Philippines; f. Consignment by a foreign entity of equipment with a local company to be used in the processing of products for export; gh. Collecting information in the Philippines; and Performing services auxiliary to an existing isolated contract of sale which are not on a continuing basis, such as installing in the Philippines machinery it has manufactured or exported to the Philippines, servicing the same, training domestic workers to operate it, and similar incidental services.11 12. What are the two (2) general tests to determine whether a foreign corporation is considered as "doing business" in the Philippines? I a. Substance test — The true test for doing business, however, seems to be whether the foreign corporation is continuing the body of the business or enterprise for which it was organized or whether it has substantially retired from it and turned it over to another. b. Continuity test — The term doing business implies a continuity of commercial dealings and arrangements, and contemplates, to that extent, the performance of acts or works or the exercise of some of the functions normally incident to, and in the progressive prosecution of, the purpose and object of its organization.12 "Implementing Rules and Regulations of R.A. No. 7042, (IRR of R-A. No. 7042), July 9,1996. l2Mentholatum Co., Inc. v. Mangaliman, G.R. No. 47701, June 27,1941. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M •110 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 13. When can a foreign corporation sue before Philippine courts? The principles regarding the right of a foreign corporation to bring suit in Philippine courts may thus be condensed in four (4) statements: 14. a. if a foreign corporation does business in the Philippines without a license, it cannot sue before the Philippine courts; b. if a foreign corporation is not doing business in the Philippines, it needs no license to sue before Philippine courts on an isolated transaction or on a cause of action entirely independent of any business transaction; c. if a foreign corporation does business in the Philippines without a Ecense, a Philippine citizen or entity which has contracted with said corporation may be estopped from chaUenging the foreign corporation’s corporate personality in a suit brought before Philippine courts; and d. if a foreign corporation does business in the Philippines with the required hcense, it can sue before Philippine courts on any transaction.13 Air Canada is a foreign corporation organized and existing under the laws of Canada. It was granted an authority to operate as an offline carrier by the Civil Aeronautics Board. As an off-line carrier, Air Canada does not have flights originating from or coming to the Philippines and does not operate any airplane in the Philippines. Air Canada engaged the services of Aerotel Ltd., Corp. (Aerotel) as its general sales agent in the Philippines. Aerotel sells Air Canada's passage documents in the Philippines. Air Canada was subsequently subjected to regular corporate income tax. The BIR reasoned that a foreign corporation engaged in business in the Philippines is classified as a resident foreign corporation under the Tax Code. Thus, considering that Air Canada is doing business in the Philippines through Aerotel, it should be subject to the 13Agilent Technologies Singapore v. Integrated Silicon Technology Phil. Corp., G.R. No. 154618, April 14, 2004. IX. SPECIAL LAWS 411 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 regular corporate income tax applicable for resident foreign corporation. Is the BIR correct in classifying Air Canada as a resident foreign corporation for taxation purposes? Yes, the BIR is correct considering that Air Canada is doing business in the Philippines. R.A. No. 7042 or the Foreign Investments Act of 1991 provides guidance with its definition of “doing business” with regard to foreign corporations. Section 3(d) of the law enumerates the activities that constitute doing business, to wit: the phrase “doing business” shall include soliciting d. orders, service contracts, opening offices, whether called “liaison” offices or branches; appointing representatives or distributors domiciled in the Philippines or who in any calendar year stay in the country for a period or periods totalling one hundred eighty (180) days or more; participating in the management, supervision or control of any domestic business, firm, entity or corporation in the Philippines; and any other act or acts that imply a continuity of commercial dealings or arrangements, and contemplate to that extent the performance of acts or works, or the exercise of some of the functions normally incident to, and in progressive prosecution of, commercial gain or of the purpose and object of the business organization: Provided, however, That the phrase “doing business” shall not be deemed to include mere investment as a shareholder by a foreign entity in domestic corporations duly registered to do business, and/or the exercise of rights as such investor; nor having a nominee director or officer to represent its interests in such corporation; nor appointing a representative or distributor domiciled in the Philippines which transacts business in its own name and for its own account. While Section 3(d) above states that “appointing a representative or distributor domiciled in the Philippines which transacts business in its own name and for its own account” is not considered as “doing business,” the Implementing Rules and Regulations of R.A. No. 7042 clarifies that “doing business” includes “appointing representatives or distributors, operating under full control of the foreign corporation, domiciled in the Philippines or J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 412 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II who in any calendar year stay in the country for a period or periods totaling one hundred eighty (180) days or more.” An offline carrier is “any foreign air carrier not certificated by the Civil Aeronautics Board, but who maintains office or who has designated or appointed agents or employees in the Philippines, who sells or offers for sale any air transportation in behalf of said foreign air carrier and/or others, or negotiate for, or holds itself out by solicitation, advertisement, or otherwise sells, provides, furnishes, contracts, or arranges for such transportation.” Aerotel performs acts or works or exercises functions that are incidental and beneficial to the purpose of Air Canada’s business. The activities of Aerotel bring direct receipts or profits to Air Canada. Aerotel does not solicit orders alone and for its own account. Aerotel cannot enter into any contract on behalf of Air Canada without the express written consent of the latter, and it must perform its functions according to the standards required by Air Canada. Through Aerotel, Air Canada is able to engage in an economic activity in the Philippines.14 15. By virtue of a Petroleum Consortium Agreement, a foreign corporation will hold a minority and non-controlling interest in an unincorporated joint venture with a Philippine entity. Instead of shares of stock, the member foreign corporation of a petroleum consortium would hold a participating percentage interest, which pertains to the percentage that a member of the consortium will contribute to the joint venture for exploration, drilling, and production costs. Such percentage interest is also the share that the consortium member would be participating in profits from petroleum production. If the member foreign corporation will not be the operator of the consortium, can it be exempt from obtaining a license to do business in the Philippines? The foreign corporation needs to obtain a license to do business in the Philippines under the Foreign Investment Act of 1991 (“FIA”) notwithstanding the fact that it holds a minority and non-controlling interest in the consortium. “Air Canada v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, G.R. No. 169507, January 11, 2016. r IX. SPECIAL LAWS 413 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 The subject foreign corporation will invest in a consortium or joint venture which is a form of partnership. For a foreign corporation to be exempted from obtaining a license to do business in the Philippines, it must prove that it merely invested as a shareholder in a domestic corporation. It is settled that exemptions from the general rule are strictly construed against those invoking the exemption. Considering that the exemption from the doing business rule pertains only to investment in a corporation, investment in any other business organization, firm, or entity (e.g., partnership) would not automatically constitute an exemption. In this connection, “participating in the management, supervision or control of any domestic business, firm, entity or corporation in the Philippines” is considered doing business. Consequently, following the strict interpretation rule, the only automatically exempt “management, supervision or control” is that of a corporation (i.e., “having a nominee director or office to represent its interests in such corporation”) and not of any other entity, such as a partnership. The differing treatment of investment in a corporation and investment in a partnership is based on a substantial distinction between the said two forms of organization. In a corporate setting, the stockholders, save in specified rare instances when their concurrence is necessary, do not manage the affairs of the corporation, a function which belongs to the Board of Directors/Trustees. In contrast, all the partners in a partnership have an equal right in the management of the business, each of them being considered as agent who could bind the partnership, except when the manner of management has been set in the Articles of Partnership or in the case of a limited partnership. Thus, investment in a partnership does not necessarily mean exemption from doing business since being a partner generally entails management, supervision, or control of the partnership. Investment in a partnership will only be akin to an investment in a corporation that is exempt from doing business rule only when the foreign corporation is exclusively a limited partner and takes no part in the management and control of the business operation of the limited partnership.16 15Doing Business; Foreign Corporation Investing in a Consortium, SEC-OGC Opinion No. 01-14, February 21, 2014. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 414 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL I^AW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 16. Sony Computer Entertainment Hong Kong ("SCEH)" is a company organized and existing under the laws of Hong Kong and operates Sony Entertainment Network ("SEN") in Singapore, Indonesia, Taiwan, Malaysia, Thailand, and Hong Kong. SEN is an online platform that offers various content and services such as an online community and an online gaming system, which requires a SEN account in order to participate. Since SEN is an internet-based system, persons in the Philippines can create a SEN account to participate in the online community and to purchase content from and/or use SEN’S services even if the SCEH does not have a physical presence in the Philippines. A SEN account holder can buy content and services from SEN only by using funds from an associated SEN online wallet, which can be funded by using a credit or debit card or a prepaid card where available. SEN employees are located in Hong Kong while SEN'S servers are based in the United States. Considering the foregoing, can SCEH be considered as not doing in business in the Philippines, and thus, will not be required to obtain a license to do business as a foreign corporation? SCEH is deemed is considered doing business in the Philippines, and thus, required to obtain a license to do business from the SEC. The activities SCEH proposes to undertake shall be considered as “doing business” in the Philippines since the twin characterization test is satisfied in this case. First, the following activities indicate that SCEH will be continuing the body or substance of the business of SCEH for which it was organized in the Philippines, to wit: (i) funding of the SEN online wallet; (ii) offering and selfing SEN services; (iii) accepting online payments for using SEN in any currency, including Philippine currency; (iv) marketing or advertising; and (v) hiring independent contractors for marketing or advertising of its products and the selling of prepaid cards in relation to its online gaming services. Second, the above-mentioned enumerated activities are transactions consummated within the Philippines although they are done in a virtual plane. Currently, most courts in the United States apply a Sliding Scale Test tailored to internet activities to determine the level or types of activities that will constitute “minimum contacts" for IX. SPECIAL LAWS 415 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 jurisdictional purposes. This Sliding Scale Test is based on the premise that “the likelihood that ‘personal jurisdiction’ can be constitutionally exercised is directly proportionate to the nature and quantity of commercial activity that an entity conducts over the internet.” At one end of the scale are “passive” websites, which alone generally do not generate sufficient contacts with a foreign state to establish personal jurisdiction since they are only used to post information therein. At the other end of the scale are “active” websites, which generate sufficient business over the internet to establish personal jurisdiction. “Interactive” websites fall in the center of the scale since they are hybrid sites that contain elements of both passive and active websites, and courts determine whether to exercise personal jurisdiction over the interactive website owner on a case-by-case basis. Applying the Sliding Scale Test, the SCEH has “minimum contacts” with the Philippines. The SEN online platform cannot be considered as a “passive website” considering that there will be sufficient contacts with the SEN account users in the Philippines and such platform is not used to merely post information. In which case, the SEN online platform should be considered as an “active website” which, as above-stated, generates sufficient contacts and business over the internet since it offers for sale and is engaged in the selling of the SEN content and services to SEN account holders in the Philippines, and, in the process, allows the funding of the SEN online wallet by the SEN account holder who is located in the Philippines. Clearly, there exists in this case sufficient “minimum contacts” between the foreign corporation SCEH and the Philippines.16 17. A foreign corporation is doing business in the Philippines but it only obtained from the SEC a license to transact business as a representative office and not a branch office. The Certificate issued by the SEC specified the purpose/s of the representative office, that is "to deal directly with the clients/customers of the applicant company in undertaking activities such as but not limited to information dissemination and promotion of the company's products as well as quality control of the products." 16Re: Foreign Corporation; Doing Business; Online Gaming, SEC-OGC Opinion No. 03-17, April 4, 2017. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 416 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME 11 May the foreign corporation with a representative office maintain any suit in the Philippines against its competitor for not complying with the laws and rules governing the goods that the competitor is selling and other causes of action that it may have against that competitor? It does not matter for purposes of determining whether a foreign corporation may sue or be sued before Philippine courts, if such corporation is “doing business” in the Philippines through a "branch office” or a “representative office.” Whether a foreign corporation is doing business in the Philippines through a branch or representative office would only determine the extent allowed by law as to what such foreign corporation can do in the Philippines. Instead, the determinative factor for purposes of determining whether a foreign corporation can sue or be sued before Philippine courts is whether the foreign corporation is doing business in the Philippines and if it is licensed to do so. Thus, the foreign corporation that is registered with the SEC and is doing business in the Philippines as a representative office may bring and defend suits before Philippine courts and other government agencies in order to protect its rights and interests.” 18. Genibrain Co., Ltd. ("Genibrain") is a foreign corporation duly organized and validly existing by virtue of and under the laws of Korea. As a holder of licenses to offer various interactive games accessible through the internet, it publishes several games online, making them available and accessible to interested players anywhere in the world, including the Philippines. In pursuit of its business, Genibrain plans to set up game servers in the Philippines, which shall be physically located in and connected to the internet through the facilities provided by a value-added service provider such as ePLDT Inc. ("ePLDT"), a company engaged in providing IT infrastructure solutions to entities by providing, among others, co-location spaces, manpower to manage the data centers, and other technical services for the effective operations and proper functioning of servers. In effect, Genibrain does not intend to maintain a fixed place where it can conduct business through representatives and agents. ’’Capacity to Sue or Be Sued by a Foreign Corporation, SEC-OGC Opinion No. 02-13, April 5, 2013. L IX. SPECIAL LAWS 417 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 Does the setting up of these servers constitute "doing business" in the Philippines, thereby requiring Genibrain to obtain a license? In Mentholatum Co., Inc. v. Anacleto Mangaliman, the Supreme Court laid down the jurisprudential test of what constitutes “doing business” in the Philippines for foreign corporations known as the "Twin Characterization Test.” Under this test, a foreign corporation is considered to be “doing business” in the Philippines when: a. The foreign corporation is maintaining or continuing in the Philippines “the body or substance of the business or enterprise for which it was organized or whether it has substantially retired from it and turned it over to another.” b. The foreign corporation is engaged in activities which necessarily imply “a continuity of commercial dealings and arrangements, and contemplates, to that extent, the performance of acts or works or the exercise of some of the functions normally incidental to, and in progressive prosecution of, the purpose and object of its organization.” Anent the first requisite, the setting up of game servers in the Philippines by Genibrain may be considered as “maintaining or continuing” in the Philippines the body or substance of the business or enterprise. From understanding how game servers work, it can be deduced that setting up servers is necessary and indispensable in the pursuit of the business of which Genibrain is engaged in. Thus, it may be deemed as the “body or substance” of the business, as contemplated in the first requisite. Although the setting up of servers does not involve the physical acts or transactions beyond the mere leasing of a specific portion of space in the Philippines to accommodate these servers, these servers shall act as memory storage where the e-game software and related data are stored. In effect, Genibrain will use the servers to store various data relative to the games that it will advertise online, making it a vital component of Genibrain’s online business. With regard to the second requisite, one must not only consider the mere act of setting up servers but also its continued presence in the Philippines. In reality, these servers will be in continuous operation while being physically present in the Philippines. Thus, the continued presence of these servers in the Philippines may be construed to mean that Genibrain is “engaged in activities which J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 418 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL IJ\W: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II necessarily imply a continuity of commercial dealings.” While there are no physical activities because the transactions appear to be processed and consummated in a virtual plane, the physical presence of these servers in the Philippines is essential in the perfection of these online transactions. Although the act of setting up servers does not per se constitute "doing business” in the Philippines, its continuous presence and operation, however, may be construed as “doing business” in the Philippines. More so, the purchase of games online is clearly a commercial transaction which constitutes “doing business” in the Philippines creating earnings and direct profits for the foreign corporation, especially if the particular games are accessed using the game servers located in the Philippines. These commercial transactions will not be possible without the continued presence and operation of these servers. Thus, pursuant to Section 123 of the Old Corporation Code (now Section 140 of the Revised Corporation Code), it is imperative that Genibrain must first obtain a license before setting up servers in the Philippines.18 19. Steelcase, Inc. (Steelcase) is a foreign corporation engaged in the manufacture of office furniture with dealers worldwide. Design International Selections, Inc. (DISI) is a domestic corporation engaged in the furniture business, including the distribution of furniture. Steelcase and DISI orally entered into a dealership agreement whereby Steelcase granted DISI the right to market, sell, distribute, install, and service its products to end-user customers within the Philippines. The business relationship continued smoothly until it was terminated sometime in January 1999 after the agreement was breached with neither party admitting any fault. Steelcase filed a complaint for sum of money against DISI alleging, among others, that DISI had an unpaid account of US$600,000.00. In its Answer, DISI alleged that the complaint failed to contain the required allegations on Steelcase's capacity to sue in the Philippines despite the fact that it (Steelcase) was doing business in the Philippines without the required license to do so. ’’Setting Up of Servers in the Philippines by a Foreign Corporation, SEC-OGC Opinion No. 22-10, June 22, 2010. ' IX. SPECIAL LAWS 419 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 Steelcase countered that it was not doing business in the Philippines when it entered into a dealership agreement with DISI where the latter, acting as the former’s appointed local distributor, transacted business in its own name and for its own account. Specifically, Steelcase contends that it was DISI that sold Steelcase's furniture directly to the end-users or customers who, in turn, directly paid DISI for the furniture they bought. Steelcase further claims that DISI, as a non­ exclusive dealer in the Philippines, had the right to market, sell, distribute, and service Steelcase products in its own name and for its own account. Does Steelcase have the capacity to sue DISI? An unlicensed foreign corporation not doing business in the Philippine has the legal capacity to sue before the local courts. The appointment of a distributor in the Philippines is not sufficient to constitute “doing business” unless it is under the full control of the foreign corporation. On the other hand, if the distributor is an independent entity which buys and distributes products, other than those of the foreign corporation, for its own name and its own account, the latter cannot be considered to be doing business in the Philippines. It should be kept in mind that the determination of whether a foreign corporation is doing business in the Philippines must be judged in light of the attendant circumstances. Here, DISI was not a mere conduit through which Steelcase conducted its business in the country. DISI was an independent contractor, distributing various products of Steelcase and of other companies, acting in its own name and for its own account. As a result, Steelcase cannot be considered to be doing business in the Philippines by its act of appointing a distributor as it falls under one of the exceptions under R.A. No. 7042.19 20. Does a foreign company which merely imports molasses from a Philippine exporter be considered as engaged in doing business in the Philippines? A foreign company that merely imports goods from a Philippine exporter, without opening an office or appointing an agent in the Philippines, is not doing business in the Philippines.20 Design International Selections, Inc., G.R. No. 171995, 19Steelcase, Inc. April 18, 2012. “Cargill, Inc. v. Intra Strata Assurance Corp., G.R. No. 163266, March 15, 2010. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M •120 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 21. Antonio D. Todaro (Todaro) filed a complaint for sum of money and damages with preliminary attachment against Pioneer International, Ltd. (PIL), Pioneer Concrete Philippines, Inc. (PCPI), and Pioneer Philippines Holdings, Inc. (PPHI). Todaro alleged that PIL is a corporation duly organized under Australian laws, while PCPI and PPHI are corporations duly organized under Philippine laws. PIL is engaged in the ready-mix and concrete aggregates business and has established a presence worldwide. PIL established PPHI as the holding company of the stocks of its operating company in the Philippines, PCPI. According to Todaro, PIL contacted him and asked if he could join it in establishing a pre-mixed concrete plant and in overseeing its operations in the Philippines. Todaro confirmed his availability and expressed interest in joining PIL. For not fulfilling the contractual obligation to employ Todaro on a permanent basis in PIL's Philippine office, Todaro initiated the present case. Among others, PIL alleges that no personal judgment could be rendered by the trial court against PIL because PIL is a foreign corporation not doing business in the Philippines. PIL insists that its sole act of "transacting" or "doing business" in the Philippines consisted of its investment in PPHI. Is the contention of PIL proper? Under Philippine law, PIL’s mere investment in PPHI does not constitute “doing business.” However, based on the allegations in Todaro’s complaint, PIL was doing business in the Philippines when it negotiated Todaro’s employment with PPHI. Section 3(d) of R.A. No. 7042, the Foreign Investments Act of 1991, states: The phrase “doing business” shall include soliciting orders, service contracts, opening offices, whether called “liaison” offices or branches; appointing representatives or distributors domiciled in the Philippines or who in any calendar year stay in the country for a period or periods totaling one hundred eighty [180] days or more; participating in the management, supervision or control of any domestic business, firm, entity or corporation in the Philippines; and any other act or acts that imply a continuity of commercial dealings or arrangements and contemplate to that extent the performance of acts or works, or the IX. SPECIAL LAWS 421 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 exercise of some of the functions normally incident to, and in progressive prosecution of commercial gain or of the purpose and object of the business organization: Provided, however, That the phrase “doing business” shall not be deemed to include mere investment as a shareholder by a foreign entity in domestic corporations duly registered to do business, and/or the exercise of rights as such investor; nor having a nominee director or officer to represent its interests in such corporation; nor appointing a representative or distributor domiciled in the Philippines which transacts business in its own name and for its own account; (Emphases added) PIL’s alleged acts in actively negotiating to employ Todaro to run its pre-mixed concrete operations in the Philippines are not mere acts of a passive investor in a domestic corporation. Such are managerial and operational acts in directing and establishing commercial operations in the Philippines.21 22. ZUIDEN is a corporation incorporated under the laws of Hong Kong engaged in the importation and exportation of several products, including lace products. On several occasions, GTVL, a Philippine corporation, purchased lace products from ZUIDEN. The agreement for these purchases, as per the instructions of GTVL, was that ZUIDEN delivers the products purchased by GTVL, to a certain Hong Kong corporation, known as Kenzar Ltd. (KENZAR), and the products will then considered as sold upon receipt by KENZAR of the goods purchased by GTVL. KENZAR had the obligation to deliver the products to the Philippines and/or to follow whatever instructions GTVL had on the matter. Insofar as ZUIDEN is concerned, upon delivery of the goods to KENZAR in Hong Kong, the transaction was concluded; and GTVL became obligated to pay the agreed purchase price. For refusal of GTVL to pay the agreed purchase price for several deliveries ordered by it and delivered by ZUIDEN, ZUIDEN filed a complaint for sum of money before Philippine courts. GTVL filed a Motion to Dismiss on the ground that 21Pioneer International, Ltd. v. Guadiz, Jr., G.R. No. 156848, October 11,2007. £ J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M •122 niVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II ZUIDEN has no legal capacity to sue since it is doing business in the Philippines without securing the required license. Should the Motion to Dismiss be granted? The Motion to Dismiss should be denied. The series of transactions between ZUIDEN and GTVL cannot be classified as “doing business” in the Philippines under Section 3(d) of R.A. No. 7042. An essential condition to be considered as “doing business” in the Philippines is the actual performance of specific commercial acts within the territory of the Philippines for the plain reason that the Philippines has no jurisdiction over commercial acts performed in foreign territories. Here, there is no showing that ZUIDEN performed within the Philippine territory the specific acts of doing business mentioned in Section 3(d) of R.A. No. 7042. While ZUIDEN and GTVL entered into a series of transactions implying a continuity of commercial dealings, the perfection and consummation of these transactions were done outside the Philippines. To be doing or “transacting business in the Philippines” for purposes of Section 133 of the Revised Corporation Code, the foreign corporation must actually transact business in the Philippines, that is, perform specific business transactions within the Philippine territory on a continuing basis in its own name and for its own account. Actual transaction of business within the Philippine territory is an essential requisite for the Philippines to acquire jurisdiction over a foreign corporation and thus require the foreign corporation to secure a Philippine business license. If a foreign corporation does not transact such kind of business in the Philippines, even if it exports its products to the Philippines, the Philippines has no jurisdiction to require such foreign corporation to secure a Philippine business license.22 23. Agilent Technologies Singapore (Pte.), Ltd. ("Agilent") is a foreign corporation, while Integrated Silicon Technology Philippines Corporation ("Integrated Silicon") is a private domestic corporation engaged in the business of manu­ facturing and assembling electronics components. Agilent and Integrated Silicon entered into a Value Added Assembly 22B. Van Zuiden Bros., Ltd. v. GTVL Manufacturing Industries, Inc., G.R. No. 147905, May 28, 2007. IX. SPECIAL LAWS 423 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 Services Agreement ("VAASA”). Under the terms of the VAASA, Integrated Silicon was to locally manufacture and assemble fiber optics for export to Agilent. Agilent, for its part, was to consign raw materials to Integrated Silicon; transport machinery to the plant of Integrated Silicon; and pay Integrated Silicon the purchase price of the finished products. Under the provisions of the VAASA, can Agilent be considered as doing business in the Philippines? By and large, to constitute “doing business,” the activity to be undertaken in the Philippines is one that is for profit-making. By the clear terms of the VAASA, Agilent’s activities in the Philippines were confined to (1) maintaining a stock of goods in the Philippines solely for the purpose of having the same processed by Integrated Silicon; and (2) consignment of equipment with Integrated Silicon to be used in the processing of products for export. As such, the Supreme Court has held that, based on the evidence presented thus far, Agilent cannot be deemed to be “doing business” in the Philippines.23 24. Asian Development Bank (ADB) agreed to extend to Marcopper Mining Corporation (Marcopper) a loan to finance the latter's mining project at Sta. Cruz, Marinduque. To secure the loan, Marcopper executed in favor of ADB a "Deed of Real Estate and Chattel Mortgage" covering substantially all of its (Marcopper's) properties and assets in Marinduque. When Marcopper defaulted in the payment of its loan obligation, MR Holdings, Ltd., (MR Holdings) assumed Marcopper's obligation to ADB. Consequently, in an "Assignment Agreement," ADB assigned to MR Holdings all its rights, interests, and obligations under the principal and complementary loan agreements. Marcopper likewise executed a "Deed of Assignment" in favor of MR Holdings. In the meantime. Solidbank Corporation (Solidbank) obtained a Partial Judgment against Marcopper from the RTC in Civil Case No. 96-80083. Having learned of the scheduled auction sale, MR Holdings filed an "Affidavit of Third-Party Claim" asserting its “Agilent Technologies Singapore v. Integrated Silicon Technology Phil. Corp., G.R. No. 154618, April 14, 2004. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M •124 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II ownership over all Marcopper's mining properties, equipment, and facilities by virtue of the "Deed of Assignment." Upon the denial of its "Affidavit of Third-Party Claim" by the RTC Manila, MR Holdings commenced with the RTC Marinduque, a complaint for reivindication of properties, etc., with prayer for preliminary injunction and temporary restraining order against Solidbank, Marcopper, and the sheriffs assigned in implementing the writ of execution. The trial court denied MR Holdings' application for a writ of preliminary injunction on the ground that MR Holdings has no legal capacity to sue, it being a foreign corporation doing business in the Philippines without license. Unsatisfied, MR Holdings elevated the matter to the Court of Appeals on a Petition for Certiorari, Prohibition, and Mandamus. The Court of Appeals affirmed the ruling of the trial court that MR Holdings has no legal capacity to sue in the Philippine courts because it is a foreign corporation doing business here without license. Is the Court of Appeals correct in its ruling? No. A foreign corporation, which becomes the assignee of mining properties, facilities, and equipment, cannot be automatically considered as doing business, nor presumed to have the intention of engaging in mining business. The MR Holdings was engaged only in isolated acts or transactions. Single or isolated acts, contracts, or transactions of foreign corporations are not regarded as a doing or carrying on of business. Typical examples are the making of a single contract, sale, sale with the taking of a note and mortgage in the state to secure payment therefor, purchase, or note, or the mere commission of a tort. In the said instances, there is no purpose to do any other business within the country. In the case at bar, the Court of Appeals categorized as “doing business” MR Holdings’ participation under the “Assignment Agreement” and the “Deed of Assignment.” This is simply untenable. The expression “doing business” should not be given such a strict and literal construction as to make it apply to any corporate dealing whatever. At this early stage and with MR Holdings’ acts or transactions limited to the assignment contracts, it cannot be said that it had performed acts intended to continue the business for which it was organized. It may not be amiss to point out that the purpose or business for which MR Holdings was organized is not discernible in the records. No effort was exerted by the Court of IX. SPECIAL LAWS 425 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 Appeals to establish the nexus between MR Holdings' business and the acts supposed to constitute "doing business." Thus, whether the assignment contracts were incidental to MR Holdings business or were continuation thereof is beyond determination. The Supreme Court did apply the case cited by the Court of Appeals, Far East Int’l Import and Export Corp, v. Nankai Kosyo Co., Ltd., which held that a single act may still constitute “doing business” if “it is not merely incidental or casual, but is of such character as distinctly to indicate a purpose on the part of the foreign corporation to do other business in the state.” In said case, there was an express admission from an official of the foreign corporation that he was sent to the Philippines to look into the operation of mines, thereby revealing the foreign corporation’s desire to continue engaging in business here. But in the case at bar, there is no evidence of similar desire or intent. Unarguably, MR Holdings may, as the Court of Appeals suggested, decide to operate Marcopper’s mining business, but, of course, at this stage, that is a mere speculation. Or it may decide to sell the credit secured by the mining properties to an offshore investor, in which case the acts will still be isolated transactions. To see through the present facts an intention on the part of MR Holdings to start a series of business transaction is to rest on assumptions or probabilities falling short of actual proof. Courts should never base its judgments on a state of facts so inadequately developed that it cannot be determined where inference ends and conjecture begins.2* 25. J9JC9B0M XYZ Inc. is a foreign corporation engaged in the manufacture and sale of elements used in sealing pumps, valves, and pipes for industrial purposes, valves and control equipment used for industrial fluid control and PVC pipes and fittings for industrial use. Its products were sold 16 times over a five (5)-month period to the same Filipino buyer. Further, it granted and extended 90day credit terms to the Filipino buyer for every purchase made. XYZ Inc. filed an action for collection of sum of money against the Filipino buyer but the trial court dismissed the case for lack of capacity to sue of XYZ Inc. considering that it does not have license to do business in the Philippines. XYZ Inc. insists that the series of sales made to the Filipino buyer would still constitute isolated transactions despite the number 2,MR Holdings, Ltd. v. Bajar, G.R. No. 138104, April 11, 2002. J9JC9B0M 426 DI VI NA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II of invoices covering several separate and distinct items sold and shipped over a span of four (4) to five (5) months. Is the contention of the XYZ Inc. proper? No. XYZ Inc. is not correct. More than the sheer number of transactions entered into, a clear and unmistakable intention on the part of XYZ Inc. to continue the body of its business in the Philippines is more than apparent. As alleged in its complaint, it is engaged in the manufacture and sale of elements used in sealing pumps, valves, and pipes for industrial purposes, valves and control equipment used for industrial fluid control and PVC pipes and fittings for industrial use. Thus, the sale by XYZ Inc. of the items covered by the receipts, which are part and parcel of its main product line, was actually carried out in the progressive prosecution of commercial gain and the pursuit of the purpose and object of its business, pure and simple. Further, its grant and extension of 90-day credit terms to the Filipino buyer for every’ purchase made, unarguably shows an intention to continue transacting with the Filipino buyer, since in the usual course of commercial transactions, credit is extended only to customers in good standing or to those on whom there is an intention to maintain long-term relationship. Equally important is the absence of any fact or circumstance which might tend even remotely to negate such intention to continue the progressive prosecution of XYZ Inc.’s business activities in this country. Had the Filipino buyer not turned out to be a bad risk, in all likelihood XYZ Inc. would have indefinitely continued its commercial transactions with him, and not surprisingly, in ever increasing volumes. Thus, the series of transactions in question could not have been isolated or casual transactions. What is determinative of “doing business” is not really the number or the quantity of the transactions, but more importantly, the intention of an entity to continue the body of its business in the country. The number and quantity are merely evidence of such intention. The phrase “isolated transaction” has a definite and fixed meaning, i.e., a transaction or series of transactions set apart from the common business of a foreign enterprise in the sense that there is no intention to engage in a progressive pursuit of the purpose and object of the business organization. Whether a foreign corporation is “doing business” does not necessarily depend upon the frequency of its transactions, but more upon the nature and character of the transactions. VAI IX. SPECIAL LAWS 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 Given the facts of this case, XYZ Inc.’s business dealings cannot fit the category of “isolated transactions” considering XYZ Inc.’s intention to continue and pursue the corpus of its business in the country.26 26. Columbia Pictures, Inc. (Columbia), thru counsel, lodged a formal complaint with the National Bureau of Investigation (NBI) for violation of P.D. No. 49, as amended, and sought its assistance in their anti-film piracy drive. Agents of the NBI and private researchers made discreet surveillance on various video establishments in Metro Manila including Sunshine Home Video Inc. (Sunshine). The search warrant was served to Sunshine and/or their representatives and in the course of the search of the premises indicated in the search warrant, the NBI Agents found and seized various video tapes of duly copyrighted motion pictures/films owned or exclusively distributed by private complainants, and machines, equipment, television sets, paraphernalia, materials, and accessories, all of which were included in the receipt for properties accomplished by the raiding team. Sunshine filed a Motion to Lift the Order of the Search Warrant which was granted by the court. Sunshine challenged Columbia's legal standing in Philippine courts, they being foreign corporations not licensed to do business in the Philippines. In so challenging Columbia's personality to sue. Sunshine pointed to the fact that it is the copyright owner or owner of exclusive rights of distribution in the Philippines of copyrighted motion pictures or films, and also to the appointment of Atty. Rico V. Domingo as their attorney-at-fact, as being constitutive of "doing business in the Philippines." Is Columbia deemed doing business in the Philippines? The true tests seem to be whether the foreign corporation is continuing the body or substance of the business or enterprise for which it was organized or whether it has substantially retired from it and turned it over to another. It is generally recognized that a foreign corporation is “doing,” “transacting,” “engaging in,” J9JC9B0M “Eriks Pte. Ltd. v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 118843, February 6,1997. J9JC9B0M 428 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II or carrying on “business” in the State when, and ordinarily only when, it has entered the State by its agent and is there engaged in carrying on and transacting through them some substantial part of its ordinary or customary business, usually continuous in the sense that it may be distinguished from merely casual, sporadic, or occasional transactions and isolated acts. The Corporation Code does not itself define or categorize what acts constitute doing or transacting business in the Philippines. Jurisprudence has, however, held that the term implies a continuity of commercial dealings and arrangements, and contemplates, to that extent, the performance of acts or works or the exercise of some of the functions normally incident to or in progressive prosecution of the purpose and subject of its organization. The fact that Columbia is admittedly copyright owners or owners of exclusive distribution rights in the Philippines motion pictures or films does not convert such ownership into an indicium of doing business which would require them to obtain a license before they can sue upon a cause of action in local courts. Neither is the appointment of Atty. Rico V. Domingo as attorney-in-fact of Columbia, tantamount to doing business in the Philippines. The exercise of one’s legal and property rights and taking steps for the vigilant protection of said rights, particularly the appointment of an attorney-in-fact, cannot be deemed to be doing business in the Philippines.26 27. Define "export enterprise" The term “export enterprise” shall mean an enterprise wherein a manufacturer, processor, or service (including tourism) enterprise exports 60% or more of its output, or wherein a trader purchases product domestically and exports 60% or more of such purchases.” 28. Define "domestic market enterprise'! The term “domestic market enterprise” shall mean an enterprise which products goods for sale, or renders services to the domestic market entirely or if exporting a portion of its output fails to consistency export at least 60% thereof.28 “Columbia Pictures, Inc. v. Court of Appeals, G.R. No. 110318, August 28, 1996. 27Section 3(e), R.A. No. 7042. “Section 3(f), R.A. No. 7042. r IX. SPECIAL LAWS 429 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 29. A Philippine Corporation is fully owned by a foreign company. It has for its primary purpose: "To own shares of stock of companies registered outside the Philippines; provided that, the corporation shall neither produce goods nor render services for the domestic market.” Can the Philippine Corporation be considered a domestic market enterprise subject to the minimum paidup capital requirement of the Philippine Peso equivalent of USD200,000.00? The Implementing Rules and Regulations of the Foreign Investments Act of 1991, Section l(k) provides that “Domestic market enterprise” shall mean an enterprise which produces goods for sale, or renders service, or otherwise engages in any business in the Philippines. Under E.O. No. 584,29 domestic market enterprises, with paidin equity capital of less than the equivalent of USD200,000.00, are restricted to a maximum of 40% foreign equity. The dominant character of a holding company is the ownership of securities by which it is possible to control or substantially influence the policies and management of one or more operating companies in a particular field of enterprise. The fact that the proposed Philippine-registered holding company will own shares of stock of foreign-registered corporations only, does not exclude it from being a domestic market enterprise since it still engages in business in the Philippines. In view of the foregoing, a 100% foreign-owned Philippineregistered corporation, whose sole purpose is to own shares of stock of companies registered outside the Philippines, and shall neither produce goods nor render services for the domestic market, is still deemed as a domestic market enterprise as defined under R.A. No. 7402, and is subject to the minimum paid-up capital requirement of the equivalent of USD200,000.00.30 “Replaced By E.O. No. 65 (Promulgating The Eleventh Regular Foreign In­ vestment Negative List). “Exemption of 100% Foreign Owned Holding Company from Minimum PaidUp Capital Requirement, SEC-OGC Opinion No. 30-09, November 23, 2009. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 430 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II C. Registration of Investments of Non-Philippine Nationals 30. To what regulatory bodies should foreign investments be registered? Under Section 5 of the FIA, as amended, a non-Philippine national, not otherwise disqualified by law, and upon registration with the SEC, or with the Department of Trade and Industry (“DTI”) in the case of single proprietorships, is allowed to do business or invest in a domestic enterprise up to 100% of its capital, unless participation of non-Philippine nationals in the enterprise is prohibited or limited under the Foreign Investments Negative List. In this regard, Section 3(c) of the same law, defines “foreign investment” as equity investment made by a non-Philippine national in the form of foreign exchange and/or other assets actually transferred to the Philippines and duly registered with the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas (“BSP”) which shall assess and appraise the value of such assets other than foreign exchange. Foreign investments registered with the BSP are entitled to full repatriation of capital and remittance of dividends/profits using foreign exchange sourced/purchased from authorized agent banks and/or their subsidiary/affiliate foreign exchange corporations. All applications for registration of foreign direct investments shall be filed with the BSP within one (1) year from the date of inward remittance/actual transfer of assets to the Philippines.31 D. Foreign Investments in Export Enterprises 31. Is 100% foreign investment in export enterprises allowed under the FIA? Foreign equity participation in export enterprises shall be allowed up to 100% provided that the products and services of such enterprises do not fall within Lists A and B of the Foreign Investment Negative List.32 31Section 36, Chapter II, Part Two of the BSP’s FX Manual, as amended. “Section 6, R.A. No. 7042. IX. SPECIAL LAWS 431 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 E. Foreign Investments in Domestic Market Enterprises 32. Can Non-Philippine Nationals Invest in Domestic Enterprises? As a general rule, there are no restrictions on extent of foreign ownership of export enterprises. In domestic market enterprises, foreigners can invest as much as 100% equity except in areas included in the Foreign Investment Negative List. Consistent with this declared policy, foreign or non-Philippine national investors are allowed to invest in domestic enterprises except when foreign ownership is either prohibited or limited by law. Section 7 of the Foreign Investment Act of 1991 (“FIA”), as amended,33 expressly provides: Sec. 7. Foreign Investments in Domestic Market Enterprises. — Non-Philippine nationals may own up to one hundred percent (100%) of domestic market enterprises unless foreign ownership therein is prohibited or limited by the Constitution and existing law or the Foreign Investment Negative List under Section 8 hereof. This Foreign Investment Negative List basically provides for two (2) component lists: (a) List A - which enumerates the areas of activities reserved to Philippine nationals by mandate of the Constitution and specific laws; and (b) List B - which contains the areas of activities and enterprises regulated pursuant to law for reasons of security, defense, risk to health and morals, and protection to small and medium-scale enterprises.31 Non-Philippine nationals are allowed to engage in small or medium-scale domestic enterprises provided that their paid in capital is at least two hundred thousand US dollars (USD200,000.00). However, when the enterprises involve advance technology as determined by the Department of Science and Technology, or ’’The FIA was amended in 1996 by R.A. No. 8179 to further liberalize foreign investments in the Philippines. 3,R.A. No. 8179 deleted List C provided under the FIA which contains investment areas already adequately served by existing enterprises and in which foreign investments need not be encouraged further. Deletion of this list is expected to open further the market to foreign investments and keep existing firms efficient and responsive to the needs of consumers. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II •132 employ at least 50 direct employees, in which case a minimum paidin capital of USD100,000.00 would be sufficient.35 F. Foreign Investment Negative List 33. What is the "Foreign Investments Negative List"? The “Foreign Investments Negative List” or “Negative List” refers to the list of areas of economic activity whose foreign ownership is limited to a maximum of 40% of the equity capital of the enterprises engaged therein.36 This Foreign Investment Negative List is divided into two (2) component lists: (a) List A - which enumerates the areas of activities reserved to Philippine nationals by mandate of the Constitution and specific laws; and (b) List B - which contains the areas of activities and enterprises regulated pursuant to law for reasons of security, defense, risk to health and morals, and protection to small and medium-scale enterprises. The latest Negative List is the “Eleventh Foreign Investment Negative List” promulgated under E.O. No. 65 which was issued on October 29, 2018. List A and List B of the Eleventh Foreign Investment Negative List provides: List A: Foreign Ownership is Limited by Mandate of the Constitution and Specific Laws No Foreign Equity a. Mass media, except recording (Article XVI, Section 11 of the 1987 Constitution; Presidential Memorandum dated May 5,1994) and internet business. (DO J Opinion No. 40, S. 1998) b. Practice of professions (Article XII, Section 14 of the Constitution, Section 1 of R.A. No. 5181, Section 7[j] of R.A. No. 8981), including Radiologic and x-ray technology (R.A. No. 7431), Criminology (R.A. No. 6506), Law (Article VIII, Section 5 of the Constitution; Rule 138, “Section 8 of the FIA, as amended by R.A. No. 8179. “Section 3(g), R.A. No. 7042. 433 JX. SPECIAL LAWS 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 Section 2 of the Rules of Court of the Philippines), and Marine deck officers and marine engine officers (R.A. No. 10635), subject to the Annex on Professions indicating the professions where (a) foreigners are allowed to practice in the Philippines subject to reciprocity; and (b) where corporate practice is allowed. Foreigners may teach at higher education levels (R.A. No. 8292), provided the subject being taught is not a professional subject (i.e., included in a government board or bar examination). C. Retail trade enterprises with paid-up capital of less than US$2,500,000.00 (Section 5 of R.A. No. 8762) d. Cooperatives (Chapter III, Article 26 of R.A. No. 6938, as amended by Chapter II, Article 10 of R.A. No. 9520) e. Organization and operation of private detective, watchmen or security guards agencies. (Section 4 of R.A. No. 5487) f. Small-scale mining. (Section 3 of R.A. No. 7076) g- Utilization of marine resources in archipelagic waters, territorial sea and exclusive economic zone as well as small-scale utilization of natural resources in rivers, lakes, bays, and lagoons. (Article. XII, Section 2 of the Constitution) h. Ownership, operation, and management of cockpits (Section 5 of P.D. No. 449) i. Manufacture, repair, stockpiling, and/or distribution of nuclear weapons. (Article II, Section 8 of the Constitution) )• Manufacture, repair, stockpiling, and/or distribution of biological, chemical, and radiological weapons and anti-personnel mines, (various treaties to which the Philippines is a signatory and conventions supported by the Philippines) k. Manufacture of firecrackers and other pyrotechnic devices. (Section 5 of R.A. No. 7183) Up to Twenty-Five Percent (25%) Foreign Equity J9JC9B0M a. Private recruitment, whether for local or overseas employment (Article 27 of P.D. No. 442) J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II •134 b. Contracts for the construction of defense-related structures (Section 1 of Commonwealth Act No. 541) Up to Thirty Percent (30%) Foreign Equity a. Advertising (Article XVI, Section 11 of the Constitution) Up to Forty Percent (40%) Foreign Equity a. Subject to applicable regulatory frameworks, contracts for the construction and repair of locally-funded public works (Section 1 of C.A. No. 541, Letter of Instruction No. 630), except: i. Infrastructure/development projects covered in R.A No. 7718; and ii. Projects which are foreign-funded or assisted and required to undergo international competitive bidding (Sec. 21[a] of R.A. No. 7718) b. Exploration, development, and utilization of natural resources (Article XII, Section 2 of the Constitution) c. Ownership of private lands (Article XII, Section 7 of the Constitution; Section 22 of C.A. No. 141; Section 4 of R.A No. 9182) d. Operation of public utilities (Article XII, Section 11 of the Constitution; Section 16 of C.A. No. 146; Section 2[a] of R.A. No. 7718), except power generation and the supply of electricity to the contestable market (Section 6 and Section 29, respectively, of R.A. No. 9136) and such other like businesses or services not covered by the definition of public utilities. e. Educational institutions other than those established by religious groups and mission boards, for foreign diplomatic personnel and their dependents, and other foreign temporary residents (Article XIV, Section 4 of the Constitution), or for short-term high-level skills development that do not form part of the formal education system as defined in Section 20 of B.P. No. 232 (1982). f. Culture, production, milling, processing, trading except retailing, of rice and corn and acquiring, by barter, IX. SPECIAL LAWS 435 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 purchase or otherwise, rice and corn and the by-products thereof. (Section 5 of P.D. No. 194) g- Contracts for the supply of materials, goods and com­ modities to government-owned or controlled corporation, company, agency or municipal corporation. (Sec. 1 of RA No. 5183) h. Operation of deep sea commercial fishing vessels. (Sec. 27 of RA No. 8550, as amended by RA No. 10654) i. Ownership of condominium units. (Sec. 5 of RA No. 4726) j. Private radio communications network (Art. XII, Sec. 11 of the Constitution, NTC Memorandum Circular No. 108-91) List B: Foreign Ownership is Limited by Reasons of Security, Defense, Risk to Health and Morals, and Protection of Small and Medium Scale Enterprises Up to Forty Percent (40%) Foreign Equity a. I J9JC9B0M Manufacture, repair, storage, and/or distribution of products and/or ingredients requiring Philippine National Police (PNP) clearance: i. Firearms (handguns to shotguns), parts of firearms and ammunition therefor, instruments or imple­ ments used or intended to be used in the manufac­ ture of firearms; ii. Gunpowder; iii. Dynamite; iv. Blasting supplies; v. Ingredients used in making explosives: 1) Chlorates of potassium and sodium; 2) Nitrates of ammonium, potassium, sodium barium, copper (11), lead (11), calcium, and cuprite; 3) Nitric acid; 4) Nitrocellulose; J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II ■136 5) Perchlorates of ammonium, potassium, and sodium; 6) Dinitrocellulose; 7) Glycerol; 8) Amorphous phosphorus; 9) Hydrogen peroxide; 10) Strontium nitrate powder; 11) Toluene; and vi. Telescopic sights, sniper scope, and other similar devices. However, the manufacture or repair of these items may be authorized by the Chief of the PNP to non-Philippine nationals; Provided that a substantial percentage of output, as determined by the said agency, is exported. Provided further that the extent of foreign equity ownership allowed shall be specified in the said authority/clearance. (R.A. No. 7042 as amended by R.A. No. 8179) b. Manufacture, repair, storage, and/or distribution of products requiring Department of National Defense (DND) clearance: i. Guns and ammunition for warfare; ii. Military ordinance and parts thereof (e.g., torpedoes, depth charges, bombs, grenades, missiles); iii. Gunnery, bombing, and fire control systems and components; iv. Guided missiles/missile systems and components; v. Tactical aircraft (fixed and rotary-winged), parts and components thereof; vi. Space vehicles and component systems; vii. Combat vessels (air, land, and naval) and auxiliaries; viii. Weapons repair and maintenance equipment; ix. Military communications equipment; x. Night vision equipment; IX. SPECIAL LAWS m 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 xi. Stimulated coherent radiation devices, components, and accessories; xii. Armament training devices; and xiii. Others as may be determined by the Secretary of the DND. However, the manufacture or repair of these items may be authorized by the Secretary of National Defense to non-Philippine nationals; Provided, that a substantial percentage of output, as determined by the said agency, is exported. Provided, further, that the extent of foreign equity ownership allowed shall be specified in the said authority/clearance. (R.A. No. 7042 as amended by R.A. No. 8179) c. Manufacture and distribution of dangerous drugs (R.A. No. 7042 as amended by R.A. No. 8179) d. Sauna and steam bathhouses, massage climes and other like activities regulated by law because of risks posed to public health and morals, except wellness centers (R.A. No. 7042 as amended by R.A. No. 8179) e. All forms of gambling (R.A. No. 7042 as amended by R.A. No. 8179) except those covered by investment agreements with PAGCOR (R.A. No. 1869, as amended by R.A. No. 9487) f. Domestic market enterprises with paid-in equity capital of less than the equivalent of US$200,000.00 (R.A. No. 7042, as amended by R.A. No. 8179) g- Domestic market enterprises which involve advanced technology or employ at least 50 direct employees with paid-in equity capital of less than the equivalent of US$100,000.00. (R.A. No. 7042, as amended by R.A. No. 8179) 34. What are the highlights of the 11th Negative List? The 11th Negative List allows full foreign participation in five (5) investment areas or activities and up to 40% foreign participation in three (3) sectors. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 438 The following table summarizes the changes introduced by the 11th Negative List in the following investment areas: Investment Area __________ Foreign Participation 10,h Negative List Internet Business, which 0% refers to internet access proriders that merely serve as carriers for transmitting messages, rather than being the creator of the message/ information. Teaching at higher edu­ 0% cation levels provided that the subject being taught is a not a profes­ sional subject (t.e., in­ cluded in a government board examination or bar examination). Training Centers en­ Up to 40% in gaged short-term high-level skills deve­ lopment that do not form part of the formal educa­ tional system. adjustment Insurance companies, lending com­ panies, financing com­ panies, and investment houses. Wellness centers • Up to 40% for ad­ justment compa­ nies • Up to 49% for lend­ ing companies • Up to 60% for fi­ nancing companies and investment houses Up to 40% Contracts for the con­ Up to 25% struction and repair of locally-funded public works, except: 11th Negative List 100% Carved out as an ex­ ception to mass me­ dia, which is strictly restricted to Filipino nationals. 100% Carved out as an ex­ ception to practice of professions, which is strictly restricted to Filipino nationals. Up to 100% Carved out as an ex­ ception to educational institutions, which are still restricted only up to 40% foreign equity.__________ Up to 100% Up to 100% Up to 40% IX. SPECIAL LAWS 439 1. FOREIGN INVESTMENT ACT OF 1991 REPUBLIC ACT NO. 7042, AS AMENDED BY REPUBLIC ACT NO. 8179 a. Infrastructure/development projects cove­ red in R.A. No. 7718 b. Projects which are foreign funded or as­ sisted and required to undergo international competitive bidding. Private radio communi­ cations network. J9JC9B0M Up to 20% Up to 40% J9JC9B0M 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 1. What are the remedies available to or against an insolvent debtor under FRIA? An individual insolvent debtor may file a petition for suspension of payments and/or may also file, or be the subject of, petition for liquidation. A juridical insolvent debtor may file, or be the subject of, a petition for rehabilitation or liquidation. A juridical insolvent debtor refers to, unless specifically excluded by a provision under FRIA, a sole proprietorship duly registered with the Department of Trade and Industry (“DTI”), a partnership duly registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), a corporation duly organized and existing under Philippine laws.1 An individual debtor refers to a natural person who is a resident and citizen of the Philippines who has become insolvent as defined under FRIA.2 a. 2. Definition of Insolvency What does insolvent mean to describe a debtor under FRIA? Insolvent shall refer to the financial condition of a debtor that is generally unable to pay its or his liabilities as they fall due in the ordinary course of business or has liabilities that are greater than its or his assets.3 Technical insolvency means that the debtor has more assets than liabilities but generally unable to pay its or his liabilities as they fall due. Actual insolvency means that the debtor’s assets are less than liabilities. 'Section 4(k). "Section m(o). "Section 4(p), R.A. No. 10142. 440 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA") 441 Prior to FRIA, only a technically insolvent debtor may file a petition for rehabilitation. An actually insolvent debtor could not file a petition for rehabilitation but should file a petition for insolvency, instead. FRIA covers both technical and actual insolvency. An actually insolvent debtor may file a petition for rehabilitation and the court will give it due course if the court believes that there is substantial likelihood that the debtor may be rehabilitated through a viable Rehabilitation Plan.4 Otherwise, the court may convert the rehabilitation proceedings into one of liquidation.5 In one case,6 the Supreme Court ruled that a corporation left without assets could not file a petition for rehabilitation, and the fact that there are pending actions to nullify the foreclosure of its assets does not change such conclusion. Given the expanded concept of insolvency under FRIA, it appears that such debtor without assets can now file a petition for rehabilitation under FRIA. The term debtor does not include banks, insurance companies, pre-need companies, and national and local government agencies or units. The rehabilitation of distressed banks and insurance companies are governed by other special laws.7 Government financial institutions other than banks and government-owned or -controlled corporations are covered by FRIA unless their specific charter provides otherwise.8 b. 3. Suspension of Payments Who may file a petition for suspension of payments? An individual debtor who, possessing sufficient property to cover all his debts but foreseeing the impossibility of meeting them when they respectively fall due, may file a verified petition that 'See Philippine Bank of Communications v. Basic Polyprinters and Packaging Corporation, G.R. No. 187581, October 20, 2014 where the Supreme Court stated that a debtor whose assets are less than liabilities may file a petition for rehabilitation under FRIA. The petition for rehabilitation, however, was dismissed. ‘Section 92. ‘New Frontier Sugar Corporation Regional Trial Court, Branch 39, Iloilo City, G.R. No. 165001, January 31, 2007. ’R.A. No. 7653, as amended; (The New Central Bank Act) P.D. No. 612, as amended (Insurance Code of the Philippines) and R.A. No. 9829 (Pre-need Code of the Philippines). •Section 5. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 442 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II he be declared in the state of suspension of payments by the court of the province or city in which he has resided for six (6) months prior to the filing of his petition. He shall attach to his petition, as a minimum: (a) a schedule of debts and liabilities; (b) an inventory of assess; and (c) a proposed agreement with his creditors.9 Suspension of payments, as a remedy under FRIA, is not available to a juridical insolvent debtor. For juridical insolvent debtors, suspension of payments is part of the commencement order which the court may issue through the filing of a petition for rehabilitation. 4. What order will the court issue if it finds the petition for suspension of payments to be sufficient in form and substance? If the court finds the petition sufficient in form and substance, it shall, within five (5) working days from the filing of the petition, issue an Order: a. calling a meeting of all the creditors named in the schedule of debts and liabilities at such time not less than 15 days nor more than 40 days from the date of such Order and designating the date, time and place of the meeting; b. directing such creditors to prepare and present written evidence of their claims before the scheduled creditors’ meeting; c. directing the publication of the said order in a newspaper of general circulation published in the province or city in which the petition is filed once a week for two (2) consecutive weeks, with the first publication to be made within seven (7) days from the time of the issuance of the Order; d. directing the clerk of court to cause the sending of a copy of the Order by registered mail, postage prepaid, to all creditors named in the schedule of debts and liabilities; e. forbidding the individual debtor from selling, transferring, encumbering or disposing in any manner of his property, 9Section 94. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 443 except those used in the ordinary operations of commerce, or of industry in which the petitioning individual debtor is engaged, so long as the proceedings relative to the suspension of payments are pending; 5. f. prohibiting the individual debtor from making any payment outside of the necessary or legitimate expenses of his business or industry, so long as the proceedings relative to the suspension of payments are pending; and g- appointing a commissioner to preside over the creditors’ meeting.10 May the court suspend any pending execution against the debtor who filed the petition? Upon motion filed by the individual debtor, the court may issue an order suspending any pending execution against the individual debtor: provided, that properties held as security by secured creditors shall not be the subject of such suspension order. The suspension order shall lapse when three (3) months shall have passed without the proposed agreement being accepted by the creditors or as soon as such agreement is denied.11 6. What is the effect of the filing of the petition for suspension of payments? No creditor shall sue or institute proceedings to collect his claim from the debtor from the time of the filing of the petition for suspension of payments and for as long as proceedings remain pending except: (a) those creditors having claims for personal labor, maintenance, expense of last illness and funeral of the wife or children of the debtor incurred in the 60 days immediately prior to the filing of the petition; and (b) secured creditors.12 In other words, the mere filing of a petition for suspension of payments suspends the enforcement of claims against the individual debtor except the excluded claims above-mentioned. J9JC9B0M ‘“Section 95. “Section 96. 12Section 96. J9JC9B0M 444 7. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II What are the conditions for the approval of the petition for suspension of payments? The presence of creditors holding claims amounting to at least three-fifths (3/5) of the liabilities shall be necessary for holding a meeting. The commissioner appointed by the court shall preside over the meeting and the clerk of court shall act as the secretary thereof, subject to the following rules: a. The clerk shall record the creditors present and amount of their respective claims; b. The commissioner shall examine the written evidence of the claims. If the creditors present hold at least threefifths (3/5) of the liabilities of the individual debtor, the commissioner shall declare the meeting open for business; c. The creditors and individual debtor shall discuss the propositions in the proposed agreement and put them to a vote; d. To form a majority, it is necessary: e. i. that two-thirds (2/3) of the creditors voting unite upon the same proposition; and ii. that the claims represented by said majority vote amount to at least three-fifths (3/5) of the total liabilities of the debtor mentioned in the petition; and After the result of the voting has been announced, all protests made against the majority vote shall be drawn up, and the commissioner and the individual debtor together with all creditors taking part in the voting shall sign the affirmed propositions. No creditor who incurred his credit within 90 days prior to the filing of the petition shall be entitled to vote.13 8. What is the double majority rule in petition for suspension of payments? It means that the proposed agreement for suspension of payments should be approved by 2/3 of number of creditors and such number of creditors must represent at least 3/5 of total liabilities. Otherwise, the court should deny the petition. “Section 97. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) ("FRIA”) 9. 445 ABC Corporation has outstanding money obligations to six (6) creditors, namely A, B, C, D, E, and F, in the aggregate amount of P250 million. The amount due to A, B, and C collectively is P150 million. In the creditors meeting, the three (3) agreed to the petition but not the remaining creditors. Should the court approve the petition for suspension of payments? No, the petition cannot be approved by the court because while A, B, and C are representing at least 3/5 of total liabilities, they do not represent at least 2/3 of total number of creditors. 10. What are the effects of the approval of the proposed Suspension of Payments agreement? If the decision of the majority of the creditors to approve the proposed agreement or any amendment thereof made during the creditors’ meeting is upheld by the court, or when no opposition or objection to said decision has been presented, the court shall order that the agreement be carried out and all parties bound thereby to comply with its terms. The court may also issue all orders which may be necessary or proper to enforce the agreement on motion of any affected party. The Order confirming the approval of the proposed agreement on any amendment thereof made during the creditors’ meeting shall be binding upon all creditors whose claims are included in the schedule of debts and liabilities submitted by the individual debtor and who were properly summoned, but not upon: (a) those creditors having claims for personal labor, maintenance, expenses of last illness and funeral of the wife or children of the debtor incurred in the 60 days immediately prior to the filing of the petition, and (b) secured creditors who failed to attend the meeting o[r] refrained from voting therein.14 11. J9JC9B0M What claims are not covered by the filing of the petition for suspension of payments and/or the court order approving the petition for suspension of payments? a. Those whose claims are not included in the schedule of debts and liabilities submitted by the individual debtor to the court; HSection 101. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 446 12. b. Those creditors having claims for personal labor, maintenance, expenses of last illness and funeral of the wife or children of the debtor incurred in the 60 days immediately prior to the filing of the petition; and, C. Secured creditors, (like mortgagee of real property and holders of security interest on personal property) When is the proposed agreement deemed rejected? The proposed agreement shall be deemed rejected if the number of creditors required for holding a meeting do not attend thereat, or if the two (2) majorities mentioned in Section 97 hereof are not in favor thereof. In such instances, the proceeding shall be terminated without recourse and the parties concerned shall be at liberty to enforce the rights which may correspond to them.16 13. When may the creditors enforce their claims against the debtor who filed the petition for suspension of payment? The creditors may enforce their claims against the debtor in the following cases: 14. a. If the proposed agreement is rejected for lack of quorum or failure to obtain the approval of the double majorities required by law. b. If the individual debtor fails, wholly or in part, to perform the agreement decided upon at the meeting of the creditors, all the rights which the creditors had against the individual debtor before the agreement shall revest in them.16 In this particular case, the individual debtor may be made subject to the insolvency proceedings in the manner established by FRIA. c. If their claims are those not covered by the rules on suspension of payments. Hortencio owned a modest grocery business in Laguna. Because of the economic downturn, he incurred huge financial liabilities. He remained afloat only because of the properties 16Section 99. 16Section 102. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA'’) 447 inherited from his parents who had both come from landed families in Laguna. His main creditor was Puresilver Company (Puresilver), the principal supplier of the merchandise sold in his store. To secure his credit with Puresilver, he executed a real estate mortgage with a dragnet clause involving his family's assets worth several millions of pesos. Nonetheless, Hortencio, while generally in the black, now faces a situation where he is unable to pay his liabilities as they fall due in the ordinary course of business. What will you advise him to do to resolve his dire financial condition? Explain your answer. If Hortencio is doing business as a registered sole proprietorship, he can file a petition for rehabilitation. Under the FRIA, a sole proprietorship can now file a petition for rehabilitation. The remedy may be availed of in case of actual or technical insolvency. In the petition, he can pray for the issuance of a commencement order which includes a stay order. The stay order, once issued, has the effect of enjoining the enforcement of claims against Hortencio. If Hortencio is not registered as a sole proprietorship, he can file a petition for suspension of payments in the city or province in which he has resided for six (6) months prior to the filing of the petition, a remedy available for an individual debtor who has more assets than liabilities but foresees the impossibility of paying his debts when they respectively fall due.17 C. 15. Rehabilitation What is rehabilitation in the context of FRIA? Rehabilitation shall refer to the restoration of the debtor to a condition of successful operation and solvency, if it is shown that its continuance of operation is economically feasible and its creditors can recover by way of the present value of payments projected in the plan, more if the debtor continues as a going concern than if it is immediately liquidated.18 J9JC9B0M ■’Section 94 of FRIA. ■’Section 4(gg). J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II ■148 16. What is the objective of rehabilitation? Corporate rehabilitation contemplates a continuance of corporate life and activities in an effort to restore and reinstate the corporation to its former position of successful operation and solvency, the purpose being to enable the company to gain a new lease on life and allow its creditors to be paid their claims out of its earnings. Thus, the basic issues in rehabilitation proceedings concern the viability and desirability of continuing the business operations of the distressed corporation, all with a view of effectively restoring it to a state of solvency or to its former healthy financial condition through the adoption of a Rehabilitation Plan.10 The purpose of rehabilitation proceedings is to enable the company to gain a new lease on life and thereby allow creditors to be paid their claims from its earnings.20 Rehabilitation assumes that the corporation has been operational but for some reasons like economic crisis or mismanagement had become distressed or insolvent. The petition for rehabilitation should be denied if the debtor had not been in the position of successful operation and solvency prior to the filing of the petition. Thus, while the debtor had indeed commenced business through the preparatory act of opening a credit line with the bank to finance the construction of a new hospital building for its future operations, but the debtor corporation itself admitted that it has not formally operated nor earned any income since its incorporation, this simply means that there exists no viable business concern to be restored and the petition for rehabilitation should be dismissed.21 17. How may the objective of restoring the debtor to its/his former state of successful operations be attained? The objective of restoring the debtor to its/his former state of successful operation and solvency may be attained through the following: a. Adoption of an economically feasible Rehabilitation Plan; ’’Philippine Asset Growth Two, Inc. and Planters Development Bank v. Fastech Synergy Philippines, Inc., el al., G.R. No. 206528, June 28, 2016. “Philippine Bank of Communications v. Basic Polyprinters and Packaging Corporation, G.R. No. 187581, October 20, 2014. 21BPI Family Savings Bank v. St Michael Medical Center, G.R. No. 205469, March 25, 2015. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) ("FRIA") 18. 449 b. During the pendency of the rehabilitation, the enforcement of claims against the debtor are generally suspended - to give time to the debtor and the Rehabilitation Receiver to rehabilitate the debtor undistracted by court suits; C. The Rehabilitation Plan is binding on the debtor and all creditors affected by the proceedings even to those who did not take part or opposed the Rehabilitation Plan under the cram down effect of the Rehabilitation Plan; and d. National and local taxes are likewise waived until approval of the Rehabilitation Plan or termination of the rehabilitation proceedings. i. Types What are the types of rehabilitation proceedings? The types of rehabilitation proceedings are as follows: a. 19. Court-supervised rehabilitation i. Voluntary ii. Involuntary b. Pre-negotiated rehabilitation c. Out-of-court or informal restructuring agreement or Rehabilitation Plan Who may initiate voluntary rehabilitation proceedings? When approved by the owner in case of a sole proprietorship, or by a majority of the partners in case of a partnership, or, in case of a corporation, by a majority vote of the board of directors or trustees and authorized by the vote of the stockholders representing at least two-thirds (2/3) of the outstanding capital stock, or in case of non-stock corporation, by the vote of at least two-thirds (2/3) of the members, in a stockholder’s or member’s meeting duly called for the purpose, an insolvent debtor may initiate voluntary proceedings under the FRIA by filing a petition for rehabilitation with the court and on the grounds hereinafter specifically provided. The petition shall be verified to establish the insolvency of the debtor and the J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 450 viability of its rehabilitation, and include, whether as an attachment or as part of the body of the petition, as a minimum, the following: a. Identification of the debtor, its principal activities and its addresses; b. Statement of the fact of and the cause of the debtor’s insolvency or inability to pay its obligations as they become due; C. The specific relief sought pursuant to FRIA; d. The grounds upon which the petition is based; e. Other information that may be required under this Act depending on the form of relief requested; f. Schedule of the debtor’s debts and liabilities including a list of creditors with their addresses, amounts of claims and collaterals, or securities, if any; g- An inventory of all its assets including receivables and claims against third parties; h. A Rehabilitation Plan; i. The names of at least three (3) nominees to the position of Rehabilitation Receiver; and j. Other documents required to be filed with the petition pursuant to the Act and the rules of procedure as may be promulgated by the Supreme Court. A group of debtors may jointly file a petition for rehabilitation under FRIA when one or more of its members foresee the impossibility of meeting debts when they respectively fall due, and the financial distress would likely adversely affect the financial condition and/or operations of the other members of the group and/or the participation of the other members of the group is essential under the terms and conditions of the proposed Rehabilitation Plan.22 20. Under what conditions may involuntary rehabilitation proceedings be initiated against an insolvent juridical debtor? Any creditor or group of creditors with a claim of, or the aggregate of whose claims is, at least Pl,000,000.00 or at least 25% of the subscribed capital stock or partners’ contributions, whichever “Section 12. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 451 is higher, may initiate involuntary proceedings against the debtor by filing a petition for rehabilitation with the court if: a. there is no genuine issue of fact or law on the claim/s of the petitioner/s, and that the due and demandable payments thereon have not been made for at least 60 days or that the debtor has failed generally to meet its liabilities as they fall due; or b. a creditor, other than the petitioner/s, has initiated foreclosure proceedings against the debtor that will prevent the debtor from paying its debts as they become due or will render it insolvent.23 The creditor/s’ petition for rehabilitation shall be verified to establish the substantial likelihood that the debtor may be rehabilitated, and include: a. identification of the debtor, its principal activities and its address; b. the circumstances sufficient to support a petition to initiate involuntary rehabilitation proceedings under Section 13 of FRIA; . C. the specific relief sought under FRIA; d. a Rehabilitation Plan; e. the names of at least three (3) nominees to the position of Rehabilitation Receiver; f. other information that may be required under this Act depending on the form of relief requested; and g- other documents required to be filed with the petition pursuant to FRIA and the rules of procedure as may be promulgated by the Supreme Court.24 21. When may creditor/s commence involuntary proceedings? Any creditor or group of creditors with a claim of, or the aggregate of whose claims is, at least Pl,000,000.00 or at least 25% of the subscribed capital stock or partners’ contributions, whichever J9JC9B0M “Section 13. “Section 14. J9JC9B0M 452 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II is higher, may initiate involuntary proceedings against the debtor by filing a petition for rehabilitation with the court if: (a) there is no genuine issue of fact on law on the claim/s of the petitioner/s, and that the due and demandable payments thereon have not been made for at least 60 days or that the debtor has failed generally to meet its liabilities as they fall due; or (b) a creditor, other than the petitioner/s, has initiated foreclosure proceedings against the debtor that will prevent the debtor from paying its debts as they become due or will render it insolvent. 22. Under what conditions may the Rehabilitation Court approve a pre-negotiated Rehabilitation Plan? An insolvent debtor, by itself or jointly with any of its creditors, may file a verified petition with the court for the approval of a pre­ negotiated Rehabilitation Plan which has been endorsed or approved by creditors holding at least two-thirds (2/3) of the total liabilities of the debtor, including secured creditors holding more than 50% of the total secured claims of the debtor and unsecured creditors holding more than 50% of the total unsecured claims of the debtor. The petition shall include, as a minimum: 23. a. a schedule of the debtor’s debts and liabilities; b. an inventory of the debtor’s assets; C. the pre-negotiated Rehabilitation Plan, including the names of at least three (3) qualified nominees for Rehabilitation Receiver; and d. a summary of disputed claims against the debtor and a report on the provisioning of funds to account for appropriate payments should any such claims be ruled valid or their amounts adjusted.26 What is the effect of the approval of the pre-negotiated Rehabilitation Plan? The approval of a pre-negotiated Rehabilitation Plan shall have the same legal effect as confirmation of a Rehabilitation Plan in a voluntary rehabilitation proceedings.26 “Section 76. “Section 82. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 463 24. What are the requirements for an Out-of-Court or Informal restructuring agreement or Rehabilitation Plan? a. The debtor must agree to the out-of-court or informal restructuring/workout agreement or Rehabilitation Plan; b. It must be approved by creditors representing at least 67% of the secured obligations of the debtor; c. It must be approved by creditors representing at least 75% of the unsecured obligations of the debtor; and d. It must be approved by creditors holding at least 85% of the total liabilities, secured and unsecured, of the debtor.27 It means that among the secured and unsecured creditors and total number of creditors, there is a threshold percentage of liabilities. The approval is based on the amount of liabilities and not based on number of creditors. 25. What is a standstill agreement? It is an agreement by the debtor and the creditors providing for a standstill period pending negotiation and finalization of the out-of-court or informal restructuring agreement which is effective and enforceable not only against the contracting parties but also against other creditors. Provided, that such agreement is approved by creditors representing more than 50% of the total liabilities of the debtor; notice thereof is published in a newspaper of general circulation in the Philippines once a week for two consecutive weeks; and the standstill period does not exceed 120 days from the date of effectivity. The notice must invite creditors to participate in the negotiation for out-of-court rehabilitation or restructuring agreement and notify them that said agreement will be binding on all creditors if the required majority votes are met.28 26. What is the effect of duly approved informal or restructuring/ workout agreement or Rehabilitation Plan? A restructuring/workout agreement or Rehabilitation Plan that is approved pursuant to an informal workout framework referred to above shall have the same legal effect as confirmation J9JC9B0M “Section 84. “Section 85. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 454 of a Rehabilitation Plan in a court-supervised rehabilitation proceedings. The notice of the Rehabilitation Plan or restructuring agreement or Plan shall be published once a week for at least three (3) consecutive weeks in a newspaper of general circulation in the Philippines. The Rehabilitation Plan or restructuring agreement shall take effect upon the lapse of 15 days from the date of the last publication of the notice thereof.'-9 ii. 27. Commencement order What is a Commencement Order? It is the order that commences the rehabilitation proceedings which is issued by the Rehabilitation Court after it finds the petition for rehabilitation as sufficient in form and substance. The rehabilitation proceedings shall be deemed to have commenced from the date of filing of the petition, which is also termed the commencement date.30 The commencement order shall: a. identify the debtor, its principal business or activity/ies and its principal place of business; b. summarize the ground/s for initiating the proceedings; c. state the relief sought under FRIA and any requirement or procedure particular to the relief sought; d. state the legal effects of the Commencement Order, including those mentioned in Section 17 hereof; e. declare that the debtor is under rehabilitation; f. direct the publication of the Commencement Order in a newspaper of general circulation in the Philippines once a week for at least two (2) consecutive weeks, with the first publication to be made within seven (7) days from the time of its issuance; g- if the petitioner is the debtor, direct the service by personal delivery of a copy of the petition on each creditor 2sSection 86. “Allied Banking Corporation v. In the Matter of the Petition to Have Steel Corporation of the Philippines Placed under Corporate Rehabilitation, G.R. No. 191939, March 14, 2018, J9JC9B0M 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 455 holding at least ten percent (10%) of the total liabilities of the debtor as determined from the schedule attached to the petition within five (5) days; if the petitioner/s is/are creditor/s, direct the service by personal delivery of a copy of the petition on the debtor within five (5) days; h. appoint a Rehabilitation Receiver who may or may not be from among the nominees of the petitioner/s, and who shall exercise such powers and duties defined in FRIA as well as the procedural rules that the Supreme Court will promulgate; i. summarize the requirements and deadlines for creditors to establish their claims against the debtor and direct all creditors to file their claims with the court at least five (5) days before the initial hearing; j. direct the Bureau of Internal Revenue (“BIR”) to file and serve on the debtor its comment on or opposition to the petition or its claim/s against the debtor under such procedures as the Supreme Court may hereafter provide; k. prohibit the debtor’s suppliers of goods or services from withholding the supply of goods and services in the ordinary course of business for as long as the debtor makes payments for the services or goods supplied after the issuance of the Commencement Order; 1. authorize the payment of administrative expenses as they become due; m. set the case for initial hearing, which shall not be more than 40 days from the date of filing of the petition for the purpose of determining whether there is substantial likelihood for the debtor to be rehabilitated; n. make available copies of the petition and Rehabilitation Plan for examination and copying by any interested party; o. indicate the location or locations at which documents regarding the debtor and the proceedings under FRIA may be reviewed and copied; P- state that any creditor or debtor, who is not the petitioner, may submit the name or nominate any other qualified person to the position of Rehabilitation Receiver at least five (5) days before the initial hearing; J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 456 q28. include a Stay or Suspension Order.31 Should the Commencement Order be served to the creditors of the insolvent debtor to bind them to the rehabilitation proceedings? No. jurisdiction over all persons affected by the rehabilitation proceedings shall be considered as acquired upon publication of the notice of the commencement of the proceedings in any newspaper of general circulation in the Philippines in the manner prescribed by the rules of procedure promulgated by the Supreme Court.32 29. What are the effects of a Commencement Order? Unless otherwise provided for by law, the court’s issuance of a Commencement Order shall, in addition to the effects of a Stay or Suspension Order: a. vest the Rehabilitation Receiver with all the powers and functions provided for in FRIA, such as the right to review and obtain all records to which the debtor’s management and directors have access, including bank accounts of whatever nature of the debtor, subject to the approval by the court of the performance bond filed by the Rehabilitation Receiver; b. prohibit, or otherwise serve as the legal basis for rendering null and void the results of any extrajudicial activity or process to seize property, sell encumbered property, or otherwise attempt to collect on or enforce a claim against the debtor after the commencement date unless otherwise allowed in FRIA, subject to the provisions of Section 50 hereof; c. serve as the legal basis for rendering null and void any set-off after the commencement date of any debt owed to the debtor by any of the debtor’s creditors; d. serve as the legal basis for rendering null and void the perfection of any lien against the debtor’s property after the commencement date; and e. consolidate the resolution of all legal proceedings by and against the debtor to the court: Provided, however, that 31Section 16. “Section 3. r 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 457 the court may allow the continuation of cases in other courts where the debtor had initiated the suit. Attempts to seek legal or other recourse against the debtor outside these proceedings shall be sufficient to support a finding of indirect contempt of court.33 Similarly, upon issuance of the Commencement Order, and until the approval of the Rehabilitation Plan or dismissal of the petition, whichever is earlier, the imposition of all taxes and fees, including penalties, interests and charges thereof, due to the national government or to LGUs shall be considered waived, in furtherance of the objectives of rehabilitation.34 30. What is the effectivity and duration of the Commencement Order? Unless lifted by the court, the Commencement Order shall be effective for the duration of the rehabilitation proceedings for as long as there is a substantial likelihood that the debtor will be successfully rehabilitated.36 The effects of such commencement order shall retroact to the date that the petition was filed, and renders void any attempt to collect on or enforce a claim against the debtor or to set off any debt by the debtor’s creditors, after the commencement date.36 It was held, however, that the retroactive effect of a Commencement Order only applies to petitions filed after the effectivity of FRIA. Section 146 of the FRIA, which makes it applicable to “all further proceedings in insolvency, suspension of payments and rehabilitation cases x x x except to the extent that in the opinion of the court their application would not be feasible or would work injustice,” still presupposes a prospective application. Thus, the rule that a third-party or accommodation mortgage may be enjoined if the mortgaged property is needed to rehabilitate the debtor only applies to mortgage foreclosed during the effectivity of FRIA.3’ “Section 17. “Section 19. “Section 21. “Allied Banking Corporation v. In the Matter of the Petition to Have Steel Corporation of the Philippines Placed under Corporate Rehabilitation, ibid.; Section 1(d), FRIA. AsiaTrust Bank, et al., G.R. No. 180036, “Situs Dev. Corporation, et al. January 16, 2013. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 458 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 31. Is court hearing required prior to the issuance of a Stay Order? The Interim Rules do not require a hearing before the issuance of a Stay Order. What it requires is an initial hearing before it can give due course to or dismiss a petition. Nevertheless, while the Interim Rules do not require the holding of a hearing before the issuance of a Stay Order, neither does it prohibit the holding of one. Thus, the trial court has ample discretion to call a hearing when it is not confident that the allegations in the petition are sufficient in form and substance, for so long as this hearing is held within the five (5)-day period from the filing of the petition — the period within which a Stay Order may issue as provided in the Interim Rules.35 32. On February 20,2021, ABC, an insolvent debtor, filed a petition for rehabilitation. On February 22, 2021, upon learning of ABC's filing of the petition, XYZ Bank, of the creditors of ABC, declared the loan of ABC with XYZ due and demandable based on the terms of the relevant loan agreement. Right after such declaration, XYZ applied the bank deposit of ABC with the Bank against ABC's outstanding loan obligation. On February 24, 2021, the court found the petition for rehabilitation sufficient in form and substance, consequently, issued on the same day a commencement order. The commencement order, among others, appointed a Rehabilitation Receiver and included a stay order which enjoined the enforcement of claims against ABC. Upon learning of the set-off, the Rehabilitation Receiver demanded that the set-off should be set-aside arguing that XYZ cannot collect the loan because of the stay order. XYZ Bank, in turn, countered that there is no more claim when the stay order was issued because such claim had been extinguished on February 22, 2021 and legal set-off took effect by operation of law. Should the set-off be nullified? Yes, the set-off should be nullified. This is because while the Commencement Order was issued two (2) days after the set-off of deposit, it retroacted to the date of the filing of the petition for 3“Pryce Corporation v. China Banking Corporation, G.R. No. 172302, February 18, 2014. Although this was decided under the Interim Rules on Corporate Rehabili­ tation, the same principle may be applied under FRIA. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) ("FRIA") 459 rehabilitation on February 20, 2021. Thus, the set-off in between should set aside. iii. Stay or Suspension Order 33. What are the effects of a Stay or Suspension Order? The Stay or Suspension Order shall: a. b. c. d. suspend all actions or proceedings, in court or otherwise, for the enforcement of claims against the debtor; suspend all actions to enforce any judgment, attachment or other provisional remedies against the debtor; prohibit the debtor from selling, encumbering, transferring or disposing in any manner any of its properties except in the ordinary course of business; and prohibit the debtor from making any payment of its liabilities outstanding as of the commencement date except as may be provided herein.39 34. What is the rationale of a Stay Order? A Stay Order is a recognition that all assets of a corporation under rehabilitation are held in trust for the equal benefit of all creditors under the doctrine of “equality is equity.” As all the creditors, secured or unsecured, ought to stand on equal footing, not any one of them should be paid ahead of others. No creditor should obtain an advantage or preference over another by the expediency of foreclosure, attachment, execution or otherwise.40 Furthermore, the stay order will enable the Rehabilitation Receiver to effectively exercise its or his powers free from judicial or extrajudicial interference that might unduly hinder or prevent the “rescue” of the distressed company, rather than to waste its/his time, effort and resources in defending claims against the corporation. This is precisely the reason for suspending all pending claims against the corporation under receivership. This is also called the “pari passu principle.”41 Under FRIA, a Stay Order is included in the Commencement Order. ’’Section 16. "Negros Navigation Company v. Court of Appeals, G.R. Nos. 163156 and 166845, December 10, 2008, reiterated in Abrera v. Hon. Barza, supra. 41BAR 2006; 2008. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 460 35. What claims are suspended by the Stay Order? Claim shall refer to all claims or demands of whatever nature or character against the debtor or its property, whether for money or otherwise, liquidated or unliquidated, fixed or contingent, matured or unmatured, disputed or undisputed, including, but not limited to: (1) all claims of the government, whether national or local, including taxes, tariffs and customs duties; and (2) claims against directors and officers of the debtor arising from acts done in the discharge of their functions falling within the scope of their authority: Provided, that, this inclusion does not prohibit the creditors or third parties from filing cases against the directors and officers acting in their personal capacities.4* 36. PA Assurance (PA) was incorporated in 1980 to engage in the sale of pre-need educational plans. It sold open-ended educational plans which guaranteed the payment of tuition and other fees to planholders irrespective of the cost at the time of availment. It also engaged in the sale of fixed value plans which guaranteed the payment of a pre-determined amount to planholders. In 1982, PA was among the country's top corporations. However, it subsequently suffered financial difficulties. On September 8, 2005, PA filed a Petition for Corporate Rehabilitation before the RTC of Makati City. On October 17, 2005, 10 plan holders filed an Opposition and Motion to Exclude Planholders from Stay Order on the ground that planholders are not creditors as they (planholders) have a trust relationship with PA. Are the planholders correct? No. The planholders are not correct. On November 21, 2000, the Court approved the Interim Rules of Procedure on Corporate Rehabilitation of 2000 (Interim Rules), which took effect on December 15, 2000. The Interim Rules apply to petitions for rehabilitation filed by corporations, partnerships, and associations pursuant to P.D. No. 902-A, as amended. Under the Interim Rules, “claim” shall include “all claims or demands of whatever nature or character against the debtor or its property, whether for money or otherwise.” “Creditor” shall mean “any holder of a claim.” Hence, the claim of the planholders from PA is included in the definition of “claims” under the Interim Rules.43 42Section 4(c). 43BAR 2014. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) ("FRIA") 461 37. Cite examples of claims that were enjoined as a result of the issuance of a Stay Order. a. The claim of a passenger against an airline company for missing luggage is a money claim or a financial demand that the law requires to be suspended upon issuance of a Stay Order.44 b. Unpaid security services.46 C. Claim under a pre-need educational plan.46 d. Claims against the distressed corporation whether for damages founded on a breach of contract of carriage, collection suits or any other claims of a pecuniary nature.47 e. Labor claims of employees48 except when filed with the NLRC, which is a quasi-judicial agency, which upon determination by the court, is capable of resolving the claim more quickly, fairly and efficiently than the court: Provided, that any final and executory judgment of such agency shall be referred to the court and shall be treated as a non-disputed claim;49 f. Loan secured by mortgages. 38, Does the suspension of actions and/or claims cover only cases pending in court? No, the suspension of all actions and/or claims against a corporation under rehabilitation does not only cover cases which are pending in court. The automatic suspension of an action for claims embraces all phases of the suit, that is, the entire proceedings of an action or suit and not just the payment of the claims.“ This Supreme Court ruling should now be qualified to exclude appeals pending with the Supreme Court as of commencement date.” “Philippine Airlines v. Court of Appeals, 389 SCRA 589. “Veterans Philippine Scout Security Agency, Inc. v. First Dominion Prime Holdings, Inc., G.R. No. 190907, August 23, 2012. “Abrera v. Hon. Romeo Barza, G.R. No. 171881, September 11,2009. "Molina v. Pacific Plans, G.R. No. 165476, August 15, 2011. “Rubberworld v. NLRC, 336 SCRA 433. “Section 18(b). “Ibid. ’’Section 18(a). J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 462 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II The return of the car subject of the writ of replevin is correct notwithstanding the pendency of the rehabilitation proceedings. This is the necessary consequence of the dismissal of the replevin case for failure to prosecute without prejudice. Upon the dismissal of the replevin case, the writ of seizure, which is merely ancillary in nature, became functus officio and should have been lifted. There was no adjudication on the merits, which means that there was no determination of the issue who has the better right to possess the subject car. Returning the seized vehicle is not an enforcement of a claim against the distressed corporation which must be suspended by virtue of the Stay Order issued by the Rehabilitation Court. The issue in a replevin case is who has a better right of possession. So long as the respondent is not interposing a MONETABY CLAIM, respondent’s prayer for the return of the car subject of the replevin suit is not in any way violative of the Rules on Corporate Rehabilitation.52 Rehabilitation proceedings are summary and non-adversarial in nature, and do not contemplate adjudication of claims that must be threshed out in ordinary court proceedings. The jurisdiction of the Rehabilitation Court is over claims against the debtor that is under rehabilitation, not over claims by the debtor against its own debtors or against third parties. The corporation under rehabilitation must file a separate action against its debtors/insurers to recover whatever claim it may have against them.53 39. ABC Bank extra-judicially foreclosed the real estate mortgage on the property of XYZ Corporation for non-payment of the loan secured by the mortgage. The certificate of sale was thereafter issued. Thereafter, XYZ filed a petition for rehabilitation and obtained a Stay Order. Will the Stay Order have the effect of suspending the consolidation of title to the property after expiration of the redemption period? Since the foreclosure of the mortgage and the issuance of the certificate of sale in favor of the mortgagee were done prior to the “Advent Capital and Medical Corporation v. Young, G.R. No. 183018, August 3, 2011. “Steel Corporation v. Mapfre Insular Insurance Corporation, G.R. No. 201199, October 16, 2013. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 463 appointment of a Rehabilitation Receiver and the issuance of the Stay Order, all the actions taken with respect to the foreclosed mortgage property which were subsequent to the issuance of the Stay Order were not affected by the Stay Order. Thus, after the redemption period expired without the mortgagor redeeming the foreclosed property, the mortgagee becomes the absolute owner of the property and it was within its right to ask for the consolidation of title and the issuance of new title in its favor. The writ of possession procured by the mortgagee despite the subsequent issuance of a stay order in the rehabilitation proceedings instituted is also vahd.54 However, if the foreclosure of the mortgage or attachment of the property of the debtor or any enforcement of claim is done between the filing of the petition and the issuance of the commencement order, such action on the part of the creditors will be set aside, in view of the retroactive effect of the commencement order.55 40. Does the issuance of the Commencement Order and the Stay Order diminish or impair the security or lien of a secured creditor? The issuance of the Commencement Order and the Suspension or Stay Order, and any other provision of this Act, shall not be deemed in any way to diminish or impair the security or lien of a secured creditor, or the value of his Hen or security, except that his right to enforce said security or lien may be suspended during the term of the Stay Order.56 The court, upon motion or recommendation of the Rehabilitation Receiver, may allow a secured creditor to enforce his security or hen, or foreclose upon property of the debtor securing his/its claim, if the said property is not necessary for the rehabilitation of the debtor. The secured creditor and/or the other lien holders shall be admitted to the rehabilitation proceedings only for the balance of his claim, if any.57 “Equitable PCI Bank v. DNG Realty and Development Corporation. 627 SCRA 125; reiterated in Town and Country Enterprises, Inc. v. Quisumbing, G.R. No. 173610, October 1, 2012. “Supra. “Section 18(b). “Section 60. 1 J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 464 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 41. Are the effects of the commencement order and the stay order on the suspension of rights to foreclose or otherwise pursue legal remedies applicable to government financial institutions? Yes, notwithstanding the provisions in their charters or other laws to the contrary.48 42. What cases/instances Suspension Order? are not covered by the Stay or The Stay or Suspension Order shall not apply: a. to cases already pending appeal in the Supreme Court as of commencement date: Provided, that any final and executory judgment arising from such appeal shall be referred to the court for appropriate action;69 b. subject to the discretion of the court, to cases pending or filed at a specialized court or quasi-judicial agency which, upon determination by the court, is capable of resolving the claim more quickly, fairly and efficiently than the court: Provided, that any final and executory judgment of such court or agency shall be referred to the court and shall be treated as a non-disputed claim;“ c. to the enforcement of claims against sureties and other persons solidarily liable with the debtor, and third party or accommodation mortgagors as well as issuers of letters of credit, unless the property subject of the third party or accommodation mortgage is necessary for the rehabilitation of the debtor as determined by the court upon recommendation by the Rehabilitation Receiver;61 It was held that the issuance of a stay order did not prevent a Regional Trial Court from acquiring jurisdiction over a guarantor who has waived the benefit of excussion.62 58Section 20. “Section 18(a). “Section 18(b). 61Section 18(c). “Trade and Investment Development Corporation v. Philippine Veterans Bank, G.R. No. 233850, July 1, 2019. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FR1A") 465 d. to any form of action of customers or clients of a securities market participant to recover or otherwise claim moneys and securities entrusted to the latter in the ordinary course of the latter’s business as well as any action of such securities market participant or the appropriate regulatory agency or self-regulatory organization to pay or settle such claims or liabilities;63 e. to the actions of a licensed broker or dealer to sell pledged securities of a debtor pursuant to a securities pledge or margin agreement for the settlement of securities transactions in accordance with the provisions of the Securities Regulation Code and its implementing rules and regulations;131 f. the clearing and settlement of financial transactions through the facilities of a clearing agency or similar entities duly authorized, registered and/or recognized by the appropriate regulatory agency like the Bangko Sentral ng Pilipinas (BSP) and the SEC as well as any form of actions of such agencies or entities to reimburse themselves for any transactions settled for the debtor;66 and g- any criminal action against the individual debtor or owner, partner, director or officer of a debtor shall not be affected by any proceeding commenced under FRIA.K It was held that the suspension of claims in corporate rehabilitation does not extend to criminal actions against the distressed corporations or its directors and officers. It would be absurd for one who has engaged in criminal conduct to escape punishment simply because the corporation of which he is director or officer filed a petition for rehabilitation. The prosecution of the officers of the corporation has no bearing on the pending rehabilitation of the corporation.67 “Section 18(d). “Section 18(e). “Section 18(f). “Section 18(g). “Panlilio v. Regional Trial Court, Branch 51, City of Manila, G.R. No. 17384G, February 2, 2011. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 466 The stay order shall likewise not cover the payment of administrative expenses as they become due.™ Similarly, the property' of the surety cannot be taken into custody b.v the Rehabilitation Receiver.69 43. ABC Company filed a Petition for Rehabilitation with the Court. An Order was issued by the Court, (1) staying enforcement of all claims, whether money or otherwise against ABC Company, its guarantors and sureties not solidarily liable with the company; and (2) prohibiting ABC Company from making payments of its liabilities, outstanding as of the date of the filing of the Petition. XYC Company is a holder of an irrevocable Standby Letter of Credit which was previously procured by ABC Company in favor of XYC Company to secure performance of certain obligations. In the light of the Order issued by the Court, can XYC Company still be able to draw on their irrevocable Standby Letter of Credit when due? Explain your answer. Yes, as an exception to a Stay or Suspension Order included in a Commencement Order issued pursuant to the FRIA”. Under Section 18(c) of FRIA, a Stay or Suspension Order shall not apply “to the enforcement of claims against sureties and other persons solidarily liable with the debtor, and third party or accommodation mortgagors as well as issuers of letters of credit x x x.” Similarly, assuming that it has not been superseded by the FRIA, Section 7(b) of the Supreme Court Rules of Procedure on Corporate Rehabilitation provides that a stay order shall not cover claims against letters of credit and similar security arrangements issued by a third party to secure the payment of the debtor’s obligations. 44. What are the administrative expenses not covered by the Stay Order? Administrative expenses shall refer to those reasonable and necessary expenses: a. incurred or arising from the filing of a petition under the provisions of FRIA; “Section 16(1). “MWSS v. Hon. Daway, 432 SCRA 559. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 45. 467 b. arising from, or in connection with, the conduct of the proceedings under FRIA, including those incurred for the rehabilitation or liquidation of the debtor; C. incurred in the ordinary course of business of the debtor after the commencement date; d. for the payment of new obligations obtained after the commencement date to finance the rehabilitation of the debtor; e. incurred for the fees of the Rehabilitation Receiver or liquidator and of the professionals engaged by them; and f. that are otherwise authorized or mandated under this Act or such other expenses as may be allowed by the Supreme Court in its rules.70 Debtor Corporation and its principal stockholders filed with the Regional Trial Court a petition for rehabilitation. The objective was for the RTC to take control of the corporation and all its assets and liabilities, earnings and operations and rehabilitating the company for the benefit of investors and creditors. Generally, the unsecured creditors had manifested will­ ingness to cooperate with Debtor Corporation. The secured creditors, however, expressed serious objections and reserva­ tions. First Bank had already initiated judicial foreclosure proceedings on the mortgage constituted on the factory of Debtor Corporation. Second Bank had already initiated foreclosure proceed­ ings on a third-party mortgage constituted on certain assets of the principal stockholders. Third Bank had already filed a suit against the principal stockholders who had held themselves liable jointly and severally for the loans of Debtor Corporation with said Bank. After examining the petition, the Rehabilitation Court directed the appointment of a Rehabilitation Receiver and I J9JC9B0M ’’Section 4(a). J9JC9B0M 468 DMNA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II issued a Commencement Order which included a Stay Order. The Stay Order directed the suspension of all actions and claims against the Debtor Corporation as well as against the principal stockholders. a. Discuss the validity of the RTC order of suspension. b. Discuss the effects of the RTC order of suspension on the judicial foreclosure proceedings initiated by First Bank. c. Would the order of suspension have any legal effect on the foreclosure proceedings initiated by Second Bank? Explain. d. Would the order of suspension have any effect on the suit filed by Third Bank? Explain. e. What measures may the receiver take to preserve the assets of Debtor Corporation? Answers: a. The RTC Order of Suspension of Payments is valid with respect to the debtor corporation, but not with respect to the principal stockholders. Group filing of petition for rehabilitation is allowed only if the debtors refer to: (1) corporations that are financially related to one another as parent corporations, subsidiaries or affiliates; (2) partnerships that are owned more than 50% by the same person; and (3) single proprietorships that are owned by the same person.” b. The RTC Order of Suspension of Payments suspended the judicial proceedings initiated by First Bank. Under the principle of equality is equity, all creditors, secured or unsecured, stand in equal footing. Thus, the Suspension Order applies to secured creditors and to the action to enforce the security against the corporation regardless of the stage thereof. c. Under Section 18 of FRIA, the Suspension Order shall not apply to the enforcement of claims against sureties and other persons solidarily liable with the debtor, and third ’’Section 4(n). 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 469 party or accommodation mortgagors as well as issuers of letter of credit, unless the property subject of the third party or accommodation mortgage is necessary for the rehabilitation of the debtor as determined by the court upon the recommendation of the Rehabilitation Receiver. Whether or not the suspension order then will stay the foreclosure of the Second Bank will depend on whether the mortgaged properties are needed for the rehabilitation of the Debtor Corporation. d. For the same reason as in (c), the Order of Suspension of Payments does not cover the suit filed by Third Bank against the principal stockholders. e. To preserve the assets of the Debtor Corporation, the receiver may take custody of, and control over, all the existing assets and property of the corporation; evaluate existing assets and liabilities, earnings and operations of the corporation; and determine the best way to salvage and protect the interest of the investors and creditors.72 46. Is the issuance of a Stay Order (as part of the Commencement Order) appealable? No, the effectivity period of a Stay Order is only “from the date of its issuance until dismissal of the petition or termination of the rehabilitation proceedings.” It is not a final disposition of the case. It is an interlocutory order defined as one that «does not finally dispose of the case, and does not end the Court’s task of adjudicating the parties’ contentions and determining then- rights and liabilities as regards each other, but obviously indicates that other things remain to be done by the Court.”73 As such, the order is not appealable. iv. Rehabilitation Receiver 47. Who is a Rehabilitation Receiver? Rehabilitation Receiver shall refer to the person or persons, natural or juridical, appointed as such by the court pursuant to the J9JC9B0M 721999 Bar Exam but modified and answered based on FRIA. ,3Pryce Corporation, supra. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 470 provisions of FRIA and which shall be entrusted with such powers and duties as set forth in the law.74 Who may serve as a Rehabilitation Receiver? 48. Any qualified natural or juridical person may serve as a Rehabilitation Receiver: Provided, that if the Rehabilitation Receiver is a juridical entity, it must designate a natural person/s who possess/es all the qualifications and none of the disqualifications as its representative, it being understood that the juridical entity and the representative/s are solidarity liable for all obligations and responsibilities of the Rehabilitation Receiver.76 49. What are the powers, duties and responsibilities of the Rehabilitation Receiver? The Rehabilitation Receiver shall be deemed an officer of the court with the principal duty of preserving and maximizing the value of the assets of the debtor during the rehabilitation proceedings, determining the viability of the rehabilitation of the debtor, preparing and recommending a Rehabilitation Plan to the court, and implementing the approved Rehabilitation Plan. To this end, and without limiting the generality of the foregoing, the Rehabilitation Receiver shall have the following powers, duties and responsibilities: a. To verify the accuracy of the factual allegations in the petition and its annexes; b. To verify and correct, if necessary, the inventory of all of the assets of the debtor, and their valuation; c. To verify and correct, if necessary, the schedule of debts and liabilities of the debtor; d. To evaluate the validity, genuineness and true amount of all the claims against the debtor; e. To take possession, custody and control, and to presene the value of all the property of the debtor; f. To sue and recover, with the approval of the court, all amounts owed to, and all properties pertaining to the debtor; ’’Section 4(hh). ’^Section 28. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 471 g- To have access to all information necessary, proper or relevant to the operations and business of the debtor and for its rehabilitation; h. To sue and recover, with the approval of the court, all property or money of the debtor paid, transferred or disbursed in fraud of the debtor or its creditors, or which constitute undue preference of creditor/s; i. To monitor the operations and the business of the debtor to ensure that no payments or transfers of property are made other than in the ordinary course of business; j. With the court’s approval, to engage the services of or to employ persons or entities to assist him in the discharge of his functions; k. To determine the manner by which the debtor may be best rehabilitated, to review, revise and/or recommend action on the Rehabilitation Plan and submit the same or a new one to the court for approval; 1. To implement the Rehabilitation Plan as approved by the court, if so provided under the Rehabilitation Plan; m. To assume and exercise the powers of management of the debtor, if directed by the court pursuant to Section 36 hereof; n. To exercise such other powers as may, from time to time, be conferred upon him by the court; and o. To submit a status report on the rehabilitation proceed­ ings every quarter or as may be required by the court motu proprio, or upon motion of any creditor, or as may be provided, in the Rehabilitation Plan. Unless appointed by the court, pursuant to Section 36 hereof, the Rehabilitation Receiver shall not take over the management and control of the debtor but may recommend the appointment of a management committee over the debtor in the cases provided by law.’6 ■ ’'Section 31. i i J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 472 DI VINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 50. Is the court bound by the report of the Rehabilitation Receiver? No. The determination of the validity and the approval of the rehabilitation plan is not the responsibility of the Rehabilitation Receiver, but remains the function of the court. The Rehabilitation Receiver’s duty prior to the court’s approval of the plan is to study the best way to rehabilitate the debtor, and to ensure that the value of the debtor’s properties is reasonably maintained; and after approval, to implement the Rehabilitation Plan. Notwithstanding the credentials of the court-appointed Rehabilitation Receiver, the duty to determine the feasibility of the rehabilitation of the debtor rests with the court. While the court may consider the receiver’s report favorably recommending the debtor’s rehabilitation, it is not bound thereby if, in its judgment, the debtor’s rehabilitation is not feasible.” Management Committee 51. When may the court appoint a Management Committee? Upon motion of any interested party, the court may appoint a Management Committee that will undertake the management of the debtor, upon clear and convincing evidence of any of the following circumstances: 52. a. Actual or imminent danger of dissipation, loss, wastage or destruction of the debtor’s assets or other properties; b. Paralyzation of the business operations of the debtor; or c. Gross mismanagement of the debtor, or fraud or other wrongful conduct on the part of, or gross or willful violation of FRIA by, existing management of the debtor or the owner, partner, director, officer or representative/s in management of the debtor.’8 What is the role of the Management Committee? When appointed pursuant to the foregoing section, the management committee shall take the place of the management ’’Philippine Asset Growth Two, Inc. and Planters Development Bank v. Fastech Synergy Philippines, Inc., et al., G.R. No. 206528, June 28, 2016. ’“Section 36. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 473 and the governing body of the debtor and assume their rights and responsibilities. The specific powers and duties of the management committee, whose members shall be considered as officers of the court, shall be prescribed by the procedural rules.79 53, Does the act of the corporation in waiving its option to lease a property without receiving any consideration therefor resulting in lost income constitute a valid ground for the appointment of a Receiver or a Management Committee? Applicants for the appointment of a Receiver or Management Committee need to establish the confluence of these two requisites. This is because appointed Receivers and Management Committees will immediately take over the management of the corporation and will have the management powers specified in law. This may have a negative effect on the operations and affairs of the corporation with third parties, as persons who are more familiar with its operations are necessarily dislodged from their positions in favor of appointees who are strangers to the corporation’s operations and affairs. The act of the corporation in waiving its option to lease a property without receiving any consideration therefor resulting in lost income in the form of goodwill money and rental payments is enough to constitute loss or dissipation of assets. YYao an ivuoyvnuviiv, however, icinuu oiiv/vv that an uiLdb there LliULC was iv show failed to Respondent, imminent danger of paralysis of the corporation’s business operations. He, therefore, failed to show at least one of the requisites for appointment of a Receiver or Management Committee.80 vi. 54. Rehabilitation Plan What is a Rehabilitation Plan? Rehabilitation Plan shall refer to a plan by which the financial well-being and viability of an insolvent debtor can be restored using various means including, but not limited to, debt forgiveness, debt rescheduling, reorganization or quasi-reorganization, dacion m pago, debt-equity conversion and sale of the business (or parts 79Section 37. “Alfredo Villamor, Jr. v. John Umale, G.R. Nos. 172834 and 172881, September 24,2014. ! J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M -17-1 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II of it) as a going concern, or setting-up of new business entity as prescribed in Section 62 of FRIA, or other similar arrangements as may be approved by the court or creditors.81 55. What are the contents of a Rehabilitation Plan? The Rehabilitation Plan shall, as a minimum: a. specify the underlying assumptions, the financial goals and the procedures proposed to accomplish such goals; b. compare the amounts expected to be received by the creditors under the Rehabilitation Plan with those that they' will receive if liquidation ensues within the next 120 days; c. contain information sufficient to give the various classes of creditors a reasonable basis for determining whether supporting the Plan is in their financial interest when compared to the immediate liquidation of the debtor, including any reduction of principal interest and penalties payable to the creditors; d. establish classes of voting creditors; e. establish subclasses of voting creditors if prior approval has been granted by the court; f. indicate how the insolvent debtor will be rehabilitated including, but not limited to, debt forgiveness, debt rescheduling, reorganization or quasi-reorganization, dacion en pago, debt-equity conversion and sale of the business (or parts of it) as a going concern, or setting-up of a new business entity or other similar arrangements as may be necessary to restore the financial well-being and viability of the insolvent debtor; g- specify the treatment of each class or subclass described in subsections (d) and (e); h. provide for equal treatment of all claims within the same class or subclass, unless a particular creditor voluntarily agrees to less favorable treatment; “‘Section 4(ii). J9JC9B0M 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) 475 i. ensure that the payments made under the plan follow the priority established under the provisions of the Civil Code on concurrence and preference of credits and other applicable laws; j- maintain the security interest of secured creditors and preserve the liquidation value of the security unless such has been waived or modified voluntarily; k. disclose all payments to creditors for pre-commencement debts made during the proceedings and the justifications thereof; 1. describe the disputed claims and the provisioning of funds to account for appropriate payments should the claim be ruled valid or its amount adjusted; m. identify the debtor’s role in the implementation of the Plan; n. state any rehabilitation covenants of the debtor, the breach of which shall be considered a material breach of the Plan; o. identify those responsible for the future management of the debtor and the supervision and implementation of the Plan, their affiliation with the debtor and their remuneration; P- address the treatment of claims arising after the confirmation of the Rehabilitation Plan; q- require the debtor and its counter-parties to adhere to the terms of all contracts that the debtor has chosen to confirm; r. arrange for the payment of all outstanding administrative expenses as a condition to the Plan’s approval unless such condition has been waived in writing by the creditors concerned; s. arrange for the payment of all outstanding taxes and assessments, or an adjusted amount pursuant to a compromise settlement with the BIR or other applicable tax authorities; t. include a certified copy of a certificate of tax clearance or evidence of a compromise settlement with the BIR; J9JC9B0M 476 56. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II U. include a valid and binding resolution of a meeting of the debtor’s stockholders to increase the shares by the required amount in cases where the Plan contemplates an additional issuance of shares by the debtor; V. state the compensation and status, if any, of the Rehabilitation Receiver after the approval of the Plan; and w. contain provisions for conciliation and/or mediation as a prerequisite to court assistance or intervention in the event of any disagreement in the interpretation or implementation of the Rehabilitation Plan.82 What are the characteristics of an economically feasible Rehabilitation Plan? In the case of Viva Shipping Lines, Inc. v. Keppel Philippines Mining, Inc., the Court took note of the characteristics of an economically feasible Rehabilitation Plan. a. The debtor has assets that can generate more cash if used in its daily operations than if sold. b. Liquidity issues can be addressed by a practicable business plan that will generate enough cash to sustain daily operations. c. The debtor has a definite source of financing for the proper and full implementation of a Rehabilitation Plan that is anchored on realistic assumptions and goals. The Court upheld the dismissal of petitioner’s Rehabilitation Plan because its assets are non-performing; its vessels were no longer serviceable which reduces the probability that rehabilitation may restore and reinstate petitioner to its former position of successful operation and solvency; and, the plan of selling properties of petitioner’s sister company to generate cash flow cannot be a basis for the approval of the Rehabilitation Plan because the plan still requires the conformity from the sister company and even if the two companies have the same directorship and ownership, they are still two separate juridical entities.88 “Section 62. “Viva Shipping Lines, Inc. v. Keppel Philippines Mining, Inc., G.R. No. 177382, February 17,2016. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) ("FRIA") The Court also enumerated Rehabilitation Plan that is infeasible: 57. the characteristics 477 of a a. the absence of a sound and workable business plan; b. baseless and unexplained assumptions, targets and goals; c. speculative capital infusion or complete lack thereof for the execution of the business plan; d. cash flow cannot sustain daily operations; and e. negative net worth and the assets are near full depreciation or fully depreciated.84 What does liquidation analysis, as an integral part of the Rehabilitation, mean? It means that the Rehabilitation Plan should contain any analysis showing that given the various stakeholders of the insolvent debtor-shareholders, creditors, the state, it is better to rehabilitate the debtor than to carry out its liquidation and that the present value recovery is better if the debtor continues as a going concern than if the debtor is to go under liquidation within 120 days from filing of the petition. Present value recovery acknowledges that, in order to pave way for rehabilitation, the creditor will not be paid by the debtor when the credit falls due. The court may order a Suspension of Payments to set a Rehabilitation Plan in motion; in the meantime, the creditor remains unpaid. By the time the creditor is paid, the financial and • economic conditions will have been changed. Money paid in the past has a different value in the future. It is unfair if the creditor merely receives the face value of the debt. Present value of the credit takes into account the interest that the amount of money would have earned if the creditor were paid on time.86 58. What does material financial commitment mean as a condition for the approval of the Rehabilitation Plan? The failure of the Rehabilitation Plan to state any material financial commitment to support rehabilitation, as well as to include J9JC9B0M “Philippine Asset Growth Two v. Fastech Synergy Philippines, ibid. aIbid. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 478 a liquidation analysis, translates to the conclusion that the RTC’s stated considerations for approval, are actually unsubstantiated, and hence, insufficient to decree the debtor’s rehabilitation. A material financial commitment gauges the resolve, determination, earnestness and good faith of the distressed corporation in financing the proposed Rehabilitation Plan. The commitment may include the voluntary undertakings of the stockholders or the would-be investors of the debtor indicating their readiness, willingness and ability to contribute funds or property to guarantee the continued successful operation of the debtor during the period of rehabilitation. As case law intimates, nothing short of legally binding investment commitment/s from third parties is required to qualify as a material financial commitment.86 The following cases are illustrative. a. The Rehabilitation Plan should be denied if the debtor avers that it will not require the infusion of additional capital but only proposes to have all accrued penalties, charges and interest waived and reduced interest rate prospectively applied to all its obligations without any concrete plan to build on debtor’s beleaguered financial position through substantial investment. Anathema to the true purpose of rehabilitation, a distressed corporation cannot be restored to its former position of successful operation and regain solvency by the sole strategy of delaying payments/waiving accrued interests and penalties at the expense of the creditors.87 b. The Rehabilitation Plan should be dismissed if the only proposed source of revenue the plan suggests is the capital which would come from the company’s potential investors, which negotiations are merely pending.88 c. A commitment to add working capital appeared to be doubtful considering that the insurance claim from “BPI Family Savings Bank v. St. Michael Medical Center, Inc., G.R. No. 205469, March 25, 2015. 87Philippine Asset Growth Two v. Fastech Synergy Philippines, G.R. No. 206528, June 28,2016. “BPI Family Savings Bank v. St. Michael Medical Center, G.R. No. 205469, March 25, 2015. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO, 10142) (“FRIA”) 479 which said working capital would be sourced had already been written-off and a claim that has been written-off is considered a bad debt or a worthless asset, and cannot be deemed a material financial commitment for purposes of rehabilitation.89 59, d. A proposal to enter into the dacion. en. pago to create a source of “fresh capital” is also not feasible because the object thereof would not be its own property but one belonging to its affiliate, a corporation also undergoing rehabilitation.80 e. At Rehabilitation Plan which is heavily, if not completely predicated on speculative business proposals as well as the contingent entry of the potential foreign investor lacks the requirement of material financial commitment.91 What are the effects of the confirmation by the court of the Rehabilitation Plan? The confirmation of the Rehabilitation Plan by the court shall result in the following: a. The Rehabilitation Plan and its provisions shall be binding upon the debtor and all persons who may be affected by it, including the creditors, whether or not such persons have participated in the proceedings or opposed the Rehabilitation Plan or whether or not their claims have been scheduled; b. The debtor shall comply with the provisions of the Rehabilitation Plan and shall take all actions necessary to carry out the Plan; c. Payments shall be made to the creditors in accordance with the provisions of the Rehabilitation Plan; d. Contracts and other arrangements between the debtor and its creditors shall be interpreted as continuing to “Philippine Bank of Communication v. Basic Polyprinters, supra. "Ibid. ’'Metropolitan Bank and Trust Co. v. Fortuna Paper Mill & Packaging Corpo­ ration, G.R. No. 190800, November 7, 2018 J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 480 apply to the extent that they do not conflict with the provisions of the Rehabilitation Plan; e. Any compromises on amounts or rescheduling of timing of payments by the debtor shall be binding on creditors regardless of whether or not the Plan is successfully implemented; and f. Claims arising after approval of the Plan that are otherwise not treated by the Plan are not subject to any Suspension Order. The Order confirming the Plan shall comply with Rule 36 of the Rules of Court: Provided, however, that the court may maintain jurisdiction over the case in order to resolve claims against the debtor that remain contested and allegations that the debtor has breached the Plan.92 60. When may the rehabilitation proceedings be terminated? The rehabilitation proceedings under Chapter II shall, upon motion by any stakeholder or the rehabilitation receiver, be terminated by order of the court either declaring a successful implementation of the Rehabilitation Plan or a failure of rehabilitation. There is failure of rehabilitation in the following cases: a. Dismissal of the petition by the court; b. The debtor fails to submit a Rehabilitation Plan; c. Under the Rehabilitation Plan submitted by the debtor, there is no substantial likelihood that the debtor can be rehabilitated within a reasonable period; d. The Rehabilitation Plan or its amendment is approved by the court but in the implementation thereof, the debtor fails to perform its obligations thereunder, or there is a failure to realize the objectives, targets or goals set forth therein, including the timelines and conditions for the settlement of the obligations due to the creditors and other claimants; “Section 69. r 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA") 61. 481 e. The commission of fraud in securing the approval of the Rehabilitation Plan or its amendment; and f. Other analogous circumstances as may be defined by the rules of procedure.93 What are the results of the termination of the rehabilitation proceedings? Termination of the proceedings shall result in the following: a. The discharge of the Rehabilitation Receiver, subject to his submission of a final accounting; and b. The lifting of the Stay Order and any other court order holding in abeyance any action for the enforcement of a claim against the debtor. Provided, however, that if the termination of proceedings is due to failure of rehabilitation or dismissal of the petition for reasons other than technical grounds, the proceedings shall be immediately converted to liquidation.94 vii. Cram-down effect 62. What is the Cram-down clause of a Rehabilitation Plan? This means that a Rehabilitation Plan may be approved by the Court even over the opposition of the creditors holding a majority of the corporation’s total liabilities if there is a showing that rehabilitation is feasible and the opposition of the creditors is manifestly unreasonable. Also known as the “cram-down” clause, this provision, which is currently incorporated in the FRIA, is necessary to curb the majority creditors’ natural tendency to dictate their own terms and conditions to the rehabilitation, absent due regard to the greater long-term benefit of all stakeholders. Otherwise stated, it forces the creditors to accept the terms and conditions of the Rehabilitation Plan, preferring long-term viability over immediate but incomplete recovery.96 “Section 74. “Section 75. “Bank of the Philippine Islands v. Sarabia Manor Hotel Corporation, G.R. No. 175844, July 29, 2013. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M •182 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 63. Sarabia is a corporation engaged in the business of owning, leasing, managing and/or operating hotels. It obtained loans from Far East Bank and Trust Company (FEBTC) in order to finance the construction of a five (5)-storey hotel building (New Building) for the purpose of expanding its hotel business. The foregoing debts were secured by real estate mortgages over several parcels of land owned by Sarabia and a comprehensive surety agreement signed by its stockholders. By virtue of a merger. Bank of the Philippine Islands (BPI) assumed all of FEBTC's rights against Sarabia. Largely because of the delayed completion of the New Building, Sarabia incurred various cash flow problems. Thus, despite the fact that it had more assets than liabilities at that time, it, nevertheless, filed a Petition] for corporate rehabilitation. After hearing, the RTC rendered judgment approving the Rehabilitation Plan which was affirmed by the Court of Appeals. BPI filed the petition with the Supreme Court. BPI mainly argues that the approved Rehabilitation Plan did not give due regard to its interests as a secured creditor in view of the imposition of a fixed interest rate of 6.75% p.a. and the extended loan repayment period. May the Rehabilitation Plan be approved and implemented despite the objection of BPI? Yes, based on the Rehabilitation Receiver’s report, Sarabia has the financial capability to undergo rehabilitation; it has the ability to have sustainable profits over a long period of time and the interests of its creditors are well-protected. Therefore, based on the above-stated reasons, the Court finds Sarabia’s rehabilitation to be feasible. While the Rehabilitation Court shall consider certain incidents in determining whether the opposition is manifestly unreasonable, BPI neither proposes Sarabia’s liquidation over its rehabilitation nor questions the controlling interest of Sarabia’s shareholders or owners. Il only takes exception to: (a) the imposition of the fixed interest rate of 6.75% p.a. as recommended by the Receiver and as approved by the courts a quo, proposing that the original escalating interest rates of 7%, 8%, 10%, 12%, and 14%, over 17 years be r 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) ("FKIA”) 483 applied instead. It must be pointed out that oppositions which push for high interest rates are generally frowned upon in rehabilitation proceedings given that the inherent purpose of a rehabilitation is to find ways and means to minimize the expenses of the distressed corporation during the rehabilitation period. It is the objective of a rehabilitation proceeding to provide the best possible framework for the corporation to gradually regain or achieve a sustainable operating form. Hence, if a creditor, whose interests remain wellpreserved under the existing Rehabilitation Plan, still declines to accept interests pegged at reasonable rates during the period of rehabilitation, and, in turn, proposes rates which are largely counter-productive to the rehabilitation, then it may be said that the creditor’s opposition is manifestly unreasonable. In this case, the Court finds BPI’s opposition on the approved interest rate to be manifestly unreasonable considering that: (a) the 6.75% p.a. interest rate already constitutes a reasonable rate of interest which is concordant with Sarabia’s projected rehabilitation; and (b) on the contrary, BPI’s proposed escalating interest rates remain hinged on the theoretical assumption of future fluctuations in the market, this notwithstanding the fact that its interests as a secured creditor remain well-preserved. In another case, the Court upheld a Rehabilitation Plan, including those terms which its creditors had found objectionable, namely, the 50% “haircut” reduction of the principal obligations and the condonation of accrued interests and penalty charges. There is nothing unreasonable or onerous about the 50% reduction of the principal amount when, as found by the court a quo, a Special Purpose Vehicle (SPV) acquired the credits of the debtor from its creditors at deep discounts of as much as 85%. Meaning, the debtor’s creditors accepted only 15% of their credit’s value. Stated otherwise, if the debtor’s creditors are in a position to accept 15% of their credit’s value, with more reason that they should be able to accept 50% thereof as full settlement by their debtor.96 While the voice and participation of the creditors is crucial in the determination of the viability of the Rehabilitation Plan, as they “Puerto Azul Land v. Pacific Wide Realty Development Corporation, G.R. No. 184000, September 17, 2014. J9JC9B0M J9JC9B0M 484 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II stand to benefit or suffer in the implementation thereof, the interest of all stakeholders is the ultimate and prime consideration.9’ d. 64. Liquidation What is the objective of liquidation of juridical debtors? To resolve and adjust competing claims and property rights of the creditors and the debtor, maximize asset recovery of the debtor and equitably distribute the debtor’s properties to the creditors based on the rules on concurrence and preference of credit. 65. What is the objective of voluntary liquidation of an individual debtor? The objective is to be discharged from his obligations and to start afresh. i. 66. Types What are the types of liquidation proceedings? Liquidation proceedings may be voluntary or involuntary. Voluntary liquidation is initiated by the insolvent debtor whereas involuntary liquidation is commenced by the creditor/s of the insolvent debtor. 67. Distinguish voluntary from involuntary liquidation of individual debtors. In voluntary liquidation, it is the debtor himself who files the petition for insolvency, while in involuntary liquidation, a creditor or group of creditors are the ones who file the petition for liquidation against the insolvent debtor. In voluntary liquidation, the filing of the petition is by itself the act of insolvency whereas in involuntary liquidation filed by creditor/s against the individual, the latter must have committed an act of insolvency. ’’Marilyn Victorio-Aquino v. Pacific Plans, Inc. and Mamerto A. Marcelo, Jr. (Court-Appointed Rehabilitation Receiver of Pacific Plans, Inc.), G.R. No. 193108, December 10, 2014. A 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) ("FRIA”) 485 The required amount of debt for the debtor to file the petition for voluntary liquidation should exceed P500,000 whereas in involuntary liquidation, the creditor/s claims should be at least P500,000. 68. Distinguish Payments. Petition for Liquidation from Suspension of The distinctions are as follows: In Liquidation, the liabilities of the debtor are more than his assets, while in Suspension of Payments, assets of the debtor are more than his liabilities but that the debtor foresees the impossibility of paying his debts as they fall due. In Liquidation, the assets of the debtor are to be converted into cash for distribution among his creditors, while in Suspension of Payments, the debtor is only asking for time within which to convert his frozen assets into liquid cash with which to pay his obligations when the latter fall due. There is discharge in Voluntary Liquidation of individual debtor but there is no discharge in Suspension of Payments. The court order in Petition for Suspension of Payments does not include secured creditors whereas in Petition for Liquidation, foreclosure proceedings shall not be allowed for a period of 180 days from issuance of the Liquidation Order. 69. Under what conditions may an insolvent juridical debtor file a petition for Voluntary Liquidation? A juridical insolvent debtor may apply for liquidation by filing a Petition for Liquidation with the court. The petition shall be verified, shall establish the insolvency of the debtor and shall contain, whether as an attachment or as part of the body of the petition: J9JC9B0M a. a schedule of the debtor’s debts and liabilities including a list of creditors with their addresses, amounts of claims and collaterals, or securities, if any; b. an inventory of all its assets including receivables and claims against third parties; and c. the names of at least three (3) nominees to the position of liquidator. J9JC9B0M DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II •186 At any time during the pendency of court-supervised or pre­ negotiated rehabilitation proceedings, the debtor may also initiate liquidation proceedings by filing a motion in the same court where the rehabilitation proceedings are pending to convert the rehabilitation proceedings into liquidation proceedings. The motion shall be verified, shall contain or set forth the same matters required in the preceding paragraph, and state that the debtor is seeking immediate dissolution and termination of its corporate existence. If the petition or the motion, as the case may be, is sufficient in form and substance, the court shall issue a Liquidation Order.® 70. Under what conditions may the creditors of a juridical insolvent debtor file a Petition for Involuntary Liquidation? Three (3) or more creditors the aggregate of whose claims is at least either Pl,000,000.00 or at least 25% of the subscribed capital stock or partner’s contributions of the debtor, whichever is higher, may apply for and seek the liquidation of an insolvent debtor by filing a petition for liquidation of the debtor with the court. The petition shall show that: a. there is no genuine issue of fact or law on the claim/s of the petitioner/s, and that the due and demandable payments thereon have not been made for at least 180 days or that the debtor has failed generally to meet its liabilities as they fall due; and b. there is no substantial likelihood that the debtor may be rehabilitated. At any time during the pendency of or after a Rehabilitation Court supervised or pre-negotiated rehabilitation proceedings, three (3) or more creditors whose claims is at least either Pl,000,000.00 or at least 25% of the subscribed capital or partner’s contributions of the debtor, whichever is higher, may also initiate liquidation proceedings by filing a motion in the same court where the rehabilitation proceedings are pending to convert the rehabilitation proceedings into liquidation proceedings. The motion shall be verified, shall contain or set forth the same matters required in the preceding paragraph, and state that the movants are seeking the immediate liquidation of the debtor. “Section 90. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) ("FRIA”) 487 If the petition or motion is sufficient in form and substance, the court shall issue an Order: a. directing the publication of the petition or motion in a newspaper of general circulation once a week for two (2) consecutive weeks; and b. directing the debtor and all creditors who are not the petitioners to file their comment on the petition or motion within 15 days from the date of last publication. If, after considering the comments filed, the court determines that the petition or motion is meritorious, it shall issue the Liquidation Order." 71. Is the issuance of an order, declaring a petitioner in a Voluntary liquidation proceeding insolvent, mandatory upon the court? Assuming that the petition was in due form and substance and that the assets of the petitioner are less than his liabilities, the court must adjudicate the insolvency.100 ii. Conversion of rehabilitation to liquidate proceed­ ings 72. When may the court convert Rehabilitation proceedings to Liquidation proceedings? During the pendency of court-supervised or pre-negotiated rehabilitation proceedings, the court may order the conversion of rehabilitation proceedings to liquidation proceedings pursuant to: (a) Section 25(c) of the Act; or (b) Section 72 of the Act; or (c) Section 75 of the Act; or (d) Section 90 of the Act; or at any other time upon the recommendation of the Rehabilitation Receiver that the rehabilitation of the debtor is not feasible. Thereupon, the court shall issue the Liquidation Order.101 Specifically, the court may convert the rehabilitation proceed­ ings to liquidation proceedings in the following cases: J9JC9B0M 1 a. Within ten (10) days from receipt of the report of the Rehabilitation Receiver, the court may convert the "Section 91. 100BAR 1991. I01Section 92. J9JC9B0M 488 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II proceedings into one for the liquidation of the debtor upon a finding that: i. the debtor is insolvent; and ii. there is no substantial likelihood for the debtor to be successfully rehabilitated as determined in accor­ dance with the rules promulgated by the Supreme Court.102 b. If no Rehabilitation Plan is confirmed within a maximum period of one year from date of filing of the petition, the proceedings may, upon motion or motu propria, be converted into one for the liquidation of the debtor.'03 c. Termination of proceedings due to failure of rehabilitation or dismissal of the petition for reasons other than technical grounds, in which case the rehabilitation proceedings shall be immediately converted to liquidation.'04 d. At any time during the pendency of court-supervised or pre-negotiated rehabilitation proceedings, the debtor may also initiate liquidation proceedings by filing a motion in the same court where the rehabilitation proceedings are pending to convert the rehabilitation proceedings into liquidation proceedings. The motion shall be verified, shall contain or set forth the same matters required in the preceding paragraph, and state that the debtor is seeking immediate dissolution and termination of its corporate existence. If the petition or the motion, as the case may be, is sufficient in form and substance, the court shall issue a Liquidation Order. e. A any other time upon the recommendation of the Rehabilitation Receiver that the rehabilitation of the debtor is not feasible. It was held that the remedy of rehabilitation should be denied to corporations whose insolvency appears to be irreversible and whose sole purpose is to delay the '“Section 25. '“Section 72. ""Section 75. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA") 489 enforcement of any of the rights of the creditors, which is rendered obvious by: (a) the absence of a sound and workable business plan; (b) baseless and unexplained assumptions, targets, and goals; and (c) speculative capital infusion or complete lack thereof for the execution of the business plan.106 73. When may an individual debtor file a petition for Voluntary Liquidation? An individual debtor whose properties are not sufficient to cover his liabilities, and owing debts exceeding P500,000.00, may apply to be discharged from his debts and liabilities by filing a verified petition with the court of the province or city in which he has resided for six (6) months prior to the filing of such petition. He shall attach to his petition a schedule of debts and liabilities and an inventory of assets. The filing of such petition shall be an act of insolvency.106 If the court finds the petition sufficient in form and substance, it shall, within five (5) working days, issue the Liquidation Order.11" 74. A debtor who has been adjudged insolvent is given his discharge by the court after his properties have been applied to his debts. A year later, with those debts still not fully paid, he wins in the sweepstakes and comes into a large fortune. His creditors sue him for the balance. Would the suit prosper? Reasons. The suit will not prosper on debts that are properly discharged in insolvency. Those that are not discharged, assuming that a discharge can be obtained, include: J9JC9B0M a. Taxes and assessments due the government, national or local; b. Obligation arising from embezzlement or fraud; c. Obligations of any person liable to the insolvent debtor for the same debt; ■“Philippine Asset Growth Two v. Fastech Synergy, supra. ‘“Section 103. ‘“’Section 104. J9JC9B0M 490 75. DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II d. Alimony or claim for support; e. In general, debts that are not provable against the estate of the insolvent or not listed in the schedule submitted by the insolvent debtor.108 When may a creditor or group of creditors file a Petition for Liquidation? Any creditor or group of creditors with a claim of, or with claims aggregating, at least P500,000.00 may file a verified petition for liquidation with the court of the province or city in which the individual debtor resides. The following shall be considered acts of insolvency, and the Petition for Liquidation shafi set forth or allege at least one of such acts: a. That such person is about to depart or has departed from the Republic of the Philippines, with intent to defraud his creditors; b. That being absent from the Republic of the Philippines, with intent to defraud his creditors, he remains absent; c. That he conceals himself to avoid the service of legal process for the purpose of hindering or delaying the liquidation or of defrauding his creditors; d. That he conceals, or is removing, any of his property to avoid its being attached or taken on legal process; e. That he has suffered his property to remain under attachment or legal process for three (3) days for the purpose of hindering or delaying the liquidation or of defrauding his creditors; f. That he has confessed or offered to allow judgment in favor of any creditor or claimant for the purpose of hindering or delaying the liquidation or of defrauding any creditor or claimant; g- That he has willfully suffered judgment to be taken against him by default for the purpose of hindering or delaying the liquidation or of defrauding his creditors; 108BAR 1988. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRlA’j 491 h. That he has suffered or procured his property to be taken on legal process with intent to give a preference to one or more of his creditors and thereby hinder or delay the liquidation or defraud any one of his creditors; i. That he has made any assignment, gift, sale, conveyance or transfer of his estate, property, rights or credits with intent to hinder or delay the liquidation or defraud his creditors; ]• That he has, in contemplation of insolvency, made any payment, gift, grant, sale, conveyance or transfer of his estate, property, rights or credits; k. That being a merchant or tradesman, he has generally defaulted in the payment of his current obligations for a period of 30 days; 1. That for a period of 30 days, he has failed, after demand, to pay any moneys deposited with him or received by him in a fiduciary capacity; and m. That an execution having been issued against him on final judgment for money, he shall have been found to be without sufficient property subject to execution to satisfy the judgment.109 76. "X" owner of a general merchandise store, departed from the Philippines with intent to defraud her creditors and has remained absent from the country. While she has liabilities totaling P100,000, her assets, however, are worth P120,000. May "X" be declared an insolvent? Reason. Yes, X may be declared insolvent. Under FRIA, although the debtor has more than sufficient property to pay all his creditors, yet if she would commit any act of insolvency, she should be declared insolvent through a petition for involuntary liquidation. One of the acts of insolvency out of the 13 enumerated by the Insolvency Law, is: that being absent from the Philippines, with intent to defraud his/her creditors, he/she remains absent. J9JC9B0M '“Section 105. J9JC9B0M 492 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II 77. Juan opened a coffee shop using money borrowed from financial institutions. After three (3) months, Juan left for the USA with the intent of defrauding his creditors. While his liabilities are PI.2 M, his assets, however are worth P1.5 M. May Juan be declared insolvent? No. Juan may not be declared insolvent if he was the one who filed the Petition for Liquidation because his assets worth Pl.5 M are more than his liabilities worth Pl.2 M. However, his creditors may file a petition for involuntary liquidation since he committed an act of insolvency.110 iii. 78. Liquidation Order What are the contents of a Liquidation Order? The Liquidation Order shall: a. declare the debtor insolvent; b. order the liquidation of the debtor and, in the case of a juridical debtor, declare it as dissolved; c. order the sheriff to take possession and control of all the property of the debtor, except those that may be exempt from execution; d. order the publication of the petition or motion in a newspaper of general circulation once a week for two (2) consecutive weeks; e. direct payments of any claims and conveyance of any property due the debtor to the liquidator; f. prohibit payments by the debtor and the transfer of any property by the debtor; g- direct all creditors to file their claims with the liquidator within the period set by the rules of procedure; h. authorize the payment of administrative expenses as they become due; i. state that the debtor and creditors who are not petitioner/s may submit the names of other nominees to the position of liquidator; and ““BAR 1998. 2. FINANCIAL REHABILITATION AND INSOLVENCY ACT OF 2010 (R.A. NO. 10142) (“FRIA”) j. 493 set the case for hearing for the election and appointment of the liquidator, which date shall not be less than 30 days nor more than 45 days from the date of the last publication.111 79. What are the effects of the issuance of the Liquidation Order? Upon the issuance of the Liquidation Order: a. the juridical debtor shall be deemed dissolved and its corporate or juridical existence terminated; b. legal title to and control of all the assets of the debtor, except those that may be exempt from execution, shall be deemed vested in the liquidator or, pending his election or appointment, with the court; c. all contracts of the debtor shall be deemed terminated and/ or breached, unless the liquidator, within 90 days from the date of his assumption of office, declares otherwise and the contracting party agrees; d. no separate action for the collection of an unsecured claim shall be allowed. Such actions already pending will be transferred to the Liquidator for him to accept and settle or contest. If the liquidator contests or disputes the claim, the court shall allow, hear and resolve such contest except when the case is already on appeal. In such a case, the suit may proceed to judgment, and any final and executory judgment therein for a claim against the debtor shall be filed and allowed in court; and e. no foreclosure proceeding shall be allowed for a period of 180 days.112 iv. Rights of secured creditors 60. Does a Liquidation Order affect the right of a secured creditor? The Liquidation Order shall not affect the right of a secured creditor to enforce his lien in accordance with the applicable contract or law. A secured creditor may: ■ i J9JC9B0M “■Section 112. ‘“Section 113. J9JC9B0M 494 DIVINA ON COMMERCIAL LAW: A COMPREHENSIVE GUIDE VOLUME II a. waive his rights under the security or lien, prove his claim in the liquidation proceedings and share in the distribution of the assets of the debtor; or b. maintain his rights under his security or lien. If the secured creditor maintains his rights under the security or lien: a. the value of the property may be fixed in a manner agreed upon by the creditor and the liquidator. When the value of the property is less than the claim it secures, the liquidator may convey the property to the secured creditor and the latter will be admitted in the liquidation proceedings as a creditor for the balance; if its va